Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. DSP56307 OVERVIEW 1 SIGNAL/CONNECTION DESCRIPTIONS 2 MEMORY CONFIGURATION 3 CORE CONFIGURATION 4 GENERAL-PURPOSE INPUT/OUTPUT 5 HOST INTERFACE (HI08) 6 ENHANCED SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL INTERFACE 7 SERIAL COMMUNICATION INTERFACE 8 TIMER MODULE 9 ENHANCED FILTER COPROCESSOR 10 ON-CHIP EMULATION MODULE 11 JTAG PORT 12 BOOTSTRAP PROGRAM A EQUATES B BSDL LISTING C EFCOP PROGRAMMING D PROGRAMMING REFERENCE E Not Recommended for New Design I INDEX For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 24-Bit Digital Signal Processor User’s Manual Motorola, Incorporated Semiconductor Products Sector 6501 William Cannon Drive West Austin, TX 78735-8598 Not Recommended for New Design For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. This document (and other documents) can be viewed on the World Wide Web at http://www.motorola-dsp.com. This manual is one of a set of three documents. You need the following manuals to have complete product information: Family Manual, User’s Manual, and Technical Data. OnCE is a trademark of Motorola, Inc. Intel is a registered trademark of the Intel Corporation. All other trademarks are those of their respective owners. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... MOTOROLA INC., 1998 Reg. U.S. Pat. & Tm. Off. Order this document by DSP56307UM/D. Rev. 0, 08/10/98 Motorola reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products herein to improve reliability, function, or design. Motorola does not assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit described herein; neither does it convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Motorola products are not authorized for use as components in life support devices or systems intended for surgical implant into the body or intended to support or sustain life. Buyer agrees to notify Motorola of any such intended end use whereupon Motorola shall determine availability and suitability of its product or products for the use intended. are registered trademarks of Motorola, Inc. Motorola, Inc. is an Equal Motorola and Employment Opportunity /Affirmative Action Employer. Not Recommended for New Design For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... TABLE OF CONTENTS SECTION 1 OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1 1.1 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3 1.2 MANUAL ORGANIZATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3 1.3 MANUAL CONVENTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4 1.4 FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6 1.5 CORE DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7 1.6 DSP56300 CORE FUNCTIONAL BLOCKS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7 1.6.1 Data ALU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8 1.6.1.1 Data ALU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8 1.6.1.2 Multiplier-Accumulator (MAC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8 1.6.2 Address Generation Unit (AGU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9 1.6.3 Program Control Unit (PCU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9 1.6.4 PLL and Clock Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11 1.6.5 JTAG TAP and OnCE Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11 1.6.6 On-Chip Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 1.6.7 Off-Chip Memory Expansion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 1.7 INTERNAL BUSES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13 1.8 BLOCK DIAGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14 1.9 DMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15 1.10 ARCHITECTURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15 1.10.1 GPIO Functionality. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15 1.10.2 HI08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16 1.10.3 ESSI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16 1.10.4 SCI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17 1.10.5 Timer Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17 1.10.6 EFCOP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18 SECTION 2 SIGNAL/CONNECTION DESCRIPTIONS. . . . . . . . 2-1 2.1 SIGNAL GROUPINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 2.2 POWER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 2.3 GROUND . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 2.4 CLOCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com i Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 2.5 2.6 2.6.1 2.6.2 2.6.3 2.7 2.8 2.9 2.10 2.11 2.12 2.13 PLL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 EXTERNAL MEMORY EXPANSION PORT (PORT A). . . . . 2-8 External Address Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8 External Data Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 External Bus Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 INTERRUPT AND MODE CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-13 HI08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 ENHANCED SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL INTERFACE 0 . . . 2-22 ENHANCED SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL INTERFACE 1 . . . 2-25 SCI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28 TIMERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30 JTAG AND ONCE INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31 SECTION 3 MEMORY CONFIGURATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1 3.1 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 3.2 PROGRAM MEMORY SPACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 3.2.1 Internal Program Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 3.2.2 Memory Switch Modes—Program Memory . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4 3.2.3 Instruction Cache . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5 3.2.4 Program Bootstrap ROM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5 3.2.5 Accessing External Program Memory. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5 3.3 X DATA MEMORY SPACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5 3.3.1 Internal X Data Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6 3.3.2 Memory Switch Modes—X Data Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6 3.3.3 Internal X I/O Space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7 3.3.4 Accessing External X Data Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7 3.4 Y DATA MEMORY SPACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7 3.4.1 Internal Y Data Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8 3.4.2 Memory Switch Modes—Y Data Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8 3.4.3 Internal Y I/O Space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9 3.4.4 External Y I/O Space. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9 3.4.5 Accessing External Y Data Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10 3.5 DYNAMIC MEMORY CONFIGURATION SWITCHING . . . 3-10 3.6 SIXTEEN-BIT COMPATIBILITY MODE CONFIGURATION 3-11 3.7 MEMORY MAPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11 Not Recommended for New Design ii DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 4 CORE CONFIGURATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1 4.1 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3 4.2 OPERATING MODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3 4.2.1 Mode 0—Expanded Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 4.2.2 Modes 1 to 7: Reserved. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 4.2.3 Mode 8—Expanded Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 4.2.4 Mode 9—Boot from Byte-Wide External Memory . . . . . . . 4-6 4.2.5 Mode A—Boot from SCI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6 4.2.6 Mode B—Reserved . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6 4.2.7 Mode C—Boot from HI08 in ISA Mode (8-Bit Bus) . . . . . . 4-7 4.2.8 Mode D—Boot from HI08 in HC11 Nonmultiplexed Mode. 4-7 4.2.9 Mode E—Boot from HI08 in 8051 Multiplexed Bus Mode . 4-7 4.2.10 Mode F—Boot from HI08: MC68302/68360 Bus Mode . . . 4-8 4.3 BOOTSTRAP PROGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8 4.4 INTERRUPT SOURCES AND PRIORITIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9 4.4.1 Interrupt Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9 4.4.2 Interrupt Priority Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12 4.4.3 Interrupt Source Priorities within an IPL . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 4.5 DMA REQUEST SOURCES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15 4.6 OMR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16 4.7 PLL CONTROL REGISTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 4.7.1 Predivider Factor Bits (PD[3:0])—PCTL Bits 23–20 . . . . 4-17 4.7.2 Clock Output Disable (COD) Bit—PCTL Bit 19 . . . . . . . . 4-17 4.7.3 PLL Enable (PEN) Bit—PCTL Bit 18 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 4.7.4 PLL Stop State (PSTP) Bit—Bit 17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 4.7.5 XTAL Disable (XTLD) Bit—PCTL Bit 16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 4.7.6 Crystal Range (XTLR) Bit—PCTL Bit 15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18 4.7.7 PCTL Bits 14–12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18 4.7.8 PLL Multiplication Factor—PCTL Bits 11–0. . . . . . . . . . . 4-18 4.8 DEVICE IDENTIFICATION REGISTER (IDR) . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18 4.9 ADDRESS ATTRIBUTE REGISTERS (AAR1–AAR4) . . . . . 4-19 4.10 JTAG IDENTIFICATION (ID) REGISTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19 4.11 JTAG BOUNDARY SCAN REGISTER (BSR) . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com iii Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... SECTION 5 GENERAL-PURPOSE INPUT/OUTPUT . . . . . . . . . 5.1 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 PROGRAMMING MODEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.1 Port B Signals and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.2 Port C Signals and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.3 Port D Signals and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.4 Port E Signals and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2.5 Triple Timer Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1 5-3 5-3 5-3 5-3 5-4 5-4 5-4 SECTION 6 HOST INTERFACE (HI08) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1 6.1 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3 6.2 HI08 FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3 6.2.1 Host-to-DSP Core Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3 6.2.2 HI08 to Host Processor Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4 6.3 HI08 HOST PORT SIGNALS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6 6.4 HI08 BLOCK DIAGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7 6.5 HI08—DSP-SIDE PROGRAMMER’S MODEL . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8 6.5.1 Host Receive Data Register (HRX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9 6.5.2 Host Transmit Data Register (HTX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9 6.5.3 Host Control Register (HCR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9 6.5.3.1 HCR Host Receive Interrupt Enable (HRIE) Bit 0 . . . 6-10 6.5.3.2 HCR Host Transmit Interrupt Enable (HTIE) Bit 1 . . . 6-10 6.5.3.3 HCR Host Command Interrupt Enable (HCIE) Bit 2 . . 6-10 6.5.3.4 HCR Host Flags 2, 3 (HF[3:2]) Bits 3, 4 . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10 6.5.3.5 HCR Reserved Bits 5–15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11 6.5.4 Host Status Register (HSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11 6.5.4.1 HSR Host Receive Data Full (HRDF) Bit 0 . . . . . . . . 6-11 6.5.4.2 HSR Host Transmit Data Empty (HTDE) Bit 1 . . . . . . 6-11 6.5.4.3 HSR Host Command Pending (HCP) Bit 2 . . . . . . . . 6-11 6.5.4.4 HSR Host Flags 0, 1 (HF[1:0]) Bits 3, 4 . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12 6.5.4.5 HSR Reserved Bits 5–15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12 6.5.5 Host Base Address Register (HBAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12 6.5.5.1 HBAR Base Address (BA[10:3]) Bits 0–7 . . . . . . . . . . 6-12 6.5.5.2 HBAR Reserved Bits 8–15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12 6.5.6 Host Port Control Register (HPCR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13 6.5.6.1 HPCR Host GPIO Port Enable (HGEN) Bit 0 . . . . . . . 6-13 Not Recommended for New Design iv DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 6.5.6.2 HPCR Host Address Line 8 Enable (HA8EN) Bit 1. . . 6-14 6.5.6.3 HPCR Host Address Line 9 Enable (HA9EN) Bit 2. . . 6-14 6.5.6.4 HPCR Host Chip Select Enable (HCSEN) Bit 3 . . . . . 6-14 6.5.6.5 HPCR Host Request Enable (HREN) Bit 4 . . . . . . . . . 6-14 6.5.6.6 HPCR Host Acknowledge Enable (HAEN) Bit 5 . . . . . 6-14 6.5.6.7 HPCR Host Enable (HEN) Bit 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15 6.5.6.8 HPCR Reserved Bit 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15 6.5.6.9 HPCR Host Request Open Drain (HROD) Bit 8 . . . . . 6-15 6.5.6.10 HPCR Host Data Strobe Polarity (HDSP) Bit 9. . . . . . 6-15 6.5.6.11 HPCR Host Address Strobe Polarity (HASP) Bit 10 . . 6-15 6.5.6.12 HPCR Host Multiplexed Bus (HMUX) Bit 11 . . . . . . . . 6-15 6.5.6.13 HPCR Host Dual Data Strobe (HDDS) Bit 12 . . . . . . . 6-16 6.5.6.14 HPCR Host Chip Select Polarity (HCSP) Bit 13 . . . . . 6-16 6.5.6.15 HPCR Host Request Polarity (HRP) Bit 14 . . . . . . . . . 6-16 6.5.6.16 HPCR Host Acknowledge Polarity (HAP) Bit 15 . . . . . 6-17 6.5.7 Host Data Direction Register (HDDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17 6.5.8 Host Data Register (HDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18 6.5.9 DSP-Side Registers after Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19 6.5.10 Host Interface DSP Core Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20 6.6 HI08—EXTERNAL HOST PROGRAMMER’S MODEL . . . . 6-21 6.6.1 Interface Control Register (ICR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-22 6.6.1.1 ICR Receive Request Enable (RREQ) Bit 0 . . . . . . . . 6-23 6.6.1.2 ICR Transmit Request Enable (TREQ) Bit 1. . . . . . . . 6-23 6.6.1.3 ICR Double Host Request (HDRQ) Bit 2. . . . . . . . . . . 6-23 6.6.1.4 ICR Host Flag 0 (HF0) Bit 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24 6.6.1.5 ICR Host Flag 1 (HF1) Bit 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24 6.6.1.6 ICR Host Little Endian (HLEND) Bit 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24 6.6.1.7 ICR Reserved Bit 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24 6.6.1.8 ICR Initialize Bit (INIT) Bit 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24 6.6.2 Command Vector Register (CVR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25 6.6.2.1 CVR Host Vector (HV[6:0]) Bits 0–6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25 6.6.2.2 CVR Host Command Bit (HC) Bit 7. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25 6.6.3 Interface Status Register (ISR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-26 6.6.3.1 ISR Receive Data Register Full (RXDF) Bit 0 . . . . . . . 6-26 6.6.3.2 ISR Transmit Data Register Empty (TXDE) Bit 1 . . . . 6-26 6.6.3.3 ISR Transmitter Ready (TRDY) Bit 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com v Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 6.6.3.4 ISR Host Flag 2 (HF2) Bit 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6.3.5 ISR Host Flag 3 (HF3) Bit 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6.3.6 ISR Reserved Bits 5, 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6.3.7 ISR Host Request (HREQ) Bit 7. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6.4 Interrupt Vector Register (IVR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6.5 Receive Byte Registers (RXH: RXM: RXL). . . . . . . . . . . 6.6.6 Transmit Byte Registers (TXH:TXM:TXL) . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6.7 Host Side Registers after Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6.8 GPIO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7 SERVICING THE HOST INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.1 HI08 Host Processor Data Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.2 Polling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7.3 Servicing Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.8 HI08 PROGRAMMING MODEL—QUICK REFERENCE . . SECTION 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.3.1 7.3.2 7.3.3 7.3.4 7.3.5 7.3.6 7.4 7.4.1 7.4.1.1 7.4.1.2 7.4.1.3 7.4.1.4 7.4.1.5 7.4.1.6 7.4.1.7 7.4.1.8 6-27 6-27 6-27 6-27 6-28 6-28 6-29 6-30 6-30 6-31 6-31 6-31 6-33 6-34 7 ENHANCED SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 ENHANCEMENTS TO THE ESSI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 ESSI DATA AND CONTROL SIGNALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 Serial Transmit Data Signal (STD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 Serial Receive Data Signal (SRD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 Serial Clock (SCK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5 Serial Control Signal (SC0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6 Serial Control Signal (SC1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7 Serial Control Signal (SC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8 ESSI PROGRAMMING MODEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9 ESSI Control Register A (CRA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11 CRA Prescale Modulus Select PM[7:0] Bits 7–0 . . . . 7-11 CRA Reserved Bits 8–10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11 CRA Prescaler Range (PSR) Bit 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11 CRA Frame Rate Divider Control DC[4:0] Bits 16–12 7-12 CRA Reserved Bit 17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13 CRA Alignment Control (ALC) Bit 18 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13 CRA Word Length Control (WL[2:0]) Bits 21–19 . . . . 7-14 CRA Select SC1 (SSC1) Bit 22 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14 Not Recommended for New Design vi DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 7.4.1.9 7.4.2 7.4.2.1 7.4.2.1.1 7.4.2.1.2 7.4.2.2 7.4.2.3 7.4.2.4 7.4.2.5 7.4.2.6 7.4.2.7 7.4.2.8 7.4.2.9 7.4.2.10 7.4.2.11 7.4.2.12 7.4.2.13 7.4.2.14 7.4.2.15 7.4.2.16 7.4.2.17 7.4.2.18 7.4.2.19 7.4.2.20 7.4.2.21 7.4.2.22 7.4.2.23 7.4.3 7.4.3.1 7.4.3.2 7.4.3.3 7.4.3.4 7.4.3.5 7.4.3.6 7.4.3.7 7.4.3.8 CRA Reserved Bit 23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14 ESSI Control Register B (CRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15 CRB Serial Output Flags (OF0, OF1) Bits 0, 1 . . . . . . 7-15 CRB Serial Output Flag 0 (OF0) Bit 0 . . . . . . . . . . 7-15 CRB Serial Output Flag 1 (OF1) Bit 1 . . . . . . . . . . 7-16 CRB Serial Control Direction 0 (SCD0) Bit 2 . . . . . . . 7-16 CRB Serial Control Direction 1 (SCD1) Bit 3 . . . . . . . 7-16 CRB Serial Control Direction 2 (SCD2) Bit 4 . . . . . . . 7-16 CRB Clock Source Direction (SCKD) Bit 5 . . . . . . . . . 7-16 CRB Shift Direction (SHFD) Bit 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-17 CRB Frame Sync Length FSL[1:0] Bits 7 and 8 . . . . . 7-17 CRB Frame Sync Relative Timing (FSR) Bit 9 . . . . . . 7-17 CRB Frame Sync Polarity (FSP) Bit 10. . . . . . . . . . . . 7-17 CRB Clock Polarity (CKP) Bit 11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-18 CRB Synchronous/Asynchronous (SYN) Bit 12 . . . . . 7-18 CRB ESSI Mode Select (MOD) Bit 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-20 Enabling, Disabling ESSI Data Transmission . . . . . . . 7-22 CRB ESSI Transmit 2 Enable (TE2) Bit 14 . . . . . . . . . 7-22 CRB ESSI Transmit 1 Enable (TE1) Bit 15 . . . . . . . . . 7-23 CRB ESSI Transmit 0 Enable (TE0) Bit 16 . . . . . . . . . 7-24 CRB ESSI Receive Enable (RE) Bit 17. . . . . . . . . . . . 7-25 CRB ESSI Transmit Interrupt Enable (TIE) Bit 18. . . . 7-26 CRB ESSI Receive Interrupt Enable (RIE) Bit 19 . . . . 7-26 Transmit Last Slot Interrupt Enable (TLIE) Bit 20 . . . . 7-26 Receive Last Slot Interrupt Enable (RLIE) Bit 21 . . . . 7-27 Transmit Exception Interrupt Enable (TEIE) Bit 22 . . . 7-27 Receive Exception Interrupt Enable (REIE) Bit 23 . . . 7-27 ESSI Status Register (SSISR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-27 SSISR Serial Input Flag 0 (IF0) Bit 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-27 SSISR Serial Input Flag 1 (IF1) Bit 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-28 SSISR Transmit Frame Sync Flag (TFS) Bit 2 . . . . . . 7-28 SSISR Receive Frame Sync Flag (RFS) Bit 3 . . . . . . 7-28 SSISR Transmitter Underrun Error Flag (TUE) Bit 4 . 7-29 SSISR Receiver Overrun Error Flag (ROE) Bit 5 . . . . 7-29 SSISR ESSI Transmit Data Register Empty (TDE) Bit 67-29 SSISR ESSI Receive Data Register Full (RDF) Bit 7 . 7-29 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com vii Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 7.4.4 ESSI Receive Shift Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4.5 ESSI Receive Data Register (RX). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4.6 ESSI Transmit Shift Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4.7 ESSI Transmit Data Registers (TX0-2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4.8 ESSI Time Slot Register (TSR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4.9 Transmit Slot Mask Registers (TSMA, TSMB) . . . . . . . . 7.4.10 Receive Slot Mask Registers (RSMA, RSMB) . . . . . . . . 7.5 OPERATING MODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.1 ESSI after Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.2 ESSI Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.3 ESSI Exceptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.4 Operating Modes: Normal, Network, and On-Demand . . 7.5.4.1 Normal/Network/On-Demand Mode Selection . . . . . . 7.5.4.2 Synchronous/Asynchronous Operating Modes . . . . . 7.5.4.3 Frame Sync Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.4.3.1 Frame Sync Signal Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.4.3.2 Frame Sync Length for Multiple Devices . . . . . . . . 7.5.4.3.3 Word Length Frame Sync and Data Word Timing. 7.5.4.3.4 Frame Sync Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.4.4 Byte Format (LSB/MSB) for the Transmitter . . . . . . . 7.5.5 Flags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6 GPIO SIGNALS AND REGISTERS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6.1 Port Control Register (PCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6.2 Port Direction Register (PRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6.3 Port Data Register (PDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-32 7-32 7-32 7-33 7-33 7-33 7-34 7-35 7-35 7-35 7-36 7-39 7-39 7-39 7-40 7-40 7-40 7-41 7-41 7-41 7-42 7-42 7-43 7-44 7-44 SECTION 8 SERIAL COMMUNICATION INTERFACE . . . . . . . 8.1 INTRODUCTION TO THE SCI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.2 SCI I/O SIGNALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.2.1 Receive Data (RXD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.2.2 Transmit Data (TXD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.2.3 SCI Serial Clock (SCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3 SCI PROGRAMMING MODEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3.1 SCI Control Register (SCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3.1.1 SCR Word Select (WDS[0:2]) Bits 0–2 . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3.1.2 SCR SCI Shift Direction (SSFTD) Bit 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1 8-3 8-3 8-3 8-4 8-4 8-4 8-8 8-8 8-9 Not Recommended for New Design viii DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 8.3.1.3 SCR Send Break (SBK) Bit 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9 8.3.1.4 SCR Wakeup Mode Select (WAKE) Bit 5 . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9 8.3.1.5 SCR Receiver Wakeup Enable (RWU) Bit 6. . . . . . . . . 8-9 8.3.1.6 SCR Wired-OR Mode Select (WOMS) Bit 7 . . . . . . . . 8-10 8.3.1.7 SCR Receiver Enable (RE) Bit 8. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10 8.3.1.8 SCR Transmitter Enable (TE) Bit 9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11 8.3.1.9 SCR Idle Line Interrupt Enable (ILIE) Bit 10 . . . . . . . . 8-11 8.3.1.10 SCR SCI Receive Interrupt Enable (RIE) Bit 11 . . . . . 8-12 8.3.1.11 SCR SCI Transmit Interrupt Enable (TIE) Bit 12. . . . . 8-12 8.3.1.12 SCR Timer Interrupt Enable (TMIE) Bit 13 . . . . . . . . . 8-12 8.3.1.13 SCR Timer Interrupt Rate (STIR) Bit 14 . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12 8.3.1.14 SCR SCI Clock Polarity (SCKP) Bit 15 . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12 8.3.1.15 Receive with Exception Interrupt Enable (REIE) Bit 168-13 8.3.2 SCI Status Register (SSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13 8.3.2.1 SSR Transmitter Empty (TRNE) Bit 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13 8.3.2.2 SSR Transmit Data Register Empty (TDRE) Bit 1 . . . 8-13 8.3.2.3 SSR Receive Data Register Full (RDRF) Bit 2 . . . . . . 8-14 8.3.2.4 SSR Idle Line Flag (IDLE) Bit 3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14 8.3.2.5 SSR Overrun Error Flag (OR) Bit 4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14 8.3.2.6 SSR Parity Error (PE) Bit 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14 8.3.2.7 SSR Framing Error Flag (FE) Bit 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15 8.3.2.8 SSR Received Bit 8 (R8) Address Bit 7 . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15 8.3.3 SCI Clock Control Register (SCCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15 8.3.3.1 SCCR Clock Divider (CD[11:0]) Bits 11–0 . . . . . . . . . 8-16 8.3.3.2 SCCR Clock Out Divider (COD) Bit 12 . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16 8.3.3.3 SCCR SCI Clock Prescaler (SCP) Bit 13 . . . . . . . . . . 8-17 8.3.3.4 SCCR Receive Clock Mode Source (RCM) Bit 14 . . . 8-17 8.3.3.5 SCCR Transmit Clock Source Bit (TCM) Bit 15 . . . . . 8-18 8.3.4 SCI Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18 8.3.4.1 SCI Receive Register (SRX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19 8.3.4.2 SCI Transmit Register (STX) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20 8.4 OPERATING MODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-21 8.4.1 SCI after Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-22 8.4.2 SCI Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-24 8.4.3 SCI Initialization Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-25 8.4.4 Preamble, Break, and Data Transmission Priority . . . . . . 8-26 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com ix Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 8.4.5 8.5 8.5.1 8.5.2 8.5.3 SCI Exceptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . GPIO SIGNALS AND REGISTERS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port E Control Register (PCRE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port E Direction Register (PRRE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Port E Data Register (PDRE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-26 8-27 8-27 8-27 8-28 SECTION 9 TRIPLE TIMER MODULE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1 9.1 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3 9.2 TRIPLE TIMER MODULE ARCHITECTURE . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3 9.2.1 Triple Timer Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-3 9.2.2 Timer Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4 9.3 TRIPLE TIMER MODULE PROGRAMMING MODEL. . . . . . 9-5 9.3.1 Prescaler Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7 9.3.2 Timer Prescaler Load Register (TPLR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7 9.3.2.1 TPLR Prescaler Preload Value (PL[20:0]) Bits 20–0 . . 9-7 9.3.2.2 TPLR Prescaler Source (PS[1:0]) Bits 22–21 . . . . . . . 9-7 9.3.2.3 TPLR Reserved Bit 23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 9.3.3 Timer Prescaler Count Register (TPCR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 9.3.3.1 TPCR Prescaler Counter Value (PC[20:0]) Bits 20–0 . 9-9 9.3.3.2 TPCR Reserved Bits 23–21 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9 9.3.4 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9 9.3.4.1 Timer Enable (TE) Bit 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9 9.3.4.2 Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable (TOIE) Bit 1 . . . . . . . 9-9 9.3.4.3 Timer Compare Interrupt Enable (TCIE) Bit 2 . . . . . . . 9-9 9.3.4.4 Timer Control (TC[3:0]) Bits 4–7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10 9.3.4.5 Inverter (INV) Bit 8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11 9.3.4.6 Timer Reload Mode (TRM) Bit 9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13 9.3.4.7 Direction (DIR) Bit 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13 9.3.4.8 Data Input (DI) Bit 12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13 9.3.4.9 Data Output (DO) Bit 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13 9.3.4.10 Prescaler Clock Enable (PCE) Bit 15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14 9.3.4.11 Timer Overflow Flag (TOF) Bit 20 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14 9.3.4.12 Timer Compare Flag (TCF) Bit 21 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14 9.3.4.13 TCSR Reserved Bits 3, 10, 14, 16–19, 22, 23 . . . . . . 9-14 9.3.5 Timer Load Register (TLR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14 9.3.6 Timer Compare Register (TCPR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15 Not Recommended for New Design x DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 9.3.7 Timer Count Register (TCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-15 9.4 TIMER MODES OF OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-16 9.4.1 Timer Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-16 9.4.1.1 Timer GPIO (Mode 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-17 9.4.1.2 Timer Pulse (Mode 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-17 9.4.1.3 Timer Toggle (Mode 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-18 9.4.1.4 Timer Event Counter (Mode 3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-19 9.4.2 Signal Measurement Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20 9.4.2.1 Measurement Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20 9.4.2.2 Measurement Input Width (Mode 4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-20 9.4.2.3 Measurement Input Period (Mode 5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-21 9.4.2.4 Measurement Capture (Mode 6) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-22 9.4.3 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM, Mode 7). . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23 9.4.4 Watchdog Modes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24 9.4.4.1 Watchdog Pulse (Mode 9). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24 9.4.4.2 Watchdog Toggle (Mode 10). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24 9.4.5 Reserved Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26 9.4.6 Special Cases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26 9.4.6.1 Timer Behavior during Wait. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26 9.4.6.2 Timer Behavior during Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26 9.4.7 DMA Trigger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-26 SECTION 10 ENHANCED FILTER COPROCESSOR . . . . . . . . 10-1 10.1 INTRODUCTION TO EFCOP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3 10.2 KEY FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3 10.3 GENERAL DESCRIPTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4 10.3.1 PMB Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5 10.3.2 EFCOP Memory Banks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7 10.3.3 Filter Multiplier and Accumulator (FMAC) . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8 10.4 EFCOP PROGRAMMING MODEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9 10.4.1 Filter Data Input Register (FDIR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9 10.4.2 Filter Data Output Register (FDOR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10 10.4.3 Filter K-Constant Input Register (FKIR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10 10.4.4 Filter Count (FCNT) Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10 10.4.5 EFCOP Control Status Register (FCSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11 10.4.6 EFCOP ALU Control Register (FACR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-16 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com xi Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 10.4.7 10.4.8 10.4.9 10.4.10 EFCOP Data Base Address (FDBA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EFCOP Coefficient Base Address (FCBA) . . . . . . . . . . Decimation/Channel Count Register (FDCH) . . . . . . . . EFCOP Interrupt Vectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17 10-18 10-18 10-19 SECTION 11 ON-CHIP EMULATION MODULE. . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-1 11.1 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3 11.2 ONCE MODULE SIGNALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3 11.3 DEBUG EVENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4 11.4 ONCE CONTROLLER. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4 11.4.1 OnCE Command Register (OCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5 11.4.1.1 Register Select (RS4–RS0) Bits 0–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5 11.4.1.2 Exit Command (EX) Bit 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7 11.4.1.3 GO Command (GO) Bit 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7 11.4.1.4 Read/Write Command (R/W) Bit 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7 11.4.2 OnCE Decoder (ODEC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8 11.4.3 OnCE Status and Control Register (OSCR) . . . . . . . . . . 11-8 11.4.3.1 Trace Mode Enable (TME) Bit 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8 11.4.3.2 Interrupt Mode Enable (IME) Bit 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8 11.4.3.3 Software Debug Occurrence (SWO) Bit 2 . . . . . . . . . 11-8 11.4.3.4 Memory Breakpoint Occurrence (MBO) Bit 3 . . . . . . . 11-8 11.4.3.5 Trace Occurrence (TO) Bit 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9 11.4.3.6 Reserved OCSR Bit 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9 11.4.3.7 Core Status (OS0, OS1) Bits 6–7. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9 11.4.3.8 Reserved Bits 8–23 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9 11.5 ONCE MEMORY BREAKPOINT LOGIC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9 11.5.1 OnCE Memory Address Latch (OMAL). . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-11 11.5.2 OnCE Memory Limit Register 0 (OMLR0). . . . . . . . . . . 11-11 11.5.3 OnCE Memory Address Comparator 0 (OMAC0) . . . . . 11-11 11.5.4 OnCE Memory Limit Register 1 (OMLR1). . . . . . . . . . . 11-11 11.5.5 OnCE Memory Address Comparator 1 (OMAC1) . . . . . 11-11 11.5.6 OnCE Breakpoint Control Register (OBCR) . . . . . . . . . 11-11 11.5.6.1 Memory Breakpoint Select (MBS0–MBS1) . . . . . . . 11-12 11.5.6.2 Breakpoint 0 Read/Write Select (RW00–RW01) . . . 11-12 11.5.6.3 Breakpoint 0 Condition Code Select (CC00–CC01). 11-13 11.5.6.4 Breakpoint 1 Read/Write Select (RW10–RW11) . . . 11-13 Not Recommended for New Design xii DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 11.5.6.5 Breakpoint 1 Condition Code Select (CC10–CC11) . 11-14 11.5.6.6 Breakpoint 0 and 1 Event Select (BT0–BT1) . . . . . . 11-14 11.5.6.7 OnCE Memory Breakpoint Counter (OMBC) . . . . . . 11-14 11.5.6.8 Reserved Bits 12–15. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-15 11.6 ONCE TRACE LOGIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-15 11.7 METHODS OF ENTERING DEBUG MODE . . . . . . . . . . . 11-16 11.7.1 External Debug Request during RESET Assertion . . . . 11-16 11.7.2 External Debug Request during Normal Activity . . . . . . 11-16 11.7.3 Executing the JTAG DEBUG_REQUEST Instruction . . 11-17 11.7.4 External Debug Request during Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-17 11.7.5 External Debug Request during Wait . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-17 11.7.6 Software Request during Normal Activity . . . . . . . . . . . 11-17 11.7.7 Enabling Trace Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-18 11.7.8 Enabling Memory Breakpoints. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-18 11.8 PIPELINE INFORMATION AND OGDB REGISTER . . . . . 11-18 11.8.1 OnCE PDB Register (OPDBR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-19 11.8.2 OnCE PIL Register (OPILR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-19 11.8.3 OnCE GDB Register (OGDBR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-19 11.9 TRACE BUFFER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-20 11.9.1 OnCE PAB Register for Fetch (OPABFR) . . . . . . . . . . . 11-20 11.9.2 PAB Register for Decode (OPABDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-20 11.9.3 OnCE PAB Register for Execute (OPABEX) . . . . . . . . . 11-20 11.9.4 Trace Buffer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-21 11.10 SERIAL PROTOCOL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-22 11.11 TARGET SITE DEBUG SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS . . . . 11-23 11.12 EXAMPLES OF USING THE ONCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-23 11.12.1 Checking Whether the Chip Has Entered Debug Mode 11-24 11.12.2 Polling the JTAG Instruction Shift Register . . . . . . . . . . 11-24 11.12.3 Saving Pipeline Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-24 11.12.4 Reading the Trace Buffer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-25 11.12.5 Displaying a Specified Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-26 11.12.6 Displaying X Memory Area Starting at Address $xxxx . 11-26 11.12.7 Returning from Debug to Normal Mode (Same Program)11-27 11.12.8 Returning from Debug to Normal Mode (New Program) 11-28 11.13 EXAMPLES OF JTAG AND ONCE INTERACTION . . . . . 11-28 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com xiii Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 12 JOINT TEST ACTION GROUP PORT . . . . . . . . . 12-1 12.1 INTRODUCTION TO THE JTAG PORT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-3 12.2 JTAG SIGNALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-4 12.2.1 Test Clock (TCK). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5 12.2.2 Test Mode Select (TMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5 12.2.3 Test Data Input (TDI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5 12.2.4 Test Data Output (TDO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5 12.2.5 Test Reset (TRST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-5 12.3 TAP CONTROLLER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6 12.3.1 Boundary Scan Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-7 12.3.2 Instruction Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-7 12.3.2.1 EXTEST (B[3:0] = 0000). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-8 12.3.2.2 SAMPLE/PRELOAD (B[3:0] = 0001) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-9 12.3.2.3 IDCODE (B[3:0] = 0010). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-9 12.3.2.4 CLAMP (B[3:0] = 0011) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-10 12.3.2.5 HI-Z (B[3:0] = 0100) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-10 12.3.2.6 ENABLE_ONCE(B[3:0] = 0110) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-11 12.3.2.7 DEBUG_REQUEST(B[3:0] = 0111) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-11 12.3.2.8 BYPASS (B[3:0] = 1111) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-11 12.4 DSP56300 RESTRICTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-12 12.5 DSP56307 BOUNDARY SCAN REGISTER . . . . . . . . . . . 12-13 APPENDICES: A BOOTSTRAP PROGRAMS B EQUATES C DSP56307 BSDL LISTING D EFCOP PROGRAMMING E PROGRAMMING REFERENCE Not Recommended for New Design xiv DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... LIST OF FIGURES Figure 1-1 DSP56307 Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14 Figure 2-1 Signals Identified by Functional Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Figure 3-1 Memory Switch Off, Cache Off, 24-Bit Mode (default) . . . . . . . 3-12 Figure 3-2 Memory Switch Off, Cache On, 24-Bit Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13 Figure 3-3 Memory Switch On (MSW = 00), Cache Off, 24-Bit Mode . . . . 3-14 Figure 3-4 Memory Switch On (MSW = 00), Cache On, 24-Bit Mode . . . . 3-15 Figure 3-5 Memory Switch On (MSW = 01), Cache Off, 24-Bit Mode . . . . 3-16 Figure 3-6 Memory Switch On (MSW = 01), Cache On, 24-Bit Mode . . . . 3-17 Figure 3-7 Memory Switch On (MSW = 10), Cache Off, 24-Bit Mode . . . . 3-18 Figure 3-8 Memory Switch On (MSW = 10), Cache On, 24-Bit Mode . . . . 3-19 Figure 3-9 Memory Switch On (MSW = 11), Cache Off, 24-Bit Mode . . . . 3-20 Figure 3-10 Memory Switch On (MSW = 11), Cache On, 24-Bit Mode . . . . 3-21 Figure 3-11 Memory Switch Off, Cache Off, 16-Bit Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22 Figure 3-12 Memory Switch Off, Cache On, 16-Bit Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23 Figure 3-13 Memory Switch On (MSW = 00), Cache Off, 16-Bit Mode . . . . 3-24 Figure 3-14 Memory Switch On (MSW = 00), Cache On, 16-Bit Mode . . . . 3-25 Figure 3-15 Memory Switch On (MSW = 01), Cache Off, 16-Bit Mode . . . . 3-26 Figure 3-16 Memory Switch On (MSW = 01), Cache On, 16-Bit Mode . . . . 3-27 Figure 3-17 Memory Switch On (MSW = 10), Cache Off, 16-Bit Mode . . . . 3-28 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com xv Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Figure 3-18 Memory Switch On (MSW = 10), Cache On, 16-Bit Mode . . . . 3-29 Figure 3-19 Memory Switch On (MSW = 11), Cache Off, 16-Bit Mode . . . . 3-30 Figure 3-20 Memory Switch On (MSW = 11), Cache On, 16-Bit Mode . . . . 3-31 Figure 4-1 Interrupt Priority Register C (IPR-C) (X:$FFFFFF). . . . . . . . . . . 4-12 Figure 4-2 Interrupt Priority Register P (IPR-P) (X:$FFFFFE). . . . . . . . . . . 4-12 Figure 4-3 DSP56307 Operating Mode Register (OMR) Format. . . . . . . . . 4-16 Figure 4-4 PLL Control Register (PCTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 Figure 4-5 Identification Register Configuration (Revision 0) . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18 Figure 4-6 Address Attribute Registers (AAR0–AAR3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19 Figure 4-7 JTAG Identification Register Configuration (Revision 0) . . . . . . 4-20 Figure 6-1 HI08 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7 Figure 6-2 Host Control Register (HCR) (X:$FFFFC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9 Figure 6-3 Host Status Register (HSR) (X:$FFFFC3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11 Figure 6-4 Host Base Address Register (HBAR) (X:$FFFFC5). . . . . . . . . . 6-12 Figure 6-5 Self Chip Select Logic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13 Figure 6-6 Host Port Control Register (HPCR) (X:$FFFFC4) . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13 Figure 6-7 Single Strobe Bus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16 Figure 6-8 Dual Strobe Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16 Figure 6-9 Host Data Direction Register (HDDR) (X:$FFFFC8) . . . . . . . . . 6-17 Figure 6-10 Host Data Register (HDR) (X:$FFFFC9) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18 Figure 6-11 HSR-HCR Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20 Figure 6-12 Interface Control Register (ICR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-22 Not Recommended for New Design xvi DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Figure 6-13 Command Vector Register (CVR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25 Figure 6-14 Interface Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-26 Figure 6-15 Interrupt Vector Register (IVR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28 Figure 6-16 HI08 Host Request Structure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32 Figure 7-1 ESSI Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5 Figure 7-2 ESSI Control Register A (CRA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9 Figure 7-3 ESSI Control Register B (CRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9 Figure 7-4 ESSI Status Register (SSISR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9 Figure 7-5 ESSI Transmit Slot Mask Register A (TSMA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10 Figure 7-6 ESSI Transmit Slot Mask Register B (TSMB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10 Figure 7-7 ESSI Receive Slot Mask Register A (RSMA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10 Figure 7-8 ESSI Receive Slot Mask Register B (RSMB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10 Figure 7-9 ESSI Clock Generator Functional Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12 Figure 7-10 ESSI Frame Sync Generator Functional Block Diagram. . . . . . 7-13 Figure 7-11 CRB FSL0 and FSL1 Bit Operation (FSR = 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-19 Figure 7-12 CRB SYN Bit Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-20 Figure 7-13 CRB MOD Bit Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-21 Figure 7-14 Normal Mode, External Frame Sync (8 Bit, 1 Word in Frame) . 7-22 Figure 7-15 Network Mode, External Frame Sync (8 Bit, 2 Words in Frame) 7-23 Figure 7-16 ESSI Data Path Programming Model (SHFD = 0). . . . . . . . . . . 7-30 Figure 7-17 ESSI Data Path Programming Model (SHFD = 1). . . . . . . . . . . 7-31 Figure 7-18 Port Control Register (PCR) (PCRC X:$FFFFBF). . . . . . . . . . . 7-43 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com xvii Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Figure 7-19 Port Direction Register (PRR)(PRRC X:$FFFFBE) . . . . . . . . . . 7-44 Figure 7-20 Port Data Register (PDR) (PDRC X:$FFFFBD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-45 Figure 8-1 SCI Control Register (SCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5 Figure 8-2 SCI Status Register (SSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5 Figure 8-3 SCI Clock Control Register (SCCR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5 Figure 8-5 16 x Serial Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16 Figure 8-6 SCI Baud Rate Generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18 Figure 8-7 SCI Programming Model - Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19 Figure 8-8 Port E Control Register (PCRE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-27 Figure 8-9 Port E Direction Register (PRRE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-28 Figure 8-10 Port E Data Register (PDRE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-29 Figure 9-1 Triple Timer Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4 Figure 9-2 Timer Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5 Figure 9-3 Timer Module Programmer’s Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6 Figure 9-4 Timer Prescaler Load Register (TPLR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7 Figure 9-5 Timer Prescaler Count Register (TPCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 Figure 10-1 EFCOP Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5 Figure 10-2 EFCOP Register Layout. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-5 Figure 10-3 Storage of Filter Coefficients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7 Figure 10-4 EFCOP Memory Organization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8 Figure 11-1 OnCE Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3 Figure 11-2 OnCE Module Multiprocessor Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4 Not Recommended for New Design xviii DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Figure 11-3 OnCE Controller Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5 Figure 11-4 OnCE Command Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5 Figure 11-5 OnCE Status and Control Register (OSCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8 Figure 11-6 OnCE Memory Breakpoint Logic 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-10 Figure 11-7 OnCE Breakpoint Control Register (OBCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-12 Figure 11-8 OnCE Trace Logic Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-15 Figure 11-9 OnCE Pipeline Information and GDB Registers . . . . . . . . . . . 11-19 Figure 11-10 OnCE Trace Buffer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-22 Figure 12-1 TAP Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-4 Figure 12-2 TAP Controller State Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-6 Figure 12-3 JTAG Instruction Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-7 Figure 12-4 JTAG ID Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-9 Figure 12-5 BYPASS Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-11 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com xix Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Not Recommended for New Design xx DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... LIST OF TABLES Table 1-1 High True/Low True Signal Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5 Table 1-2 Available Memory Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 Table 2-1 DSP56307 Functional Signal Groupings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3 Table 2-2 Power Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5 Table 2-3 Grounds. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Table 2-4 Clock Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 Table 2-5 Phase-Locked Loop Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 Table 2-6 External Address Bus Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8 Table 2-7 External Data Bus Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 Table 2-8 External Bus Control Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9 Table 2-9 Interrupt and Mode Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-13 Table 2-10 Host Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16 Table 2-11 Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22 Table 2-12 Enhanced Serial Synchronous Interface 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25 Table 2-13 Serial Communication Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28 Table 2-14 Triple Timer Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30 Table 2-15 OnCE/JTAG Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32 Table 4-1 DSP56307 Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4 Table 4-2 Interrupt Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com xxi Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Table 4-3 Interrupt Priority Level Bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 Table 4-4 Interrupt Source Priorities within an IPL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 Table 4-5 DMA Request Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15 Table 6-1 HI08 Signal Definitions for Various Operational Modes . . . . . . . . 6-6 Table 6-2 HI08 Data Strobe Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6 Table 6-3 HI08 Host Request Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6 Table 6-4 Host Command Interrupt Priority List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10 Table 6-5 HDR and HDDR Functionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18 Table 6-6 DSP Side Registers after Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19 Table 6-7 Host Side Register Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-22 Table 6-8 TREQ and RREQ modes (HDRQ = 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23 Table 6-9 TREQ and RREQ modes (HDRQ = 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23 Table 6-10 INIT Command Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24 Table 6-11 HREQ and HDRQ Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28 Table 6-12 Host Side Registers after Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-30 Table 6-13 Host Control Register (HCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-34 Table 6-14 HI08 Programming Model: DSP Side. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-35 Table 6-15 HI08 Programming Model: Host Side. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-38 Table 7-1 ESSI Clock Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8 Table 7-2 ESSI Word Length Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14 Table 7-3 FSL1 and FSL0 Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-17 Table 7-4 Mode and Signal Definition Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-24 Not Recommended for New Design xxii DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Table 7-5 Port Control Register and Port Direction Register Bits . . . . . . . 7-44 Table 8-1 Word Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8 Table 8-2 TCM and RCM Bit Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17 Table 8-3 SCI Registers after Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-23 Table 8-4 Port Control Register and Port Direction Register Bits . . . . . . . 8-28 Table 9-1 Prescaler Source Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 Table 9-2 Timer Control Bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10 Table 9-3 Inverter (INV) Bit Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11 Table 10-1 EFCOP Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6 Table 10-2 EFCOP Registers and Base Addresses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9 Table 10-3 FCNT Register Bit Descriptions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11 Table 10-4 FCSR Bit Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12 Table 10-5 FACR Bit Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17 Table 10-6 FDCH Register Bit Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20 Table 10-7 EFCOP Interrupt Vectors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21 Table 10-8 EFCOP DMA Request Sources. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-21 Table 11-1 OnCE Register Select Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-6 Table 11-2 EX Bit Definition. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7 Table 11-3 GO Bit Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7 Table 11-4 R/W Bit Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-7 Table 11-5 Core Status Bits Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9 Table 11-6 Memory Breakpoint 0 and 1 Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-12 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com xxiii Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Table 11-7 Breakpoint 0 Read/Write Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-13 Table 11-8 Breakpoint 0 Condition Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-13 Table 11-9 Breakpoint 1 Read/Write Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-13 Table 11-10 Breakpoint 1 Condition Select Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-14 Table 11-11 Breakpoint 0 and 1 Event Select Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-14 Table 11-12 TMS Sequencing for DEBUG_REQUEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-29 Table 11-13 TMS Sequencing for ENABLE_ONCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-30 Table 11-14 TMS Sequencing for Reading Pipeline Registers Table 12-1 JTAG Instructions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-8 Table 12-2 DSP56306 BSR Bit Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-13 . . . . . . . . . 11-30 Not Recommended for New Design xxiv DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... OVERVIEW Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 1-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Overview 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 1.8 1.9 1.10 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-3 MANUAL ORGANIZATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-3 MANUAL CONVENTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-4 FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6 CORE DESCRIPTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7 DSP56300 CORE FUNCTIONAL BLOCKS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7 INTERNAL BUSES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-13 BLOCK DIAGRAM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-14 DMA. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-15 ARCHITECTURE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-15 Not Recommended for New Design 1-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview Introduction 1.1 INTRODUCTION This manual describes the DSP56307 24-bit digital signal processor (DSP), its memory, operating modes, and peripheral modules. The DSP56307 is an implementation of the DSP56300 core with a unique configuration of on-chip memory, cache, and peripherals. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... This manual is to be used with the DSP56300 Family Manual (DSP56300FM/AD), which describes the CPU, core programming models, and instruction set details. DSP56307 Technical Data (DSP56307/D)Ñreferred to as the data sheetÑprovides electrical specifications, timing, pinout, and packaging descriptions of the DSP56307. You can obtain these documents, as well as MotorolaÕs DSP development tools, through a local Motorola Semiconductor Sales Office or authorized distributor. To receive the latest information on this DSP, access the Motorola DSP home page at the address given on the back cover of this document. 1.2 MANUAL ORGANIZATION This manual contains the following sections and appendices: ¥ Section 1 Overview provides a brief description of the DSP56307, including a features list and block diagram, lists related documentation needed to use this chip, and describes the organization of this manual. ¥ Section 2 Signal/Connection Descriptions describes the DSP56307 signals and their functional groupings. ¥ Section 3 Memory Configuration describes the DSP56307 memory spaces, RAM configuration, memory configuration bit settings, memory configurations, and memory maps. ¥ Section 4 Core Configuration describes the registers for configuring the DSP56300 core when programming the DSP56307, in particular the interrupt vector locations and the operation of the interrupt priority registers, and explains the operating modes and how they affect the processorÕs program and data memories. ¥ Section 5 GeneraL-Purpose Input/Output describes the DSP56307 general-purpose input/output (GPIO) capability and the programming model for the GPIO signals (operation, registers, and control). ¥ Section 6 Host Interface (HI08) describes the 8-bit host interface (HI08), including a quick reference to the HI08 programming model. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 1-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview Manual Conventions ¥ Section 7 Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface describes the 24-bit ESSI, which provides two identical full duplex UART-style serial ports for communications with devices such as codecs, DSPs, microprocessors, and peripherals implementing the Motorola serial peripheral interface (SPI) protocol. ¥ Section 8 Serial Communication Interface describes the 24-bit SCI, a full duplex serial port for serial communication to DSPs, microcontrollers, or other peripherals (such as modems or other RS-232 devices). Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Section 9 Triple Timer Module describes the three identical devices that may be used as internals or event counters. ¥ Section 10 Enhanced Filter Coprocessor describes the echo cancellation and filtering coprocessor. ¥ Section 11 On-Chip Emulation Module describes the On-Chip Emulation (OnCEª) module, which is accessed through the joint test action group (JTAG) port. ¥ Section 12 Joint Test Action Group Port describes the specifics of the JTAG port on the DSP56307. ¥ Appendix Overview lists the bootstrap code used for the DSP56307. ¥ Appendix B Equates lists the equates (I/O, HI08, SCI, ESSI, exception processing, timer, direct memory access (DMA), phase-locked loop (PLL), BIU, and interrupts for the DSP56307. ¥ Appendix C DSP56307 BSDL Listing provides the BSDL listing for the DSP56307. ¥ Appendix D EFCOP Programming describes the two types of digital filters supported by the enhanced filter coprocessor (EFCOP) and provides examples of how to use them. ¥ Appendix E Programming Reference lists peripheral addresses, interrupt addresses, and interrupt priorities for the DSP56307 and contains programming sheets listing the contents of the major DSP56307 registers for programmerÕs reference. 1.3 MANUAL CONVENTIONS This manual uses the following conventions: ¥ Bits within registers are always listed from most significant bit (MSB) to least significant bit (LSB). Not Recommended for New Design 1-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview Manual Conventions ¥ Bits within a register are indicated AA[n:m], n > m, when more than one bit is involved in a description. For purposes of description, the bits are presented as if they are contiguous within a register. However, this is not always the case. Refer to the programming model diagrams or to the programmerÕs sheets to see the exact location of bits within a register. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ When a bit is described as Òset,Ó its value is 1. When a bit is described as Òcleared,Ó its value is 0. ¥ The word ÒassertÓ means that a high true (active high) signal is pulled high to VCC or that a low true (active low) signal is pulled low to ground. The word ÒdeassertÓ means that a high true signal is pulled low to ground or that a low true signal is pulled high to VCC. See Table 1-1. Table 1-1 High True/Low True Signal Conventions 1. 2. 3. Signal/Symbol Logic State Signal State Voltage PIN1 True Asserted Ground2 PIN False Deasserted VCC3 PIN True Asserted VCC PIN False Deasserted Ground PIN is a generic term for any pin on the chip. Ground is an acceptable low voltage level. See the appropriate data sheet for the range of acceptable low voltage levels (typically a TTL logic low). VCC is an acceptable high voltage level. See the appropriate data sheet for the range of acceptable high voltage levels (typically a TTL logic high). ¥ Pins or signals that are asserted low (made active when pulled to ground) are indicated like this in text: Ð In text, they have an overbar: for example, RESET is asserted low. Ð In code examples, they have a tilde in front of their names. In Example 1-1, line 3 refers to the SS0 signal (shown as ~SS0). ¥ Sets of signals are indicated by the first and last signals in the set, for instance HA1ÐHA8. ¥ ÒInput/OutputÓ indicates a bidirectional signal. ÒInput or OutputÓ indicates a signal that is exclusively one or the other. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 1-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview Features ¥ Code examples are displayed in a monospaced font, as shown in Example 1-1. Example 1-1 Sample Code Listing BFSET #$0007,X:PCC; Configure: line 1 ; MISO0, MOSI0, SCK0 for SPI master line 2 ; ~SS0 as PC3 for GPIO line 3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Hex values are indicated with a dollar sign ($) preceding the hex value, as follows: $FFFFFF is the X memory address for the core interrupt priority register. ¥ The word ÒresetÓ is used in four different contexts in this manual: 1.4 Ð the reset signal, written as RESET, Ð the reset instruction, written as RESET, Ð the reset operating state, written as Reset, and Ð the reset function, written as reset. FEATURES Motorola developed the DSP56307, a member of the DSP56300 core family of programmable DSPs, to support wireless infrastructure applications with general filtering operations. The on-chip EFCOP processes filter algorithms in parallel with core operation, thus increasing overall DSP performance and efficiency. Like the other family members, the DSP56307 uses a high-performance, single-clock-cycle-per-instruction engine (code compatible with Motorola's popular DSP56000 core family), a barrel shifter, 24-bit addressing, instruction cache, and DMA controller. The DSP56307 offers 100 million instructions per second (MIPS) performance using an internal 100 MHz clock with 2.5 V core and independent 3.3 V input/output (I/O) power. All DSP56300 core family members contain the DSP56300 core and additional modules. The modules are chosen from a library of standard predesigned elements, such as memories and peripherals. New modules may be added to the library to meet customer specifications. A standard interface between the DSP56300 core and the on-chip memory and peripherals supports a wide variety of memory and peripheral configurations. In particular, the DSP56307 includes MotorolaÕs JTAG port as well as MotorolaÕs OnCE module. Not Recommended for New Design 1-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview Core Description The DSP56307, with its large on-chip memory array of 64K words and its EFCOP, is well suited for high-end multichannel telecommunication applications, such as wireless infrastructure, multi-line voice/data/fax processing, video conferencing, and general digital signal processing. 1.5 CORE DESCRIPTION Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Core features are described fully in the DSP56300 Family Manual. (This manual, in contrast, documents pinout, memory, and peripheral features.) ¥ 100 MIPS with a 100 MHz clock at 3.3 V ¥ Object code compatible with the DSP56000 core ¥ Highly parallel instruction set ¥ Large on-chip RAM memory of 64K words ¥ EFCOP running concurrently with the core, capable of executing 100 million filter taps per second at peak performance ¥ Hardware debugging support Ð JTAG test access port (TAP) Ð OnCE module Ð Address trace mode reflects internal accesses at the external port ¥ Reduced power dissipation 1.6 Ð Very low-power CMOS design Ð Wait and stop low-power standby modes Ð Fully-static logic, operation frequency down to 0 Hz (dc) Ð Optimized power-management circuitry (instruction-dependent, peripheral-dependent, and mode-dependent) DSP56300 CORE FUNCTIONAL BLOCKS The DSP56300 core provides the following functional blocks: ¥ Data arithmetic logic unit (ALU) ¥ Address generation unit Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 1-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview DSP56300 Core Functional Blocks ¥ Program control unit ¥ PLL and clock oscillator ¥ JTAG TAP and OnCE module ¥ Memory In addition, the DSP56307 provides a set of on-chip peripherals, shown in Section 1.8. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 1.6.1 Data ALU The data ALU performs all the arithmetic and logical operations on data operands in the DSP56300 core. These are the components of the data ALU: ¥ Fully pipelined 24 × 24-bit parallel multiplier-accumulator ¥ Bit field unit, comprising a 56-bit parallel barrel shifter (fast shift and normalization; bit stream generation and parsing) ¥ Conditional ALU instructions ¥ Software-controllable 24-bit or 16-bit arithmetic support ¥ Four 24-bit input general purpose registers: X1, X0, Y1, and Y0 ¥ Six data ALU registers (A2, A1, A0, B2, B1, and B0) that are concatenated into two general purpose, 56-bit accumulators, A and B, accumulator shifters ¥ Two data bus shifter/limiter circuits 1.6.1.1 Data ALU Registers The data ALU registers can be read or written over the X data bus and the Y data bus as 16- or 32-bit operands. The source operands for the data ALU, which can be 16, 32, or 40 bits, always originate from data ALU registers. The results of all data ALU operations are stored in an accumulator. All the data ALU operations are performed in two clock cycles in pipeline fashion so that a new instruction can be initiated in every clock cycle, yielding an effective execution rate of one instruction per clock cycle. The destination of every arithmetic operation can be used as a source operand for the immediate following operation without penalty. 1.6.1.2 Multiplier-Accumulator (MAC) The MAC unit comprises the main arithmetic processing unit of the DSP56300 core and performs all of the calculations on data operands. In the case of arithmetic instructions, the unit accepts as many as three input operands and outputs one 56-bit result of the Not Recommended for New Design 1-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview DSP56300 Core Functional Blocks following form: extension:most significant product:least significant product (EXT:MSP:LSP). Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The multiplier executes 24-bit × 24-bit, parallel, fractional multiplies between twoÕs-complement signed, unsigned, or mixed operands. The 48-bit product is right-justified and added to the 56-bit contents of either the A or B accumulator. A 56-bit result can be stored as a 24-bit operand. The LSP can either be truncated or rounded into the MSP. Rounding is performed if specified. 1.6.2 Address Generation Unit (AGU) The AGU performs the effective address calculations using integer arithmetic necessary to address data operands in memory and contains the registers that generate the addresses. It implements four types of arithmetic: linear, modulo, multiple wrap-around modulo, and reverse-carry. The AGU operates in parallel with other chip resources to minimize address-generation overhead. The AGU is divided into two halves, each with its own address ALU. Each address ALU has four sets of register triplets, and each register triplet is composed of an address register, an offset register, and a modifier register. The two address ALUs are identical. Each contains a 16-bit full adder (called an offset adder). A second full adder (called a modulo adder) adds the summed result of the first full adder to a modulo value that is stored in its respective modifier register. A third full adder (called a reverse-carry adder) is also provided. The offset adder and the reverse-carry adder work in parallel and share common inputs. The only difference between them is that the carry propagates in opposite directions. Test logic determines which of the three summed results of the full adders is output. Each address ALU can update one address register from its own address register file during one instruction cycle. The contents of the associated modifier register specifies the type of arithmetic to be used in the address register update calculation. The modifier value is decoded in the address ALU. 1.6.3 Program Control Unit (PCU) The PCU performs instruction prefetch, instruction decoding, hardware DO loop control, and exception processing. The PCU implements a seven-stage pipeline and Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 1-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview DSP56300 Core Functional Blocks controls the different processing states of the DSP56300 core. The PCU consists of three hardware blocks: ¥ Program decode controller ¥ Program address generator Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Program interrupt controller The program decode controller decodes the 24-bit instruction loaded into the instruction latch and generates all signals necessary for pipeline control. The program address generator contains all the hardware needed for program address generation, system stack, and loop control. The program interrupt controller arbitrates among all interrupt requests (internal interrupts, as well as the five external requests IRQA, IRQB, IRQC, IRQD, and NMI), and generates the appropriate interrupt vector address. PCU features include the following: ¥ Position-independent code support ¥ Addressing modes optimized for DSP applications (including immediate offsets) ¥ On-chip instruction cache controller ¥ On-chip memory-expandable hardware stack ¥ Nested hardware DO loops ¥ Fast auto-return interrupts The PCU implements its functions using the following registers: ¥ Program counter register ¥ Status register ¥ Loop address register ¥ Loop counter register ¥ Vector base address register ¥ Size register ¥ Stack pointer ¥ Operating mode register ¥ Stack counter register The PCU also includes a hardware system stack. Not Recommended for New Design 1-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview DSP56300 Core Functional Blocks 1.6.4 PLL and Clock Oscillator The clock generator in the DSP56300 core comprises two main blocks: the PLL, which performs clock input division, frequency multiplication, and skew elimination; and the clock generator, which performs low-power division and clock pulse generation. These features allow you to do the following: ¥ Change the low-power divide factor without losing the lock. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Output a clock with skew elimination. The PLL allows the processor to operate at a high internal clock frequency using a low-frequency clock input, a feature that offers two immediate benefits: ¥ A lower-frequency clock input reduces the overall electromagnetic interference generated by a system. ¥ The ability to oscillate at different frequencies reduces costs by eliminating the need to add additional oscillators to a system. 1.6.5 JTAG TAP and OnCE Module The DSP56300 core provides a dedicated user-accessible TAP that is fully compatible with the IEEE 1149.1 Standard Test Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture. Problems associated with testing high-density circuit boards have led to development of this standard under the sponsorship of the Test Technology Committee of IEEE and the JTAG. The DSP56300 core implementation supports circuit-board test strategies based on this standard. The test logic includes a TAP consisting of four dedicated signals, a 16-state controller, and three test data registers. A boundary scan register links all device signals into a single shift register. The test logic, implemented utilizing static logic design, is independent of the device system logic. More information about the JTAG port is provided in Section 12 Joint Test Action Group Port on page 12-1. The OnCE module provides a means of interacting with the DSP56300 core and its peripherals nonintrusively so that a user can examine registers, memory, or on-chip peripherals. This facilitates hardware and software development on the DSP56300 core processor. OnCE module functions are provided through the JTAG TAP signals. More information on the OnCE module is provided in Section 11 On-Chip Emulation Module on page 11-1. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 1-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview DSP56300 Core Functional Blocks 1.6.6 On-Chip Memory Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The memory space of the DSP56300 core is partitioned into program memory space, X data memory space, and Y data memory space. The data memory space is divided into X data memory and Y data memory in order to work with the two address ALUs and to feed two operands simultaneously to the data ALU. Memory space includes internal RAM and ROM and can be expanded off-chip under software control. More information about the internal memory is provided in Section 3 Memory Configuration on page 3-1. Program RAM, instruction cache, X data RAM, and Y data RAM size are programmable, as shown in Table 1-2: Table 1-2 Available Memory Configurations Program RAM Size Instruction Cache Size X Data RAM Size* Y Data RAM Size* Instruction Cache Switch Mode M1 M0 16K × 24-bit 0 24K × 24-bit 24K × 24-bit disabled disabled 0/1 0/1 15K × 24-bit 1024 × 24-bit 24K × 24-bit 24K × 24-bit enabled disabled 0/1 0/1 48K × 24-bit 0 8K × 24-bit 8K × 24-bit disabled enabled 0 0 47K × 24-bit 1024 × 24-bit 8K × 24-bit 8K × 24-bit enabled enabled 0 0 40K × 24-bit 0 12K × 24-bit 12K × 24-bit disabled enabled 0 1 39K × 24-bit 1024 × 24-bit 12K × 24-bit 12K × 24-bit enabled enabled 0 1 32K × 24-bit 0 16K × 24-bit 16K × 24-bit disabled enabled 1 0 31K × 24-bit 1024 × 24-bit 16K × 24-bit 16K × 24-bit enabled enabled 1 0 24K × 24-bit 0 20K × 24-bit 20K × 24-bit disabled enabled 1 1 23K × 24-bit 1024 × 24-bit 20K × 24-bit 20K × 24-bit enabled enabled 1 1 *Includes 4K × 24-bit shared memory (i.e., memory shared by the core and the EFCOP and not accessible by the DMA controller) There is an on-chip 192 x 24-bit bootstrap ROM. 1.6.7 Off-Chip Memory Expansion Memory can be expanded off chip to the following capacities: ¥ Data memory expansion to two 16 M × 24-bit word memory spaces in 24-bit address mode (64K in 16-bit address mode) ¥ Program memory expansion to one 16 M × 24-bit word memory space in 24-bit address mode (64K in 16-bit address mode) Further features of off-chip memory include the following: ¥ External memory expansion port Not Recommended for New Design 1-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview Internal Buses ¥ Simultaneous glueless interface to static RAM (SRAM) and dynamic RAM (DRAM) 1.7 INTERNAL BUSES To provide data exchange between these blocks, the DSP56307 implements the following buses: Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Peripheral I/O expansion bus to peripherals ¥ Program memory expansion bus to program ROM ¥ X memory expansion bus to X memory ¥ Y memory expansion bus to Y memory ¥ Global data bus between PCU and other core structures ¥ Program data bus for carrying program data throughout the core ¥ X memory data bus for carrying X data throughout the core ¥ Y memory data bus for carrying Y data throughout the core ¥ Program address bus for carrying program memory addresses throughout the core ¥ X memory address bus for carrying X memory addresses throughout the core ¥ Y memory address bus for carrying Y memory addresses throughout the core. The block diagram in Figure 1-1 illustrates those buses among other components. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 1-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview Block Diagram 1.8 BLOCK DIAGRAM With the exception of the program data bus, all internal buses on the DSP56300 family members are 24-bit buses. The program data bus is also a 24-bit bus. Figure 1-1 shows a block diagram of the DSP56307. 3 16 6 6 EFCOP Peripheral Expansion Area Address Generation Unit Six Channel DMA Unit YAB XAB PAB DAB Y Data RAM 24K ¥ 24 DDB YDB XDB PDB GDB Internal Data Bus Switch EXTAL XTAL RESET PINIT/NMI X Data RAM 24K ¥ 24 24-Bit DSP56300 Core Bootstrap ROM Clock Generator Program RAM 16K ¥ 24 or (Program RAM 15K ¥ 24 and Instruction Cache 1024 ¥ 24) YM_EB Enhanced Filtering Coprocessor XM_EB ESSI Interface PM_EB Host Interface HI08 Triple Timer SCI Interface PIO_EB Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Memory Expansion Area Program Interrupt Controller PLL 2 Program Decode Controller Program Address Generator External Address Bus Switch External Bus Interface and I - Cache Control External Data Bus Switch Data ALU 24 ¥ 24+56Æ56-bit MAC Two 56-bit Accumulators 56-bit Barrel Shifter MODA/IRQA MODB/IRQB MODC/IRQC MODD/IRQD Power Mngmnt. 18 Address 13 Control 24 Data 5 JTAG OnCE™ DE AA1367 Figure 1-1 DSP56307 Block Diagram Note: See Section 1.6.6 On-Chip Memory on page 1-12 for details about memory size. Not Recommended for New Design 1-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview DMA 1.9 DMA The DMA block has the following features: ¥ Six DMA channels supporting internal and external accesses ¥ One-, two-, and three-dimensional transfers (including circular buffering) ¥ End-of-block-transfer interrupts Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Triggering from interrupt lines and all peripherals 1.10 ARCHITECTURE Motorola designed the DSP56307 to perform a wide variety of fixed-point digital signal processing functions. In addition to the core features previously discussed, the DSP56307 provides the following peripherals: ¥ As many as 34 user-configurable GPIO signals ¥ HI08 to external hosts ¥ Dual ESSI ¥ SCI ¥ Triple timer module ¥ Memory switch mode ¥ Four external interrupt/mode control lines 1.10.1 GPIO Functionality The GPIO port consists of as many as 34 programmable signals, all of which are also used by the peripherals (HI08, ESSI, SCI, and timer). There are no dedicated GPIO signals. After a reset, the signals are automatically configured as GPIO. Three memory-mapped registers per peripheral control GPIO functionality. The techniques to use when programming these registers to control GPIO functionality are detailed in Section 5 GeneraL-Purpose Input/Output . Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 1-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview Architecture Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 1.10.2 HI08 The HI08 is a byte-wide, full-duplex, double-buffered, parallel port that can connect directly to the data bus of a host processor. The HI08 supports a variety of buses and provides connection with a number of industry-standard DSPs, microcomputers, and microprocessors without requiring any additional logic. The DSP core treats the HI08 as a memory-mapped peripheral occupying eight 24-bit words in data memory space. The DSP can use the HI08 as a memory-mapped peripheral, using either standard polled or interrupt programming techniques. Separate transmit and receive data registers are double-buffered to allow the DSP and host processor to transfer data efficiently at high speed. Memory mapping allows you to program DSP core communication with the HI08 registers by using standard instructions and addressing modes. 1.10.3 ESSI The DSP56307 provides two independent and identical ESSI. Each ESSI provides a full-duplex serial port for communication with a variety of serial devices, including one or more industry-standard codecs, other DSPs, microprocessors, and peripherals that implement the Motorola SPI. The ESSI consists of independent transmitter and receiver sections and a common ESSI clock generator. The capabilities of the ESSI include the following: ¥ Independent (asynchronous) or shared (synchronous) transmit and receive sections with separate or shared internal/external clocks and frame syncs ¥ Normal mode operation using frame sync ¥ Network mode operation with as many as 32 time slots ¥ Programmable word length (8, 12, or 16 bits) ¥ Program options for frame synchronization and clock generation ¥ One receiver and three transmitters per ESSI Not Recommended for New Design 1-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview Architecture 1.10.4 SCI Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The DSP56307Õs SCI provides a full-duplex port for serial communication with other DSPs, microprocessors, or peripherals such as modems. The SCI interfaces without additional logic to peripherals that use TTL-level signals. With a small amount of additional logic, the SCI can connect to peripheral interfaces that have non-TTL level signals, such as the RS-232C, RS-422, etc. This interface uses three dedicated signals: transmit data, receive data, and SCI serial clock. It supports industry-standard asynchronous bit rates and protocols, as well as high-speed synchronous data transmission (up to 12.5 Mbps for a 100 MHz clock). The asynchronous protocols supported by the SCI include a multidrop mode for master/slave operation with wakeup on idle line and wakeup on address bit capability. This mode allows the DSP56307 to share a single serial line efficiently with other peripherals. The SCI consists of separate transmit and receive sections that can operate asynchronously with respect to each other. A programmable baud-rate generator provides the transmit and receive clocks. An enable vector and an interrupt vector have been included so that the baud-rate generator can function as a general purpose timer when it is not being used by the SCI or when the interrupt timing is the same as that used by the SCI. 1.10.5 Timer Module The triple timer module is composed of a common 21-bit prescaler and three independent and identical general purpose 24-bit timer/event counters, each one having its own memory-mapped register set. Each timer has a single signal that can function as a GPIO signal or as a timer signal. Each timer can use internal or external clocking and can interrupt the DSP after a specified number of events (clocks) or signal an external device after counting internal events. Each timer connects to the external world through one bidirectional signal. When this signal is configured as an input, the timer can function as an external event counter or measures external pulse width/signal period. When the signal is used as an output, the timer can function as either a timer, a watchdog, or a pulse width modulator. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 1-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Overview Architecture 1.10.6 EFCOP Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The EFCOP is a peripheral block interfacing with the DSP core via the peripheral module bus. The EFCOP is a general-purpose, fully programmable coprocessor designed to perform filtering tasks concurrently with the DSP core with minimum core overhead. The DSP core and the EFCOP can share data by means of an 8K-word shared data memory. DMA channels shuttle input and output data between the DSP core and the EFCOP. The EFCOP supports a variety of filter modes, some of which are optimized for cellular base station applications: ¥ Real finite impulse response (FIR) with real taps ¥ Complex FIR with complex taps ¥ Complex FIR generating pure real or pure imaginary outputs alternately ¥ A 4-bit decimation factor in FIR filters, thus providing a decimation ratio up to 16 ¥ Direct form 1 (DFI) infinite impulse response (IIR) filter ¥ Direct form 2 (DFII) IIR filter ¥ Four scaling factors (1, 4, 8, 16) for IIR output ¥ Adaptive FIR filter with true least mean square (LMS) coefficient updates ¥ Adaptive FIR filter with delayed LMS coefficient updates The EFCOP supports up to 4K taps and 4K coefficients in any combination of number and length of filters (e.g., eight filters of length 512, or 16 filters of length 256). It can perform either 24-bit or 16-bit precision arithmetic with full support for saturation arithmetic. The EFCOP is a cost-effective and power-efficient coprocessor that accelerates filtering tasks, such as echo cancellation or correlation, concurrently with software running on the DSP core. Not Recommended for New Design 1-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 2 2 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... SIGNAL/CONNECTION DESCRIPTIONS Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.9 2.10 2.11 2.12 2.13 SIGNAL GROUPINGS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-3 POWER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5 GROUND. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6 CLOCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7 PLL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7 EXTERNAL MEMORY EXPANSION PORT (PORT A). . . . . . . .2-8 INTERRUPT AND MODE CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-13 HI08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16 ENHANCED SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL INTERFACE 0 (ESSI0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-22 ENHANCED SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL INTERFACE 1 (ESSI1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-25 SCI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-28 TIMERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-30 JTAG AND OnCE INTERFACE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31 Not Recommended for New Design 2-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Signal Groupings 2.1 SIGNAL GROUPINGS The DSP56307 input and output signals are organized into functional groups, as shown in Table 2-1 and as illustrated in Figure 2-1. Table 2-1 DSP56307 Functional Signal Groupings Number of Signals Detailed Description Power (VCC) 20 Figure 2-2 Ground (GND) 19 Figure 2-3 Clock 2 Figure 2-4 PLL 3 Figure 2-5 18 Figure 2-6 24 Figure 2-7 Bus control 13 Figure 2-8 Interrupt and mode control 5 Figure 2-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Functional Group Address bus Port Data bus A1 HI08 Port B2 16 Figure 2-10 ESSI Ports C and D3 12 Figure 2-11 and Figure 2-12 SCI Port E4 3 Figure 2-13 Timer5 3 Figure 2-14 OnCE/JTAG Port 6 Figure 2-15 Note: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Port A signals define the external memory interface port, including the external address bus, data bus, and control signals. The data bus lines have internal keepers. Port B signals are the HI08 port signals multiplexed with the GPIO signals. All Port B signals have keepers. Port C and D signals are the two ESSI port signals multiplexed with the GPIO signals. All Port C and D signals have keepers. Port E signals are the SCI port signals multiplexed with the GPIO signals. All Port C signals have keepers. All timer signals have keepers. Figure 2-1 is a diagram of DSP56307 signals by functional group. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Signal Groupings DSP56307 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... VCCP VCCQL VCCQH VCCA VCCD VCCC VCCH VCCS GNDP GNDP1 GNDQ GNDA GNDD GNDC GNDH GNDS 4 3 3 4 2 2 Grounds: PLL PLL Internal Logic Address Bus Data Bus Bus Control HI08 ESSI/SCI/Timer 4 4 4 2 2 EXTAL XTAL During Reset PINIT Power Inputs: PLL Core Logic I/O Address Bus Data Bus Bus Control HI08 ESSI/SCI/Timer Clock CLKOUT PCAP After Reset NMI Interrupt/Mode Control 8 Host Interface (HI08) Port1 Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Port 0 (ESSI0)2 3 Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Port 1 (ESSI1)2 3 During Reset MODA MODB MODC MODD RESET After Reset IRQA IRQB IRQC IRQD RESET Non-Multiplexed Bus H0–H7 HA0 HA1 HA2 HCS/HCS Single DS HRW HDS/HDS Single HR HREQ/HREQ HACK/HACK Multiplexed Bus HAD0–HAD7 HAS/HAS HA8 HA9 HA10 Double DS HRD/HRD HWR/HWR Double HR HTRQ/HTRQ HRRQ/HRRQ SC00–SC02 SCK0 SRD0 STD0 Port C GPIO PC0–PC2 PC3 PC4 PC5 SC10–SC12 SCK1 SRD1 STD1 Port D GPIO PD0–PD2 PD3 PD4 PD5 RXD TXD SCLK Port E GPIO PE0 PE1 PE2 PLL Port B GPIO PB0–PB7 PB8 PB9 PB10 PB13 PB11 PB12 PB14 PB15 Port A A0–A17 D0–D23 AA0–AA3/ RAS0–RAS3 RD WR TA BR BG BB CAS BCLK BCLK Note: 1. 2. 3. 18 24 4 External Address Bus External Data Bus External Bus Control Serial Communications Interface (SCI) Port2 Timers3 TIO0 TIO1 TIO2 Timer GPIO TIO0 TIO1 TIO2 TCK TDI TDO OnCE/JTAG TMS Port TRST DE The HI08 port supports a non-multiplexed or a multiplexed bus, single or double Data Strobe (DS), and single or double Host Request (HR) configurations. Since each of these modes is configured independently, any combination of these modes is possible. These HI08 signals can also be configured alternately as GPIO signals (PB0–PB15). Signals with dual designations (e.g., HAS/HAS) have configurable polarity. The ESSI0, ESSI1, and SCI signals are multiplexed: ESSI0 with the Port C GPIO signals (PC0–PC5), ESSI1 with Port D GPIO signals (PD0–PD5), and SCI with Port E GPIO signals (PE0–PE2). TIO0–TIO2 can be configured as GPIO signals. AA1502 Figure 2-1 Signals Identified by Functional Group Not Recommended for New Design 2-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Power 2.2 POWER Table 2-2 Power Inputs Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Power Name Description VCCP PLL PowerÑVCCP is VCC dedicated for PLL use. The voltage should be well-regulated and the input should be provided with an extremely low impedance path to the VCC power rail. VCCQL Quiet Core (Low) PowerÑVCCQL is an isolated power for the core processing logic. This input must be isolated externally from all other chip power inputs. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. VCCQH Quiet External (High) PowerÑVCCQH is a quiet power source for I/O lines. This input must be tied externally to all other chip power inputs, except VCCQL. The user must provide adequate decoupling capacitors. VCCA Address Bus PowerÑVCCA is an isolated power for sections of the address bus I/O drivers. This input must be tied externally to all other chip power inputs, except VCCQL. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. VCCD Data Bus PowerÑVCCD is an isolated power for sections of the data bus I/O drivers. This input must be tied externally to all other chip power inputs, except VCCQL. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. VCCC Bus Control PowerÑVCCC is an isolated power for the bus control I/O drivers. This input must be tied externally to all other chip power inputs, except VCCQL. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. VCCH Host PowerÑVCCH is an isolated power for the HI08 I/O drivers. This input must be tied externally to all other chip power inputs, except VCCQL. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. VCCS ESSI, SCI, and Timer PowerÑVCCS is an isolated power for the ESSI, SCI, and timer I/O drivers. This input must be tied externally to all other chip power inputs, except VCCQL. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Ground 2.3 GROUND Table 2-3 Grounds Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Ground Name Description GNDP PLL GroundÑGNDP is ground-dedicated for PLL use. The connection should be provided with an extremely low-impedance path to ground. VCCP should be bypassed to GNDP by a 0.47 µF capacitor located as close as possible to the chip package. GNDP1 PLL Ground 1ÑGNDP1 is ground-dedicated for PLL use. The connection should be provided with an extremely low-impedance path to ground. GNDQ Quiet GroundÑGNDQ is an isolated ground for the internal processing logic. This connection must be tied externally to all other chip ground connections. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. GNDA Address Bus GroundÑGNDA is an isolated ground for sections of the address bus I/O drivers. This connection must be tied externally to all other chip ground connections. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. There are four GNDA connections. GNDD Data Bus GroundÑGNDD is an isolated ground for sections of the data bus I/O drivers. This connection must be tied externally to all other chip ground connections. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. GNDC Bus Control GroundÑGNDC is an isolated ground for the bus control I/O drivers. This connection must be tied externally to all other chip ground connections. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. GNDH Host GroundÑGNDH is an isolated ground for the HI08 I/O drivers. This connection must be tied externally to all other chip ground connections. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. GNDS ESSI, SCI, and Timer GroundÑGNDS is an isolated ground for the ESSI, SCI, and timer I/O drivers. This connection must be tied externally to all other chip ground connections. The user must provide adequate external decoupling capacitors. Not Recommended for New Design 2-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Clock 2.4 CLOCK Table 2-4 Clock Signals Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Type State During Reset Signal Description EXTAL Input Input External Clock/Crystal InputÑEXTAL interfaces the internal crystal oscillator input to an external crystal or an external clock. XTAL Output Chip-driven Crystal OutputÑXTAL connects the internal crystal oscillator output to an external crystal. If an external clock is used, leave XTAL unconnected. 2.5 PLL Table 2-5 Phase-Locked Loop Signals Signal Name PCAP Type Input State During Reset Input Signal Description PLL CapacitorÑPCAP is an input connecting an off-chip capacitor to the PLL filter. Connect one capacitor terminal to PCAP and the other terminal to VCCP. If the PLL is not used, PCAP may be tied to VCC, GND, or left floating. CLKOUT Output Chip-driven Clock OutputÑCLKOUT provides an output clock synchronized to the internal core clock phase. If the PLL is enabled and both the multiplication and division factors equal one, then CLKOUT is also synchronized to EXTAL. If the PLL is disabled, the CLKOUT frequency is half the frequency of EXTAL. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions External Memory Expansion Port (Port A) Table 2-5 Phase-Locked Loop Signals (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Type PINIT Input NMI Input 2.6 State During Reset Input Signal Description PLL InitialÑDuring assertion of RESET, the value of PINIT is written into the PLL enable (PEN) bit of the PLL control (PCTL) register, determining whether the PLL is enabled or disabled. Nonmaskable InterruptÑAfter RESET deassertion and during normal instruction processing, this Schmitt-trigger input is the negative-edge-triggered NMI request internally synchronized to CLKOUT. EXTERNAL MEMORY EXPANSION PORT (PORT A) Note: 2.6.1 When the DSP56307 enters a low-power standby mode (stop or wait), it releases bus mastership and tri-states the relevant Port A signals: A0ÐA17, D0ÐD23, AA0/RAS0ÐAA3/RAS3, RD, WR, BB, CAS, BCLK, BCLK. External Address Bus Table 2-6 External Address Bus Signals Signal Name A0ÐA17 Type Output State During Reset Tri-stated Signal Description Address BusÑWhen the DSP is the bus master, A0ÐA17 are active-high outputs that specify the address for external program and data memory accesses. Otherwise, the signals are tri-stated. To minimize power dissipation, A0ÐA17 do not change state when external memory spaces are not being accessed. Not Recommended for New Design 2-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions External Memory Expansion Port (Port A) 2.6.2 External Data Bus Table 2-7 External Data Bus Signals Signal Name Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... D0ÐD23 2.6.3 Type Input/ Output State During Reset Tri-stated Signal Description Data BusÑWhen the DSP is the bus master, D0ÐD23 are active-high, bidirectional input/outputs that provide the bidirectional data bus for external program and data memory accesses. Otherwise, D0ÐD23 are tri-stated. These lines have weak keepers to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. External Bus Control Table 2-8 External Bus Control Signals Signal Name AA0ÐAA3 Type State During Reset Output Tri-stated Signal Description Address AttributeÑWhen defined as AA, these signals can be used as chip selects or additional address lines. The default use defines a priority scheme under which only one AA signal can be asserted at a time. Setting the AA priority disable (APD) bit (Bit 14) of the OMR, the priority mechanism is disabled and the lines can be used together as four external lines that can be decoded externally into 16 chip select signals. Row Address StrobeÑWhen defined as RAS, these signals can be used as RAS for DRAM interface. These signals are tri-statable outputs with programmable polarity. RAS0ÐRAS3 Output RD Output Tri-stated Read EnableÑWhen the DSP is the bus master, RD is an active-low output that is asserted to read external memory on the data bus (D0ÐD23). Otherwise, RD is tri-stated. WR Output Tri-stated Write EnableÑWhen the DSP is the bus master, WR is an active-low output that is asserted to write external memory on the data bus (D0ÐD23). Otherwise, the signals are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions External Memory Expansion Port (Port A) Table 2-8 External Bus Control Signals (Continued) Signal Name Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... TA Type Input State During Reset Signal Description Ignored Input Transfer AcknowledgeÑIf the DSP56307 is the bus master and there is no external bus activity, or the DSP56307 is not the bus master, the TA input is ignored. The TA input is a data transfer acknowledge (DTACK) function that can extend an external bus cycle indefinitely. Any number of wait states (1, 2. . .infinity) may be added to the wait states inserted by the bus control register (BCR) by keeping TA deasserted. In typical operation, TA is deasserted at the start of a bus cycle, is asserted to enable completion of the bus cycle, and is deasserted before the next bus cycle. The current bus cycle completes one clock period after TA is asserted synchronous to CLKOUT. The number of wait states is determined by the TA input or by the BCR, whichever is longer. The BCR can be used to set the minimum number of wait states in external bus cycles. In order to use the TA functionality, the BCR must be programmed to at least one wait state. A zero wait state access cannot be extended by TA deassertion; otherwise, improper operation may result. TA can operate synchronously or asynchronously depending on the setting of the TAS bit in the OMR. TA functionality may not be used while performing DRAM type accesses; otherwise, improper operation may result. Not Recommended for New Design 2-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions External Memory Expansion Port (Port A) Table 2-8 External Bus Control Signals (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Type State During Reset BR Output Output (deasserted) BG Input Signal Description Bus RequestÑBR is an active-low output, never tri-stated. BR is asserted when the DSP requests bus mastership. BR is deasserted when the DSP no longer needs the bus. BR may be asserted or deasserted independently of whether the DSP56307 is a bus master or a bus slave. Bus ÒparkingÓ allows BR to be deasserted even though the DSP56307 is the bus master. (See the description of bus ÒparkingÓ in the BB signal description.) The bus request hole (BRH) bit in the BCR allows BR to be asserted under software control even though the DSP does not need the bus. BR is typically sent to an external bus arbitrator that controls the priority, parking, and tenure of each master on the same external bus. BR is only affected by DSP requests for the external bus, never for the internal bus. During hardware reset, BR is deasserted and the arbitration is reset to the bus slave state. Ignored Input Bus GrantÑBG is an active-low input. BG must be asserted/deasserted synchronous to CLKOUT for proper operation. BG is asserted by an external bus arbitration circuit when the DSP56307 becomes the next bus master. When BG is asserted, the DSP56307 must wait until BB is deasserted before taking bus mastership. When BG is deasserted, bus mastership is typically given up at the end of the current bus cycle. This may occur in the middle of an instruction that requires more than one external bus cycle for execution. The default operation of this bit requires a setup and hold time as specified in DSP56307 Technical Data (the data sheet). An alternate mode can be invoked: set the asynchronous bus arbitration enable (ABE) bit (Bit 13) in the OMR. When this bit is set, BG and BB are synchronized internally. This eliminates the respective setup and hold time requirements but adds a required delay between the deassertion of an initial BG input and the assertion of a subsequent BG input. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions External Memory Expansion Port (Port A) Table 2-8 External Bus Control Signals (Continued) Signal Name Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... BB Type State During Reset Input/ Input Output Signal Description Bus BusyÑBB is a bidirectional active-low input/output and must be asserted and deasserted synchronous to CLKOUT. BB indicates that the bus is active. Only after BB is deasserted can the pending bus master become the bus master (and then assert the signal again). The bus master may keep BB asserted after ceasing bus activity regardless of whether BR is asserted or deasserted. Called Òbus parking,Ó this allows the current bus master to reuse the bus without rearbitration until another device requires the bus. The deassertion of BB is done by an Òactive pull-upÓ method (i.e., BB is driven high and then released and held high by an external pull-up resistor). The default operation of this bit requires a setup and hold time as specified in the DSP56307 Technical Data sheet. An alternate mode can be invoked: set the ABE bit (Bit 13) in the OMR. When this bit is set, BG and BB are synchronized internally. See BG for additional information. BB requires an external pull-up resistor. CAS Output Tri-stated Column Address StrobeÑWhen the DSP is the bus master, CAS is an active-low output used by DRAM to strobe the column address. Otherwise, if the bus mastership enable (BME) bit in the DRAM control register is cleared, the signal is tri-stated. BCLK Output Tri-stated Bus ClockÑWhen the DSP is the bus master, BCLK is an active-high output. BCLK is active as a sampling signal when the program address tracing mode is enabled (i.e., the ATE bit in the OMR is set). When BCLK is active and synchronized to CLKOUT by the internal PLL, BCLK precedes CLKOUT by one-fourth of a clock cycle. The BCLK rising edge may be used to sample the internal program memory access on the A0ÐA23 address lines. BCLK Output Tri-stated Bus Clock NotÑWhen the DSP is the bus master, BCLK is an active-low output and is the inverse of the BCLK signal. Otherwise, the signal is tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design 2-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Interrupt and Mode Control 2.7 INTERRUPT AND MODE CONTROL The interrupt and mode control signals select the chipÕs operating mode as it comes out of hardware reset. After RESET is deasserted, these inputs are hardware interrupt request lines. Table 2-9 Interrupt and Mode Control Type State During Reset RESET Input Input ResetÑRESET is an active-low, Schmitt-trigger input. Deassertion of RESET is internally synchronized to CLKOUT. When asserted, the chip is placed in the Reset state and the internal phase generator is reset. The Schmitt-trigger input allows a slowly rising input (such as a capacitor charging) to reset the chip reliably. If RESET is deasserted synchronous to CLKOUT, exact start-up timing is guaranteed, allowing multiple processors to start synchronously and operate together in Òlock-step.Ó When the RESET signal is deasserted, the initial chip operating mode is latched from the MODA, MODB, MODC, and MODD inputs. The RESET signal must be asserted after power up. MODA Input Input Mode Select AÑMODA is an active-low Schmitt-trigger input, internally synchronized to CLKOUT. MODA, MODB, MODC, and MODD select one of 16 initial chip operating modes, latched into the OMR when the RESET signal is deasserted. IRQA Input Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Signal Description External Interrupt Request AÑAfter reset, this input becomes a level-sensitive or negative-edge-triggered, maskable interrupt request input during normal instruction processing. If IRQA is asserted synchronous to CLKOUT, multiple processors can be resynchronized using the WAIT instruction and asserting IRQA to exit the wait state. If the processor is in the stop standby state and IRQA is asserted, the processor will exit the stop state. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Interrupt and Mode Control Table 2-9 Interrupt and Mode Control (Continued) Type State During Reset MODB Input Input IRQB Input MODC Input IRQC Input Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Signal Description Mode Select BÑMODB is an active-low Schmitt-trigger input, internally synchronized to CLKOUT. MODA, MODB, MODC, and MODD select one of 16 initial chip operating modes, latched into the OMR when the RESET signal is deasserted. External Interrupt Request BÑAfter reset, this input becomes a level-sensitive or negative-edge-triggered, maskable interrupt request input during normal instruction processing. If IRQB is asserted synchronous to CLKOUT, multiple processors can be resynchronized using the WAIT instruction and asserting IRQB to exit the wait state. If the processor is in the stop standby state and IRQB is asserted, the processor will exit the stop state. Input Mode Select CÑMODC is an active-low Schmitt-trigger input, internally synchronized to CLKOUT. MODA, MODB, MODC, and MODD select one of 16 initial chip operating modes, latched into the OMR when the RESET signal is deasserted. External Interrupt Request CÑAfter reset, this input becomes a level-sensitive or negative-edge-triggered, maskable interrupt request input during normal instruction processing. If IRQC is asserted synchronous to CLKOUT, multiple processors can be resynchronized using the WAIT instruction and asserting IRQC to exit the wait state. If the processor is in the stop standby state and IRQC is asserted, the processor will exit the stop state. Not Recommended for New Design 2-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Interrupt and Mode Control Table 2-9 Interrupt and Mode Control (Continued) Type State During Reset MODD Input Input IRQD Input Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Signal Description Mode Select DÑMODD is an active-low Schmitt-trigger input, internally synchronized to CLKOUT. MODA, MODB, MODC, and MODD select one of 16 initial chip operating modes, latched into the OMR when the RESET signal is deasserted. External Interrupt Request DÑAfter reset, this input becomes a level-sensitive or negative-edge-triggered, maskable interrupt request input during normal instruction processing. If IRQD is asserted synchronous to CLKOUT, multiple processors can be resynchronized using the WAIT instruction and asserting IRQD to exit the wait state. If the processor is in the stop standby state and IRQD is asserted, the processor will exit the stop state. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions HI08 2.8 HI08 The HI08 provides a fast parallel-data-to-8-bit port that may be connected directly to the host bus. The HI08 supports a variety of standard buses and can be directly connected to a number of industry standard microcomputers, microprocessors, DSPs, and DMA hardware. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 2-10 Host Interface Signal Name Type State During Reset Tri-stated Signal Description H0ÐH7 Input/ Output Host DataÑWhen the HI08 is programmed to interface a nonmultiplexed host bus and the HI function is selected, these signals are lines 0Ð7 of the data bidirectional, tri-state bus. HAD0ÐHAD7 Input/ Output Host AddressÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a multiplexed host bus and the HI function is selected, these signals are lines 0Ð7 of the address/data bidirectional, multiplexed, tri-state bus. PB0ÐPB7 Input or Output Port B 0Ð7ÑWhen the HI08 is configured as GPIO through the host port control register (HPCR), these signals are individually programmed as inputs or outputs through the HI08 data direction register (HDDR). Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design 2-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions HI08 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 2-10 Host Interface (Continued) Signal Name Type State During Reset HA0 Input Input HAS/HAS Input PB8 Signal Description Host Address Input 0ÑWhen the HI08 is programmed to interface a nonmultiplexed host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is line 0 of the host address input bus. Host Address StrobeÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a multiplexed host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is the host address strobe (HAS) Schmitt-trigger input. The polarity of the address strobe is programmable but is configured active-low (HAS) following reset. Input or Output Port B 8ÑWhen the HI08 is configured as GPIO through the HPCR, this signal is individually programmed as an input or output through the HDDR. Note: HA1 Input HA8 Input PB9 Input or Output Input This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Host Address Input 1ÑWhen the HI08 is programmed to interface a nonmultiplexed host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is line 1 of the host address (HA1) input bus. Host Address 8ÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a multiplexed host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is line 8 of the host address (HA8) input bus. Port B 9ÑWhen the HI08 is configured as GPIO through the HPCR, this signal is individually programmed as an input or output through the HDDR. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions HI08 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 2-10 Host Interface (Continued) Signal Name Type State During Reset HA2 Input Input HA9 Input PB10 Input or Output Signal Description Host Address Input 2ÑWhen the HI08 is programmed to interface a nonmultiplexed host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is line 2 of the host address (HA2) input bus. Host Address 9ÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a multiplexed host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is line 9 of the host address (HA9) input bus. Port B 10ÑWhen the HI08 is configured as GPIO through the HPCR, this signal is individually programmed as an input or output through the HDDR. Note: HRW Input HRD/HRD Input PB11 Input or Output Input This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Host Read/WriteÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a single-data-strobe host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is the Host Read/Write (HRW) input. Host Read DataÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a double-data-strobe host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is the HRD strobe Schmitt-trigger input. The polarity of the data strobe is programmable, but is configured as active-low (HRD) after reset. Port B 11ÑWhen the HI08 is configured as GPIO through the HPCR, this signal is individually programmed as an input or output through the HDDR. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design 2-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions HI08 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 2-10 Host Interface (Continued) Signal Name Type State During Reset HDS/HDS Input Input HWR/HWR Input PB12 Signal Description Host Data StrobeÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a single-data-strobe host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is the host data strobe (HDS) Schmitt-trigger input. The polarity of the data strobe is programmable, but is configured as active-low (HDS) following reset. Host Write DataÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a double-data-strobe host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is the host write data strobe (HWR) Schmitt-trigger input. The polarity of the data strobe is programmable, but is configured as active-low (HWR) following reset. Port B 12ÑWhen the HI08 is configured as GPIO through the HPCR, this signal is individually programmed as an input or output through the HDDR. Input or Output Note: HCS Input HA10 Input PB13 Input or Output Input This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Host Chip SelectÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a nonmultiplexed host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is the host chip select (HCS) input. The polarity of the chip select is programmable, but is configured active-low (HCS) after reset. Host Address 10ÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a multiplexed host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is line 10 of the host address (HA10) input bus. Port B 13ÑWhen the HI08 is configured as GPIO through the HPCR, this signal is individually programmed as an input or output through the HDDR. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-19 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions HI08 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 2-10 Host Interface (Continued) Signal Name Type State During Reset HREQ/HREQ Output Input HTRQ/HTRQ Output Transmit Host RequestÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a double host request host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is the transmit host request (HTRQ) output. The polarity of the host request is programmable, but is configured as active-low (HTRQ) following reset. The host request may be programmed as a driven or open-drain output. PB14 Input or Output Port B 14ÑWhen the HI08 is programmed to interface a multiplexed host bus and the signal is configured as GPIO through the HPCR, this signal is individually programmed as an input or output through the HDDR. Signal Description Host RequestÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a single host request host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is the host request (HREQ) output. The polarity of the host request is programmable, but is configured as active-low (HREQ) following reset. The host request may be programmed as a driven or open-drain output. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design 2-20 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions HI08 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 2-10 Host Interface (Continued) Signal Name Type State During Reset HACK/ HACK Input Input HRRQ/ HRRQ Output Receive Host RequestÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a double host request host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is the receive host request (HRRQ) output. The polarity of the host request is programmable, but is configured as active-low (HRRQ) after reset. The host request may be programmed as a driven or open-drain output. PB15 Input or Output Port B 15ÑWhen the HI08 is configured as GPIO through the HPCR, this signal is individually programmed as an input or output through the HDDR. Signal Description Host AcknowledgeÑWhen HI08 is programmed to interface a single host request host bus and the HI function is selected, this signal is the host acknowledge (HACK) Schmitt-trigger input. The polarity of the host acknowledge is programmable, but is configured as active-low (HACK) after reset. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-21 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface 0 2.9 ENHANCED SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL INTERFACE 0 There are two synchronous serial interfaces (ESSI0 and ESSI1) that provide a full-duplex serial port for serial communication with a variety of serial devices, including one or more industry-standard codecs, other DSPs, microprocessors, and peripherals which implement the Motorola serial peripheral interface (SPI). Table 2-11 Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface 0 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name SC00 Type Input or Output State During Reset Input PC0 Signal Description Serial Control 0ÑThe function of SC00 is determined by the selection of either synchronous or asynchronous mode. For asynchronous mode, this signal will be used for the receive clock I/O (Schmitt-trigger input). For synchronous mode, this signal is used either for transmitter 1 output or for serial I/O flag 0. Port C 0ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PC0. When configured as PC0, signal direction is controlled through the port directions register (PRR0). The signal can be configured as ESSI signal SC00 through the port control register (PCR0). Note: SC01 Input/ Output PC1 Input or Output Input This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Serial Control 1ÑThe function of this signal is determined by the selection of either synchronous or asynchronous mode. For asynchronous mode, this signal is the receiver frame sync I/O. For synchronous mode, this signal is used either for transmitter 2 output or for serial I/O flag 1. Port C 1ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PC1. When configured as PC1, signal direction is controlled through PRR0. The signal can be configured as an ESSI signal SC01 through PCR0. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design 2-22 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface 0 Table 2-11 Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface 0 (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Type SC02 Input/ Output PC2 Input or Output State During Reset Input Signal Description Serial Control Signal 2ÑSC02 is used for frame sync I/O. SC02 is the frame sync for both the transmitter and receiver in synchronous mode, and for the transmitter only in asynchronous mode. When configured as an output, this signal is the internally generated frame sync signal. When configured as an input, this signal receives an external frame sync signal for the transmitter (and the receiver in synchronous operation). Port C 2ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PC2. When configured as PC2, signal direction is controlled through PRR0. The signal can be configured as an ESSI signal SC02 through PCR0. Note: SCK0 Input/ Output Input This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Serial ClockÑSCK0 is a bidirectional Schmitt-trigger input signal providing the serial bit rate clock for the ESSI. The SCK0 is a clock input or output, used by both the transmitter and receiver in synchronous modes or by the transmitter in asynchronous modes. Although an external serial clock can be independent of and asynchronous to the DSP system clock, it must exceed the minimum clock cycle time of 6T (i.e., the system clock frequency must be at least three times the external ESSI clock frequency). The ESSI needs at least three DSP phases inside each half of the serial clock. PC3 Input or Output Port C 3ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PC3. When configured as PC3, signal direction is controlled through PRR0. The signal can be configured as an ESSI signal SCK0 through PCR0. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-23 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface 0 Table 2-11 Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface 0 (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Type SRD0 Input/ Output PC4 Input or Output State During Reset Input Signal Description Serial Receive DataÑSRD0 receives serial data and transfers the data to the ESSI receive shift register. SRD0 is an input when data is being received. Port C 4ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PC4. When configured as PC4, signal direction is controlled through PRR0. The signal can be configured as an ESSI signal SRD0 through PCR0. Note: STD0 Input/ Output PC5 Input or Output Input This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Serial Transmit DataÑSTD0 is used for transmitting data from the serial transmit shift register. STD0 is an output when data is being transmitted. Port C 5ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PC5. When configured as PC5, signal direction is controlled through PRR0. The signal can be configured as an ESSI signal STD0 through PCR0. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design 2-24 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface 1 2.10 ENHANCED SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL INTERFACE 1 Table 2-12 Enhanced Serial Synchronous Interface 1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Type SC10 Input or Output PD0 Input or Output State During Reset Input Signal Description Serial Control 0ÑThe function of SC10 is determined by the selection of either synchronous or asynchronous mode. For asynchronous mode, this signal will be used for the receive clock I/O (Schmitt-trigger input). For synchronous mode, this signal is used either for transmitter 1 output or for serial I/O flag 0. Port D 0ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PD0. When configured as PD0, signal direction is controlled through the port directions register (PRR1). The signal can be configured as an ESSI signal SC10 through the port control register (PCR1). Note: SC11 Input/ Output PD1 Input or Output Input This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Serial Control 1ÑThe function of this signal is determined by the selection of either synchronous or asynchronous mode. For asynchronous mode, this signal is the receiver frame sync I/O. For synchronous mode, this signal is used either for Transmitter 2 output or for Serial I/O Flag 1. Port D 1ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PD1. When configured as PD1, signal direction is controlled through PRR1. The signal can be configured as an ESSI signal SC11 through PCR1. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-25 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface 1 Table 2-12 Enhanced Serial Synchronous Interface 1 (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Type SC12 Input/ Output PD2 Input or Output State During Reset Input Signal Description Serial Control Signal 2ÑSC12 is used for frame sync I/O. SC12 is the frame sync for both the transmitter and receiver in synchronous mode, and for the transmitter only in asynchronous mode. When configured as an output, this signal is the internally generated frame sync signal. When configured as an input, this signal receives an external frame sync signal for the transmitter (and the receiver in synchronous operation). Port D 2ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PD2. When configured as PD2, signal direction is controlled through PRR1. The signal can be configured as an ESSI signal SC12 through PCR1. Note: SCK1 Input/ Output Input This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Serial ClockÑSCK1 is a bidirectional Schmitt-trigger input signal providing the serial bit rate clock for the ESSI. The SCK1 is a clock input or output used by both the transmitter and receiver in synchronous modes, or by the transmitter in asynchronous modes. Although an external serial clock can be independent of and asynchronous to the DSP system clock, it must exceed the minimum clock cycle time of 6T (i.e., the system clock frequency must be at least three times the external ESSI clock frequency). The ESSI needs at least three DSP phases inside each half of the serial clock. PD3 Input or Output Port D 3ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PD3. When configured as PD3, signal direction is controlled through PRR1. The signal can be configured as an ESSI signal SCK1 through PCR1. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design 2-26 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface 1 Table 2-12 Enhanced Serial Synchronous Interface 1 (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Type SRD1 Input/ Output PD4 Input or Output State During Reset Input Signal Description Serial Receive DataÑSRD1 receives serial data and transfers the data to the ESSI receive shift register. SRD1 is an input when data is being received. Port D 4ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PD4. When configured as PD4, signal direction is controlled through PRR1. The signal can be configured as an ESSI signal SRD1 through PCR1. Note: STD1 Input/ Output PD5 Input or Output Input This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Serial Transmit DataÑSTD1 is used for transmitting data from the serial transmit shift register. STD1 is an output when data is being transmitted. Port D 5ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PD5. When configured as PD5, signal direction is controlled through PRR1. The signal can be configured as an ESSI signal STD1 through PCR1. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-27 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions SCI 2.11 SCI The SCI provides a full duplex port for serial communication to other DSPs, microprocessors, or peripherals such as modems. Table 2-13 Serial Communication Interface Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Type RXD Input PE0 Input or Output State During Reset Input Signal Description Serial Receive DataÑThis input receives byte oriented serial data and transfers it to the SCI receive shift register. Port E 0ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PE0. When configured as PE0, signal direction is controlled through the SCI port directions register (PRR). The signal can be configured as an SCI signal RXD through the SCI port control register (PCR). Note: TXD Output PE1 Input or Output Input This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Serial Transmit DataÑThis signal transmits data from SCI transmit data register. Port E 1ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PE1. When configured as PE1, signal direction is controlled through the SCI PRR. The signal can be configured as an SCI signal TXD through the SCI PCR. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design 2-28 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions SCI Table 2-13 Serial Communication Interface (Continued) Signal Name SCLK Type Input/ Output PE2 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Input or Output State During Reset Input Signal Description Serial ClockÑThis is the bidirectional Schmitt-trigger input signal providing the input or output clock used by the transmitter and/or the receiver. Port E 2ÑThe default configuration following reset is GPIO input PE2. When configured as PE2, signal direction is controlled through the SCI PRR. The signal can be configured as an SCI signal SCLK through the SCI PCR. Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-29 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Timers 2.12 TIMERS Three identical and independent timers are implemented in the DSP56307. Each timer can use internal or external clocking and can either interrupt the DSP56307 after a specified number of events (clocks) or signal an external device after counting a specific number of internal events. Table 2-14 Triple Timer Signals Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name TIO0 Type Input or Output State During Reset Input Signal Description Timer 0 Schmitt-Trigger Input/OutputÑ When Timer 0 functions as an external event counter or in measurement mode, TIO0 is used as input. When Timer 0 functions in watchdog, timer, or pulse modulation mode, TIO0 is used as output. The default mode after reset is GPIO input. This can be changed to output or configured as a timer I/O through the timer 0 control/status register (TCSR0). Note: TIO1 Input or Output Input This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Timer 1 Schmitt-Trigger Input/OutputÑ When Timer 1 functions as an external event counter or in measurement mode, TIO1 is used as input. When Timer 1 functions in watchdog, timer, or pulse modulation mode, TIO1 is used as output. The default mode after reset is GPIO input. This can be changed to output or configured as a timer I/O through the timer 1 control/status register (TCSR1). Note: This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. Not Recommended for New Design 2-30 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions JTAG and OnCE Interface Table 2-14 Triple Timer Signals (Continued) Signal Name Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... TIO2 Type Input or Output State During Reset Input Signal Description Timer 2 Schmitt-Trigger Input/OutputÑ When timer 2 functions as an external event counter or in measurement mode, TIO2 is used as input. When timer 2 functions in watchdog, timer, or pulse modulation mode, TIO2 is used as output. The default mode after reset is GPIO input. This can be changed to output or configured as a timer I/O through the timer 2 control/status register (TCSR2). Note: 2.13 This signal has a weak keeper to maintain the last state even if all drivers are tri-stated. JTAG AND OnCE INTERFACE The DSP56300 family and in particular the DSP56307 support circuit-board test strategies based on the IEEE 1149.1 Standard Test Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture, the industry standard developed under the sponsorship of the Test Technology Committee of IEEE and the JTAG. The OnCE module interfaces nonintrusively with the DSP56300 core and its peripherals so that you can examine registers, memory, or on-chip peripherals. Functions of the OnCE module are provided through the JTAG TAP signals. For programming models, see Section 12 Joint Test Action Group Port and Section 11 On-Chip Emulation Module . Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-31 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions JTAG and OnCE Interface Table 2-15 OnCE/JTAG Interface Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Signal Name Type State During Reset Signal Description TCK Input Input Test ClockÑTCK is a test clock input signal used to synchronize the JTAG test logic. TDI Input Input Test Data InputÑTDI is a test data serial input signal used for test instructions and data. TDI is sampled on the rising edge of TCK and has an internal pull-up resistor. TDO Output Tri-stated Test Data OutputÑTDO is a test data serial output signal used for test instructions and data. TDO is tri-statable and is actively driven in the shift-IR and shift-DR controller states. TDO changes on the falling edge of TCK. TMS Input Input Test Mode SelectÑTMS is an input signal used to sequence the test controllerÕs state machine. TMS is sampled on the rising edge of TCK and has an internal pull-up resistor. TRST Input Input Test ResetÑTRST is an active-low Schmitt-trigger input signal used to asynchronously initialize the test controller. TRST has an internal pull-up resistor. TRST must be asserted after power up. Not Recommended for New Design 2-32 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions JTAG and OnCE Interface Table 2-15 OnCE/JTAG Interface (Continued) Signal Name Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DE Type Input/ Output State During Reset Input Signal Description Debug EventÑDE is an open-drain, bidirectional, active-low signal that provides, as an input, a means of entering the debug mode of operation from an external command controller, and, as an output, a means of acknowledging that the chip has entered the debug mode. This signal, when asserted as an input, causes the DSP56300 core to finish the current instruction being executed, save the instruction pipeline information, enter the debug mode, and wait for commands to be entered from the debug serial input line. This signal is asserted as an output for three clock cycles when the chip enters the debug mode as a result of a debug request or as a result of meeting a breakpoint condition. The DE has an internal pull-up resistor. This is not a standard part of the JTAG TAP controller. The signal connects directly to the OnCE module to initiate debug mode directly or to provide a direct external indication that the chip has entered the debug mode. All other interface with the OnCE module must occur through the JTAG port. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 2-33 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Signal/Connection Descriptions Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... JTAG and OnCE Interface Not Recommended for New Design 2-34 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... MEMORY CONFIGURATION Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3 PROGRAM MEMORY SPACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3 X DATA MEMORY SPACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-5 Y DATA MEMORY SPACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-7 DYNAMIC MEMORY CONFIGURATION SWITCHING . . . . . .3-10 SIXTEEN-BIT COMPATIBILITY MODE CONFIGURATION . . .3-11 MEMORY MAPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 Not Recommended for New Design 3-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Introduction Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 3.1 INTRODUCTION Like all members of the DSP56300 core family, the DSP56307 can address three sets of 16 M × 24-bit memory internally: program, X data, and Y data. Each of these memory spaces can include both on-chip and external memory (accessed through the external memory interface). The DSP56307 is extremely flexible because it has several modes to allocate on-chip memory between the program memory and the two data memory spaces. You can also configure it to operate in a special sixteen-bit compatibility mode that allows the chip to use DSP56000 object code without any change; this can result in higher performance of existing code for applications that do not require a larger address space. This section provides detailed information about each of these memory spaces. See the DSP56300 Family Manual for general information about memory. 3.2 PROGRAM MEMORY SPACE Program memory space consists of the following: ¥ Internal program memory (program RAM, 16K by default, up to 40K) ¥ (Optional) instruction cache (1K) formed from program RAM ¥ Bootstrap program ROM (192 x 24-bit) ¥ (Optional) Off-chip memory expansion (as much as 64K in 16-bit mode or 256K in 24-bit mode using the 18 external address lines or 4 M using the external address lines and the four address attribute lines) Note: 3.2.1 Program memory space at locations $FF00C0Ð$FFFFFF is reserved and should not be accessed. Internal Program Memory The default on-chip program memory consists of a 24-bit-wide, high-speed, SRAM occupying the lowest 16K locations ($0Ð$3FFF) in program memory space. The on-chip program RAM is organized in 64 banks with 256 locations each. You can make additional program memory available using the memory switch mode described in Section 3.2.2Memory Switch ModesÑProgram Memory . Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Program Memory Space 3.2.2 Memory Switch Modes—Program Memory Memory switch mode allows reallocation of portions of X and Y data RAM as program RAM. Bit 7 in the OMR is the memory switch (MS) bit that controls this function, as follows: Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ When the MS bit is cleared, program memory consists of the default 16K × 24-bit memory space described in the previous section. In this default mode, the lowest external program memory location is $4000. ¥ When the MS bit is set, a portion of the higher locations of the internal X and Y data memory are switched to internal program memory. The memory switch configuration (MSW[1:0]) bits (also called M1 and M0) in the OMR select one of the following options: Ð MSW[1:0] = 00ÑThe 16K higher locations ($2000Ð$5FFF) of the internal X data memory and the 16K higher locations ($2000Ð$5FFF) of the internal Y data memory are switched to internal program memory. In such a case, the on-chip program memory occupies the lowest 48K locations ($0Ð$BFFF) in the program memory space. The instruction cache, if enabled, occupies the lowest 1K program words (locations $0Ð$3FF). The lowest external program memory location in this mode is $C000. Ð MSW[1:0] = 01ÑThe 12K higher locations ($3000Ð$5FFF) of the internal X data memory and the 12K higher locations ($3000Ð$5FFF) of the internal Y data memory are switched to internal program memory. In such a case, the on-chip program memory occupies the lowest 40K locations ($0Ð$9FFF) in the program memory space. The instruction cache, if enabled, occupies the lowest 1K program words (locations $0Ð$3FF). The lowest external program memory location in this mode is $C000, while program memory locations $A000Ð$BFFF are considered reserved and should not be accessed. Ð MSW[1:0] = 10ÑThe 8K higher locations ($4000Ð$5FFF) of the internal X data memory and the 8K higher locations ($4000Ð$5FFF) of the internal Y data memory are switched to internal program memory. In such a case, the on-chip program memory occupies the lowest 32K locations ($0Ð$7FFF) in the program memory space. The instruction cache, if enabled, occupies the lowest 1K program words (locations $0Ð$3FF). The lowest external program memory location in this mode is $C000, while program memory locations $8000Ð$BFFF are considered reserved and should not be accessed. Ð MSW[1:0] = 11ÑThe 4K higher locations ($5000Ð$5FFF) of the internal X memory and the 4K higher locations ($5000Ð$5FFF) of the internal Y memory are switched to internal program memory. In such a case, the on-chip program memory occupies the lowest 24K locations ($0Ð$5FFF) in the Not Recommended for New Design 3-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration X Data Memory Space program memory space. The instruction cache, if enabled, occupies the lowest 1 K program words (locations $0Ð$3FF). The lowest external program memory location in this mode is $C000, while program memory locations $6000-$BFFF are considered reserved and should not be accessed. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 3.2.3 Instruction Cache In program memory space, the lowest 1024 (1K) program words (located at locations $0Ð$3FF) function as an internal instruction cache. When the instruction cache is enabled (i.e., the CE bit in the SR is set), the lowest 1K program words are reserved for instruction cache and should not be accessed for other purposes. Note: 3.2.4 When using an enabled instruction cache, you must assign a valid value for the vector address bus so that interrupts can be handled properly. Program Bootstrap ROM The program memory space occupying locations $FF0000Ð$FF00BF includes the internal bootstrap ROM. This ROM contains 192 words combining the bootstrap program for the DSP56307. 3.2.5 Accessing External Program Memory Refer to the DSP56300 Family Manual, especially Section 2 Expansion Port, for detailed information on using the external memory interface to access external program memory. 3.3 X DATA MEMORY SPACE The X data memory space consists of the following: ¥ Internal X data memory (24K by default down to 8K) ¥ Internal X I/O space (upper 128 locations) ¥ (Optionally) Off-chip memory expansion (as much as 64K in 16-bit mode, or 256K in 24-bit mode using the 18 external address lines, or 4 M using the external address lines and the four address attribute lines). Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration X Data Memory Space The X memory space, located at locations $FF0000Ð$FFEFFF, is reserved and should not be accessed. Note: Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 3.3.1 Internal X Data Memory The default on-chip X data RAM is a 24-bit-wide, internal, static memory occupying the lowest 24 K locations ($0Ð$5FFF) in X memory space. The on-chip X data RAM is organized in 96 banks, 256 locations each. Available X data memory space is reduced and reallocated to program memory using the memory switch mode described in the next section. 3.3.2 Memory Switch Modes—X Data Memory Memory switch mode reallocates of portions of X and Y data RAM as program RAM. Bit 7 in the OMR is the MS bit that controls this function, as follows: ¥ When the MS bit is cleared, the X data memory consists of the default 24K × 24-bit memory space described in the previous section. In this default mode, the lowest external X data memory location is $6000. ¥ When the MS bit is set, a portion of the higher locations of the internal X memory is switched to internal program memory. The memory switch (MSW[1:0]) configuration bits in the OMR select one of the following options: Ð MSW[1:0] = 00ÑThe 16K higher locations ($2000Ð$5FFF) of the internal X memory are switched to internal program memory, and therefore the highest internal X memory location is $1FFF. The X memory space at the switched locations ($2000Ð$5FFF) becomes reserved and should not be accessed. The lowest external X memory location is $6000. Ð MSW[1:0] = 01ÑThe 12K higher locations ($3000Ð$5FFF) of the internal X memory are switched to internal program memory, and therefore the highest internal X memory location will be $2FFF. The X memory space at the switched locations ($3000Ð$5FFF) becomes reserved and should not be accessed. The lowest external X memory location is $6000. Ð MSW[1:0] = 10ÑThe 8K higher locations ($4000Ð$5FFF) of the internal X memory are switched to internal program memory, and therefore the highest internal X memory location will be $3FFF. The X memory space at the switched locations ($4000Ð$5FFF) becomes reserved and should not be accessed. The lowest external X memory location is $6000. Not Recommended for New Design 3-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Y Data Memory Space Ð Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Note: 3.3.3 MSW[1:0] = 11ÑThe 4K higher locations ($5000Ð$5FFF) of the internal X memory are switched to internal program memory, and therefore the highest internal X memory location will be $4FFF. The X memory space at the switched locations ($5000Ð$5FFF) becomes reserved and should not be accessed. The lowest external X memory location is $6000. The 4K lowest locations ($0Ð$FFF) of the internal X memory are considered shared memory. The shared memory is accessible by the core and by the on-chip EFCOP. The EFCOP connects to the shared memory in place of the DMA bus. Therefore, there is no DMA accessibility to the shared memory, and simultaneous accesses are not permitted by core and EFCOP to the same memory bank (of 256 locations) of the shared memory. It is your responsibility to prevent such simultaneous accesses. Internal X I/O Space One part of the on-chip peripheral registers and some of the DSP56307 core registers occupy the top 128 locations of the X data memory ($FFFF80Ð$FFFFFF). This area is referred to as the internal X I/O space and it can be accessed by MOVE, MOVEP instructions and by bit-oriented instructions (BCHG, BCLR, BSET, BTST, BRCLR, BRSET, BSCLR, BSSET, JCLR, JSET, JSCLR and JSSET). The contents of the internal X I/O memory space are listed in Appendix E Programming Reference, Table E-2 on page E-5. 3.3.4 Accessing External X Data Memory Refer to the DSP56300 Family Manual, especially Section 2 Expansion Port, for detailed information on using the external memory interface to access external X data memory. 3.4 Y DATA MEMORY SPACE The Y data memory space consists of the following: ¥ Internal Y data memory (24K by default down to 8K) ¥ Internal Y I/O space (16 locationsÑ$FFFF80Ð$FFFF8F) ¥ External Y I/O space (upper 112 locations) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Y Data Memory Space ¥ (Optionally) Off-chip memory expansion (as much as 64K in 16-bit mode or 256K in 24-bit mode using the 18 external address lines or 4 M using the external address lines and the four address attribute lines) The Y memory space at locations $FF0000Ð$FFEFFF is reserved and should not be accessed. Note: Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 3.4.1 Internal Y Data Memory The default on-chip Y data RAM is a 24-bit-wide, internal, static memory occupying the lowest 24K locations ($0Ð$5FFF) in Y memory space. The on-chip Y data RAM is organized in 96 banks, 256 locations each. Available Y data memory space is reduced and reallocated to program memory by using the memory switch mode described in the following paragraphs. 3.4.2 Memory Switch Modes—Y Data Memory Memory switch mode reallocates of portions of X and Y data RAM as program RAM. Bit 7 in the OMR is the MS bit that controls this function, as follows: ¥ When the MS bit is cleared, the Y data memory consists of the default 24K × 24-bit memory space described in the previous section. In this default mode, the lowest external Y data memory location is $6000. ¥ When MS mode bit in the OMR is set, a portion of the higher locations of the internal Y memory are switched to internal program memory. The memory switch configuration (MSW[1:0]) bits in the OMR select one of the following options: Ð MSW[1:0] = 00ÑThe 16K higher locations ($2000Ð$5FFF) of the internal Y memory are switched to internal program memory, and therefore the highest internal Y memory location is $1FFF. The Y memory space at the switched locations ($2000Ð$5FFF) becomes reserved and should not be accessed by the user. The lowest external Y memory location is $6000. Ð MSW[1:0] = 01ÑThe 12K higher locations ($3000Ð$5FFF) of the internal Y memory are switched to internal program memory, and therefore the highest internal Y memory location is $2FFF. The Y memory space at the switched locations ($3000Ð$5FFF) becomes reserved and should not be accessed. The lowest external Y memory location is $6000. Not Recommended for New Design 3-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Y Data Memory Space Ð MSW[1:0] = 10ÑThe 8K higher locations ($4000Ð$5FFF) of the internal Y memory are switched to internal program memory, and therefore the highest internal Y memory location is $3FFF. The Y memory space at the switched locations ($4000Ð$5FFF) becomes reserved and should not be accessed. The lowest external Y memory location is $6000. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Ð MSW[1:0] = 11ÑThe 4K higher locations ($5000Ð$5FFF) of the internal Y memory are switched to internal program memory, and therefore the highest internal Y memory location is $4FFF. The Y memory space at the switched locations ($5000-$5FFF) becomes reserved and should not be accessed. The lowest external Y memory location is $6000. Note: 3.4.3 The 4K lowest locations ($0-$FFF) of the internal Y memory are shared memory, which is accessible to the core and the on-chip EFCOP. The EFCOP connects to the shared memory in place of the DMA bus. Therefore, DMA cannot access the shared memory, and simultaneous accesses are not permitted by core and EFCOP to the same memory bank (of 256 locations) of the shared memory. It is your responsibility to prevent such simultaneous accesses. Internal Y I/O Space The second part of the on-chip peripheral registers occupies 64 locations ($FFFF80Ð$FFFFBF) of the Y data memory. This area is referred to as the internal Y I/O space, and it can be accessed by MOVE, MOVEP instructions and by bit-oriented instructions (BCHG, BCLR, BSET, BTST, BRCLR, BRSET, BSCLR, BSSET, JCLR, JSET, JSCLR and JSSET). The contents of the internal Y I/O memory space are listed in Appendix E Programming Reference, Table E-3 Internal Y I/O Memory Map on page E-12. 3.4.4 External Y I/O Space Off-chip peripheral registers should be mapped into the top 64 locations ($FFFFC0Ð$FFFFFF) to take advantage of the move peripheral data (MOVEP) instruction and the bit-oriented instructions (BCHG, BCLR, BSET, BTST, BRCLR, BRSET, BSCLR, BSSET, JCLR, JSET, JSCLR and JSSET). This area is referred to as the external Y I/O space. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Dynamic Memory Configuration Switching 3.4.5 Accessing External Y Data Memory Refer to the DSP56300 Family Manual for detailed information about using the external memory interface to access external Y data memory. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 3.5 DYNAMIC MEMORY CONFIGURATION SWITCHING As described in the previous sections, the internal memory configuration is altered by remapping RAM modules from X and Y data memories into program memory space and vice versa. Data contents of the switched RAM modules are preserved. The memory can be dynamically switched from one configuration to another by changing the MS and MSW[1:0] bits in the OMR. Address ranges directly affected by the switch operation are described in the previous sections and summarized by the memory maps presented at the end of this section. The memory switch can be accomplished provided that the affected address ranges are not being accessed during the instruction cycle in which the switch operation takes place. CAUTION To ensure that dynamic switching is trouble-free, do not allow any accesses (including instruction fetches) to or from the affected address ranges in program and data memories during the switch cycle. Note: The switch cycle actually occurs 3 instruction cycles after the instruction that modifies MS/MSW bits. Any sequence that complies with the switch condition is valid. For example, if the program flow executes in the address range that is not affected by the switch, the switch condition can be met very easily. In this case, a switch can be accomplished by just changing MS/MSW bits in OMR in the regular program flow, assuming no accesses to the affected address ranges of the data memory occur up to three instructions after the instruction that changes the OMR bits. Because an interrupt could cause the DSP to fetch Not Recommended for New Design 3-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Sixteen-Bit Compatibility Mode Configuration instructions out of sequence and might violate the switch condition, special care should be taken in relation to the interrupt vector routines. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... CAUTION Special attention must be paid when executing a memory switch routine using the OnCE port. Running the switch routine in trace mode, for example, can cause the switch to complete after the MS/MSW bits change while the DSP is in debug mode. As a result, subsequent instructions might be fetched according to the new memory configuration (after the switch), and thus might execute improperly. 3.6 SIXTEEN-BIT COMPATIBILITY MODE CONFIGURATION The sixteen-bit compatibility (SC) mode allows the DSP56307 to use DSP56000 object code without change. The SC bit (Bit 13 in the SR) is used to switch from the default 24-bit mode to this special 16-bit mode. SC is cleared by reset. You must set this bit to select the SC mode. The address ranges described in the previous sections apply in the SC mode with regard to the reallocation of X and Y data memory to program memory in MS mode, but the maximum addressing ranges are limited to $FFFF, and all data and program code are 16 bits wide. 3.7 MEMORY MAPS The following figures illustrate each of the memory space and RAM configurations defined by the settings of the MS (and MSW[1:0]), CE, and SC bits. The figures show the configuration and describe the bit settings, memory sizes, and memory locations. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Default Program $FFFFFF X Data $FFFFFF Internal I/O $FFFF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Internal Reserved $FFF000 $FF00C0 $FF0000 Bootstrap ROM $FF0000 External External Y Data $FFFFFF $FFFFC0 $FFFF80 $FFF000 External I/O Internal I/O External Internal Reserved Internal Reserved $FF0000 External External $006000 $006000 $004000 Internal Program RAM 16K $000000 $000000 Bit Settings MS 0 * MSW [1:0] any value Internal Y data RAM 24K Internal X data RAM 24K $000000 Memory Configuration CE SC 0 0 Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 16K 24K $0000Ð$3FFF $0000Ð$5FFF Addressable Memory Size 24K None $0000Ð$5FFF 16 M Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-1 Memory Switch Off, Cache Off, 24-Bit Mode (default) Not Recommended for New Design 3-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program X Data $FFFFFF $FFFFFF Internal I/O $FFFF80 $FFF000 Internal Reserved Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... $FFF000 Internal Reserved $FF00C0 $FF0000 External Y Data $FFFFFF $FFFFC0 $FFFF80 Bootstrap ROM Internal I/O External Internal Reserved $FF0000 $FF0000 External External I/O External External $006000 $006000 $004000 Internal Program RAM 15K $000400 Reserved $000000 $000000 Bit Settings MS 0 * MSW [1:0] Internal Y data RAM 24K $000000 Memory Configuration CE SC 1 0 any value Internal X data RAM 24K Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 15K 24K $0400Ð$3FFF $0000Ð$5FFF 24K Enabled $0000Ð$5FFF Addressable Memory Size 16 M Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-2 Memory Switch Off, Cache On, 24-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFFFF X Data $FFFFFF Internal I/O $FFFF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Internal Reserved $FFF000 $FF00C0 $FF0000 Bootstrap ROM $FF0000 External External $FFF000 Internal Reserved Internal I/O External $FF0000 External $006000 $006000 Internal Reserved Internal Program RAM $002000 Internal X data 48K RAM 8K $000000 $000000 Bit Settings External I/O Internal Reserved External $00C000 $002000 Internal Reserved Internal Y data RAM 8K $000000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 00 0 0 * Y Data $FFFFFF $FFFFC0 $FFFF80 Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 48K 8K $0000Ð$BFFF $0000Ð$1FFF 8K None $0000Ð$1FFF Addressable Memory Size 16 M Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-3 Memory Switch On (MSW = 00), Cache Off, 24-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design 3-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFFFF X Data $FFFFFF Internal I/O $FFFF80 Internal Reserved $FFF000 $FF0000 Bootstrap ROM $FF0000 External $006000 Internal Program RAM 47K $002000 $000400 $000000 Reserved Internal I/O External $FF0000 External $006000 Internal Reserved Internal X data RAM 8K $000000 Bit Settings External I/O Internal Reserved External $00C000 $002000 Internal Reserved Internal Y data RAM 8K $000000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 00 1 0 * $FFF000 Internal Reserved $FF00C0 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... External Y Data $FFFFFF $FFFFC0 $FFFF80 Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 47K 8K $0400Ð$BFFF $0000Ð$1FFF Addressable Memory Size 8K Enabled $0000Ð$1FFF 16 M Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-4 Memory Switch On (MSW = 00), Cache On, 24-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFFFF X Data $FFFFFF Internal I/O $FFFF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Internal Reserved $FFF000 $FF00C0 $FF0000 Bootstrap ROM $FF0000 External $00C000 $00A000 External $FFF000 Internal Reserved External I/O Internal I/O External Internal Reserved $FF0000 External External Reserved $006000 $006000 Internal Reserved Internal $003000 Program RAM Internal X data 40K RAM 12K $000000 $000000 Bit Settings $003000 Internal Reserved Internal Y data RAM 12K $000000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 01 0 0 * Y Data $FFFFFF $FFFFC0 $FFFF80 Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 40K 12K $0000Ð$9FFF $0000Ð$2FFF 12K None $0000Ð$2FFF Addressable Memory Size 16 M Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-5 Memory Switch On (MSW = 01), Cache Off, 24-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design 3-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFFFF X Data $FFFFFF Internal I/O $FFFF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Internal Reserved $FFF000 $FF00C0 $FF0000 Bootstrap ROM $FF0000 External $00C000 $00A000 External External I/O Internal I/O External Internal Reserved $FF0000 External External Reserved Internal Program RAM $003000 39K Reserved $000000 $006000 Internal Reserved Internal X data RAM 12K $000000 Bit Settings $003000 Internal Reserved Internal Y data RAM 12K $000000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 01 1 0 * $FFF000 Internal Reserved $006000 $000400 Y Data $FFFFFF $FFFFC0 $FFFF80 Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 39K 12K $0400Ð$9FFF $0000Ð$2FFF Addressable Memory Size 12K Enabled $0000Ð$2FFF 16 M Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-6 Memory Switch On (MSW = 01), Cache On, 24-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFFFF X Data $FFFFFF Internal I/O $FFFF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Internal Reserved $FFF000 $FF00C0 $FF0000 Bootstrap ROM $FF0000 External Internal Reserved External I/O Internal I/O External Internal Reserved $FF0000 External Reserved $006000 $006000 Reserved $004000 Internal Program RAM Internal X data 32K RAM 16K $000000 $000000 Bit Settings Reserved $004000 Internal Y data RAM 16K $000000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 10 0 0 * $FFF000 External $00C000 $008000 External Y Data $FFFFFF $FFFFC0 $FFFF80 Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 32K 16K $0000Ð$7FFF $0000Ð$3FFF 16K None $0000Ð$3FFF Addressable Memory Size 16 M Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-7 Memory Switch On (MSW = 10), Cache Off, 24-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design 3-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFFFF X Data $FFFFFF Internal I/O $FFFF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Internal Reserved $FFF000 $FF00C0 $FF0000 Bootstrap ROM $FF0000 External Internal Reserved Internal I/O External Internal Reserved $FF0000 External Reserved $008000 $006000 $006000 Internal Program RAM $004000 31K Reserved $000000 Reserved Internal X data RAM 16K $000000 Bit Settings $004000 Reserved Internal Y data RAM 16K $000000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 10 1 0 * $FFF000 External I/O External $00C000 $000400 External Y Data $FFFFFF $FFFFC0 $FFFF80 Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 31K 16K $0400Ð$7FFF $0000Ð$3FFF Addressable Memory Size 16K Enabled $0000Ð$3FFF 16 M Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-8 Memory Switch On (MSW = 10), Cache On, 24-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-19 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFFFF X Data $FFFFFF Internal I/O $FFFF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Internal Reserved $FFF000 $FF00C0 $FF0000 Bootstrap ROM $FF0000 External External Y Data $FFFFFF $FFFFC0 $FFFF80 $FFF000 Internal Reserved Internal I/O External Internal Reserved $FF0000 External $00C000 External I/O External Reserved $006000 Internal Program RAM 24K $000000 $005000 Reserved $005000 Internal X data RAM 20K $000000 Bit Settings Reserved Internal Y data RAM 20K $000000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 11 0 0 * $006000 $006000 Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 24K 20K $0000Ð$5FFF $0000Ð$4FFF 20K None $0000Ð$4FFF Addressable Memory Size 16 M Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-9 Memory Switch On (MSW = 11), Cache Off, 24-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design 3-20 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFFFF X Data $FFFFFF Internal I/O $FFFF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Internal Reserved $FFF000 $FF00C0 $FF0000 Bootstrap ROM $FF0000 External External Y Data $FFFFFF $FFFFC0 $FFFF80 $FFF000 Internal Reserved External I/O Internal I/O External Internal Reserved $FF0000 External $00C000 External Reserved $006000 $000400 $006000 Internal $005000 Program RAM 23K Reserved $000000 Internal X data RAM 20K $000000 Bit Settings $005000 Reserved Internal Y data RAM 20K $000000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 11 1 0 * $006000 Reserved Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 23K 20K $0400Ð$5FFF $0000Ð$4FFF Addressable Memory Size 20K Enabled $0000Ð$4FFF 16 M Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-10 Memory Switch On (MSW = 11), Cache On, 24-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-21 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFF X Data $FFFF $FFFF Internal I/O $FF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... External Y Data $FFC0 $FF80 External $6000 External I/O Internal I/O External $6000 $4000 Internal Program RAM 16K $0000 Internal X data RAM 24K $0000 Bit Settings MS 0 MSW [1:0] any value Internal Y data RAM 24K $0000 Memory Configuration CE SC 0 1 Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 16K 24K $0000Ð$3FFF $0000Ð$5FFF 24K None $0000Ð$5FFF Addressable Memory Size 64K *Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-11 Memory Switch Off, Cache Off, 16-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design 3-22 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFF X Data $FFFF Internal I/O Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... $FF80 External Y Data $FFFF $FFC0 $FF80 External External I/O Internal I/O External $6000 $6000 $4000 Internal Program RAM 15K $0400 Reserved $0000 $0000 Bit Settings MS 0 * MSW [1:0] $0000 Memory Configuration CE SC 1 1 any value Internal Y data RAM 24K Internal X data RAM 24K Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 15K 24K $0400Ð$3FFF $0000Ð$5FFF 24K Enabled $0000Ð$5FFF Addressable Memory Size 64K Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-12 Memory Switch Off, Cache On, 16-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-23 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program X Data $FFFF $FFFF $FFFF Internal I/O External Y Data $FF80 $FFC0 $FF80 External I/O Internal I/O $C000 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... External $6000 External $6000 Reserved Internal Program RAM 48K $0000 $2000 $0000 Bit Settings $2000 Internal X data RAM 8K $0000 Internal Y data RAM 8K Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 00 0 1 * Reserved Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 48K 8K $0000Ð$BFFF $0000Ð$1FFF 8K None $0000Ð$1FFF Addressable Memory Size 64K Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-13 Memory Switch On (MSW = 00), Cache Off, 16-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design 3-24 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program X Data $FFFF $FFFF Internal I/O External Y Data $FFFF $FF80 External I/O $FFC0 $FF80 Internal I/O Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... $C000 External $6000 External $6000 Reserved Internal Program RAM 47K $0400 Reserved $0000 $2000 $2000 Internal X data RAM 8K $0000 $0000 Bit Settings Internal Y data RAM 8K Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 00 1 1 * Reserved Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 47K 8K $0400Ð$BFFF $0000Ð$1FFF Addressable Memory Size 8K Enabled $0000Ð$1FFF 64K Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-14 Memory Switch On (MSW = 00), Cache On, 16-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-25 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFF X Data $FFFF $FFFF Internal I/O External Y Data $FF80 $FFC0 $FF80 External I/O Internal I/O $A000 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... External $6000 External $6000 Reserved Internal Program RAM 40K $0000 $3000 $3000 Internal Y data RAM 12K Internal X data RAM 12K $0000 Bit Settings $0000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 01 0 1 * Reserved Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 40K 12K $0000Ð$9FFF $0000Ð$2FFF 12K None $0000Ð$2FFF Addressable Memory Size 64K Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-15 Memory Switch On (MSW = 01), Cache Off, 16-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design 3-26 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program X Data $FFFF $FFFF $FFFF Internal I/O $FF80 External Y Data $FFC0 $FF80 External I/O Internal I/O $A000 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... External $6000 External $6000 Reserved Internal Program RAM 39K $3000 Reserved $0000 $0400 $0000 $3000 Internal Y data RAM 12K Internal X data RAM 12K Bit Settings $0000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 01 1 1 * Reserved Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 39K 12K $0400Ð$9FFF $0000Ð$2FFF Addressable Memory Size 12K Enabled $0000Ð$2FFF 64K Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-16 Memory Switch On (MSW = 01), Cache On, 16-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-27 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFF X Data $FFFF $FFFF Internal I/O External Y Data $FF80 $FFC0 $FF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... External External I/O Internal I/O External $8000 $6000 $4000 Internal Program RAM 32K $0000 Reserved Internal X data RAM 16K $0000 Bit Settings $4000 Reserved Internal Y data RAM 16K $0000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 10 0 1 * $6000 Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 32K 16K $0000Ð$7FFF $0000Ð$3FFF 16K None $0000Ð$3FFF Addressable Memory Size 64K Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-17 Memory Switch On (MSW = 10), Cache Off, 16-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design 3-28 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program X Data $FFFF $FFFF $FFFF Internal I/O $FF80 External Y Data $FFC0 $FF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... External External I/O Internal I/O External $8000 $6000 $6000 Reserved $4000 Internal Program RAM 31K $0400 $0000 Reserved $0000 Bit Settings Internal X data RAM 16K $0000 Internal Y data RAM 16K Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 10 1 1 * Reserved $4000 Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 31K 16K $0400Ð$7FFF $0000Ð$3FFF Addressable Memory Size 16K Enabled $0000Ð$3FFF 64K Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-18 Memory Switch On (MSW = 10), Cache On, 16-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-29 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program $FFFF X Data $FFFF $FFFF Internal I/O External Y Data $FF80 $FFC0 $FF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... External $6000 $6000 $5000 Internal Program RAM 24K $0000 $0000 Internal I/O External $6000 $5000 Reserved Internal Y data RAM 20K Internal X data RAM 20K Bit Settings $0000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 11 0 1 * Reserved External I/O Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 24K 20K $0000Ð$5FFF $0000Ð$4FFF 20K None $0000Ð$4FFF Addressable Memory Size 64K Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-19 Memory Switch On (MSW = 11), Cache Off, 16-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design 3-30 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Memory Maps Program X Data $FFFF $FFFF $FFFF Internal I/O $FF80 External Y Data $FFC0 $FF80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... External $6000 $6000 $5000 Internal Program RAM 23K $0400 $0000 Reserved $0000 Internal I/O External $6000 $5000 Reserved Internal Y data RAM 20K Internal X data RAM 20K Bit Settings $0000 Memory Configuration MS MSW [1:0] CE SC 1 11 1 1 * Reserved External I/O Program RAM X Data RAM* Y Data RAM* Cache 23K 20K $0400Ð$5FFF $0000Ð$4FFF Addressable Memory Size 20K Enabled $0000Ð$4FFF 64K Lowest 4K of X data RAM and 4K of Y data RAM are shared memory that can be accessed by the core and the EFCOP but is not accessible by the DMA controller. Figure 3-20 Memory Switch On (MSW = 11), Cache On, 16-Bit Mode Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 3-31 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Memory Configuration Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Memory Maps Not Recommended for New Design 3-32 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 4 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... CORE CONFIGURATION Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 4-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Core Configuration 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 4.7 4.8 4.9 4.11 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3 OPERATING MODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3 BOOTSTRAP PROGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-8 INTERRUPT SOURCES AND PRIORITIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-9 DMA REQUEST SOURCES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-15 OMR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-16 PLL CONTROL REGISTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-17 DEVICE IDENTIFICATION REGISTER (IDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-18 ADDRESS ATTRIBUTE REGISTERS (AAR1–AAR4) . . . . . . .4-19 JTAG BOUNDARY SCAN REGISTER (BSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-20 Not Recommended for New Design 4-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Introduction 4.1 INTRODUCTION This chapter presents DSP56300 core configuration details specific to the DSP56307. These configuration details include the following: ¥ Operating modes ¥ Bootstrap program ¥ Interrupt sources and priorities Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ DMA request sources ¥ OMR ¥ PLL control register ¥ AA control registers ¥ JTAG boundary scan register For information on specific registers or modules in the DSP56300 core, refer to the DSP56300 Family Manual. 4.2 OPERATING MODES The DSP56307 begins operation by leaving the Reset state and going into one of eight operating modes. As the DSP56307 exits the Reset state, it loads the values of MODA, MODB, MODC, and MODD into bits MA, MB, MC, and MD of the OMR. These bit settings determine the chipÕs operating mode, which determines the bootstrap program option the chip uses to start up. The MAÐMD bits of the OMR can also be set directly by software. A jump directly to the bootstrap program entry point ($FF0000) after the OMR bits are set causes the DSP56307 to execute the specified bootstrap program option (except modes 0 and 8). Table 4-1 shows the DSP56307 bootstrap operation modes, the corresponding settings of the external operational mode signal lines (the mode bits MAÐMD in the OMR), and the reset vector address to which the DSP56307 jumps once it leaves the Reset state. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 4-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Operating Modes Table 4-1 DSP56307 Operating Modes Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Mode MODD MODC MODB MODA Reset Vector Description 0 0 0 0 0 $C00000 Expanded mode 1 1 0 0 0 1 $FF0000 Reserved 2 0 0 1 0 $FF0000 Reserved 3 0 0 1 1 $FF0000 Reserved 4 0 1 0 0 $FF0000 Reserved 5 0 1 0 1 $FF0000 Reserved 6 0 1 1 0 $FF0000 Reserved 7 0 1 1 1 $FF0000 Reserved 8 1 0 0 0 $008000 Expanded mode 9 1 0 0 1 $FF0000 Bootstrap from byte-wide memory A 1 0 1 0 $FF0000 Bootstrap through SCI B 1 0 1 1 $FF0000 Reserved C 1 1 0 0 $FF0000 HI08 bootstrap in ISA/DSP5630X mode D 1 1 0 1 $FF0000 HI08 bootstrap in HC11 nonmultiplexed mode E 1 1 1 0 $FF0000 HI08 bootstrap in 8051 multiplexed bus mode F 1 1 1 1 $FF0000 HI08 bootstrap in MC68302 bus mode Note: 1. Address $C00000 is reflected as address $00000 on Port A signals A0ÐA17. Not Recommended for New Design 4-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Operating Modes Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 4.2.1 Mode 0—Expanded Mode Mode MODD MODC MODB MODA 0 0 0 0 0 Reset Vector $C00000 Description Expanded mode The bootstrap ROM is bypassed and the DSP56307 starts fetching instructions beginning at address $C00000. Memory accesses are performed using SRAM memory access type with 31 wait states and no address attributes selected (default). 4.2.2 Modes 1 to 7: Reserved These modes are reserved for future use. 4.2.3 Mode 8—Expanded Mode Mode MODD MODC MODB MODA 8 1 0 0 0 Reset Vector $008000 Description Expanded mode The bootstrap ROM is bypassed and the DSP56307 starts fetching instructions beginning at address $008000. Memory accesses are performed using SRAM memory access type with 31 wait states and no address attributes selected. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 4-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Operating Modes Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 4.2.4 Mode 9—Boot from Byte-Wide External Memory Mode MODD MODC MODB MODA 9 1 0 0 1 Reset Vector $FF0000 Description Bootstrap from byte-wide memory (at $D00000) The bootstrap program loads instructions through Port A from external byte-wide memory, starting at P:$D00000. The SRAM memory access type is selected by the values in address attribute register 1 (AAR1). Thirty-one wait states are inserted between each memory access. Address $D00000 is reflected as address $00000 on Port A signals A0ÐA17. The boot program concatenates every 3 bytes read from the external memory into a 24-bit wide DSP56307 word. 4.2.5 Mode A—Boot from SCI Mode MODD MODC MODB MODA A 1 0 1 0 Reset Vector $FF0000 Description Bootstrap through SCI Instructions are loaded through the SCI. The bootstrap program sets the SCI to operate in 10-bit asynchronous mode, with 1 start bit, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit, and no parity. Data is received in this order: start bit, 8 data bits (LSB first), and one stop bit. Data is aligned in the SCI receive data register with the LSB of the least significant byte of the received data appearing at Bit 0.The user must provide an external clock source with a frequency at least 16 times the transmission data rate. Each byte received by the SCI is echoed back through the SCI transmitter to the external transmitter. The boot program concatenates every 3 bytes read from the SCI into a 24-bit wide DSP56307 word. 4.2.6 Mode B—Reserved Mode MODD MODC MODB MODA B 1 0 1 1 Reset Vector Description $FF0000 Reserved This mode is reserved for future use. Not Recommended for New Design 4-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Operating Modes Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 4.2.7 Mode C—Boot from HI08 in ISA Mode (8-Bit Bus) Mode MODD MODC MODB MODA C 1 1 0 0 Reset Vector $FF0000 Description HI08 bootstrap in ISA/DSP5630X In this mode, the HI08 is configured to interface with an ISA bus or with the memory expansion port of a master DSP5630n processor through the HI08. The HI08 pin configuration is optimized for connection to the ISA bus or memory expansion port of a master DSP based on DSP56300 core. 4.2.8 Mode D—Boot from HI08 in HC11 Nonmultiplexed Mode Mode MODD MODC MODB MODA D 1 1 0 1 Reset Vector $FF0000 Description HI08 Bootstrap in HC11 nonmultiplexed The bootstrap program sets the host interface to interface with the Motorola HC11 microcontroller through the HI08. The HI08 pin configuration is optimized for connection to Motorola HC11 nonmultiplexed bus. . 4.2.9 Mode E—Boot from HI08 in 8051 Multiplexed Bus Mode Mode MODD MODC MODB MODA E 1 1 1 0 Reset Vector $FF0000 Description HI08 bootstrap in 8051 multiplexed bus The bootstrap program sets the host interface to interface with the Intel 8051 bus through the HI08. The program stored in this location, after testing MODA, MODB, MODC, and MODD, bootstraps through HI08. The HI08 pin configuration is optimized for connection to the Intel 8051 multiplexed bus. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 4-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Bootstrap Program Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 4.2.10 Mode F—Boot from HI08: MC68302/68360 Bus Mode Mode MODD MODC MODB MODA 7 F 1 1 1 Reset Vector $FF0000 Description HI08 bootstrap in MC68302 bus The bootstrap program sets the host interface to interface with the Motorola MC68302 or MC68360 bus through the HI08. The HI08 pin configuration is optimized for connection to a Motorola MC68302 or MC68360 bus. 4.3 BOOTSTRAP PROGRAM The bootstrap program is factory-programmed in an internal 192-word by 24-bit bootstrap ROM located in program memory space at locations $FF0000Ð$FF00BF. The bootstrap program can load any program RAM segment from an external byte-wide EPROM, the SCI, or the host port. The bootstrap program code is listed in Appendix A Bootstrap Programs. Upon exiting the Reset state, the DSP56307 performs these steps: 1. Samples the MODA, MODB, MODC, and MODD signal lines. 2. Loads their values into bits MA, MB, MC, and MD in the OMR. As explained in Section 4.2, the mode input signals (MODAÐMODD) and the resulting MA, MB, MC, and MD bits determine which bootstrap mode the DSP56307 enters: ¥ If MA, MB, MC, and MD are all cleared (bootstrap mode 0), the program bypasses the bootstrap ROM, and the DSP56307 starts loading instructions from external program memory location $C00000. ¥ If MA, MB, and MC are cleared and MD is set (bootstrap mode 8), the program bypasses the bootstrap ROM and the DSP56307 starts loading in instruction values from external program memory location $008000. ¥ Otherwise, the DSP56307 jumps to the bootstrap program entry point at $FF0000. Note: The bootstrap in any HI08 bootstrap mode may be stopped by setting the Host Flag 0 (HF0). This starts execution of the loaded user program from the specified starting address. Not Recommended for New Design 4-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Interrupt Sources and Priorities You can invoke the bootstrap program options (except modes 0 and 8) at any time by setting the MA, MB, MC, and MD bits in the OMR and jumping to the bootstrap program entry point, $FF0000. Software can directly set the mode selection bits in the OMR. Bootstrap modes 0 and 8 are the normal DSP56307 functioning modes. Bootstrap modes 9, A, and CÐF select different specific bootstrap loading source devices. In these modes, the bootstrap program expects the following data sequence when downloading the user program through an external port: 1. Three bytes defining the number of (24-bit) program words to be loaded Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 2. Three bytes defining the (24-bit) start address to which the user program loads in the DSP56307 program memory 3. The user program (three bytes for each 24-bit program word) Note: The three bytes for each data sequence must be loaded least significant byte first. Once the bootstrap program completes loading the specified number of words, it jumps to the specified starting address and executes the loaded program. 4.4 INTERRUPT SOURCES AND PRIORITIES DSP56307 interrupt handling, like that of all DSP56300 family members, is optimized for DSP applications. Refer to Section 7 of the DSP56300 Family Manual. The interrupt table is located in the 256 locations of program memory to which by the vector base address (VBA) register in the PCU points. 4.4.1 Interrupt Sources Because each interrupt is allocated two instructions in the table, there are 128 table entries for interrupt handling. Table 4-2 shows the table entry address for each interrupt source. The DSP56307 initialization program loads the table entry for each interrupt serviced with two interrupt servicing instructions. In the DSP56307, only some of the 128 vector addresses are used for specific interrupt sources. The remaining interrupt vectors are reserved and can be used for host NMI (IPL = 3) or for host command interrupt (IPL = 2). If certain interrupts are not to be used, those interrupt vector locations can be used for program or data storage. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 4-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Interrupt Sources and Priorities Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 4-2 Interrupt Sources Interrupt Starting Address Interrupt Priority Level Range VBA:$00 3 Hardware RESET VBA:$02 3 Stack error VBA:$04 3 Illegal instruction VBA:$06 3 Debug request interrupt VBA:$08 3 Trap VBA:$0A 3 Nonmaskable interrupt (NMI) VBA:$0C 3 Reserved VBA:$0E 3 Reserved VBA:$10 0Ð2 IRQA VBA:$12 0Ð2 IRQB VBA:$14 0Ð2 IRQC VBA:$16 0Ð2 IRQD VBA:$18 0Ð2 DMA channel 0 VBA:$1A 0Ð2 DMA channel 1 VBA:$1C 0Ð2 DMA channel 2 VBA:$1E 0Ð2 DMA channel 3 VBA:$20 0Ð2 DMA channel 4 VBA:$22 0Ð2 DMA channel 5 VBA:$24 0Ð2 TIMER 0 compare VBA:$26 0Ð2 TIMER 0 overflow VBA:$28 0Ð2 TIMER 1 compare VBA:$2A 0Ð2 TIMER 1 overflow VBA:$2C 0Ð2 TIMER 2 compare VBA:$2E 0Ð2 TIMER 2 overflow VBA:$30 0Ð2 ESSI0 receive data VBA:$32 0Ð2 ESSI0 receive data with exception status VBA:$34 0Ð2 ESSI0 receive last slot VBA:$36 0Ð2 ESSI0 transmit data VBA:$38 0Ð2 ESSI0 transmit data with exception status VBA:$3A 0Ð2 ESSI0 transmit last slot Interrupt Source Not Recommended for New Design 4-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Interrupt Sources and Priorities Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 4-2 Interrupt Sources (Continued) Interrupt Starting Address Interrupt Priority Level Range VBA:$3C 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$3E 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$40 0Ð2 ESSI1 receive data VBA:$42 0Ð2 ESSI1 receive data with exception status VBA:$44 0Ð2 ESSI1 receive last slot VBA:$46 0Ð2 ESSI1 transmit data VBA:$48 0Ð2 ESSI1 transmit data with exception status VBA:$4A 0Ð2 ESSI1 transmit last slot VBA:$4C 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$4E 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$50 0Ð2 SCI receive data VBA:$52 0Ð2 SCI receive data with exception status VBA:$54 0Ð2 SCI transmit data VBA:$56 0Ð2 SCI idle line VBA:$58 0Ð2 SCI timer VBA:$5A 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$5C 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$5E 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$60 0Ð2 Host receive data full VBA:$62 0Ð2 Host transmit data empty VBA:$64 0Ð2 Host command (default) VBA:$66 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$68 0-2 EFCOP data input buffer empty VBA:$6A 0-2 EFCOP data output buffer full VBA:$6C 0-2 Reserved VBA:$6E 0-2 Reserved : : VBA:$FE 0Ð2 Interrupt Source : Reserved Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 4-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Interrupt Sources and Priorities 4.4.2 Interrupt Priority Levels There are two interrupt priority registers in the DSP56307. The IPRÐC is dedicated to DSP56300 core interrupt sources, and IPRÐP is dedicated to DSP56307 peripheral interrupt sources. IPRÐC is shown on Figure 4-1 and IPRÐP is shown in Figure 4-2. 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 D5L1 D5L0 D4L1 D4L0 D3L1 D3L0 D2L1 16 15 D2L0 D1L1 14 13 12 D1L0 D0L1 D0L0 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DMA0 IPL DMA1 IPL DMA2 IPL DMA3 IPL DMA4 IPL DMA5 IPL 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 IDL2 IDL1 IDL0 ICL2 ICL1 ICL0 IBL2 IBL1 IBL0 IAL2 IAL1 IAL0 IRQA IPL IRQA mode IRQB IPL IRQB mode IRQC IPL IRQC mode IRQD IPL IRQD mode AA1539 Figure 4-1 Interrupt Priority Register C (IPR-C) (X:$FFFFFF) 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 reserved 11 10 9 8 T0L1 T0L0 7 6 SCL1 5 SCL0 S1L1 4 S1L0 3 2 S0L1 S0L0 1 0 HPL1 HPL0 HI08 IPL ESSI0 IPL ESSI1 IPL SCI IPL TRIPLE TIMER IPL EFCOP IPL AA1540 Figure 4-2 Interrupt Priority Register P (IPR-P) (X:$FFFFFE) Not Recommended for New Design 4-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Interrupt Sources and Priorities . Table 4-3 Interrupt Priority Level Bits Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... IPL bits 4.4.3 Interrupts Enabled Interrupts Masked Interrupt Priority Level xxL1 xxL0 0 0 No Ñ 0 0 1 Yes 0 1 1 0 Yes 0, 1 2 1 1 Yes 0, 1, 2 3 Interrupt Source Priorities within an IPL If more than one interrupt request is pending when an instruction executes, the interrupt source with the highest IPL is serviced first. When several interrupt requests with the same IPL are pending, another fixed-priority structure within that IPL determines which interrupt source is serviced first. This fixed-priority list of interrupt sources within an IPL is shown in Table 4-4. Table 4-4 Interrupt Source Priorities within an IPL Priority Interrupt Source Level 3 (nonmaskable) Highest Hardware RESET Stack error Illegal instruction Debug request interrupt Trap Lowest Nonmaskable interrupt Levels 0, 1, 2 (maskable) Highest IRQA (external interrupt) IRQB (external interrupt) IRQC (external interrupt) IRQD (external interrupt) DMA channel 0 interrupt Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 4-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Interrupt Sources and Priorities Table 4-4 Interrupt Source Priorities within an IPL (Continued) Priority Interrupt Source DMA channel 1 interrupt DMA channel 2 interrupt DMA channel 3 interrupt DMA channel 4 interrupt Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DMA channel 5 interrupt Host command interrupt Host transmit data empty Host receive data full ESSI0 RX data with exception interrupt ESSI0 RX data interrupt ESSI0 receive last slot interrupt ESSI0 TX data with exception interrupt ESSI0 transmit last slot interrupt ESSI0 TX data interrupt ESSI1 RX data with exception interrupt ESSI1 RX data interrupt ESSI1 receive last slot interrupt ESSI1 TX data with exception interrupt ESSI1 transmit last slot interrupt ESSI1 TX data interrupt SCI receive data with exception interrupt SCI receive data SCI transmit data SCI idle line SCI timer TIMER0 overflow interrupt TIMER0 compare interrupt TIMER1 overflow interrupt TIMER1 compare interrupt Not Recommended for New Design 4-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration DMA Request Sources Table 4-4 Interrupt Source Priorities within an IPL (Continued) Priority Interrupt Source TIMER2 overflow interrupt TIMER2 compare interrupt EFCOP data input buffer empty Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Lowest 4.5 EFCOP data output buffer full DMA REQUEST SOURCES The DMA request source bits (DRS[4:0]) in the DMA control/status registers) encode the source of DMA requests used to trigger DMA transfers. The DMA request sources may be internal peripherals or external devices requesting service through the IRQA, IRQB, IRQC, or IRQD signals. Table 4-5 shows the values of the DRS bits. Table 4-5 DMA Request Sources DMA Request Source Bits DRS4 . . . DRS0 Requesting Device 00000 External (IRQA signal) 00001 External (IRQB signal) 00010 External (IRQC signal) 00011 External (IRQD signal) 00100 Transfer done from DMA channel 0 00101 Transfer done from DMA channel 1 00110 Transfer done from DMA channel 2 00111 Transfer done from DMA channel 3 01000 Transfer done from DMA channel 4 01001 Transfer done from DMA channel 5 01010 ESSI0 receive data (RDF0 = 1) 01011 ESSI0 transmit data (TDE0 = 1) 01100 ESSI1 receive data (RDF1 = 1) 01101 ESSI1 transmit data (TDE1 = 1) 01110 SCI receive data (RDRF = 1) 01111 SCI transmit data (TDRE = 1) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 4-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration OMR Table 4-5 DMA Request Sources (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DMA Request Source Bits DRS4 . . . DRS0 Requesting Device 10000 Timer0 (TCF0 = 1) 10001 Timer1 (TCF1 = 1) 10010 Timer2 (TCF2 = 1) 10011 Host receive data full (HRDF = 1) 10100 Host transmit data empty (HTDE = 1) 10101 EFCOP input buffer empty (FDIBE=1) 10110 EFCOP output buffer full (FDOBF=1) 10111Ð11111 4.6 Reserved OMR The OMR is a 24-bit read/write register divided into three byte-sized units. The lowest two bytes (EOM and COM) are used to control the chipÕs operating mode. The high byte (SCS) is used to control and monitor the stack extension. The OMR control bits are shown in Figure 4-3. See the DSP56300 Family Manual for a complete description of the OMR. SCS 23 22 21 20 19 EOM 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 COM 10 MSW[1:0] SEN WRP EOV EUN XYS ATE APD ABE BRT TAS BE MSW1Ð MSW0 - Memory Switch ConÞguration 9 8 CDP1:0 7 6 MS SD 5 4 3 2 1 0 EBD MD MC MB MA ATE - Address Tracing Enable MS - Memory Switch Mode APD - Address Attribute Disable SD - Stop Delay SEN - Stack Extension Enable ABE - Async. Bus Arbitration Enable EBD - External Bus Disable WRP - Extended Stack Wrap Flag BRT - Bus Release Timing MD - Operating Mode D EOV - Extended Stack Overßow Flag TAS - TA Synchronize Select MC - Operating Mode C EUN - Extended Stack Underßow Flag BE - Burst Mode Enable MB - Operating Mode B XYS - Stack Extension Space Select CDP1 - Core-DMA Priority 1 MA - Operating Mode A CDP0 - Core-DMA Priority 0 AA1541 - Reserved bit; read as zero; should be written with zero for future compatibility Figure 4-3 DSP56307 Operating Mode Register (OMR) Format Not Recommended for New Design 4-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration PLL Control Register 4.7 PLL CONTROL REGISTER The PLL control register (PCTL) is an X-I/O mapped, 24-bit read/write register used to direct the operation of the on-chip PLL. The PCTL control bits are shown in Figure 4-4. See the DSP56300 Family Manual for a full description of the PCTL. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 23 PD3 11 MF11 22 PD2 10 MF10 21 PD1 9 MF9 20 PD0 8 MF8 19 COD 7 MF7 18 PEN 6 MF6 17 PSTP 5 MF5 16 XTLD 4 MF4 15 XTLR 3 MF3 14 DF2 2 MF2 13 DF1 1 MF1 12 DF0 0 MF0 AA0852 Figure 4-4 PLL Control Register (PCTL) 4.7.1 Predivider Factor Bits (PD[3:0])—PCTL Bits 23–20 The predivider factor bits (PD[3:0]) define the predivision factor (PDF) to be applied to the PLL input frequency. The PD[3:0] bits are cleared during DSP56307 hardware reset, which corresponds to a PDF of one. 4.7.2 Clock Output Disable (COD) Bit—PCTL Bit 19 The COD bit controls the output buffer of the clock at the CLKOUT pin. When COD is set, the CLKOUT output is pulled high. When COD is cleared, the CLKOUT pin provides a 50% duty cycle clock synchronized to the internal core clock. 4.7.3 PLL Enable (PEN) Bit—PCTL Bit 18 The PEN bit enables PLL operation. 4.7.4 PLL Stop State (PSTP) Bit—Bit 17 The PSTP bit controls PLL and on-chip crystal oscillator behavior during the stop processing state. 4.7.5 XTAL Disable (XTLD) Bit—PCTL Bit 16 The XTLD bit controls the on-chip crystal oscillator XTAL output. The XTLD bit is cleared during DSP56307 hardware reset; consequently, the XTAL output signal is active, permitting normal operation of the crystal oscillator. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 4-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Device Identification Register (IDR) 4.7.6 Crystal Range (XTLR) Bit—PCTL Bit 15 The XTLR bit controls the on-chip crystal oscillator transconductance. The XTLR bit is set to a predetermined value during hardware reset. 4.7.7 PCTL Bits 14–12 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The division factor bits DF[2:0] define the DF of the low-power divider. These bits specify the DF as a power of two in the range from 20 to 27. 4.7.8 PLL Multiplication Factor—PCTL Bits 11–0 The multiplication factor bits (MF[11:0]) define the multiplication factor (MF) that is applied to the PLL input frequency. The MF bits are cleared during DSP56307 hardware reset, and thus it corresponds to an MF of one. 4.8 DEVICE IDENTIFICATION REGISTER (IDR) The IDR is a 24-bit, read-only factory-programmed register that identifies DSP56300 family members. It specifies the derivative number and revision number of the device. This information is used in testing or by software. Figure 4-5 shows the contents of the IDR. Revision numbers are assigned as follows: $0 is revision 0, $1 is revision A, and so on. 23 16 15 12 11 0 Reserved Revision Number Derivative Number $00 $0 $307 AA1503 Figure 4-5 Identification Register Configuration (Revision 0) Not Recommended for New Design 4-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration Address Attribute Registers (AAR1–AAR4) 4.9 ADDRESS ATTRIBUTE REGISTERS (AAR1–AAR4) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... An AAR is shown in Figure 4-6. There are four of these registers in the DSP56307 (AAR0ÐAAR3), one for each address attribute signal. For a full description of the address attribute registers see the DSP56300 Family Manual. Address multiplexing is not supported by the DSP56307. Bit 6 (BAM) of the AAR is reserved and should be written with 0 only. 11 10 9 8 7 6 BNC3 BNC2 BNC1 BNC0 BPAC 5 4 3 2 1 0 BYEN BXEN BPEN BAAP BAT1 BAT0 External Access Type AA pin polarity Program space Enable X data space Enable Y data space Enable Reserved Packing Enable Number of Address bit to compare 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 BAC11 BAC10 BAC9 BAC8 BAC7 BAC6 BAC5 BAC4 BAC3 BAC2 BAC1 BAC0 Address to Compare - Reserved Bit AA1504 Figure 4-6 Address Attribute Registers (AAR0ÐAAR3) (X:$FFFFF9Ð$FFFFF6) 4.10 JTAG IDENTIFICATION (ID) REGISTER The JTAG ID register is a 32-bit read-only factory-programmed register that distinguishes the component on a board according to the IEEE 1149.1 standard. Figure 4-7 shows the JTAG ID register configuration. Version information corresponds to the revision number ($0 for revision 0, $1 for revision A, etc.). Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 4-19 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Core Configuration JTAG Boundary Scan Register (BSR) I) 31 28 27 22 21 12 11 1 0 Version Information Customer Part Number Sequence Number Manufacturer Identity 1 0000 000110 0000000111 00000001110 1 AA1505 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Figure 4-7 JTAG Identification Register Configuration (Revision 0) 4.11 JTAG BOUNDARY SCAN REGISTER (BSR) The BSR in the DSP56307 JTAG implementation contains bits for all device signals, clock pins, and their associated control signals. All DSP56307 bidirectional pins have a corresponding register bit in the BSR for pin data and are controlled by an associated control bit in the BSR. The BSR is documented in Section 12 Joint Test Action Group Port of this manual, and the JTAG code listing is in Appendix C DSP56307 BSDL Listing. Not Recommended for New Design 4-20 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... GENERAL-PURPOSE INPUT/OUTPUT Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 5-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. GeneraL-Purpose Input/Output INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3 PROGRAMMING MODEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 5.1 5.2 Not Recommended for New Design 5-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. GeneraL-Purpose Input/Output Introduction 5.1 INTRODUCTION The DSP56307 provides 34 bidirectional signals that can be configured as GPIO signals or as peripheral dedicated signals. No dedicated GPIO signals are provided. All of these signals are GPIO by default after reset. The control register settings of the DSP56307 peripherals determine whether these signals function as GPIO or as peripheral dedicated signals. This section tells how signals can be used as GPIO. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 5.2 PROGRAMMING MODEL Section 2 Signal/Connection Descriptions of this manual documents in detail the special uses of the 34 bidirection signals. These signals fall into five groups and are controlled separately or as the following groups. ¥ Port B: 16 GPIO signals (shared with the HI08 signals) ¥ Port C: six GPIO signals (shared with the ESSI0 signals) ¥ Port D: six GPIO signals (shared with the ESSI1 signals) ¥ Port E: three GPIO signals (shared with the SCI signals) ¥ Timers: three GPIO signals (shared with the triple timer signals) 5.2.1 Port B Signals and Registers Each of the 16 Port B signals not used as an HI08 signal can be configured as a GPIO signal. The GPIO functionality of Port B is controlled by three registers: host control register (HCR), host port GPIO data register (HDR), and host port GPIO direction register (HDDR). These registers are documented in Section 6 Host Interface (HI08) of this manual. 5.2.2 Port C Signals and Registers Each of the six Port C signals not used as an ESSI0 signal can be configured as a GPIO signal. The GPIO functionality of Port C is controlled by three registers: Port C control register (PCRC), Port C direction register (PRRC), and Port C data register (PDRC). These registers are documented in Section 7 Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface of this manual. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 5-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. GeneraL-Purpose Input/Output Programming Model 5.2.3 Port D Signals and Registers Each of the six Port D signals not used as an ESSI1 signal can be configured as a GPIO signal. The GPIO functionality of Port D is controlled by three registers: Port D control register (PCRD), Port D direction register (PRRD), and Port D data register (PDRD). These registers are documented in Section 7 Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface of this manual. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 5.2.4 Port E Signals and Registers Each of the three Port E signals not used as an SCI signal can be configured as a GPIO signal. The GPIO functionality of Port E is controlled by three registers: Port E control register (PCRE), Port E direction register (PRRE) and Port E data register (PDRE). These registers are documented in Section 8 Serial Communication Interface of this manual. 5.2.5 Triple Timer Signals Each of the three triple timer interface signals (TIO0ÐTIO2) not used as a timer signal can be configured as a GPIO signal. Each signal is controlled by the appropriate timer control status register (TCSR0ÐTCSR2). These registers are documented in Section 9 Triple Timer Module of this manual. Not Recommended for New Design 5-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 6 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... HOST INTERFACE (HI08) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3 HI08 FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3 HI08 HOST PORT SIGNALS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-6 HI08 BLOCK DIAGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-7 HI08—DSP-SIDE PROGRAMMER’S MODEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-8 HI08—EXTERNAL HOST PROGRAMMER’S MODEL . . . . . . .6-21 SERVICING THE HOST INTERFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-31 HI08 PROGRAMMING MODEL—QUICK REFERENCE . . . . .6-34 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 6.5 6.6 6.7 6.8 Not Recommended for New Design 6-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) Introduction 6.1 INTRODUCTION The host interface (HI08) is a byte-wide, full-duplex, double-buffered parallel port that can connect directly to the data bus of a host processor. The HI08 supports a variety of buses and provides glueless connection with a number of industry-standard microcomputers, microprocessors, and DSPs. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Because the host bus can operate asynchronously to the DSP core clock, the HI08 registers are divided into two banks. The host register bank is accessible to the external host and the DSP register bank is accessible to the DSP core. The HI08 supports two classes of interfaces: ¥ Host processor/microcontroller connection interface ¥ GPIO port Signals not used as HI08 port signals can be configured as GPIO signals, up to a total of 16. 6.2 HI08 FEATURES This section lists the features of the host-to-DSP and DSP-to-host interfaces. Sections 6.5 and 6.6 contain further details. 6.2.1 Host-to-DSP Core Interface ¥ Mapping: Ð Registers are directly mapped into eight internal X data memory locations. ¥ Data word: Ð DSP56307 24-bit (native) data words are supported, as are 8-bit and 16-bit words. ¥ Transfer modes: Ð DSP-to-host Ð Host-to-DSP Ð Host command Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08 Features ¥ Handshaking protocols: Ð Software polled Ð Interrupt driven Ð Core DMA accesses Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Instructions: Ð Memory-mapped registers allow the standard MOVE instruction to transfer data between the DSP56307 and external hosts. Ð A special MOVEP instruction provides for I/O service capability using fast interrupts. Ð Bit addressing instructions (e.g., BCHG, BCLR, BSET, BTST, JCLR, JSCLR, JSET, JSSET) simplify I/O service routines. 6.2.2 HI08 to Host Processor Interface ¥ Sixteen signals support nonmultiplexed or multiplexed buses: Ð H0ÐH7/HAD0ÐHAD7 host data bus (H0ÐH7) or host multiplexed address/data bus (HAD0ÐHAD7) Ð HAS/HA0 address strobe (HAS) or host address line (HA0) Ð HA8/HA1 host address line (HA8) or host address line (HA1) Ð HA9/HA2 host address line (HA9) or host address line (HA2) Ð HRW/HRD read/write select (HRW) or read strobe (HRD) Ð HDS/HWR data strobe (HDS) or write strobe (HWR) Ð HCS/HA10 host chip select (HCS) or host address line (HA10) Ð HREQ/HTRQ host request (HREQ) or host transmit request (HTRQ) Ð HACK/HRRQ host acknowledge (HACK) or host receive request (HRRQ) ¥ Mapping: Ð HI08 registers are mapped into eight consecutive locations in external bus address space. Ð The HI08 acts as a memory or I/O-mapped peripheral for microprocessors, microcontrollers, etc. ¥ Data word: 8 bits Not Recommended for New Design 6-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08 Features ¥ Transfer modes: Ð Mixed 8-bit, 16-bit, and 24-bit data transfers ¥ DSP-to-host ¥ Host-to-DSP Ð Host command Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Handshaking protocols: Ð Software polled Ð Interrupt-driven (Interrupts are compatible with most processors, including the MC68000, 8051, HC11, and Hitachi H8.) ¥ Dedicated interrupts: Ð Separate interrupt lines for each interrupt source Ð Special host commands force DSP core interrupts under host processor control. These commands are useful for ¥ Real-time production diagnostics ¥ Creation of a debugging window for program development ¥ Host control protocols ¥ Interface capabilities: Ð Glueless interface (no external logic required) to ¥ Motorola HC11 ¥ Hitachi H8 ¥ 8051 family ¥ Thomson P6 family Ð Minimal glue-logic (pull-ups, pull-downs) required to interface to ¥ ISA bus ¥ Motorola 68K family ¥ Intel X86 family Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08 Host Port Signals 6.3 HI08 HOST PORT SIGNALS The host port signals are documented in Section 2 Signal/Connection Descriptions. Each host port signal may be programmed as a host port signal or as a GPIO signal, PB0ÐPB15. See Table 6-1 through Table 6-3. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 6-1 HI08 Signal Definitions for Various Operational Modes HI08 Port Signal Multiplexed Address/Data Bus Mode Nonmultiplexed Bus Mode GPIO Mode HAD0ÐHAD7 HAD0ÐHAD7 H0ÐH7 PB0ÐPB7 HAS/HA0 HAS/HAS HA0 PB8 HA8/HA1 HA8 HA1 PB9 HA9/HA2 HA9 HA2 PB10 HCS/HA10 HA10 HCS/HCS PB13 Table 6-2 HI08 Data Strobe Signals HI08 Port Signal Single Strobe Bus Dual Strobe Bus GPIO Mode HRW/HRD HRW HRD/HRD PB11 HDS/HWR HDS/HDS HWR/HWR PB12 Table 6-3 HI08 Host Request Signals HI08 Port Signal Vector Required No Vector Required GPIO Mode HREQ/ HTRQ HREQ/HREQ HTRQ/HTRQ PB14 HACK/ HRRQ HACK/HACK HRRQ/HRRQ PB15 Not Recommended for New Design 6-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08 Block Diagram 6.4 HI08 BLOCK DIAGRAM Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Figure 6-1 shows the HI08 registers. The DSP core can access the top row of registers (HCR, HSR, HDDR, HDR, HBAR, HPCR, HTX, HRX) can be accessed by the DSP core. The host processor can access the bottom row of registers (ISR, ICR, CVR, IVR, RXH:RXM:RXL, and TXH:TXM:TXL). HCR = host control register HSR = host status register HPCR = host port control register HBAR = host base address register HTX = host transmit register HRX = host receive register HDDR = host data direction register HDR = host data register Core DMA Data Bus DSP Peripheral Data Bus 24 HCR 24 HSR 24 HDDR 24 24 HDR 24 HBAR 8 24 HPCR 24 24 HTX Address Comparator 24 HRX 24 24 5 3 ISR ICR 8 8 CVR 8 IVR 8 Latch 8 RXH RXM RXL 3 8 8 8 TXH TXM TXL 8 8 8 HOST Bus ICR = interface control register CVR = command vector register ISR = interface status register IVR = interrupt vector register RXH = receive register high RXM = receive register middle RXL = receive register low TXH = transmit register high TXM = transmit register middle TXL = transmit register low AA0657 Figure 6-1 HI08 Block Diagram Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 6.5 HI08—DSP-SIDE PROGRAMMER’S MODEL The DSP56307 core treats the HI08 as a memory-mapped peripheral occupying eight 24-bit words in X data memory space. The DSP can use the HI08 as a normal memory-mapped peripheral, employing either standard polled or interrupt-driven programming techniques. Separate transmit and receive data registers are double-buffered to allow the DSP and host processor to transfer data efficiently at high speed. Direct memory mapping allows the DSP56307 core to communicate with the HI08 registers using standard instructions and addressing modes. In addition, the MOVEP instruction allows direct data transfers between DSP56307 internal memory and the HI08 registers or vice versa. There are two kinds of host processor registers, data and control, with eight registers in all. All eight registers can be accessed by the DSP core, but not by the external host. The following are data registers, 24-bit registers used for high-speed data transfer to and from the DSP. ¥ Host data receive register (HRX) ¥ Host data transmit register (HTX) The DSP-side control registers are 16-bit registers that control DSP functions. The DSP56307 needs the eight MSBs in the DSP-side control registers as 0. These registers are the following: ¥ Host control register (HCR) ¥ Host status register (HSR) ¥ Host base address register (HBAR) ¥ Host port control register (HPCR) ¥ Host GPIO data direction register (HDDR) ¥ Host GPIO data register (HDR) Both hardware and software resets disable the HI08. After a reset, the HI08 signals are configured as GPIO and disconnected from the DSP56307 core (i.e., the signals are left floating). Not Recommended for New Design 6-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model 6.5.1 Host Receive Data Register (HRX) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The HRX register performs host-to-DSP data transfers.The DSP56307 views it as a 24-bit read-only register. Its address is X:$FFFFC6. It is loaded with 24-bit data from the transmit data registers (TXH:TXM:TXL on the host side) when both the transmit data register empty (TXDE (ISR, Bit 1), on the host side) and host receive data full (HRDF (HSR, Bit 0) on the DSP side) bits are cleared. The transfer operation sets both the TXDE and HRDF bits. When the HRDF bit is set, the HRX register contains valid data. The DSP56307 may set the HRIE bit (HCR, Bit 0) to cause a host receive data interrupt when HRDF is set. When the DSP56307 reads the HRX register, the HRDF bit is cleared. 6.5.2 Host Transmit Data Register (HTX) The HTX register performs DSP-to-host data transfers. The DSP56307 views it as a 24-bit write-only register. Its address is X:$FFFFC7. Writing to the HTX register clears the host transfer data empty bit (HTDE (HSR Bit 1), on the DSP side). The contents of the HTX register are transferred as 24-bit data to the receive byte registers (RXH:RXM:RXL) when both the HTDE and receive data full (RXDF (ISR, Bit 0), on the host side) bits are cleared. This transfer operation sets the RXDF and HTDE bits. The DSP56307 can set the HTIE bit to cause a host transmit data interrupt when HTDE is set. To prevent the previous data from being overwritten, data should not be written to the HTX until the HTDE bit is set. Note: When data is written to a peripheral device, there is a two-cycle pipeline delay until any status bits affected by this operation are updated. If the user reads any of those status bits within the next two cycles, the bit will not reflect its current status. See the DSP56300 Family Manual, Appendix B, Polling a Peripheral Device for Write for further details. 6.5.3 Host Control Register (HCR) The HCR is a 16-bit read/write control register by which the DSP core controls the HI08 operating mode. The HCR bits are described in the following paragraphs. Initialization values for HCR bits are documented in Section 6.5.9 DSP-Side Registers after Reset on page 6-19. Reserved bits are read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 HF3 HF2 HCIE HTIE HRIE Figure 6-2 Host Control Register (HCR) (X:$FFFFC2) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 —Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility. AA0658 Figure 6-2 Host Control Register (HCR) (X:$FFFFC2) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 6.5.3.1 HCR Host Receive Interrupt Enable (HRIE) Bit 0 When set, the HRIE bit generates a host receive data interrupt request if the host receive data full (HRDF) bit in the host status register (HSR, Bit 0) is set. The HRDF bit is set when data is transferred to the HRX from the TXH, TXM, or TXL registers. If HRIE is cleared, HRDF interrupts are disabled. 6.5.3.2 HCR Host Transmit Interrupt Enable (HTIE) Bit 1 When set, the HTIE bit generates a host transmit data interrupt request if the host transmit data empty (HTDE) bit in the HSR is set. The HTDE bit is set when data is transferred from the HTX to the RXH, RXM, or RXL registers. If HTIE is cleared, HTDE interrupts are disabled. 6.5.3.3 HCR Host Command Interrupt Enable (HCIE) Bit 2 When set, the HCIE bit generates a host command interrupt request if the host command pending (HCP) status bit in the HSR is set. If HCIE is cleared, HCP interrupts are disabled. The interrupt address is determined by the host command vector register (CVR). Note: If more than one interrupt request source is asserted and enabled (e.g., HRDF is set, HCP is set, HRIE is set, and HCIE is set), the HI08 generates interrupt requests according to priorities shown in Table 6-4. Table 6-4 Host Command Interrupt Priority List Priority Interrupt Source Highest Host Command (HCP = 1) Transmit Data (HTDE = 1) Lowest Receive Data (HRDF = 1) 6.5.3.4 HCR Host Flags 2, 3 (HF[3:2]) Bits 3, 4 HF[3:2] bits function as general-purpose flags for DSP-to-host communication. HF[3:2] can be set or cleared by the DSP core. The values of HF[3:2] are reflected in the interface status register (ISR); that is, if they are modified by the DSP software, the host processor can read the modified values by reading the ISR. Not Recommended for New Design 6-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model These two general-purpose flags can be used individually or as encoded pairs in a simple DSP-to-host communication protocol, implemented in both the DSP and the host processor software. 6.5.3.5 HCR Reserved Bits 5–15 These bits are reserved. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 6.5.4 Host Status Register (HSR) The HSR is a 16-bit read-only status register by which the DSP reads the HIO8 status and flags. The host processor cannot access it directly. Reserved bits are read as 0 and should be written with 0. The initialization values for the HSR bits are documented in Section 6.5.9 DSP-Side Registers after Reset on page 6-19. The HSR bits are documented in the following paragraphs. 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 HF1 HF0 HCP 1 0 HTDE HRDF —Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility. AA0659 Figure 6-3 Host Status Register (HSR) (X:$FFFFC3) 6.5.4.1 HSR Host Receive Data Full (HRDF) Bit 0 The HRDF bit indicates that the host receive data register (HRX) contains data from the host processor. HRDF is set when data is transferred from the TXH:TXM:TXL registers to the HRX register. If HRDF is set, the HI08 generates a receive data full DMA request. HRDF is cleared when HRX is read by the DSP core. HRDF can also be cleared by the host processor using the initialize function. 6.5.4.2 HSR Host Transmit Data Empty (HTDE) Bit 1 The HTDE bit indicates that the host transmit data register (HTX) is empty and can be written by the DSP core. HTDE is set when the HTX register is transferred to the RXH:RXM:RXL registers. HTDE can also be set by the host processor using the initialize function. If HTDE is set, the HI08 generates a transmit data full DMA request. HTDE is cleared when HTX is written by the DSP core. 6.5.4.3 HSR Host Command Pending (HCP) Bit 2 The HCP bit indicates that the host has set the HC bit and that a host command interrupt is pending. The HCP bit reflects the status of the HC bit in the CVR. HC and HCP are cleared by the HI08 hardware when the interrupt request is serviced by the DSP core. If the host clears HC, HCP is also cleared. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model 6.5.4.4 HSR Host Flags 0, 1 (HF[1:0]) Bits 3, 4 HF[1:0] bits are used as general-purpose flags for host-to-DSP communication. HF[1:0] may be set or cleared by the host. These bits reflect the status of host flags HF[1:0] in the ICR on the host side. These two general-purpose flags can be used individually or as encoded pairs in a simple host-to-DSP communication protocol, implemented in both the DSP and the host processor software. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 6.5.4.5 HSR Reserved Bits 5–15 These bits are reserved. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0. 6.5.5 Host Base Address Register (HBAR) The HBAR is used in multiplexed bus modes to select the base address where the host-side registers are mapped into the bus address space. The address from the host bus is compared with the base address as programmed in the base address register. An internal chip select is generated if a match is found. Figure 6-5 shows how the chip-select logic uses this register. 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 BA10 BA9 BA8 BA7 BA6 BA5 BA4 BA3 AA0665 Figure 6-4 Host Base Address Register (HBAR) (X:$FFFFC5) 6.5.5.1 HBAR Base Address (BA[10:3]) Bits 0–7 These bits reflect the base address where the host-side registers are mapped into the bus address space. 6.5.5.2 HBAR Reserved Bits 8–15 These bits are reserved. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0. Not Recommended for New Design 6-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model HAD[0–7] A[3:7] Comparator Latch HAS HA[8:10] Base Address Register DSP Peripheral Data Bus 8 bits Chip select Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... AA0666 Figure 6-5 Self Chip Select Logic 6.5.6 Host Port Control Register (HPCR) The HPCR is a 16-bit read/write control register by which the DSP controls the HI08 operating mode. Reserved bits are read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. The initialization values for the HPCR bits are given in Section 6.5.9 DSP-Side Registers after Reset on page 6-19. The HPCR bits are documented in the following paragraphs. 15 14 HAP HRP 13 12 11 10 9 8 HCSP HDDS HMUX HASP HDSP HROD 7 6 HEN 5 4 3 2 1 0 HAEN HREN HCSEN HA9EN HA8EN HGEN —Reserved bit, read as 0, should be written with 0 for future compatibility. AA0660 Figure 6-6 Host Port Control Register (HPCR) (X:$FFFFC4) Note: To assure proper operation of the DSP56307, the HPCR bits HAP, HRP, HCSP, HDDS, HMUX, HASP, HDSP, HROD, HAEN, and HREN should be changed only if HEN is cleared. Likewise, the HPCR bits HAP, HRP, HCSP, HDDS, HMUX, HASP, HDSP, HROD, HAEN, HREN, HCSEN, HA9EN, and HA8EN should not be set when HEN is set nor simultaneously with HEN being set. 6.5.6.1 HPCR Host GPIO Port Enable (HGEN) Bit 0 If HGEN is set, signals configured as GPIO are enabled. If this bit is cleared, signals configured as GPIO are disconnected: outputs are high impedance, inputs are electrically disconnected. Signals configured as HI08 are not affected by the value of HGEN. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model 6.5.6.2 HPCR Host Address Line 8 Enable (HA8EN) Bit 1 If HA8EN is set and the HI08 is used in multiplexed bus mode, then HA8/A1 is used as host address line 8 (HA8). If this bit is cleared and the HI08 is used in multiplexed bus mode, then HA8/HA1 is used as a GPIO signal according to the value of the HDDR and HDR. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Note: HA8EN is ignored when the HI08 is not in the multiplexed bus mode (i.e., when HMUX is cleared). 6.5.6.3 HPCR Host Address Line 9 Enable (HA9EN) Bit 2 If HA9EN is set and the HI08 is used in multiplexed bus mode, then HA9/HA2 is used as host address line 9 (HA9). If this bit is cleared, and the HI08 is used in multiplexed bus mode, then HA9/HA2 is configured as a GPIO signal according to the value of the HDDR and HDR. Note: HA9EN is ignored when the HI08 is not in the multiplexed bus mode (i.e., when HMUX is cleared). 6.5.6.4 HPCR Host Chip Select Enable (HCSEN) Bit 3 If the HCSEN bit is set, then HCS/HA10 is used as host chip select (HCS) in the nonmultiplexed bus mode (i.e., when HMUX is cleared), and as host address line 10 (HA10) in the multiplexed bus mode (i.e., when HMUX is set). If this bit is cleared, then HCS/HA10 is configured as a GPIO signal according to the value of the HDDR and HDR. 6.5.6.5 HPCR Host Request Enable (HREN) Bit 4 The HREN bit controls the host request signals. If HREN is set and the HI08 is in the single host request mode (i.e., if HDRQ is cleared in the host interface control register (ICR)), then HREQ/HTRQ is configured as the host request (HREQ) output. If HREN is cleared, HREQ/HTRQ and HACK/HRRQ are configured as GPIO signals according to the value of the HDDR and HDR. If HREN is set in the double host request mode (i.e., if HDRQ is set in the ICR), then HREQ/HTRQ is configured as the host transmit request (HTRQ) output and HACK/HRRQ as the host receive request (HRRQ) output. If HREN is cleared, HREQ/HTRQ and HACK/HRRQ are configured as GPIO signals according to the value of the HDDR and HDR. 6.5.6.6 HPCR Host Acknowledge Enable (HAEN) Bit 5 The HAEN bit controls the HACK signal. In the single host request mode (HDRQ is cleared in the ICR), if HAEN and HREN are both set, HACK/HRRQ is configured as the host acknowledge (HACK) input. If HAEN or HREN is cleared, HACK/HRRQ is Not Recommended for New Design 6-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model configured as a GPIO signal according to the value of the HDDR and HDR. In the double host request mode (HDRQ is set in the ICR), HAEN is ignored. 6.5.6.7 HPCR Host Enable (HEN) Bit 6 If HEN is set, the HI08 operates as the host interface. If HEN is cleared, the HI08 is not active, and all the HI08 signals are configured as GPIO signals according to the value of the HDDR and HDR. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 6.5.6.8 HPCR Reserved Bit 7 This bit is reserved. It is read as 0 and should be written as 0. 6.5.6.9 HPCR Host Request Open Drain (HROD) Bit 8 The HROD bit controls the output drive of the host request signals. In the single host request mode (i.e., when HDRQ is cleared in ICR), if HROD is cleared and host requests are enabled (i.e., if HREN is set and HEN is set in the host port control register (HPCR)), then the HREQ signal is always driven by the HI08. If HROD is set and host requests are enabled, the HREQ signal is an open drain output. In the double host request mode (i.e., when HDRQ is set in the ICR), if HROD is cleared and host requests are enabled (i.e., if HREN is set and HEN is set in the HPCR), then the HTRQ and HRRQ signals are always driven. If HROD is set and host requests are enabled, the HTRQ and HRRQ signals are open drain outputs. 6.5.6.10 HPCR Host Data Strobe Polarity (HDSP) Bit 9 If HDSP is cleared, the data strobe signals are configured as active low inputs, and data is transferred when the data strobe is low. If HDSP is set, the data strobe signals are configured as active high inputs, and data is transferred when the data strobe is high. The data strobe signals are either HDS by itself or both HRD and HWR together. 6.5.6.11 HPCR Host Address Strobe Polarity (HASP) Bit 10 If HASP is cleared, the host address strobe (HAS) signal is an active low input, and the address on the host address/data bus is sampled when the HAS signal is low. If HASP is set, HAS is an active-high address strobe input, and the address on the host address or data bus is sampled when the HAS signal is high. 6.5.6.12 HPCR Host Multiplexed Bus (HMUX) Bit 11 If HMUX is set, the HI08 latches the lower portion of a multiplexed address/data bus. In this mode the internal address line values of the host registers are taken from the internal latch. If HMUX is cleared, it indicates that the HI08 is connected to a nonmultiplexed type of bus. The values of the address lines are then taken from the HI08 input signals. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model 6.5.6.13 HPCR Host Dual Data Strobe (HDDS) Bit 12 If the HDDS bit is cleared, the HI08 operates in single strobe bus mode. In this mode, the bus has a single data strobe signal for both reads and writes. If the HDDS bit is set, the HI08 operates in dual strobe bus mode. In this mode, the bus has two separate data strobes: one for data reads, the other for data writes. See Figure 6-7 and Figure 6-8 for more information about the two types of buses. . Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... HRW HDS In a single strobe bus, a DS (data strobe) signal qualifies the access, while a R/W (Read-Write) signal specifies the direction of the access. AA0661 Figure 6-7 Single Strobe Bus Data Write Data In HWR Write Cycle Data Read Data Out HRD Read Cycle In dual strobe bus, there are separate HRD and HWR signals that specify the access as being a read or write access, respectively. AA0662 Figure 6-8 Dual Strobe Bus 6.5.6.14 HPCR Host Chip Select Polarity (HCSP) Bit 13 If the HCSP bit is cleared, the host chip select (HCS) signal is configured as an active low input and the HI08 is selected when the HCS signal is low. If the HCSP signal is set, HCS is configured as an active high input and the HI08 is selected when the HCS signal is high. 6.5.6.15 HPCR Host Request Polarity (HRP) Bit 14 The HRP bit controls the polarity of the host request signals. Not Recommended for New Design 6-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model In single host request mode (i.e., when HDRQ is cleared in the ICR), if HRP is cleared and host requests are enabled (i.e., if HREN is set and HEN is set), then the HREQ signal is an active low output. If HRP is set and host requests are enabled, the HREQ signal is an active high output. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... In the double host request mode (i.e., when HDRQ is set in the ICR), if HRP is cleared and host requests are enabled (i.e., if HREN is set and HEN is set), then the HTRQ and HRRQ signals are active low outputs. If HRP is set and host requests are enabled, the HTRQ and HRRQ signals are active high outputs. 6.5.6.16 HPCR Host Acknowledge Polarity (HAP) Bit 15 If the HAP bit is cleared, the host acknowledge (HACK) signal is configured as an active low input. The HI08 drives the contents of the IVR onto the host bus when the HACK signal is low. If the HAP bit is set, the HACK signal is configured as an active high input. The HI08 outputs the contents of the IVR when the HACK signal is high. 6.5.7 Host Data Direction Register (HDDR) The HDDR controls the direction of the data flow for each of the HI08 signals configured as GPIO. Even when the HI08 functions as the host interface, its unused signals can be configured as GPIO signals. For information about the HI08 GPIO configuration options, see Section 6.6.8 GPIO on page 6-30. If Bit DRxx is set, the corresponding HI08 signal is configured as an output signal. If Bit DRxx is cleared, the corresponding HI08 signal is configured as an input signal. 15 14 13 12 11 10 DR15 DR14 DR13 DR12 DR11 DR10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DR9 DR8 DR7 DR6 DR5 DR4 DR3 DR2 DR1 DR0 AA0663 Figure 6-9 Host Data Direction Register (HDDR) (X:$FFFFC8) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model 6.5.8 Host Data Register (HDR) The HDR register holds the data value of the corresponding bits of the HI08 signals configured as GPIO signals. The functionality of Bit Dxx depends on the corresponding HDDR bit (i.e., DRxx). The HDR cannot be accessed by the host processor. 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D15 D14 D13 D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 AA0664 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Figure 6-10 Host Data Register (HDR) (X:$FFFFC9) Table 6-5 HDR and HDDR Functionality HDDR HDR Dxx DRxx GPIO Signala a. Non-GPIO Signala 0 Read-only bitÑThe value read is the binary value of the signal. The corresponding signal is configured as an input. Read-only bitÑDoes not contain significant data. 1 Read/write bitÑ The value written is the value read. The corresponding signal is configured as an output, and is driven with the data written to Dxx. Read/write bitÑ The value written is the value read. defined by the selected configuration Not Recommended for New Design 6-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model 6.5.9 DSP-Side Registers after Reset Table 6-6 shows the results of the four reset types on the bits in each of the HI08 registers accessible to the DSP56307. The hardware reset (HW) is caused by the RESET signal. The software reset (SW) is caused by execution of the RESET instruction. The individual reset (IR) is caused by the HEN bit (HPCR Bit 6) being cleared. The stop reset (ST) is caused by execution of the STOP instruction. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 6-6 DSP Side Registers after Reset Reset Type Note: Register Name Register Data HCR HW Reset SW Reset IR Reset ST Reset All bits 0 0 Ña Ñ HPCR All bits 0 0 Ñ Ñ HSR HF[1:0] 0 0 Ñ Ñ HCP 0 0 0 0 HTDE 1 1 1 1 HRDF 0 0 0 0 HBAR BA[10:3] $80 $80 Ñ Ñ HDDR DR[15:0] 0 0 Ñ Ñ HDR D[15:0] Ñ Ñ Ñ Ñ HRX HRX [23:0] empty empty empty empty HTX HTX [23:0] empty empty empty empty a. The bit value is indeterminate after reset. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-19 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—DSP-Side Programmer’s Model 6.5.10 Host Interface DSP Core Interrupts Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The HI08 can request interrupt service from either the DSP56307 or the host processor. The DSP56307 interrupts are internal and do not require the use of an external interrupt signal. When the appropriate interrupt enable bit in the HCR is set, an interrupt condition caused by the host processor sets the appropriate bit in the HSR, generating an interrupt request to the DSP56307. The DSP56307 acknowledges interrupts caused by the host processor by jumping to the appropriate interrupt service routine. The following interrupts are possible. ¥ Host command ¥ Transmit data register empty ¥ Receive data register full Although there is a set of vectors reserved for host command use, the host command can access any interrupt vector in the interrupt vector table. The DSP interrupt service routine must read or write the appropriate HI08 register (e.g., clearing HRDF or HTDE) to clear the interrupt. In the case of host command interrupts, the interrupt acknowledge from the DSP56307 program controller clears the pending interrupt condition. Enable 15 X:HCR 0 HF3 HF2 HCIE HTIE HRIE HCR DSP Core Interrupts Receive Data Full Transmit Data Empty Host Command 15 X:HSR 0 HF1 HF0 HCP HTDE HRDF HSR Status AA0667 Figure 6-11 HSR-HCR Operation Not Recommended for New Design 6-20 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—External Host Programmer’s Model 6.6 HI08—EXTERNAL HOST PROGRAMMER’S MODEL Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The HI08 provides a simple, high-speed interface to a host processor. To the host bus, the HI08 appears to be eight byte-wide registers. Separate transmit and receive data registers are double-buffered to allow the DSP core and host processor to transfer data efficiently at high speed. The host can access the HI08 asynchronously by using polling techniques or interrupt-based techniques. The HI08 appears to the host processor as a memory-mapped peripheral occupying eight bytes in the host processor address space. (See Table 6-7.)The eight HI08 registers include the following: ¥ A control register (ICR) ¥ A status register (ISR) ¥ Three data registers (RXH/TXH, RXM/TXM, and RXL/TXL) ¥ Two vector registers (IVR and CVR) The CVR is a special command register by which the host processor issues commands to the DSP56307. Only by the host processor can access this register. Host processors can use standard host processor instructions (e.g., byte move) and addressing modes to communicate with the HI08 registers. The HI08 registers are aligned so that 8-bit host processors can use 8-, 16-, or 24-bit load and store instructions for data transfers. The HREQ/HTRQ and HACK/HRRQ handshake flags are provided for polled or interrupt-driven data transfers with the host processor. Because of the speed of the DSP56307 interrupt response, most host microprocessors can load or store data at their maximum programmed I/O instruction rate without testing the handshake flags for each transfer. If full handshake is not needed, the host processor can treat the DSP56307 as a fast device, and data can be transferred between the host processor and the DSP56307 at the fastest data rate of the host processor. One of the most innovative features of the host interface is the host command feature. With this feature, the host processor can issue vectored interrupt requests to the DSP56307. The host can select any of 128 DSP interrupt routines for execution by writing a vector address register in the HI08. This flexibility allows the host processor to execute up to 128 pre-programmed functions inside the DSP56307. For example, the DSP56307 host interrupts allow the host processor to read or write DSP registers (X, Y, or program memory locations), force interrupt handlers (e.g., SSI, SCI, IRQA, IRQB interrupt routines), and perform control or debugging operations. Note: When the DSP enters stop mode, the HI08 signals are electrically disconnected internally, thus disabling the HI08 until the core leaves stop mode. While the Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-21 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—External Host Programmer’s Model HI08 configuration remains unchanged in stop mode, the core cannot be restarted via the HI08 interface. Do not issue a STOP command to the DSP via the HI08 unless you provide some other mechanism to exit stop mode. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 6-7 Host Side Register Map 6.6.1 Host Address Big Endian HLEND = 0 Little Endian HLEND = 1 0 ICR ICR Interface Control 1 CVR CVR Command Vector 2 ISR ISR Interface Status 3 IVR IVR Interrupt Vector 4 00000000 00000000 Unused 5 RXH/TXH RXL/TXL 6 RXM/TXM RXM/TXM 7 RXL/TXL RXH/TXH Receive/Transmit Bytes Interface Control Register (ICR) The ICR is an 8-bit read/write control register by which the host processor controls the HI08 interrupts and flags. The DSP core cannot access the ICR. The ICR is a read/write register, which allows the use of bit manipulation instructions on control register bits. The control bits are described in the following paragraphs. 7 INIT 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 HLEND HF1 HF0 HDRQ TREQ RREQ —Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility. AA0668 Figure 6-12 Interface Control Register (ICR) Not Recommended for New Design 6-22 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—External Host Programmer’s Model 6.6.1.1 ICR Receive Request Enable (RREQ) Bit 0 The RREQ bit controls the HREQ signal for host receive data transfers. RREQ enables host requests via the host request (HREQ or HRRQ) signal when the receive data register full (RXDF) status bit in the ISR is set. If RREQ is cleared, RXDF interrupts are disabled. If RREQ and RXDF are set, the host request signal (HREQ or HRRQ) is asserted. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 6.6.1.2 ICR Transmit Request Enable (TREQ) Bit 1 TREQ is enables host requests via the host request (HREQ or HTRQ) signal when the transmit data register empty (TXDE) status bit in the ISR is set. If TREQ is cleared, TXDE interrupts are disabled. If TREQ and TXDE are set, the host request signal is asserted. Table 6-8 and Table 6-9 summarize the effect of RREQ and TREQ on the HREQ and HRRQ signals. Table 6-8 TREQ and RREQ modes (HDRQ = 0) TREQ RREQ HREQ Signal 0 0 No interrupts (polling) 0 1 RXDF request (interrupt) 1 0 TXDE request (interrupt) 1 1 RXDF and TXDE request (interrupts) Table 6-9 TREQ and RREQ modes (HDRQ = 1) TREQ RREQ HTRQ Signal HRRQ Signal 0 0 No interrupts (polling) No interrupts (polling) 0 1 No interrupts (polling) RXDF request (interrupt) 1 0 TXDE request (interrupt) No interrupts (polling) 1 1 TXDE request (interrupt) RXDF request (interrupt) 6.6.1.3 ICR Double Host Request (HDRQ) Bit 2 If cleared, the HDRQ bit configures HREQ/HTRQ and HACK/HRRQ as HREQ and HACK, respectively. If HDRQ is set, HREQ/HTRQ is configured as HTRQ, and HACK/HRRQ is configured as HRRQ. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-23 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—External Host Programmer’s Model 6.6.1.4 ICR Host Flag 0 (HF0) Bit 3 The HF0 bit is a general-purpose flag for host-to-DSP communication. HF0 can be set or cleared by the host processor and cannot be changed by the DSP56307. HF0 is reflected in the HSR on the DSP side of the HI08. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 6.6.1.5 ICR Host Flag 1 (HF1) Bit 4 The HF1 bit is a general-purpose flag for host-to-DSP communication. HF1 can be set or cleared by the host processor and cannot be changed by the DSP56307. HF1 is reflected in the HSR on the DSP side of the HI08. 6.6.1.6 ICR Host Little Endian (HLEND) Bit 5 If the HLEND bit is cleared, the host can access the HI08 in big-endian byte order. If set, the host can access the HI08 in little-endian byte order. If the HLEND bit is cleared the RXH/TXH register is located at address $5, the RXM/TXM register at $6, and the RXL/TXL register at $7. If the HLEND bit is set, the RXH/TXH register is located at address $7, the RXM/TXM register at $6, and the RXL/TXL register at $5. 6.6.1.7 ICR Reserved Bit 6 This bit is reserved. It is read as 0 and should be written with 0. 6.6.1.8 ICR Initialize Bit (INIT) Bit 7 The host processor uses the INIT bit to force initialization of the HI08 hardware. During initialization, the HI08 transmit and receive control bits are configured. It may or may not be necessary to use the INIT bit to initialize the HI08 hardware, depending on the software design of the interface. The type of initialization when the INIT bit is set depends on the state of TREQ and RREQ in the HI08. The INIT command, which is local to the HI08 conveniently configures the HI08 into the desired data transfer mode. Table 6-10 shows the effect of the INIT command. When the host sets the INIT bit, the HI08 hardware executes the INIT command. The interface hardware clears the INIT bit after the command executes. Table 6-10 INIT Command Effects TREQ RREQ After INIT Execution Transfer Direction Initialized 0 0 INIT = 0 None 0 1 INIT = 0; RXDF = 0; HTDE = 1 DSP to host 1 0 INIT = 0; TXDE = 1; HRDF = 0 Host to DSP Not Recommended for New Design 6-24 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—External Host Programmer’s Model Table 6-10 INIT Command Effects RREQ After INIT Execution 1 1 INIT = 0; RXDF = 0; HTDE = 1; TXDE = 1; HRDF = 0 6.6.2 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Transfer Direction Initialized TREQ Host to/from DSP Command Vector Register (CVR) The host processor uses the CVR to cause the DSP56307 to execute an interrupt. The host command feature is independent of any of the data transfer mechanisms in the HI08. It can cause execution of any of the 128 possible interrupt routines in the DSP core. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 HC HV6 HV5 HV4 HV3 HV2 HV1 HV0 AA0669 Figure 6-13 Command Vector Register (CVR) 6.6.2.1 CVR Host Vector (HV[6:0]) Bits 0–6 The seven HV bits select the host command interrupt address to be used by the host command interrupt logic. When the host command interrupt is recognized by the DSP interrupt control logic, the address of the interrupt routine taken is 2 × HV. The host can write HC and HV in the same write cycle. The host processor can select any of the 128 possible interrupt routine starting addresses in the DSP by writing the interrupt routine address divided by 2 into the HV bits. This means that the host processor can force any of the existing interrupt handlers (SSI, SCI, IRQA, IRQB, etc.) and can use any of the reserved or otherwise unused addresses (provided they have been pre-programmed in the DSP). HV is set to $32 (vector location $0064) by hardware, software, individual, and stop resets. 6.6.2.2 CVR Host Command Bit (HC) Bit 7 The host processor uses the HC bit to handshake the execution of host command interrupts. Normally, the host processor sets HC to request a host command interrupt from the DSP56307. When the host command interrupt is acknowledged by the DSP56307, HIO8 hardware clears the HC bit. The host processor can read the state of HC to determine when the host command has been accepted. After setting HC, the host must not write to the CVR again until the HIO8 hardware clears the HC. Setting the HC bit causes host command pending (HCP) to be set in the HSR. The host can write to the HC and HV bits in the same write cycle. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-25 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—External Host Programmer’s Model 6.6.3 Interface Status Register (ISR) The host processor uses the ISR, an 8-bit read-only status register, to interrogate the status and flags of the HI08. The host processor can write to this address without affecting the internal state of the HI08. The ISR cannot be accessed by the DSP core. The following paragraphs document the ISR bits. 7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... HREQ 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 HF3 HF2 TRDY TXDE RXDF —Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility. AA0670 Figure 6-14 Interface Status Register 6.6.3.1 ISR Receive Data Register Full (RXDF) Bit 0 The RXDF bit indicates that the receive byte registers (RXH:RXM:RXL) contain data from the DSP56307 and may be read by the host processor. RXDF is set when the HTX is transferred to the receive byte registers. RXDF is cleared when the receive data register (RXL or RXH according to HLEND bit) is read by the host processor. The host processor can clear RXDF using the initialize function. RXDF can assert the external HREQ signal if the RREQ bit is set. Regardless of whether the RXDF interrupt is enabled, RXDF indicates whether the RX registers are full and data can be latched out (so that the host processor can use polling techniques). 6.6.3.2 ISR Transmit Data Register Empty (TXDE) Bit 1 The TXDE bit indicates that the transmit byte registers (TXH:TXM:TXL) are empty and can be written by the host processor. TXDE is set when the contents of the transmit byte registers are transferred to the HRX register. TXDE is cleared when the transmit register (TXL or TXH according to HLEND bit) is written by the host processor. The host processor can set TXDE using the initialize function. TXDE may be used to assert the external HTRQ signal if the TREQ bit is set. Regardless of whether the TXDE interrupt is enabled, TXDE indicates whether the TX registers are full and data can be latched in (so that polling techniques may be used by the host processor). Not Recommended for New Design 6-26 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—External Host Programmer’s Model 6.6.3.3 ISR Transmitter Ready (TRDY) Bit 2 The TRDY status bit indicates that TXH:TXM:TXL and the HRX registers are empty. CAUTION Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... TRDY = TXDE and HRDF If TRDY is set, the data that the host processor writes to TXH:TXM:TXL is immediately transferred to the DSP side of the HI08. This feature has many applications. For example, if the host processor issues a host command that causes the DSP56307 to read the HRX, the host processor can be guaranteed that the data it just transferred to the HI08 is that being received by the DSP56307. 6.6.3.4 ISR Host Flag 2 (HF2) Bit 3 The HF2 bit in the ISR indicates the state of HF2 in the HCR on the DSP side. HF2 can be changed only by the DSP56307. See Section 6.5.3.4 HCR Host Flags 2, 3 (HF[3:2]) Bits 3, 4 on page 6-10 for related information. 6.6.3.5 ISR Host Flag 3 (HF3) Bit 4 The HF3 bit in the ISR indicates the state of HF3 in the HCR on the DSP side. HF3 can be changed only by the DSP56307. See Section 6.5.3.4 HCR Host Flags 2, 3 (HF[3:2]) Bits 3, 4 on page 6-10 for related information. 6.6.3.6 ISR Reserved Bits 5, 6 These bits are reserved. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0. 6.6.3.7 ISR Host Request (HREQ) Bit 7 If HDRQ is set, the HREQ bit indicates the status of the external transmit and receive request output signals (HTRQ and HRRQ). If HDRQ is cleared, it indicates the status of the external host request output signal (HREQ). Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-27 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—External Host Programmer’s Model Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 6-11 HREQ and HDRQ Settings HDRQ HREQ Effect 0 0 HREQ is cleared; no host processor interrupts are requested. 0 1 HREQ is set; an interrupt is requested. 1 0 HTRQ and HRRQ are cleared, no host processor interrupts are requested. 1 1 HTRQ or HRRQ are set; an interrupt is requested. The HREQ bit can be set from either or both of two conditionsÑeither the receive byte registers are full or the transmit byte registers are empty. These conditions are indicated by status bits: ISR RXDF indicates that the receive byte registers are full, and ISR TXDE indicates that the transmit byte registers are empty. If the interrupt source is enabled by the associated request enable bit in the ICR, HREQ is set if one or more of the two enabled interrupt sources is set. 6.6.4 Interrupt Vector Register (IVR) The IVR is an 8-bit read/write register that typically contains the interrupt vector number used with MC68000 family processor vectored interrupts. Only the host processor can read and write this register. The contents of the IVR are placed on the host data bus, H[7:0], when both the HREQ and HACK signals are asserted. The contents of this register are initialized to $0F by a hardware or software reset. This value corresponds to the uninitialized interrupt vector in the MC68000 family. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 IV7 IV6 IV5 IV4 IV3 IV2 IV1 IV0 AA0671 Figure 6-15 Interrupt Vector Register (IVR) 6.6.5 Receive Byte Registers (RXH: RXM: RXL) The host processor views the receive byte registers as three 8-bit read-only registers. These registers are the receive high register (RXH), the receive middle register (RXM), and the receive low register (RXL). They receive data from the high, middle, and low Not Recommended for New Design 6-28 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—External Host Programmer’s Model bytes, respectively, of the HTX register and are selected by the external host address inputs (HA[2:0]) during a host processor read operation. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The memory address of the receive byte registers are set by the HLEND bit in the ICR. If the HLEND bit is set, the RXH is located at address $7, RXM at $6, and RXL at $5. If the HLEND bit is cleared, the RXH is located at address $5, RXM at $6, and RXL at $7. When data is transferred from the HTX register to the receive byte register at host address $7, the receive data register full (RXDF) bit is set. The host processor may program the RREQ bit to assert the external HREQ signal when RXDF is set. This indicates that the HI08 has a full word (either 8, 16, or 24 bits) for the host processor. The host processor may program the RREQ bit to assert the external HREQ signal when RXDF is set. Assertion of the HREQ signal informs the host processor that the receive byte registers have data to be read. When the host reads the receive byte register at host address $7, the RXDF bit is cleared. 6.6.6 Transmit Byte Registers (TXH:TXM:TXL) The host processor views the transmit byte registers as three 8-bit write-only registers. These registers are the transmit high register (TXH), the transmit middle register (TXM), and the transmit low register (TXL). These registers send data to the high, middle, and low bytes, respectively, of the HRX register and are selected by the external host address inputs, HA[2:0], during a host processor write operation. If the HLEND bit in the ICR is set, the TXH register is located at address $7, the TXM register at $6, and the TXL register at $5. If the HLEND bit in the ICR is cleared, the TXH register is located at address $5, the TXM register at $6, and the TXL register at $7. Data can be written into the transmit byte registers when the transmit data register empty (TXDE) bit is set. The host processor can program the TREQ bit to assert the external HREQ/HTRQ signal when TXDE is set. This informs the host processor that the transmit byte registers are empty. Writing to the data register at host address $7 clears the TXDE bit. The contents of the transmit byte registers are transferred as 24-bit data to the HRX register when both the TXDE and the HRDF bit are cleared. This transfer operation sets TXDE and HRDF. Note: When data is written to a peripheral device, there is a two-cycle pipeline delay until any status bits affected by this operation are updated. If you read any of those status bits within the next two cycles, the bit will not reflect its current status. See the DSP56300 Family Manual, Appendix B, Polling a Peripheral Device for Write for further details. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-29 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08—External Host Programmer’s Model 6.6.7 Host Side Registers after Reset Table 6-12 shows the result of the four kinds of reset on bits in each of the HI08 registers seen by the host processor. To cause a hardware reset, assert the RESET signal. To cause a software reset, execute the RESET instruction. To reset the HEN bit individually, clear the HEN bit in the HPCR. To cause a stop reset, execute the STOP instruction. Table 6-12 Host Side Registers after Reset Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Reset Type Register Name Register Data ICR CVR HW Reset SW Reset IR Reset ST Reset All bits 0 0 Ñ Ñ HC 0 0 0 0 HV[0:6] $32 $32 Ñ Ñ HREQ 0 0 1 if TREQ is set; 0 otherwise 1 if TREQ is set; 0 otherwise HF3 -HF2 0 0 Ñ Ñ TRDY 1 1 1 1 TXDE 1 1 1 1 RXDF 0 0 0 0 IVR IV[0:7] $0F $0F Ñ Ñ RX RXH: RXM:RXL empty empty empty empty TX TXH: TXM:TXL empty empty empty empty ISR 6.6.8 GPIO When configured as GPIO, the HI08 is viewed by the DSP56307 as memory-mapped registers (as in Section 6.5) that control up to 16 I/O signals. Software and hardware resets clear all DSP-side control registers and configure the HI08 as GPIO with all 16 signals disconnected. External circuitry connected to the HI08 may need external pull-up/pull-down resistors until the signals are configured for operation. The registers cleared are the HPCR, HDDR, and HDR. You can select either GPIO or HI08: to select Not Recommended for New Design 6-30 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) Servicing the Host Interface GPIO functions, clear HPCR bits 6 through 1; to select other HI08 functions, set those same bits. If the HI08 is in GPIO mode, the HDDR configures each corresponding signal in the HDR as an input signal if the HDDR bit is cleared or as an output signal if the HDDR bit is set. For more details, see Sections 6.5.7 Host Data Direction Register (HDDR) on page 6-17 and 6.5.8 Host Data Register (HDR) on page 6-18. 6.7 SERVICING THE HOST INTERFACE Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The HI08 can be serviced by one of the following protocols: ¥ Polling ¥ Interrupts The host processor writes to the appropriate HI08 register to reset the control bits and configure the HI08 for proper operation. 6.7.1 HI08 Host Processor Data Transfer To the host processor, the HI08 appears as a contiguous block of SRAM. To transfer data between itself and the HI08, the host processor performs the following steps: 1. The host processor asserts the HI08 address to select the register to be read or written. Chip select is in non-mux mode. The address strobe is in mux mode. 2. The host processor selects the direction of the data transfer. If it is writing, the host processor sources the data on the bus. 3. The host processor strobes the data transfer. 6.7.2 Polling In polling mode, the HREQ/HTRQ signal is not connected to the host processor and HACK must be deasserted to insure IVR data is not being driven on H[7:0] when other registers are being polled. If the HACK function is not needed, the HACK signal can be configured as a GPIO signal; see Section 6.5.6 Host Port Control Register (HPCR) on page 6-13 for more about that topic. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-31 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) Servicing the Host Interface The host processor first performs a data read transfer to read the ISR, as in Figure 6-16. This allows the host processor to assess the status of the HI08 and perform the appropriate actions. Generally, after the appropriate data has been transferred, the corresponding status bit is updated to reflect the transfer. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ If RXDF is set, the receive data register is full, and a data read can be performed by the host processor. ¥ If TXDE is set, the transmit data register is empty. A data write can be performed by the host processor. ¥ If TRDY is set, the transmit data register is empty. This implies that the receive data register on the DSP side is also empty. Data written by the host processor to the HI08 is transferred directly to the DSP side. ¥ If (HF2 and HF3) ≠ 0, depending on how the host flags have been used, this condition may indicate that an application-specific state within the DSP56307 has been reached. Intervention by the host processor may be required. ¥ If HREQ is set, the HREQ/TRQ signal has been asserted, and the DSP56307 is requesting the attention of the host processor. One of the other four conditions exists. If the host processor issues a command to the DSP56307 by writing to the CVR and setting the HC bit, it can read the HC bit in the CVR to determine whether the command has been accepted by the interrupt controller in the DSP core. When the command is accepted for execution, the HC bit is cleared by the interrupt controller in the DSP core. Status 7 $2 HREQ 0 0 HF3 HF2 TRDY TXDE 0 RXDF ISR Host Request Asserted HRRQ HREQ HTRQ 7 $0 INIT 0 0 0 HF1 HF0 HBEND TREQ RREQ ICR Enable AA0672 Figure 6-16 HI08 Host Request Structure Not Recommended for New Design 6-32 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) Servicing the Host Interface 6.7.3 Servicing Interrupts If either the HREQ/HTRQ or HRRQ signal or both are connected to the interrupt input of a host processor, the HI08 can request service from that host processor by asserting one of these signals. Figure 6-16 illustrates several possibilities: ¥ When TXDE is set and the corresponding enabling bit (TREQ) is set, then HTRQ is asserted. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ When RXDF is set and the corresponding enabling bit (RREQ) is set, then HRRQ is asserted. ¥ When both TXDE and RXDF as well as their corresponding enabling bits (TREQ and RREQ) are all set, then HREQ is asserted. HREQ normally connects to the maskable interrupt input of the host processor. The host processor acknowledges host interrupts by executing an interrupt service routine. The two LSBs (RXDF and TXDE) of the ISR register may be tested by the host processor to determine the interrupt source, as indicated in Figure 6-16. The host processor interrupt service routine must read or write the appropriate HI08 data register to clear the interrupt. HREQ/HTRQ and/or HRRQ is deasserted under either of the following conditions: ¥ The enabled request is cleared or masked. ¥ The DSP is reset. If the host processor is a member of the MC68000 family, there is no need for the additional step when the host processor reads the ISR to determine how to respond to an interrupt generated by the DSP56307. Instead, the DSP56307 automatically sources the contents of the IVR on the data bus when the host processor acknowledges the interrupt by asserting HACK. The contents of the IVR are placed on the host data bus while HREQ/TRQ (or HRRQ) and HACK are simultaneously asserted. The IVR data tells the MC680XX host processor which interrupt routine to execute to service the DSP56307. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 6-33 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) HI08 Programming Model—Quick Reference 6.8 HI08 PROGRAMMING MODEL—QUICK REFERENCE The HI08 programming model consists of a DSP side and a host side. Table 6-13 shows the DSP-side registers. Table 6-13 Host Control Register (HCR) Value After Reset Type: Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Bit # Bit Values Bit Name Function H/W or S/W Ind. STOP 0 Host Receive Interrupt Enable (HRIE) 0 1 HRRQ Interrupt Disabled HRRQ Interrupt Enabled 0 Ñ Ñ 1 Host Transmit Interrupt Enable (HTIE) 0 1 HTRQ Interrupt Disabled HTRQ Interrupt Enabled 0 Ñ Ñ 2 Host Command Interrupt Enable (HCIE) 0 1 HCP Interrupt Disabled HCP Interrupt Enabled 0 Ñ Ñ 3 Host Flag 2 4 Host Flag 3 Ñ Ñ General purpose flags defined by user software. 0 0 Table 6-14 shows the DSP-side programming model. Table 6-15 beginning on page 6-38 shows the host-side programming model. Not Recommended for New Design 6-34 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA MOTOROLA Table 6-14 HI08 Programming Model: DSP Side Bit # HCR HPC R Name Comments Value Reset Type Function HW/ SW IR ST HRIE Receive Interrupt Enable 0 1 HRRQ interrupt disabled HRRQ interrupt enabled 0 Ñ Ñ 1 HTIE Transmit Interrupt Enable 0 1 HTRQ interrupt disabled HTRQ interrupt enabled 0 Ñ Ñ 2 HCIE Host Command Interrupt Enable 0 1 HCP interrupt disabled HCP interrupt enabled 0 Ñ Ñ 3 HF2 Host Flag 2 0 4 HF3 Host Flag 3 0 Ñ Ñ 0 HGEN Host GPIO Enable 0 1 GPIO signal disconnected GPIO signals active 0 Ñ Ñ 1 HA8EN Host Address Line 8 Enable 0 1 HA8/A1 = GPIO HA8/A1 = HA8 This bit is treated as 1 if HMUX = 0. This bit is treated as 0 if HEN = 0. 0 Ñ Ñ 2 HA9EN Host Address Line 9 Enable 0 1 HA9/A2 = GPIO HA9/A2 = HA9 This bit is treated as 1 if HMUX = 0. This bit is treated as 0 if HEN = 0. 0 Ñ Ñ 3 HCSE N Host Chip Select Enable 0 1 HCS/A10 = GPIO HCS/A10 = HCS This bit is treated as 0 if HEN = 0. 0 Ñ Ñ 6-35 Host Interface (HI08) 0 HI08 Programming Model—Quick Reference Motorola Confidential Proprietary, NDA Required DSP56307 User’s Manual Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Reg Bit # MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 User’s Manual Motorola Confidential Proprietary, NDA Required HPC R 4 Name HREN Value Host Request Enable 0 1 5 HAEN Host Acknowledge Enable Comments 0 1 Function HDRQ = 0 HDRQ = 1 HREQ/HTRQ = GPIO HREQ/HTRQ HACK/HRRQ = GPIO HREQ/HTRQ = HREQ,HREQ/HTRQ HACK/HRRQ = HTRQ, HRRQ HDRQ = 0 HDRQ=1 HACK/HRRQ = GPIO HREQ/HTRQ HACK/HRRQ = GPIO HACK/HRRQ = HACK HREQ/HTRQ HACK/HRRQ = HTRQ, HRRQ This bit is ignored if HDRQ = 1. This bit is treated as 0 if HREN = 0. This bit is treated as 0 if HEN = 0. Reset Type HW/ SW IR ST 0 — — 0 — — 0 — — 6 HEN Host Enable 0 1 Host Port = GPIO Host Port Active 8 HROD Host Request Open Drain 0 1 HREQ/HTRQ/HRRQ = driven HREQ/HTRQ/HRRQ = open drain This bit is ignored if HEN = 0. 0 9 HDSP Host Data Strobe Polarity 0 1 HDS/HRD/HWR active low HDS/HRD/HWR active high This bit is ignored if HEN = 0. 0 — — 10 HASP Host Address Strobe Polarity 0 1 HAS active low HAS active high This bit is ignored if HEN = 0. 0 — — 11 HMUX Host Multiplexed Bus 0 1 Separate address and data lines Multiplexed address/data This bit is ignored if HEN = 0. 0 — — 12 HDDS Host Dual Data Strobe 0 1 Single Data Strobe (HDS) Double Data Strobe (HWR, HRD) This bit is ignored if HEN = 0. 0 — — Host Interface (HI08) Reg HI08 Programming Model—Quick Reference 6-36 Table 6-14 HI08 Programming Model: DSP Side MOTOROLA Table 6-14 HI08 Programming Model: DSP Side Reg Bit Name Value Function Reset Type HW/ SW IR ST HCSP Host Chip Select Polarity 0 1 HCS active low HCS active high This bit is ignored if HEN = 0. 0 — — 14 HRP Host Request Polarity 0 1 HREQ/HTRQ/HRRQ active low HREQ/HTRQ/HRRQ active high This bit is ignored if HEN = 0. 0 — — 15 HAP Host Acknowledge Polarity 0 1 HACK active low HACK active high This bit is ignored if HEN = 0. 0 — — 0 HRDF Host Receive Data Full 0 1 no receive data to be read Receive Data Register is full 0 0 0 1 HTDE Host Transmit Data Empty 1 0 The Transmit Data Register is empty. The Transmit Data Register is not empty. 1 1 1 2 HCP Host Command Pending 0 1 no host command pending host command pending 0 0 0 3 HF0 Host Flag 0 0 — — 4 HF1 Host Flag 1 0 — — HBA R 7-0 BA10BA3 Host Base Address Register $80 HRX 23-0 DSP Receive Data Register empty HTX 23-0 DSP Transmit Data Register empty HDR 16-0 D16D0 GPIO signal Data $0000 — — HDR R 16-0 DR16DR0 GPIO signal Direction $0000 — — HSR [0] [1] Input Output Host Interface (HI08) 6-37 13 HPC R HI08 Programming Model—Quick Reference Motorola Confidential Proprietary, NDA Required DSP56307 User’s Manual Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... # Comments Bit Comments Motorola Confidential Proprietary, NDA Required DSP56307 User’s Manual MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... # ICR ISR Reset Type Name Value Function HW/ SW IR ST 0 RREQ Receive Request Enable 0 1 HRRQ interrupt disabled HRRQ interrupt enabled 0 — — 1 TREQ Transmit Request Enable 0 1 HTRQ interrupt disabled HTRQ interrupt enabled 0 — — 2 HDRQ Double Host Request 0 HREQ/HTRQ = HREQ, HACK/HRRQ = HACK HREQ/HTRQ = HTRQ, HACK/HRRQ = HRRQ 0 — — 1 3 HF0 Host Flag 0 0 — — 4 HF1 Host Flag 1 0 — — 5 HLEND Host Little Endian 0 1 Big Endian order Little Endian order 0 — — 7 INIT Initialize 1 Reset data paths according to TREQ and RREQ 0 — — 0 RXDF Receive Data Register Full 0 1 Host Receive Register is empty Host Receive Register is full 0 0 0 1 TXDE Transmit Data Register Empty 1 0 Host Transmit Register is empty Host Transmit Register is full 1 1 1 2 TRDY Transmitter Ready 1 0 transmit FIFO (6 deep) is empty transmit FIFO is not empty 1 1 1 3 HF2 Host Flag 2 0 — — 4 HF3 Host Flag 3 0 — — 7 HREQ Host Request 0 0 0 0 1 HREQ signal is deasserted HREQ signal is asserted (if enabled) cleared by HI08 hardware Host Interface (HI08) Reg HI08 Programming Model—Quick Reference 6-38 Table 6-15 HI08 Programming Model: Host Side MOTOROLA Table 6-15 HI08 Programming Model: Host Side Reg Bit Comments Name Value Function HW/ SW IR ST default vector via programmable $32 — — cleared by HI08 hardware when the HC interrupt request is serviced 0 0 0 — — CVR 6-0 HV6-H V0 Host Command Vector CVR 7 HC Host Command RXH/ M/L 7-0 Host Receive Data Register empty TXH/ M/L 7-0 Host Transmit Data Register empty IVR 7-0 IV7-IV0 Interrupt Register 0 1 no host command pending host command pending 68000 family vector register $0F Host Interface (HI08) 6-39 HI08 Programming Model—Quick Reference Motorola Confidential Proprietary, NDA Required DSP56307 User’s Manual Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... # Reset Type Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Host Interface (HI08) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... HI08 Programming Model—Quick Reference Not Recommended for New Design 6-40 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ENHANCED SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL INTERFACE Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-3 ESSI DATA AND CONTROL SIGNALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-4 ESSI PROGRAMMING MODEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-9 OPERATING MODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-35 GPIO SIGNALS AND REGISTERS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-42 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 7.1 7.3 7.4 7.5 7.6 Not Recommended for New Design 7-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Introduction 7.1 INTRODUCTION The ESSI provides a full-duplex serial port for serial communication with a variety of serial devices, including one or more industry-standard codecs, other DSPs, microprocessors, and peripherals that implement the Motorola serial peripheral interface (SPI). The ESSI consists of independent transmitter and receiver sections and a common ESSI clock generator. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... There are two independent and identical ESSIs in the DSP56307: ESSI0 and ESSI1. For the sake of simplicity, a single generic ESSI is described here. The ESSI block diagram is shown in Figure 7-1. This interface is synchronous because all serial transfers are synchronized to one clock. This synchronous interface should not be confused with the asynchronous channels mode of the ESSI, in which separate clocks are used for the receiver and transmitter. In that mode, the ESSI is still a synchronous device because all transfers are synchronized to these clocks. Note: Additional synchronization signals are used to delineate the word frames. The normal mode of operation is used to transfer data at a periodic rate, one word per period. The network mode is similar in that it is also intended for periodic transfers; however, it supports up to 32 words (time slots) per period. The network mode can be used to build time division multiplexed (TDM) networks. In contrast, the on-demand mode is intended for nonperiodic transfers of data. This mode can be used to transfer data serially at high speed when the data become available. This mode offers a subset of the SPI protocol. Since each ESSI unit can be configured with one receiver and three transmitters, the two units can be used together for surround sound applications (which need two digital input channels and six digital output channels). 7.2 ENHANCEMENTS TO THE ESSI The SSI used in the DSP56000 family has been enhanced in the following ways to make the ESSI: ¥ Network enhancements Ð Time slot mask registers (receive and transmit) Ð End-of-frame interrupt Ð Drive enable signal (to be used with transmitter 0) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Data and Control Signals ¥ Audio enhancements Ð Three transmitters per ESSI (for six-channel surround sound) ¥ General enhancements Ð Can trigger DMA interrupts (receive or transmit) Ð Separate exception enable bits Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Other changes 7.3 Ð One divide-by-2 removed from the internal clock source chain Ð Control register A prescaler range (CRA(PSR)) bit definition is reversed Ð Gated clock mode not available ESSI DATA AND CONTROL SIGNALS Three to six signals are required for ESSI operation, depending on the operating mode selected. The serial transmit data (STD) signal and serial control (SC0 and SC1) signals are fully synchronized to the clock if they are programmed as transmit-data signals. 7.3.1 Serial Transmit Data Signal (STD) The STD signal transmits data from the serial transmit shift register. STD is an output when data is being transmitted from the TX0 shift register. With an internally-generated bit clock, the STD signal becomes a high impedance output signal for a full clock period after the last data bit is transmitted if another data word does not follow immediately. If sequential data words are transmitted, the STD signal does not assume a high-impedance state. The STD signal can be programmed as a GPIO signal (P5) when the ESSI STD function is not is use. 7.3.2 Serial Receive Data Signal (SRD) The SRD signal receives serial data and transfers the data to the ESSI receive shift register. SRD can be programmed as a GPIO signal (P4) when the ESSI SRD function is not in use. Not Recommended for New Design 7-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Data and Control Signals GDB DDB RCLK RSMA RX SHIFT REG SRD RSMB RX Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... TSMA TCLK TX0 SHIFT REG STD TSMB TX0 CRA TX1 SHIFT REG CRB SC0 TX1 TSR TX2 SHIFT REG SSISR SC1 TX2 Interrupts Clock/Frame Sync Generators and Control Logic SC2 SCK AA0678 Figure 7-1 ESSI Block Diagram 7.3.3 Serial Clock (SCK) The SCK signal is a bidirectional signal providing the serial bit rate clock for the ESSI interface. The SCK signal is a clock input or output used by all the enabled transmitters and receiver in synchronous modes or by all the enabled transmitters in asynchronous Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Data and Control Signals modes. See Table 7-1 on page 7-8 for details. SCK can be programmed as a GPIO signal (P3) when the ESSI SCK function is not in use. Notes: 1. Although an external serial clock can be independent of and asynchronous to the DSP system clock, the external ESSI clock frequency must not exceed Fcore/3, and each ESSI phase must exceed the minimum of 1.5 CLKOUT cycles. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 2. The internally sourced ESSI clock frequency must not exceed Fcore/4. 7.3.4 Serial Control Signal (SC0) ESSI0: SC00; ESSI1: SC10 The programmer determines the function of this signal by selecting either synchronous or asynchronous mode, according to Table 7-4 on page 7-24. In asynchronous mode, this signal is used for the receive clock I/O. In synchronous mode, this signal is used as the transmitter data out signal for transmit shift register TX1 or for serial flag I/O. A typical application of serial flag I/O would be multiple device selection for addressing in codec systems. If SC0 is configured as a serial flag signal or receive clock signal, its direction is determined by the serial control direction 0 (SCD0) bit in ESSI control register B (CRB). When configured as an output, SC0 functions as the serial output flag 0 (OF0) or as a receive shift register clock output. If SC0 is used as the serial output flag 0, its value is determined by the value of the serial output flag 0 (OF0) bit in the CRB. If SC0 is an input, it functions as either serial Input Flag 0 or a receive shift register clock input. As serial input flag 0, SC0 controls the state of the serial input flag 0 (IF0) bit in the ESSI status register (SSISR). When SC0 is configured as a transmit data signal, it is always an output signal, regardless of the SCD0 bit value. SC0 is fully synchronized with the other transmit data signals (STD and SC1). SC0 can be programmed as a GPIO signal (P0) when the ESSI SC0 function is not in use. Note: The ESSI can operate with more than one active transmitter only in synchronous mode. Not Recommended for New Design 7-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Data and Control Signals 7.3.5 Serial Control Signal (SC1) ESSI0:SC01; ESSI1: SCI11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The programmer determines the function of this signal by selecting either synchronous or asynchronous mode, according toTable 7-4 on page 7-24. In asynchronous mode (such as a single codec with asynchronous transmit and receive), SC1 is the receiver frame sync I/O. In synchronous mode, SC1 is used for the transmitter data out signal of transmit shift register TX2, for the transmitter 0 drive-enabled signal, or for serial flag I/O. When used as serial flag I/O, it operates like SC0. SC0 and SC1 are independent flags, but can be used together for multiple serial device selection. SC0 and SC1 can be unencoded to select up to two codecs or decoded externally to select up to four codecs. If SC1 is configured as a serial flag signal, its direction is determined by the SCD1 bit in the CRB. If SC1 is configured as a serial flag or receive frame sync signal, its direction is determined by the serial control direction 1 (SCD1) bit in the CRB. When configured as an output, the SC1 signal functions as a serial output flag, as the transmitter 0 drive-enabled signal, or as the receive frame sync signal output. If SC1 is used as serial output flag 1, its value is determined by the value of the serial output flag 1 (OF1) bit in the CRB. When configured as an input, this signal can receive frame sync signals from an external source, or it acts as a serial input flag. As a serial input flag, SC1controls status bit IF1 in the SSISR. When this signal is configured as a transmit data signal, it is always an output signal, regardless of the SCD1 bit value. As an output, it is fully synchronized with the other ESSI transmit data signals (STD and SC0). SC1 can be programmed as a GPIO signal (P1) when the ESSI SC1 function is not in use. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Data and Control Signals Table 7-1 ESSI Clock Sources SYN SCKD SCD0 RX Clock Source RX Clock Out TX Clock Source TX Clock Out Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Asynchronous 0 0 0 EXT, SC0 Ñ EXT, SCK Ñ 0 0 1 INT SC0 EXT, SCK Ñ 0 1 0 EXT, SC0 Ñ INT SCK 0 1 1 INT SC0 INT SCK Synchronous 1 0 0/1 EXT, SCK Ñ EXT, SCK Ñ 1 1 0/1 INT SCK INT SCK 7.3.6 Serial Control Signal (SC2) ESSI0:SC02; ESSI1:SC02 This signal is used for frame sync I/O. The frame sync is SC2 for both the transmitter and receiver in synchronous mode and for the transmitter only in asynchronous mode. The direction of this signal is determined by the SCD2 bit in the CRB. When configured as an output, this signal outputs the internally generated frame sync signal. When configured as an input, this signal receives an external frame sync signal for the transmitter in asynchronous mode and for both the transmitter and receiver when in synchronous mode. SC2 can be programmed as a GPIO signal (P2) when the ESSI SC2 function is not in use. Not Recommended for New Design 7-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 7.4 ESSI PROGRAMMING MODEL The ESSI is composed of the following registers: ¥ Two control registers (CRA, CRB) ¥ One status register (SSISR) ¥ Three transmit data registers (TX0, TX1, TX2) ¥ One receive data register (RX) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Two transmit slot mask registers (TSMA, TSMB) ¥ Two receive slot mask registers (RSMA, RSMB) ¥ One special-purpose time slot register (TSR) The following paragraphs document each of the bits in the ESSI registers. Section 7.6 documents the GPIO of the ESSI. 11 10 9 8 PSR 23 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM7 PM6 PM5 PM4 PM3 PM2 PM1 PM0 17 22 21 20 19 18 SSC1 WL2 WL1 WL0 ALC 16 15 14 13 DC4 DC3 DC2 DC1 12 DC0 AA0857 Figure 7-2 ESSI Control Register A (CRA) (ESSI0 X:$FFFFB5, ESSI1 X:$FFFFA5) 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CKP FSP FSR FSL1 FSL0 SHFD SCKD SCD2 SCD1 SCD0 OF1 OF0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 REIE TEIE RLIE TLIE RIE TIE RE TE0 TE1 TE2 MOD SYN AA0858 Figure 7-3 ESSI Control Register B (CRB) (ESSI0 X:$FFFFB6, ESSI1 X:$FFFFA6) 11 23 10 22 9 21 8 20 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RDF TDE ROE TUE RFS TFS IF1 IF0 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 AA0859 Figure 7-4 ESSI Status Register (SSISR) (ESSI0 X:$FFFFB7, ESSI1 X:$FFFFA7) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ESSI Programming Model 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TS11 TS10 TS9 TS8 TS7 TS6 TS5 TS4 TS3 TS2 TS1 TS0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 TS15 TS14 TS13 12 TS12 AA0860 Figure 7-5 ESSI Transmit Slot Mask Register A (TSMA) (ESSI0 X:$FFFFB4, ESSI1 X:$FFFFA4) 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TS27 TS26 TS25 TS24 TS23 TS22 TS21 TS20 TS19 TS18 TS17 TS16 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 TS31 TS30 TS29 12 TS28 AA0861 Figure 7-6 ESSI Transmit Slot Mask Register B (TSMB) (ESSI0 X:$FFFFB3, ESSI1 X:$FFFFA3) 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RS11 RS10 RS9 RS8 RS7 RS6 RS5 RS4 RS3 RS2 RS1 RS0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 RS15 RS14 RS13 12 RS12 AA0862 Figure 7-7 ESSI Receive Slot Mask Register A (RSMA) (ESSI0 X:$FFFFB2, ESSI1 X:$FFFFA2) 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RS27 RS26 RS25 RS24 RS23 RS22 RS21 RS20 RS19 RS18 RS17 RS16 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 RS31 RS30 RS29 RS28 – Reserved bit; read as zero; should be written with zero for future compatibility AA0863 Figure 7-8 ESSI Receive Slot Mask Register B (RSMB) (ESSI0 X:$FFFFB1, ESSI1 X:$FFFFA1) Not Recommended for New Design 7-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 7.4.1 ESSI Control Register A (CRA) The ESSI Control Register A (CRA) is one of two 24-bit read/write control registers used to direct the operation of the ESSI. CRA controls the ESSI clock generator bit and frame sync rates, word length, and number of words per frame for serial data. The CRA control bits are documented in the following paragraphs and in Figure 7-2. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 7.4.1.1 CRA Prescale Modulus Select PM[7:0] Bits 7–0 The PM[7:0] bits specify the divide ratio of the prescale divider in the ESSI clock generator. A divide ratio from 1 to 256 (PM = $0 to $FF) can be selected. The bit clock output is available at the transmit clock signal (SCK) and/or the receive clock (SC0) signal of the DSP. The bit clock output is also available internally for use as the bit clock to shift the transmit and receive shift registers. The ESSI clock generator functional diagram is shown in Figure 7-9. Fcore is the DSP56307 core clock frequency (the same frequency as the CLKOUT signal when that signal is enabled). Careful choice of the crystal oscillator frequency and the prescaler modulus generates the industry-standard codec master clock frequencies of 2.048 MHz, 1.544 MHz, and 1.536 MHz. Both the hardware RESET signal and the software RESET instruction clear PM[7:0]. 7.4.1.2 CRA Reserved Bits 8–10 These bits are reserved. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0. 7.4.1.3 CRA Prescaler Range (PSR) Bit 11 The PSR controls a fixed divide-by-eight prescaler in series with the variable prescaler. This bit is used to extend the range of the prescaler for those cases where a slower bit clock is needed. When PSR is set, the fixed prescaler is bypassed. When PSR is cleared, the fixed divide-by-eight prescaler is operational, as in Figure 7-9. This definition is reversed from that of the SSI in other members of the DSP56000 family. The maximum allowed internally generated bit clock frequency is the internal DSP56307 clock frequency divided by 4; the minimum possible internally generated bit clock frequency is the DSP56307 internal clock frequency divided by 4096. Both the hardware RESET signal and the software RESET instruction clear PSR. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model The combination PSR = 1 and PM[7:0] = $00 (dividing Fcore by 2) can cause synchronization problems and thus should not be used. Note: TX #1 or Flag0 Out CRB(TE1) CRB(OF0) (Sync Mode) Flag0 In SSISR(IF0) (Sync Mode) CRA(WL2:0) RX Word Clock /8, /12, /16, /24, /32 SCD0 = 0 SYN = 0 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... CRB(SYN) = 1 Sync: SCn0 TX #1, or Flag0 CRB(SCD0) Async: RX clk 0 SCD0 = 1 3 4,5 RCLOCK SYN = 1 CRA(WL2:0) TCLOCK TX Word Clock /8, /12, /16, /24, /32 1 2 3 4,5 Internal Bit Clock SCKn Sync: TX/RX clk Async: CRB(SCKD) TX clk TX Shift Register CRA(PSR) FCORE 2 RX Shift Register SYN = 0 0 /2 1 /1 or /8 1 0 (Opposite from SSI) CRA(PM7:0) /1 to /256 0 255 Note: 1. FCORE is the DSP56300 Core internal clock frequency. 2. ESSI internal clock range: min = FOSC/4096 max = FOSC/4 3. ÔnÕ in signal name is ESSI # (0 or 1) AA0679 Figure 7-9 ESSI Clock Generator Functional Block Diagram 7.4.1.4 CRA Frame Rate Divider Control DC[4:0] Bits 16–12 The values of the DC[4:0] bits control the divide ratio for the programmable frame rate dividers used to generate the frame clocks. In network mode, this ratio can be interpreted as the number of words per frame minus one. In normal mode, this ratio determines the word transfer rate. The divide ratio can range from 1 to 32 (DC = 00000 to 11111) for normal mode and 2 to 32 (DC = 00001 to 11111) for network mode. A divide ratio of one (DC = 00000) in network mode is a special case known as on-demand mode. In normal mode, a divide ratio of one (DC = 00000) provides continuous periodic data word transfers. A bit-length frame sync must be used in this case; you select it by setting the FSL[1:0] bits in the CRA to (01). Both the hardware RESET signal and the software RESET instruction clear DC[4:0]. The ESSI frame sync generator functional diagram is shown in Figure 7-10. Not Recommended for New Design 7-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model RX Word Clock CRB(FSL1) CRB(FSR) CRA(DC4:0) Sync Type /1 to /32 0 Internal Rx Frame Sync CRB(SCD1) 31 CRB(SCD1) = 1 SYN = 0 CRB(SYN) = 0 Receive Control Logic SCn1 Receive Frame Sync SCD1 = 0 Sync: TX #2, Flag1, or drive enb. SYN = 1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... SYN = 1 These signals are identical in sync mode. Async: RX F.S. Flag1 In SSISR(IF1) (Sync Mode) CRB(FSL1:0) CRB(FSR) TX #2, Flag1 Out, or drive enb. CRB(TE2) CRB(OF1) CRA(SSC1) (Sync Mode) TX Word Clock CRB(SCD2) CRA(DC4:0) Sync Type /1 to /32 0 Internal TX Frame Sync SCn2 31 Transmit Control Logic Sync: TX/RX F.S. Async: TX F.S. Transmit Frame Sync AA0680 Figure 7-10 ESSI Frame Sync Generator Functional Block Diagram 7.4.1.5 CRA Reserved Bit 17 This bit is reserved. It is read as 0 and should be written with 0. 7.4.1.6 CRA Alignment Control (ALC) Bit 18 The ESSI handles 24-bit fractional data. Shorter data words are left-aligned to the MSB, bit 23. For applications that use 16-bit fractional data, shorter data words are left-aligned to bit 15. The ALC bit supports shorter data words. If ALC is set, received words are left-aligned to bit 15 in the receive shift register. Transmitted words must be left-aligned to bit 15 in the transmit shift register. If the ALC bit is cleared, received words are left-aligned to bit 23 in the receive shift register. Transmitted words must be left-aligned to bit 23 in the transmit shift register. The ALC bit is cleared by either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. Note: If the ALC bit is set, only 8-, 12-, or 16-bit words should be used. The use of 24- or 32-bit words leads to unpredictable results. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 7.4.1.7 CRA Word Length Control (WL[2:0]) Bits 21–19 The WL[2:0] bits select the length of the data words transferred via the ESSI. Word lengths of 8-, 12-, 16-, 24-, or 32-bits can be selected, as in Table 7-2. The ESSI data path programming model in Figure 7-16 and Figure 7-17 shows additional information about how to select different length data words. The ESSI data registers are 24 bits long. The ESSI transmits 32-bit words either by duplicating the last bit 8 times when WL[2:0] = 100, or by duplicating the first bit 8 times when WL[2:0] = 101. The WL[2:0] bits are cleared by a hardware RESET signal or by a software RESET instruction. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 7-2 ESSI Word Length Selection 7.4.1.8 WL2 WL1 WL0 Number of Bits/Word 0 0 0 8 0 0 1 12 0 1 0 16 0 1 1 24 1 0 0 32 (valid data in the first 24 bits) 1 0 1 32 (valid data in the last 24 bits) 1 1 0 Reserved 1 1 1 Reserved CRA Select SC1 (SSC1) Bit 22 The SSC1 bit controls the functionality of the SC1 signal. If SSC1 is set, the ESSI is configured in Synchronous mode (the CRB synchronous/asynchronous bit (SYN) is set), and transmitter 2 is disabled (transmit enable (TE2) = 0)), then the SC1 signal acts as the transmitter 0 driver-enabled signal while the SC1 signal is configured as output (SCD1 = 1). This configuration enables an external buffer for the transmitter 0 output. If SSC1 is cleared, the ESSI is configured in synchronous mode (SYN = 1), and transmitter 2 is disabled (TE2 = 0), then the SC1 acts as the serial I/O flag while the SC1 signal is configured as output (SCD1 = 1). 7.4.1.9 CRA Reserved Bit 23 This bit is reserved. It is read as 0 and should be written with 0. Not Recommended for New Design 7-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 7.4.2 ESSI Control Register B (CRB) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Control Register B (CRB) is one of two 24-bit read/write control registers that direct the operation of the ESSI, as shown in Figure 7-3 on page 7-9. CRB controls the ESSI multifunction signals, SC[2:0], which can be used as clock inputs or outputs, frame synchronization signals, transmit data signals, or serial I/O flag signals. The serial output flag control bits and the direction control bits for the serial control signals are in the ESSI CRB. Interrupt enable bits for the receiver and the transmitter are also in the CRB. The bit setting of the CRB also determines how many transmitters are enabled; 0, 1, 2, or 3 transmitters can be enabled. The CRB settings also determine the ESSI operating mode. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clear all the bits in the CRB. The relationship between the ESSI signals SC[2:0], SCK, and the CRB bits is summarized in Table 7-4 on page 7-24. The ESSI CRB bits are described in the following paragraphs. 7.4.2.1 CRB Serial Output Flags (OF0, OF1) Bits 0, 1 The ESSI has two serial output flag bits, OF1 and OF0. The normal sequence follows for setting output flags when transmitting data (by transmitter 0 through the STD signal only). 1. Wait for TDE (TX0 empty) to be set. 2. Write the flags. 3. Write the transmit data to the TX register. Bits OF0 and OF1 are double-buffered so that the flag states appear on the signals when the TX data is transferred to the transmit shift register. The flag bit values are synchronized with the data transfer. Note: The timing of the optional serial output signals SC[2:0] is controlled by the frame timing and is not affected by the settings of TE2, TE1, TE0, or the receive enable (RE) bit of the CRB. 7.4.2.1.1 CRB Serial Output Flag 0 (OF0) Bit 0 When the ESSI is in synchronous mode and transmitter 1 is disabled (TE1 = 0), the SC0 signal is configured as ESSI flag 0. If the serial control direction bit (SCD0) is set, the SC0 signal is an output. Data present in Bit OF0 is written to SC0 at the beginning of the frame in normal mode or at the beginning of the next time slot in network mode. Bit OF0 is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or by a software RESET instruction. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 7.4.2.1.2 CRB Serial Output Flag 1 (OF1) Bit 1 When the ESSI is in synchronous mode and transmitter 2 is disabled (TE2 = 0), the SC1 signal is configured as ESSI flag 1. If the serial control direction bit (SCD1) is set, the SC1 signal is an output. Data present in bit OF1 is written to SC1 at the beginning of the frame in normal mode or at the beginning of the next time slot in network mode. Bit OF1 is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or by a software RESET instruction. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 7.4.2.2 CRB Serial Control Direction 0 (SCD0) Bit 2 In synchronous mode (SYN = 1) when transmitter 1 is disabled (TE1 = 0), or in asynchronous mode (SYN = 0), SCD0 controls the direction of the SC0 I/O signal. When SCD0 is set, SC0 is an output; when SCD0 is cleared, SC0 is an input. When TE1 is set, the value of SCD0 is ignored and the SC0 signal is always an output. Bit SCD0 is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or by a software RESET instruction. 7.4.2.3 CRB Serial Control Direction 1 (SCD1) Bit 3 In synchronous mode (SYN = 1) when transmitter 2 is disabled (TE2 = 0), or in asynchronous mode (SYN = 0), SCD1 controls the direction of the SC1 I/O signal. When SCD1 is set, SC1 is an output; when SCD1 is cleared, SC1 is an input. When TE2 is set, the value of SCD1 is ignored and the SC1 signal is always an output. Bit SCD1 is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or by a software RESET instruction. 7.4.2.4 CRB Serial Control Direction 2 (SCD2) Bit 4 SCD2 controls the direction of the SC2 I/O signal. When SCD2 is set, SC2 is an output; when SCD2 is cleared, SC2 is an input. SCD2 is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or by a software RESET instruction. 7.4.2.5 CRB Clock Source Direction (SCKD) Bit 5 SCKD selects the source of the clock signal that clocks the transmit shift register in asynchronous mode and both the transmit and receive shift registers in synchronous mode. If SCKD is set and the ESSI is in synchronous mode, the internal clock is the source of the clock signal used for all the transmit shift registers and the receive shift register. If SCKD is set and the ESSI is in asynchronous mode, the internal clock source becomes the bit clock for the transmit shift register and word length divider. The internal clock is output on the SCK signal. When SCKD is cleared, the external clock source is selected. The internal clock generator is disconnected from the SCK signal, and an external clock source may drive this signal. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears SCKD. Not Recommended for New Design 7-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 7.4.2.6 CRB Shift Direction (SHFD) Bit 6 The SHFD bit determines the shift direction of the transmit or receive shift register. If SHFD is set, data is shifted in and out with the LSB first. If SHFD is cleared, data is shifted in and out with the MSB first, as in Figure 7-16 on page 7-30 and Figure 7-17 on page 7-31. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears SHFD. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 7.4.2.7 CRB Frame Sync Length FSL[1:0] Bits 7 and 8 These bits select the length of frame sync to be generated or recognized, as in Figure 7-11 on page 7-19, Figure 7-14 on page 7-22, and Figure 7-15 on page 7-23. Table 7-3 shows the values of FSL[1:0]. Table 7-3 FSL1 and FSL0 Encoding Frame Sync Length FSL1 FSL0 RX TX 0 0 word word 0 1 word bit 1 0 bit bit 1 1 bit word Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears FSL[1:0]. 7.4.2.8 CRB Frame Sync Relative Timing (FSR) Bit 9 The FSR bit determines the relative timing of the receive and transmit frame sync signal in reference to the serial data lines for word length frame sync only. When FSR is cleared, the word length frame sync occurs together with the first bit of the data word of the first slot. When FSR is set, the word length frame sync occurs one serial clock cycle earlier (i.e., simultaneously with the last bit of the previous data word). Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears FSR. 7.4.2.9 CRB Frame Sync Polarity (FSP) Bit 10 The FSP bit determines the polarity of the receive and transmit frame sync signals. When FSP is cleared, the frame sync signal polarity is positive; that is, the frame start is indicated by the frame sync signal going high. When FSP is set, the frame sync signal polarity is negative; that is, the frame start is indicated by the frame sync signal going low. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears FRB. 7.4.2.10 CRB Clock Polarity (CKP) Bit 11 The CKP bit controls which bit clock edge data and frame sync are clocked out and latched in. If CKP is cleared, the data and the frame sync are clocked out on the rising edge of the transmit bit clock and latched in on the falling edge of the receive bit clock. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... If CKP is set, the data and the frame sync are clocked out on the falling edge of the transmit bit clock and latched in on the rising edge of the receive bit clock. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears CKP. 7.4.2.11 CRB Synchronous/Asynchronous (SYN) Bit 12 SYN controls whether the receive and transmit functions of the ESSI occur synchronously or asynchronously with respect to each other. (See Figure 7-12 on page 7-20.) When SYN is cleared, the ESSI is in asynchronous mode, and separate clock and frame sync signals are used for the transmit and receive sections. When SYN is set, the ESSI is in synchronous mode, and the transmit and receive sections use common clock and frame sync signals. Only in synchronous mode can more than one transmitter be enabled. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears SYN. Not Recommended for New Design 7-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model Word Length: FSL1 = 0, FSL0 = 0 Serial Clock RX, TX Frame SYNC RX, TX Serial Data Data Data NOTE: Frame sync occurs while data is valid. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... One Bit Length: FSL1 = 1, FSL0 = 0 Serial Clock RX, TX Frame SYNC RX, TX Serial Data Data Data NOTE: Frame sync occurs for one bit time preceding the data. Mixed Frame Length: FSL1 = 0, FSL0 = 1 Serial Clock RX Frame Sync RXSerial Data Data Data Data Data TX Frame SYNC TX Serial Data Mixed Frame Length: FSL1 = 1, FSL0 = 1 Serial Clock RX Frame SYNC RX Serial Data Data Data Data Data TX Frame SYNC TX Serial Data AA0681 Figure 7-11 CRB FSL0 and FSL1 Bit Operation (FSR = 0) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-19 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 7.4.2.12 CRB ESSI Mode Select (MOD) Bit 13 MOD selects the operational mode of the ESSI, as in Figure 7-13 on page 7-21, Figure 7-14 on page 7-22, and Figure 7-15 on page 7-23. When MOD is cleared, the normal mode is selected; when MOD is set, the network mode is selected. In normal mode, the frame rate divider determines the word transfer rate: one word is transferred per frame sync during the frame sync time slot. In network mode, a word can be transferred every time slot. For details, see Section 7.5. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears MOD. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Asynchronous (SYN = 0) Transmitter Clock SC ESSI Bit Clock SC0 STD Frame SYNC External Transmit Clock External Transmit Frame SYNC Internal Clock Internal Frame SYNC External Receive Clock External Receive Frame SYNC Clock SC2 SC1 Frame SYNC SRD RECEIVER NOTE: Transmitter and receiver may have different clocks and frame syncs. SYNCHRONOUS (SYN = 1) Transmitter Clock SCK ESSI Bit Clock STD Frame SYNC External Clock External Frame SYNC Internal Clock Internal Frame SYNC Clock SC2 Frame SYNC SRD Receiver NOTE: Transmitter and receiver may have the same clock frame syncs. AA0682 Figure 7-12 CRB SYN Bit Operation Not Recommended for New Design 7-20 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA MOTOROLA Normal Mode (MOD = 0) SSI Control Register B (CRB) (READ/WRITE) Frame SYNC Transmitter Interrupt (or DMA Request) and Flags Set Serial Data Data Data Receiver Interrupt (or DMA Request) and Flags Set NOTE: Interrupts occur and data is transferred once per frame sync. Network Mode (MOD = 1) Serial Clock Transmitter Interrupts (or DMA Request) and Flags Set Serial Data Slot 1 Slot 2 Slot 3 Slot 1 Slot 2 Receiver Interrupt (or DMA Request) and Flags Set NOTE: Interrupts occur every time slot and a word may be transferred. AA0683 Figure 7-13 CRB MOD Bit Operation 7-21 Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Frame SYNC ESSI Programming Model Motorola Confidential Proprietary, NDA Required DSP56307 User’s Manual Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Serial Clock Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model Frame SYNC (FSL0 = 0, FSL1 = 0) Frame SYNC (FSL0 = 0, FSL1 = 1) Data Out Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Flags Slot 0 Wait Slot 0 AA0684 Figure 7-14 Normal Mode, External Frame Sync (8 Bit, 1 Word in Frame) 7.4.2.13 Enabling, Disabling ESSI Data Transmission The ESSI has three transmit enable bits (TE[2:0]), one for each data transmitter. The process of transmitting data from TX1 and TX2 is the same. TX0 differs from those two bits in that it can also operate in asynchronous mode. The normal transmit enable sequence is to write data to one or more transmit data registers (or the time slot register (TSR)) before you set the TE bit. The normal transmit disable sequence is to set the transmit data empty (TDE) bit and then to clear the TE, transmit interrupt enable (TIE), and transmit exception interrupt enable (TEIE) bits. In network mode, if you clear the appropriate TE bit and set it again, then you disable the corresponding transmitter (0, 1, or 2) after transmission of the current data word. The transmitter remains disabled until the beginning of the next frame. During that time period, the corresponding SC (or STD in the case of TX0) signal remains in a high-impedance state. 7.4.2.14 CRB ESSI Transmit 2 Enable (TE2) Bit 14 The TE2 bit enables the transfer of data from TX2 to transmit shift register 2. TE2 is functional only when the ESSI is in synchronous mode and is ignored when the ESSI is in asynchronous mode. When TE2 is set and a frame sync is detected, transmitter 2 is enabled for that frame. When TE2 is cleared, transmitter 2 is disabled after completing transmission of data currently in the ESSI transmit shift register. Any data present in TX2 is not transmitted. If TE2 is cleared, data can be written to TX2; the TDE bit is cleared, but data is not transferred to transmit shift register 2. If the TE2 bit is kept cleared until the start of the next frame, it causes the SC1 signal to act as a serial I/O flag from the start of the frame in both normal and network mode. The Not Recommended for New Design 7-22 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model transmit enable sequence in on-demand mode can be the same as in normal mode, or the TE2 bit can be left enabled. The TE2 bit is cleared by either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. The setting of the TE2 bit does not affect the generation of frame sync or output flags. Note: Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Frame SYNC (FSL0 = 0, FSL1 = 0) Frame SYNC (FSL0 = 0, FSL1 = 1) Data Flags SLOT 0 SLOT 1 SLOT 0 SLOT 1 AA1593 Figure 7-15 Network Mode, External Frame Sync (8 Bit, 2 Words in Frame) 7.4.2.15 CRB ESSI Transmit 1 Enable (TE1) Bit 15 The TE1 bit enables the transfer of data from TX1 to Transmit Shift Register 1. TE1 is functional only when the ESSI is in synchronous mode and is ignored when the ESSI is in asynchronous mode. When TE1 is set and a frame sync is detected, transmitter 1 is enabled for that frame. When TE1 is cleared, transmitter 1 is disabled after completing transmission of data currently in the ESSI transmit shift register. Any data present in TX1 is not transmitted. If TE1 is cleared, data can be written to TX1; the TDE bit is cleared, but data is not transferred to transmit shift register 1. If the TE1 bit is kept cleared until the start of the next frame, it causes the SC0 signal to act as serial I/O flag from the start of the frame in both normal and network mode. The transmit enable sequence in on-demand mode can be the same as in normal mode, or the TE1 bit can be left enabled. The TE1 bit is cleared by either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-23 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model Note: The TE1 bit does not affect the generation of frame sync or output flags. 7.4.2.16 CRB ESSI Transmit 0 Enable (TE0) Bit 16 The TE0 bit enables the transfer of data from TX1 to transmit shift register 0. TE0 is functional when the ESSI is in either synchronous or asynchronous mode. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... When TE0 is set and a frame sync is detected, the transmitter 0 is enabled for that frame. When TE0 is cleared, transmitter 0 is disabled after the transmission of data currently in the ESSI transmit shift register. The STD output is tri-stated, and any data present in TX0 is not transmitted. In other words, data can be written to TX0 with TE0 cleared; the TDE bit is cleared, but data is not transferred to the transmit shift register 0. The TE0 bit is cleared by either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. The transmit enable sequence in on-demand mode can be the same as in normal mode, or TE0 can be left enabled. Note: Transmitter 0 is the only transmitter that can operate in asynchronous mode (SYN = 0). TE0 does not affect the generation of frame sync or output flags. Table 7-4 Mode and Signal Definition Table Control Bits ESSI Signals SYN TE0 TE1 TE2 RE SC0 SC1 SC2 SCK STD SRD 0 0 X X 0 U U U U U U 0 0 X X 1 RXC FSR U U U RD 0 1 X X 0 U U FST TXC TD0 U 0 1 X X 1 RXC FSR FST TXC TD0 RD 1 0 0 0 0 U U U U U U 1 0 0 0 1 F0/U F1/T0D/U FS XC U RD 1 0 0 1 0 F0/U TD2 FS XC U U 1 0 0 1 1 F0/U TD2 FS XC U RD 1 0 1 0 0 TD1 F1/T0D/U FS XC U U 1 0 1 0 1 TD1 F1/T0D/U FS XC U RD 1 0 1 1 0 TD1 TD2 FS XC U U Not Recommended for New Design 7-24 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model Table 7-4 Mode and Signal Definition Table (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Control Bits ESSI Signals SYN TE0 TE1 TE2 RE SC0 SC1 SC2 SCK STD SRD 1 0 1 1 1 TD1 TD2 FS XC U RD 1 1 0 0 0 F0/U F1/T0D/U FS XC TD0 U 1 1 0 0 1 F0/U F1/T0D/U FS XC TD0 RD 1 1 0 1 0 F0/U TD2 FS XC TD0 U 1 1 0 1 1 F0/U TD2 FS XC TD0 RD 1 1 1 0 0 TD1 F1/T0D/U FS XC TD0 U 1 1 1 0 1 TD1 F1/T0D/U FS XC TD0 RD 1 1 1 1 0 TD1 TD2 FS XC TD0 U 1 1 1 1 1 TD1 TD2 FS XC TD0 RD TXC RXC XC FST FSR FS TD0 TD1 TD2 T0D RD F0 F1 U X = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = Transmitter clock Receiver clock Transmitter/receiver clock (synchronous operation) Transmitter frame sync Receiver frame sync Transmitter/receiver frame sync (synchronous operation) Transmit data signal 0 Transmit data signal 1 Transmit data signal 2 Transmitter 0 drive enable if SSC1 = 1 & SCD1 = 1 Receive data Flag 0 Flag 1 if SSC1 = 0 Unused (can be used as GPIO signal) Indeterminate 7.4.2.17 CRB ESSI Receive Enable (RE) Bit 17 When the RE bit is set, the receive portion of the ESSI is enabled. When this bit is cleared, the receiver is disabled: data transfer into RX is inhibited. If data is being received while this bit is cleared, the remainder of the word is shifted in and transferred to the ESSI receive data register. RE must be set in both normal and on-demand modes for the ESSI to receive data. In network mode, clearing RE and setting it again disables the receiver after reception of Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-25 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model the current data word. The receiver remains disabled until the beginning of the next data frame. RE is cleared by either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. Note: Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 7.4.2.18 The setting of the RE bit does not affect the generation of a frame sync. CRB ESSI Transmit Interrupt Enable (TIE) Bit 18 When the TIE bit is set, it enables a DSP transmit interrupt; the interrupt is generated when both the TIE and the TDE bits in the ESSI status register are set. When TIE is cleared, the transmit interrupt is disabled. The transmit interrupt is documented in Section 7.5.3. When data is written to the data registers of the enabled transmitters or to the TSR, it clears TDE and also clears the interrupt. Transmit interrupts with exception conditions have higher priority than normal transmit data interrupts. If the transmitter underrun error (TUE) bit is set (signaling that an exception has occurred) and the TEIE bit is set, the ESSI requests an SSI transmit data with exception interrupt from the interrupt controller. TIE is cleared by either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 7.4.2.19 CRB ESSI Receive Interrupt Enable (RIE) Bit 19 When the RIE bit is set, it enables a DSP receive data interrupt; the interrupt is generated when both the RIE and receive data register full (RDF) bit (in the SSISR) are set. When RIE is cleared, this interrupt is disabled. The receive interrupt is documented in Section 7.5.3. When the receive data register is read, it clears RDF and the pending interrupt. Receive interrupts with exception have higher priority than normal receive data interrupts. If the receiver overrun error (ROE) bit is set (signaling that an exception has occurred) and the REIE bit is set, the ESSI requests an SSI receive data with exception interrupt from the interrupt controller. RIE is cleared by either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 7.4.2.20 Transmit Last Slot Interrupt Enable (TLIE) Bit 20 When the TLIE bit is set, it enables an interrupt at the beginning of the last slot of a frame when the ESSI is in network mode. When TLIE is set, the DSP is interrupted at the start of the last slot in a frame regardless of the transmit mask register setting. When TLIE is cleared, the transmit last slot interrupt is disabled. The transmit last slot interrupt is documented in Section 7.5.3. TLIE is cleared by either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. TLIE is disabled when the ESSI is in on-demand mode (DC = $0). Not Recommended for New Design 7-26 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 7.4.2.21 Receive Last Slot Interrupt Enable (RLIE) Bit 21 When the RLIE bit is set, it enables an interrupt after the last slot of a frame ends when the ESSI is in network mode. When RLIE is set, the DSP is interrupted after the last slot in a frame ends regardless of the receive mask register setting. When RLIE is cleared, the receive last slot interrupt is disabled. The use of the receive last slot interrupt is documented in Section 7.5.3. RLIE is cleared by either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. RLIE is disabled when the ESSI is in on-demand mode (DC = $0). Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 7.4.2.22 Transmit Exception Interrupt Enable (TEIE) Bit 22 When the TEIE bit is set, the DSP is interrupted when both TDE and TUE in the ESSI status register are set. When TEIE is cleared, this interrupt is disabled. The use of the transmit interrupt is documented in Section 7.5.3. A read of the status register, followed by a write to all the data registers of the enabled transmitters, clears both TUE and the pending interrupt. TEIE is cleared by either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 7.4.2.23 Receive Exception Interrupt Enable (REIE) Bit 23 When the REIE bit is set, the DSP is interrupted when both RDF and ROE in the ESSI status register are set. When REIE is cleared, this interrupt is disabled. The receive interrupt is documented in Section 7.5.3. A read of the status register followed by a read of the receive data register clears both ROE and the pending interrupt. REIE is cleared by either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 7.4.3 ESSI Status Register (SSISR) The SSISR (in Figure 7-4 on page 7-9) is a 24-bit read-only status register used by the DSP to read the status and serial input flags of the ESSI. The SSISR bits are documented in the following paragraphs. 7.4.3.1 SSISR Serial Input Flag 0 (IF0) Bit 0 The IF0 bit is enabled only when SC0 is an input flag and the synchronous mode is selected; that is, when SC0 is programmed as ESSI in the port control register (PCR), the SYN bit is set, and the TE1 and SCD0 bits are cleared. The ESSI latches any data present on the SC0 signal during reception of the first received bit after the frame sync is detected. The IF0 bit is updated with this data when the data in the receive shift register is transferred into the receive data register. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-27 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model If it is not enabled, the IF0 bit is cleared. A hardware RESET signal, software RESET instruction, ESSI individual reset, or STOP instruction reset all clear the IF0 bit. 7.4.3.2 SSISR Serial Input Flag 1 (IF1) Bit 1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The IF1 bit is enabled only when SC1 is an input flag and synchronous mode is selected; that is, when SC1 is programmed as ESSI in the port control register (PCR), the SYN bit is set, and the TE2 and SCD1 bits are cleared. The ESSI latches any data present on the SC1 signal during reception of the first received bit after the frame sync is detected. The IF1 bit is updated with this data when the data in the receive shift register is transferred into the receive data register. If it is not enabled, the IF1 bit is cleared. A hardware RESET signal, software RESET instruction, ESSI individual reset, or STOP instruction reset all clear the IF1 bit. 7.4.3.3 SSISR Transmit Frame Sync Flag (TFS) Bit 2 When set, TFS indicates that a transmit frame sync occurred in the current time slot. TFS is set at the start of the first time slot in the frame and cleared during all other time slots. If the transmitter is enabled, data written to a transmit data register during the time slot when TFS is set is transmitted (in network mode) during the second time slot in the frame. TFS is useful in network mode to identify the start of a frame. TFS is valid only if at least one transmitter is enabled (i.e., when TE0, TE1, or TE2 is set). A hardware RESET signal, software RESET instruction, ESSI individual reset, or STOP instruction reset all clear TFS. Note: 7.4.3.4 In normal mode, TFS is always read as 1 when data is being transmitted because there is only one time slot per frame, the frame sync time slot. SSISR Receive Frame Sync Flag (RFS) Bit 3 When set, the RFS bit indicates that a receive frame sync occurred during the reception of a word in the serial receive data register. In other words, the data word is from the first time slot in the frame. When the RFS bit is cleared and a word is received, it indicates (only in network mode) that the frame sync did not occur during reception of that word. RFS is valid only if the receiver is enabled (i.e., if the RE bit is set). A hardware RESET signal, software RESET instruction, ESSI individual reset, or STOP instruction reset all clear RFS. Note: In normal mode, RFS is always read as 1 when data is read because there is only one time slot per frame, the frame sync time slot. Not Recommended for New Design 7-28 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 7.4.3.5 SSISR Transmitter Underrun Error Flag (TUE) Bit 4 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The TUE bit is set when at least one of the enabled serial transmit shift registers is empty (i.e., there is no new data to be transmitted) and a transmit time slot occurs. When a transmit underrun error occurs, the previous data (which is still present in the TX registers not written) is retransmitted. In normal mode, there is only one transmit time slot per frame. In network mode, there can be up to 32 transmit time slots per frame. If the TEIE bit is set, a DSP transmit underrun error interrupt request is issued when the TUE bit is set. A hardware RESET signal, software RESET instruction, ESSI individual reset, or STOP instruction reset all clear TUE. The programmer can also clear TUE by first reading the SSISR with the TUE bit set, then writing to all the enabled transmit data registers or to the TSR. 7.4.3.6 SSISR Receiver Overrun Error Flag (ROE) Bit 5 The ROE bit is set when the serial receive shift register is filled and ready to transfer to the receive data register (RX) but RX is already full (i.e., the RDF bit is set). If the REIE bit is set, a DSP receiver overrun error interrupt request is issued when the ROE bit is set. A hardware RESET signal, software RESET instruction, ESSI individual reset, or STOP instruction reset all clear ROE. The programmer can also clear ROE by reading the SSISR with the ROE bit set and then reading the RX. 7.4.3.7 SSISR ESSI Transmit Data Register Empty (TDE) Bit 6 The TDE bit is set when the contents of the transmit data register of every enabled transmitter are transferred to the transmit shift register. It is also set for a TSR disabled time slot period in network mode (as if data were being transmitted after the TSR has been written). When set, the TDE bit indicates that data should be written to all the TX registers of the enabled transmitters or to the TSR. The TDE bit is cleared when the DSP56307 writes to all the transmit data registers of the enabled transmitters, or when the DSP writes to the TSR to disable transmission of the next time slot. If the TIE bit is set, a DSP transmit data interrupt request is issued when TDE is set. A hardware RESET signal, software RESET instruction, ESSI individual reset, or STOP instruction reset all clear the TDE bit. 7.4.3.8 SSISR ESSI Receive Data Register Full (RDF) Bit 7 The RDF bit is set when the contents of the receive shift register are transferred to the receive data register. The RDF bit is cleared when the DSP reads the receive data register. If RIE is set, a DSP receive data interrupt request is issued when RDF is set. A hardware RESET signal, software RESET instruction, ESSI individual reset, or STOP instruction reset all clear the RDF bit. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-29 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 23 8 7 16 15 Receive High Byte 0 Receive Middle Byte 7 0 7 ESSI Receive Data Register (Read Only) Receive Low Byte 0 7 0 16 15 8 7 Serial 23 Receive Receive High Byte Receive Middle Byte Shift Register 7 0 7 0 7 0 Receive Low Byte 0 24 Bit Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 16 Bit 12 Bit 8 Bit SRD WL1, WL0 MSB LSB 8-bit Data MSB 0 0 Least Significant Zero Fill 0 LSB 12-bit Data LSB MSB 16-bit Data MSB LSB 24-bit Data NOTES: Data is received MSB first if SHFD = 0. 24-bit fractional format (ALC = 0). 32-bit mode is not shown. (a) Receive Registers 23 16 15 Transmit High Byte 8 7 Transmit Middle Byte 0 ESSI Transmit Data Register (Write Only) Transmit Low Byte 7 0 7 0 7 0 23 16 15 0 7 0 Transmit High Byte STD 7 Transmit Middle Byte 0 MSB MSB MSB 7 ESSI Transmit Shift Register Transmit Low Byte 0 7 0 LSB 8-bit Data 0 0 Least Significant Zero Fill 0 LSB 12-bit Data LSB 16-bit Data MSB (b) Transmit Registers LSB 24-bit Data NOTES: Data is transmitted MSB first if SHFD = 0. 4-bit fractional format (ALC = 0). 32-bit mode is not shown. AA0686 Figure 7-16 ESSI Data Path Programming Model (SHFD = 0) Not Recommended for New Design 7-30 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 23 8 7 16 15 Receive High Byte Receive Middle Byte ESSI Receive Data Register (Read Only) Receive Low Byte 7 0 7 0 7 0 23 16 15 0 7 0 Receive High Byte SRD 7 Receive Middle Byte 0 MSB ESSI Receive Shift Register Receive Low Byte 7 0 7 0 LSB 8-bit Data 0 MSB Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 0 0 Least Significant Zero Fill 0 LSB 12-bit Data LSB MSB 16-bit Data MSB LSB 24-bit Data (a) Receive Registers 23 16 15 Transmit High Byte 8 7 Transmit Middle Byte 7 0 7 0 7 23 16 15 0 7 Transmit High Byte 7 Transmit Middle Byte 0 7 NOTES: Data is received MSB first if SHFD = 0. 24-bit fractional format (ALC = 0). 32-bit mode is not shown. 0 ESSI Transmit Data Register Transmit Low Byte (Write Only) 0 0 ESSI Transmit Shift Register Transmit Low Byte 0 7 0 24 Bit 16 Bit 12 Bit 8 Bit MSB STD LSB 8-bit Data 0 MSB 0 0 WL1, WL0 Least Significant Zero Fill LSB 12-bit Data LSB MSB 16-bit Data MSB LSB 24-bit Data (b) Transmit Registers NOTES: Data is received MSB first if SHFD = 0. 4-bit fractional format (ALC = 0). 32-bit mode is not shown. AA0687 Figure 7-17 ESSI Data Path Programming Model (SHFD = 1) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-31 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 7.4.4 ESSI Receive Shift Register Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The 24-bit receive shift register (see Figure 7-16 and Figure 7-17) receives incoming data from the serial receive data signal. Data is shifted in by the selected (internal/external) bit clock when the associated frame sync I/O is asserted. It is assumed that data is received MSB first if SHFD is cleared and LSB first if SHFD is set. Data is transferred to the ESSI receive data register after 8, 12, 16, 24, or 32 serial clock cycles have been counted, depending on the word-length control bits in the CRA. 7.4.5 ESSI Receive Data Register (RX) The receive data register (RX) is a 24-bit read-only register that accepts data from the receive shift register as it becomes full, according to Figure 7-16 and Figure 7-17. The data read is aligned according to the value of the ALC bit. When the ALC bit is cleared, the MSB is bit 23, and the least significant byte is unused. When the ALC bit is set, the MSB is bit 15, and the most significant byte is unused. Unused bits are read as 0. If the associated interrupt is enabled, the DSP is interrupted whenever the RX register becomes full. 7.4.6 ESSI Transmit Shift Registers The three 24-bit transmit shift registers contain the data being transmitted, as in Figure 7-16 and Figure 7-17. Data is shifted out to the serial transmit data signals by the selected (whether internal or external) bit clock when the associated frame sync I/O is asserted. The word-length control bits in CRA determine the number of bits that must be shifted out before the shift registers are considered empty and can be written again. Depending on the setting of the CRA, the number of bits to be shifted out can be 8, 12, 16, 24, or 32. The data transmitted is aligned according to the value of the ALC bit. When the ALC bit is cleared, the MSB is Bit 23 and the least significant byte is unused. When ALC is set, the MSB is Bit 15 and the most significant byte is unused. Unused bits are read as 0. Data is shifted out of these registers MSB first if the SHFD bit is cleared and LSB first if the SHFD bit is set. Not Recommended for New Design 7-32 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model 7.4.7 ESSI Transmit Data Registers (TX0-2) ESSI0:TX20, TX10, TX00; ESSI1:TX21, TX11, TX01 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... TX2, TX1, and TX0 are 24-bit write-only registers. Data to be transmitted is written into these registers and automatically transferred to the transmit shift registers. (See Figure 7-16 and Figure 7-17.) The data transmitted (8, 12, 16, or 24 bits) is aligned according to the value of the ALC bit. When the ALC bit is cleared, the MSB is Bit 23. When ALC is set, the MSB is Bit 15. If the transmit data register empty interrupt has been enabled, the DSP is interrupted whenever a transmit data register becomes empty. Note: 7.4.8 When data is written to a peripheral device, there is a two-cycle pipeline delay until any status bits affected by this operation are updated. If you read any of those status bits within the next two cycles, the bit does not reflect its current status. For details, see the DSP56300 Family Manual, Appendix B, Polling a Peripheral Device for Write. ESSI Time Slot Register (TSR) TSR is effectively a write-only null data register that prevents data transmission in the current transmit time slot. For timing purposes, TSR is a write-only register that behaves like an alternative transmit data register, except that, rather than transmitting data, the transmit data signals of all the enabled transmitters are in the high-impedance state for the current time slot. 7.4.9 Transmit Slot Mask Registers (TSMA, TSMB) The transmit slot mask registers are two 16-bit read/write registers. When the TSMA or TSMB is read to the internal data bus, the register contents occupy the two low-order bytes of the data bus, and the high-order byte is filled by 0. In network mode the transmitter(s) use these registers to determine which action to take in the current transmission slot. Depending on the setting of the bits, the transmitter(s) either tri-state the transmitter(s) data signal(s) or transmit a data word and generate a transmitter empty condition. TSMA and TSMB (as in Figure 7-16 and Figure 7-17) can be seen as a single 32-bit register: TSM. Bit n in TSM (TSn) is an enable/disable control bit for transmission in slot number N. When TSn is cleared, all the transmit data signals of the enabled transmitters are tri-stated during transmit time slot number N. The data is still transferred from the enabled transmit data register(s) to the transmit shift register. However, the TDE and the TUE flags are not set. Consequently, during a disabled slot, no transmitter empty Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-33 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface ESSI Programming Model interrupt is generated. The DSP is interrupted only for enabled slots. Data written to the transmit data register when the transmitter empty interrupt request is being serviced is transmitted in the next enabled transmit time slot. When TSn is set, the transmit sequence proceeds normally. Data is transferred from the TX register to the shift register during slot number N and the TDE flag is set. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The TSM slot mask does not conflict with the TSR. Even if a slot is enabled in the TSM, you can chose to write to the TSR to tri-state the signals of the enabled transmitters during the next transmission slot. Setting the bits in the TSM affects the next frame transmission. The frame being transmitted is not affected by the new TSM setting. If the TSM is read, it shows the current setting. After a hardware RESET signal or software RESET instruction, the TSM register is reset to $FFFFFFFF; that value enables all 32 slots for data transmission. 7.4.10 Receive Slot Mask Registers (RSMA, RSMB) The receive slot mask registers are two 16-bit read/write registers. In network mode, the receiver(s) use these registers to determine which action to take in the current time slot. Depending on the setting of the bits, the receiver(s) either tri-state the receiver(s) data signal(s) or receive a data word and generate a receiver full condition. RSMA and RSMB (as in Figure 7-16 and Figure 7-17) can be seen as one 32-bit register, RSM. Bit n in RSM (RSn) is an enable/disable control bit for time slot number N. When RSn is cleared, all the data signals of the enabled receivers are tri-stated during time slot number N. Data is transferred from the receive data register(s) to the receive shift register(s), but the RDF and ROE flags are not set. During a disabled slot, no receiver full interrupt is generated. The DSP is interrupted only for enabled slots. When RSn is set, the receive sequence proceeds normally. Data is received during slot number N, and the RDF flag is set. When the bits in the RSM are set, their setting affects the next frame transmission. The frame currently being transmitted is not affected by the new RSM setting. If the RSM is read, it shows the current setting. When RSMA or RSMB is read by the internal data bus, the register contents occupy the two low-order bytes of the data bus, and the high-order byte is filled by 0. After a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction, the RSM register is reset to $FFFFFFFF; that value enables all 32 time slots for data transmission. Not Recommended for New Design 7-34 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Operating Modes 7.5 OPERATING MODES The ESSI operating modes are selected via the ESSI control registers (CRA and CRB). The operating modes are documented in the following paragraphs. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 7.5.1 ESSI after Reset A hardware RESET signal or software RESET instruction clears the port control register and the port direction control register, thus configuring all the ESSI signals as GPIO. The ESSI is in the reset state while all ESSI signals are programmed as GPIO; it is active only if at least one of the ESSI I/O signals is programmed as an ESSI signal. 7.5.2 ESSI Initialization To initialize the ESSI, do the following: 1. Send a reset: hardware RESET signal, software RESET instruction, ESSI individual reset, or STOP instruction reset. 2. Program the ESSI control and time slot registers. 3. Write data to all the enabled transmitters. 4. Configure at least one signal as ESSI signal. 5. If an external frame sync is used, from the moment the ESSI is activated, at least five (5) serial clocks are needed before the first external frame sync is supplied. Otherwise, improper operation may result. When the PC[5:0] bits in the GPIO port control register (PCR) are cleared during program execution, the ESSI stops serial activity and enters the individual reset state. All status bits of the interface are set to their reset state. The contents of CRA and CRB are not affected. The ESSI individual reset allows a program to reset each interface separately from the other internal peripherals. During ESSI individual reset, internal DMA accesses to the data registers of the ESSI are not valid, and data read there are undefined. To insure proper operation of the ESSI, use an ESSI individual reset when you change the ESSI control registers (except for bits TEIE, REIE, TLIE, RLIE, TIE, RIE, TE2, TE1, TE0, and RE). Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-35 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Operating Modes Here is an example of how to initialize the ESSI. 1. Put the ESSI in its individual reset state by clearing the PCR bits. 2. Configure the control registers (CRA, CRB) to set the operating mode. Disable the transmitters and receiver by clearing the TE[2:0] and RE bits. Set the interrupt enable bits for the operating mode chosen. 3. Enable the ESSI by setting the PCR bits to activate the input/output signals to be used. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 4. Write initial data to the transmitters that are in use during operation. This step is needed even if DMA services the transmitters. 5. Enable the transmitters and receiver to be used. Now the ESSI can be serviced by polling, interrupts, or DMA. Once the ESSI has been enabled (Step 3), operation starts as follows: ¥ For internally generated clock and frame sync, these signals start activity immediately after the ESSI is enabled. ¥ Data is received by the ESSI after the occurrence of a frame sync signal (either internally or externally generated) only when the receive enable (RE) bit is set. ¥ Data is transmitted after the occurrence of a frame sync signal (either internally or externally generated) only when the transmitter enable (TE[2:0]) bit is set. 7.5.3 ESSI Exceptions The ESSI can generate six different exceptions. They are discussed in the following paragraphs (ordered from the highest to the lowest exception priority): 1. ESSI receive data with exception status: Occurs when the receive exception interrupt is enabled, the receive data register is full, and a receiver overrun error has occurred. This exception sets the ROE bit. The ROE bit is cleared when you first read the SSISR and then read RX. 2. ESSI receive data: Occurs when the receive interrupt is enabled, the receive data register is full, and no receive error conditions exist. A read of RX clears the pending interrupt. This error-free interrupt can use a fast interrupt service routine for minimum overhead. 3. ESSI receive last slot interrupt: Occurs when the ESSI is in network mode and the last slot of the frame has ended. This interrupt is generated regardless of the receive mask register setting. The Not Recommended for New Design 7-36 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Operating Modes receive last slot interrupt can signal that the receive mask slot register can be reset, the DMA channels can be reconfigured, and data memory pointers can be reassigned. Using the receive last slot interrupt guarantees that the previous frame is serviced with the previous setting and the new frame is serviced with the new setting without synchronization problems. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Note: The maximum time it takes to service a receive last slot interrupt should not exceed N Ð 1 ESSI bits service time (where N is the number of bits the ESSI can transmit per time slot). 4. ESSI transmit data with exception status: Occurs when the transmit exception interrupt is enabled, at least one transmit data register of the enabled transmitters is empty, and a transmitter underrun error has occurred. This exception sets the TUE bit. The TUE bit is cleared when you first read the SSISR and then write to all the transmit data registers of the enabled transmitters, or when you write to TSR to clear the pending interrupt. 5. ESSI transmit last slot interrupt: Occurs when the ESSI is in network mode at the start of the last slot of the frame. This exception occurs regardless of the transmit mask register setting. The transmit last slot interrupt can signal that the transmit mask slot register can be reset, the DMA channels can be reconfigured, and data memory pointers can be reassigned. Using the transmit last slot interrupt guarantees that the previous frame is serviced with the previous setting and the new frame is serviced with the new setting without synchronization problems. Note: The maximum transmit last slot interrupt service time should not exceed N Ð 1 ESSI bits service time (where N is the number of bits in a slot). 6. ESSI transmit data: Occurs when the transmit interrupt is enabled, at least one of the enabled transmit data registers is empty, and no transmitter error conditions exist. Write to all the enabled TX registers or to the TSR to clear this interrupt. This error-free interrupt uses a fast interrupt service routine for minimum overhead (if no more than two transmitters are used). Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-37 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Operating Modes To configure an ESSI exception, perform the following steps: 1. Configure interrupt service routine (ISR) a. Load vector base address register VBA (b23:8) b. Define I_VEC to be equal to the VBA value (if that is nonzero). If it is defined, I_VEC must be defined for the assembler before the interrupt equate file is included. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... c. Load the exception vector table entry: two-word fast interrupt, or jump/branch to subroutine (long interrupt). p:I_SI0TD 2. Configure interrupt trigger; preload transmit data a. Enable and prioritize overall peripheral interrupt functionality. IPRP (S0L1:0) b. Write data to all enabled transmit registers. TX00 c. Enable a peripheral interrupt-generating function. CRB (TE0) Notes: d. Enable a specific peripheral interrupt. CRB0 (TIE) e. Enable peripheral and associated signals. PCRC (PC5:0) f. Unmask interrupts at the global level. SR (I1:0) 1. The example material to the right of the steps above shows register settings for configuring an ESSI0 transmit interrupt using transmitter 0. 2. The order of the steps is optional except that the interrupt trigger configuration must not be completed until the ISR configuration is complete. Since step c. may cause an immediate transmit without generating an interrupt, perform the transmit data preload in step b. before step c. to insure valid data is sent in the first transmission. 3. After the first transmit, subsequent transmit values are typically loaded into TXnn by the ISR (one value per register per interrupt). Therefore, if N items are to be sent from a particular TXnn, the ISR will need to load the transmit register (N Ð 1) times. 4. Steps c. and d. be performed in a single instruction. 5. If an interrupt trigger event occurs at a time before all interrupt trigger configuration steps are performed, the event is ignored forever; in other words, the event is not queued. Not Recommended for New Design 7-38 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Operating Modes 6. If interrupts derived from the core or other peripherals need to be enabled at the same time as ESSI interrupts, step f. should be done last. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 7.5.4 Operating Modes: Normal, Network, and On-Demand The ESSI has three basic operating modes and several data and operation formats. These modes can be programmed using the ESSI control registers. The data and operation formats available to the ESSI are selected when you set or clear control bits in the CRA and CRB. These control bits are WL[2:1], MOD, SYN, FSL[1:0], FSR, FSP, CKP, and SHFD. 7.5.4.1 Normal/Network/On-Demand Mode Selection You select either normal mode or network mode by clearing or setting the MOD bit in the CRB. In normal mode, the ESSI sends or receives one data word per frame (per enabled receiver or transmitter). In network mode, 2 to 32 time slots per frame may be selected. During each frame, 0 to 32 data words may be received or transmitted (from each enabled receiver or transmitter). In either case, the transfers are periodic. The normal mode typically transfers data to or from a single device. Network mode is typically used in time division multiplexed networks of codecs or DSPs with multiple words per frame. Network mode has a submode called on-demand mode. You set the MOD bit in the CRB for network mode, and you set the frame rate divider to 0 (DC = $00000) to select on-demand mode.This submode does not generate a periodic frame sync. A frame sync pulse is generated only when data is available to transmit. The frame sync signal indicates the first time slot in the frame. On-demand mode requires that the transmit frame sync be internal (output) and the receive frame sync be external (input). For simplex operation, synchronous mode could be used; however, for full-duplex operation, asynchronous mode must be used. You can enable data transmission that is data-driven by writing data into each TX. Although the ESSI is double-buffered, only one word can be written to each TX, even if the transmit shift register is empty. The receive and transmit interrupts function normally, using TDE and RDF; however, transmit underruns are impossible for on-demand transmission and are disabled. This mode is useful to interface to codecs requiring a continuous clock. 7.5.4.2 Synchronous/Asynchronous Operating Modes The transmit and receive sections of the ESSI interface are synchronous or asynchronous. The transmitter and receiver use common clock and synchronization signals in synchronous mode; they use separate clock and sync signals in asynchronous mode. The SYN bit in CRB selects synchronous or asynchronous operation. When the SYN bit is cleared, the ESSI TX and RX clocks and frame sync sources are independent. If the SYN Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-39 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Operating Modes bit is set, the ESSI TX and RX clocks and frame sync are driven by the same source (either external or internal). Since the ESSI is designed to operate either synchronously or asynchronously, separate receive and transmit interrupts are provided. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Transmitter 1 and transmitter 2 operate only in synchronous mode. Data clock and frame sync signals are generated internally by the DSP or obtained from external sources. If clocks are internally generated, the ESSI clock generator derives bit clock and frame sync signals from the DSP internal system clock. The ESSI clock generator consists of a selectable fixed prescaler with a programmable prescaler for bit rate clock generation and a programmable frame-rate divider with a word-length divider for frame-rate sync-signal generation. 7.5.4.3 Frame Sync Selection The transmitter and receiver can operate independently. The transmitter can have either a bit-long or word-long frame-sync signal format, and the receiver can have the same or another format. The selection is made by programming FSL[1:0], FSR, and FSP bits in the CRB. 7.5.4.3.1 Frame Sync Signal Format FSL1 controls the frame-sync signal format. ¥ If the FSL1 bit is cleared, the RX frame sync is asserted during the entire data transfer period. This frame sync length is compatible with Motorola codecs, serial peripherals that conform to the Motorola SPI, serial A/D and D/A converters, shift registers, and telecommunication pulse code modulation serial I/O. ¥ If the FSL1 bit is set, the RX frame sync pulses active for one bit clock immediately before the data transfer period. This frame sync length is compatible with Intel and National components, codecs, and telecommunication pulse code modulation serial I/O. 7.5.4.3.2 Frame Sync Length for Multiple Devices The ability to mix frame sync lengths is useful to configure systems in which data is received from one type of device (e.g., codec) and transmitted to a different type of device. FSL0 controls whether RX and TX have the same frame sync length. ¥ If the FSL0 bit is cleared, both RX and TX have the same frame sync length. ¥ If the FSL0 bit is set, RX and TX have different frame sync lengths. FSL0 is ignored when the SYN bit is set. Not Recommended for New Design 7-40 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Operating Modes 7.5.4.3.3 Word Length Frame Sync and Data Word Timing The FSR bit controls the relative timing of the word length frame sync relative to the data word timing. ¥ When the FSR bit is cleared, the word length frame sync is generated (or expected) with the first bit of the data word. ¥ When the FSR bit is set, the word length frame sync is generated (or expected) with the last bit of the previous word. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... FSR is ignored when a bit-length frame sync is selected. 7.5.4.3.4 Frame Sync Polarity The FSP bit controls the polarity of the frame sync. ¥ When the FSP bit is cleared, the polarity of the frame sync is positive; that is, the frame sync signal is asserted high. The ESSI synchronizes on the leading edge of the frame sync signal. ¥ When the FSP bit is set, the polarity of the frame sync is negative; that is, the frame sync is asserted low. The ESSI synchronizes on the trailing edge of the frame sync signal. The ESSI receiver looks for a receive frame sync edge (leading edge if FSP is cleared, trailing edge if FSP is set) only when the previous frame is completed. If the frame sync is asserted before the frame is completed (or before the last bit of the frame is received in the case of a bit frame sync or a word-length frame sync with FSR set), the current frame sync is not recognized, and the receiver is internally disabled until the next frame sync. Frames do not have to be adjacent; that is, a new frame sync does not have to follow the previous frame immediately. Gaps of arbitrary periods can occur between frames. All the enabled transmitters are tri-stated during these gaps. 7.5.4.4 Byte Format (LSB/MSB) for the Transmitter Some devices, such as codecs, require a MSB-first data format. Other devices, such as those that use the AES-EBU digital audio format, require the LSB first. To be compatible with all formats, the shift registers in the ESSI are bidirectional. You select either MSB or LSB by programming the SHFD bit in the CRB. ¥ If the SHFD bit is cleared, data is shifted into the receive shift register MSB first and shifted out of the transmit shift register MSB first. ¥ If the SHFD bit is set, data is shifted into the receive shift register LSB first and shifted out of the transmit shift register LSB first. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-41 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface GPIO Signals and Registers 7.5.5 Flags Two ESSI signals (SC[1:0]) are available for use as serial I/O flags. Their operation is controlled by the SYN, SCD[1:0], SSC1, and TE[2:1] bits in the CRB/CRA.The control bits OF[1:0] and status bits IF[1:0] are double-buffered to and from SC[1:0]. Double-buffering the flags keeps the flags in sync with TX and RX. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The SC[1:0] flags are available in the Synchronous mode only. Each flag can be separately programmed. Flag SC0 is enabled when transmitter 1 is disabled (TE1 = 0). The flagÕs direction is selected by the SCD0 bit. When SCD0 is set, SC0 is configured as output. When SCD0 is cleared, SC0 is configured as input. Similarly, the SC1 flag is enabled when transmitter 2 is disabled (TE2 = 0), and the SC1 signal is not configured as the transmitter 0 drive-enabled signal (Bit SSC1 = 0). The direction of SC1 is determined by the SCD1 bit. When SCD1 is set, SC1 is an output flag. When SCD1 is cleared, SC1 is an input flag. When programmed as input flags, the value of the SC[1:0] bits is latched at the same time as the first bit of the received data word is sampled. Once the input has been latched, the signal on the input flag signal (SC0 and SC1) can change without affecting the input flag. The value of SC[1:0] does not change until the first bit of the next data word is received. When the received data word is latched by RX, the latched values of SC[1:0] are latched by the SSISR IF[1:0] bits respectively and can be read by software. When programmed as output flags, the value of the SC[1:0] bits is taken from the value of the OF[1:0] bits. The value of the OF[1:0] bits is latched when the contents of TX are transferred to the transmit shift register. The value on SC[1:0] is stable from the time the first bit of the transmit data word is transmitted until the first bit of the next transmit data word is transmitted. The OF[1:0] values can be set directly by software. This allows the DSP56307 to control data transmission by indirectly controlling the value of the SC[1:0] flags. 7.6 GPIO SIGNALS AND REGISTERS The GPIO functionality of an ESSI port (whether C or D) is controlled by three registers: port control register (PCRC, PCRD), port direction register (PRRC, PRRD), and port data register (PDRC, PDRD). Not Recommended for New Design 7-42 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface GPIO Signals and Registers 7.6.1 Port Control Register (PCR) The read/write 24-bit PCR controls the functionality of the ESSI GPIO signals. Each of PC[5:0] bits controls the functionality of the corresponding port signal. When a PC[i] bit is set, the corresponding port signal is configured as an ESSI signal. When a PC[i] bit is cleared, the corresponding port signal is configured as a GPIO signal. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears all PCR bits. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PC5 PC4 PC3 PC2 PC1 PC0 STDn SRDn SCKn SCKn2 SCKn1 SCKn0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 0 = GPIO, 1 = ESSI PCRC: ESSI0, PCRD: ESSI1 Reserved bit; read as zero; should be written with zero for future compatibility AA0688 Figure 7-18 Port Control Register (PCR) (PCRC X:$FFFFBF) (PCRD X:$FFFFAF) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-43 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface GPIO Signals and Registers 7.6.2 Port Direction Register (PRR) The read/write 24-bit PRR controls the data direction of the ESSI GPIO signals. When PRR[i] is set, the corresponding signal is an output signal. When PRR[i] is cleared, the corresponding signal is an input signal. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PDC5 PDC4 PDC3 PDC2 PDC1 PDC0 STDn SRDn SCKn SCKn2 SCKn1 SCKn0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 0 = Input, 1 = Output PRRC: ESSI0, PRRD: ESSI1 Reserved bit; read as zero; should be written with zero for future compatibility AA0689 Figure 7-19 Port Direction Register (PRR)(PRRC X:$FFFFBE) (PRRD X:$FFFFAE) Note: Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears all PRR bits. The following table shows the port signal configurations. Table 7-5 Port Control Register and Port Direction Register Bits PC[i] PDC[i] Port Signal[i] Function 1 X ESSI 0 0 GPIO input 0 1 GPIO output Note: 7.6.3 X: The signal setting is irrelevant to Port Signal[i] function. Port Data Register (PDR) The read/write 24-bit PDR is used to read or write data to and from the ESSI GPIO signals. The PD[5:0] bits are used to read or write data from and to the corresponding port signals if they are configured as GPIO signals. If a port signal [i] is configured as a GPIO input, then the corresponding PD[i] bit reflects the value present on this signal. If a Not Recommended for New Design 7-44 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface GPIO Signals and Registers port signal [i] is configured as a GPIO output, then the value written into the corresponding PD[i] bit is reflected on this signal. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PD5 PD4 PD3 PD2 PD1 PD0 STDn SRDn SCKn SCKn2 SCKn1 SCKn0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PDRD: ESSI0, PDRD: ESSI1 Reserved bit; read as zero; should be written with zero for future compatibility AA0690 Figure 7-20 Port Data Register (PDR) (PDRC X:$FFFFBD) (PDRD X:$FFFFAD) Note: Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears all PDR bits. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 7-45 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... GPIO Signals and Registers Not Recommended for New Design 7-46 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 8 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... SERIAL COMMUNICATION INTERFACE Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-3 SCI I/O SIGNALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-3 SCI PROGRAMMING MODEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-4 OPERATING MODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-21 GPIO SIGNALS AND REGISTERS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-27 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 Not Recommended for New Design 8-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface Introduction to the SCI 8.1 INTRODUCTION TO THE SCI Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The DSP56307 serial communication interface (SCI) provides a full-duplex port for serial communication with other DSPs, microprocessors, or peripherals such as modems. The SCI interfaces without additional logic to peripherals that use TTL-level signals. With a small amount of additional logic, the SCI can connect to peripheral interfaces that have non-TTL level signals, such as RS232C, RS422, etc. This interface uses three dedicated signals: transmit data, receive data, and SCI serial clock. It supports industry-standard asynchronous bit rates and protocols, as well as high-speed synchronous data transmission (up to 8.25 Mbps for a 66 MHz clock). The asynchronous protocols supported by the SCI include a multidrop mode for master/slave operation with wakeup on idle line and wakeup on address bit capability. This mode allows the DSP56302 to share a single serial line efficiently with other peripherals. The SCI consists of separate transmit and receive sections that can operate asynchronously with respect to each other. A programmable baud-rate generator provides the transmit and receive clocks. An enable vector and an interrupt vector have been included so that the baud-rate generator can function as a general purpose timer when it is not being used by the SCI, or when the interrupt timing is the same as that used by the SCI. 8.2 SCI I/O SIGNALS Each of the three SCI signals (RXD, TXD, and SCLK) can be configured as either a GPIO signal or as a specific SCI signal. Each signal is independent of the others. For example, if only the TXD signal is needed, the RXD and SCLK signals can be programmed for GPIO. However, at least one of the three signals must be selected as an SCI signal to release the SCI from reset. SCI interrupts are enabled by programming the SCI control registers before any of the SCI signals are programmed as SCI functions. In this case, only one transmit interrupt can be generated because the Transmit Data Register is empty. The timer and timer interrupt operate regardless of how the SCI pins are configured - either as SCI or GPIO. 8.2.1 Receive Data (RXD) This input signal receives byte-oriented serial data and transfers the data to the SCI receive shift register. Asynchronous input data is sampled on the positive edge of the Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model receive clock (1 × SCLK) if SCKP is cleared. RXD can be configured as a GPIO signal (PE0) when the SCI RXD function is not being used. 8.2.2 Transmit Data (TXD) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... This output signal transmits serial data from the SCI transmit shift register. Data changes on the negative edge of the asynchronous transmit clock (SCLK) if SCKP is cleared. This output is stable on the positive edge of the transmit clock. TXD can be programmed as a GPIO signal (PE1) when the SCI TXD function is not being used. 8.2.3 SCI Serial Clock (SCLK) This bidirectional signal provides an input or output clock from which the transmit and/or receive baud rate is derived in asynchronous mode and from which data is transferred in synchronous mode. SCLK can be programmed as a GPIO signal (PE2) when the SCI SCLK function is not being used. This signal can be programmed as PE2 when data is being transmitted on TXD, since the clock does not need to be transmitted in asynchronous mode. Because SCLK is independent of SCI data I/O, there is no connection between programming the PE2 signal as SCLK and data coming out the TXD signal. 8.3 SCI PROGRAMMING MODEL The SCI programming model can be viewed as three types of registers: ¥ Control Ð SCI Control Register (SCR) in Figure 8-1 Ð SCI Clock Control Register (SCCR) in Figure 8-3 ¥ Status Ð SCI Status Register (SSR) in Figure 8-2 ¥ Data transfer Ð SCI Receive Data Registers (SRX) in Figure 8-7 Ð SCI Transmit Data Registers (STX) in Figure 8-7 Ð SCI Transmit Data Address Register (STXA) in Figure 8-7 Not Recommended for New Design 8-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The SCI includes the GPIO functions documented in Section 8.5 GPIO Signals and Registers on page 8-27. The following paragraphs describe each bit in the programming model. 7 WOMS 6 RWU 5 WAKE 4 SBK 3 SSFTD 2 WDS2 1 WDS1 0 WDS0 15 SCKP 14 STIR 13 TMIE 12 TIE 11 RIE 10 ILIE 9 TE 8 RE 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 REIE AA0854 Figure 8-1 SCI Control Register (SCR) 7 R8 6 FE 5 PE 4 OR 3 IDLE 2 RDRF 1 TDRE 0 TRNE 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 AA0855 Figure 8-2 SCI Status Register (SSR) 7 CD7 6 CD6 5 CD5 4 CD4 3 CD3 2 CD2 1 CD1 0 CD0 15 TCM 14 RCM 13 SCP 12 COD 11 CD11 10 CD10 9 CD9 8 CD8 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility AA0856 Figure 8-3 SCI Clock Control Register (SCCR) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model Mode 0 0 0 0 WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 TX (SSFTD = 0) 8-bit Synchronous Data (Shift Register Mode) D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D6 D7 or Data Type One Byte From Shift Register Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Mode 2 0 1 0 WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 TX (SSFTD = 0) Start Bit 10-bit Asynchronous (1 Start, 8 Data, 1 Stop) D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 Stop Bit Mode 4 1 0 0 WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 TX (SSFTD = 0) Start Bit 11-bit Asynchronous (1 Start, 8 Data, 1 Even Parity, 1 Stop) D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 or Data Type Even Parity Stop Bit Odd Parity Stop Bit Mode 5 1 0 1 WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 TX (SSFTD = 0) Start Bit 11-bit Asynchronous (1 Start, 8 Data, 1 Odd Parity, 1 Stop) D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 or Data Type Mode 6 1 1 0 WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 TX (SSFTD = 0) Start Bit 11-bit Asynchronous Multidrop (1 Start, 8 Data, 1 Data Type, 1 Stop) D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Data Type Stop Bit Data Type: 1 = Address Byte Note: 1. Modes 1, 3, and 7 are reserved. 0 = Data Byte 2. D0 = LSB; D7 = MSB 3. Data is transmitted and received LSB first if SSFTD = 0, or MSB first if AA0691 Not Recommended for New Design 8-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model Mode 0 0 0 0 WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 8-bit Synchronous Data (Shift Register Mode) TX (SSFTD = 1) D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 D1 D0 or Data Type One Byte From Shift Register Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Mode 2 10-bit Asynchronous (1 Start, 8 Data, 1 Stop) 0 1 0 WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 TX (SSFTD = 1) Start Bit D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 Stop Bit Mode 4 1 0 0 WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 TX (SSFTD = 1) 11-bit Asynchronous (1 Start, 8 Data, 1 Even Parity, 1 Stop) Start Bit D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 or Data Type Even Parity Stop Bit Odd Parity Stop Bit Mode 5 11-bit Asynchronous (1 Start, 8 Data, 1 Odd Parity, 1 Stop) 1 0 1 WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 TX (SSFTD = 1) Start Bit D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 or Data Type Mode 6 11-bit Asynchronous Multidrop (1 Start, 8 Data, 1 Data Type, 1 Stop) 1 1 0 WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 TX (SSFTD = 1) Start Bit D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 Data Type Stop Bit Data Type: 1 = Address Byte Note: 1. Modes 1, 3, and 7 are reserved. 0 = Data Byte 2. D0 = LSB; D7 = MSB 3. Data is transmitted and received LSB first if SSFTD = 0, or MSB first if AA0691 (cont.) Figure 8-4 SCI Data Word Formats Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model 8.3.1 SCI Control Register (SCR) The SCR is a 24-bit read/write register that controls the serial interface operation. Seventeen of the 24 bits are currently defined. Each bit is documented in the following paragraphs. 8.3.1.1 SCR Word Select (WDS[0:2]) Bits 0–2 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The word select WDS[0:2] bits select the format of transmitted and received data. Format modes are listed in Table 8-1 and shown in Figure 8-4. Table 8-1 Word Formats WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 Mode Word Formats 0 0 0 0 8-Bit Synchronous Data (shift register mode) 0 0 1 1 Reserved 0 1 0 2 10-Bit Asynchronous (1 start, 8 data, 1 stop) 0 1 1 3 Reserved 1 0 0 4 11-Bit Asynchronous (1 start, 8 data, 1 even parity, 1 stop) 1 0 1 5 11-Bit Asynchronous (1 start, 8 data, 1 odd parity, 1 stop) 1 1 0 6 11-Bit Multidrop Asynchronous (1 start, 8 data, 1 data type, 1 stop) 1 1 1 7 Reserved Asynchronous modes are compatible with most UART-type serial devices, and support standard RS232C communication links. Multidrop asynchronous mode is compatible with the MC68681 DUART, the M68HC11 SCI interface, and the Intel 8051 serial interface. Synchronous data mode is essentially a high-speed shift register used for I/O expansion and stream-mode channel interfaces. You can synchronize data by using a gated transmit and receive clock compatible with the Intel 8051 serial interface mode 0. When odd parity is selected, the transmitter counts the number of 1s in the data word. If the total is not an odd number, the parity bit is set, thus producing an odd number. If the receiver counts an even number of 1s, an error in transmission has occurred. When even parity is selected, an even number must result from the calculation performed at both ends of the line, or an error in transmission has occurred. Not Recommended for New Design 8-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears the word select bits. 8.3.1.2 SCR SCI Shift Direction (SSFTD) Bit 3 The SSFTD bit determines the order in which the SCI data shift registers shift data in or out: MSB first when set, LSB first when cleared. The parity and data type bits do not change their position in the frame, and remain adjacent to the stop bit. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears SSFTD. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 8.3.1.3 SCR Send Break (SBK) Bit 4 A break is an all-zero word frameÑa start bit 0, characters of all 0s (including any parity), and a stop bit 0 (i.e., ten or eleven 0s, depending on the mode selected). If SBK is set and then cleared, the transmitter completes transmission of the current frame, sends 10 or 11 0s (depending on WDS mode), and reverts to idle or sending data. If SBK remains set, the transmitter continually sends whole frames of 0s (10 or 11 bits with no stop bit). At the completion of the break code, the transmitter sends at least one high (set) bit before transmitting any data to guarantee recognition of a valid start bit. Break can be used to signal an unusual condition, message, etc., by forcing a frame error; the frame error is caused by a missing stop bit. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears SBK. 8.3.1.4 SCR Wakeup Mode Select (WAKE) Bit 5 When WAKE is cleared, the wakeup on idle line mode is selected. In the wakeup on idle line mode, the SCI receiver is re-enabled by an idle string of at least 10 or 11 (depending on WDS mode) consecutive 1s. The transmitterÕs software must provide this idle string between consecutive messages. The idle string cannot occur within a valid message because each word frame there contains a start bit that is 0. When WAKE is set, the wakeup on address bit mode is selected. In the wakeup on address bit mode, the SCI receiver is re-enabled when the last (eighth or ninth) data bit received in a character (frame) is 1. The ninth data bit is the address bit (R8) in the 11-bit multidrop mode; the eighth data bit is the address bit in the 10-bit asynchronous and 11-bit asynchronous with parity modes. Thus, the received character is an address that has to be processed by all sleeping processorsÑthat is, each processor has to compare the received character with its own address and decide whether to receive or ignore all following characters. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears WAKE. 8.3.1.5 SCR Receiver Wakeup Enable (RWU) Bit 6 When RWU is set and the SCI is in asynchronous mode, the wakeup function is enabled; i. e., the SCI is asleep and can be awakened by the event defined by the WAKE bit. In Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model Sleep state, all interrupts and all receive flags except IDLE are disabled. When the receiver wakes up, RWU is cleared by the wakeup hardware. The programmer can also clear the RWU bit to wake up the receiver. RWU can be used by the programmer to ignore messages that are for other devices on a multidrop serial network. Wakeup on idle line (i. e., WAKE is cleared) or wakeup on address bit (i. e., WAKE is set) must be chosen. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ When WAKE is cleared and RWU is set, the receiver does not respond to data on the data line until an idle line is detected. ¥ When WAKE is set and RWU is set, the receiver does not respond to data on the data line until a data frame with Bit 9 set is detected. When the receiver wakes up, the RWU bit is cleared, and the first frame of data is received. If interrupts are enabled, the CPU is interrupted and the interrupt routine reads the message header to determine whether the message is intended for this DSP. ¥ If the message is for this DSP, the message is received, and RWU is set to wait for the next message. ¥ If the message is not for this DSP, the DSP immediately sets RWU. Setting RWU causes the DSP to ignore the remainder of the message and wait for the next message. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears RWU. RWU is ignored in synchronous mode. 8.3.1.6 SCR Wired-OR Mode Select (WOMS) Bit 7 When the WOMS bit is set, the SCI TXD driver is programmed to function as an open-drain output and can be wired together with other TXD signals in an appropriate bus configuration, such as a master-slave multidrop configuration. An external pullup resistor is required on the bus. When the WOMS is cleared, the TXD signal uses an active internal pullup. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears WOMS. 8.3.1.7 SCR Receiver Enable (RE) Bit 8 When RE is set, the receiver is enabled. When RE is cleared, the receiver is disabled, and data transfer from the receive shift register to the receive data register (SRX) is inhibited. If RE is cleared while a character is being received, the reception of the character is completed before the receiver is disabled. RE does not inhibit RDRF or receive interrupts. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears RE. Not Recommended for New Design 8-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model 8.3.1.8 SCR Transmitter Enable (TE) Bit 9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... When TE is set, the transmitter is enabled. When TE is cleared, the transmitter completes transmission of data in the SCI transmit data shift register, and then the serial output is forced high (i.e., idle). Data present in the SCI transmit data register (STX) is not transmitted. STX can be written and TDRE cleared, but the data is not transferred into the shift register. TE does not inhibit TDRE or transmit interrupts. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears TE. Setting TE causes the transmitter to send a preamble of ten or eleven consecutive 1s (depending on WDS). This procedure gives the programmer a convenient way to ensure that the line goes idle before starting a new message. To force this separation of messages by the minimum idle line time, we recommend the following sequence: 1. Write the last byte of the first message to STX. 2. Wait for TDRE to go high, indicating the last byte has been transferred to the transmit shift register. 3. Clear TE and set TE to queue an idle line preamble to follow immediately the transmission of the last character of the message (including the stop bit). 4. Write the first byte of the second message to STX. In this sequence, if the first byte of the second message is not transferred to STX prior to the finish of the preamble transmission, the transmit data line remains idle until STX is finally written. 8.3.1.9 SCR Idle Line Interrupt Enable (ILIE) Bit 10 When ILIE is set, the SCI interrupt occurs when IDLE (SCI status register bit 3) is set. When ILIE is cleared, the IDLE interrupt is disabled. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears ILIE. An internal flag, the shift register idle interrupt (SRIINT) flag, is the interrupt request to the interrupt controller. SRIINT is not directly accessible to the user. When a valid start bit has been received, an idle interrupt is generated if both IDLE and ILIE are set. The idle interrupt acknowledge from the interrupt controller clears this interrupt request. The idle interrupt is not asserted again until at least one character has been received. The results are as follows: ¥ The IDLE bit shows the real status of the receive line at all times. ¥ An idle interrupt is generated once for each idle state, no matter how long the idle state lasts. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model 8.3.1.10 SCR SCI Receive Interrupt Enable (RIE) Bit 11 The RIE bit is set to enable the SCI receive data interrupt. If RIE is cleared, the receive data interrupt is disabled, and then the RDRF bit in the SCI status register must be polled to determine whether the receive data register is full. If both RIE and RDRF are set, the SCI requests an SCI receive data interrupt from the interrupt controller. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Receive interrupts with exception have higher priority than normal receive data interrupts. Therefore, if an exception occurs (i.e., if PE, FE, or OR are set) and REIE is set, the SCI requests an SCI receive data with exception interrupt from the interrupt controller. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears RIE. 8.3.1.11 SCR SCI Transmit Interrupt Enable (TIE) Bit 12 The TIE bit is set to enable the SCI transmit data interrupt. If TIE is cleared, transmit data interrupts are disabled, and the transmit data register empty (TDRE) bit in the SCI status register must be polled to determine whether the transmit data register is empty. If both TIE and TDRE are set, the SCI requests an SCI transmit data interrupt from the interrupt controller. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears TIE. 8.3.1.12 SCR Timer Interrupt Enable (TMIE) Bit 13 The TMIE bit is set to enable the SCI timer interrupt. If TMIE is set, timer interrupt requests are sent to the interrupt controller at the rate set by the SCI clock register. The timer interrupt is automatically cleared by the timer interrupt acknowledge from the interrupt controller. This feature allows DSP programmers to use the SCI baud rate generator as a simple periodic interrupt generator if the SCI is not in use, if external clocks are used for the SCI, or if periodic interrupts are needed at the SCI baud rate. The SCI internal clock is divided by 16 (to match the 1 × SCI baud rate) for timer interrupt generation. This timer does not require that any SCI signals be configured for SCI use to operate. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears TMIE. 8.3.1.13 SCR Timer Interrupt Rate (STIR) Bit 14 The STIR bit controls a divide-by-32 in the SCI Timer interrupt generator. When STIR is cleared, the divide-by-32 is inserted in the chain. When STIR is set, the divide-by-32 is bypassed, thereby increasing timer resolution by a factor of 32. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears this bit. To insure proper operation of the timer, STIR must not be changed during timer operation (i.e., if TMIE = 1). 8.3.1.14 SCR SCI Clock Polarity (SCKP) Bit 15 The SCKP bit controls the clock polarity sourced or received on the clock signal (SCLK), eliminating the need for an external inverter. When SCKP is cleared, the clock polarity is positive; when SCKP is set, the clock polarity is negative. In synchronous mode, positive polarity means that the clock is normally positive and transitions negative during valid Not Recommended for New Design 8-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model data. Negative polarity means that the clock is normally negative and transitions positive during valid data. In asynchronous mode, positive polarity means that the rising edge of the clock occurs in the center of the period that data is valid. Negative polarity means that the falling edge of the clock occurs during the center of the period that data is valid. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears SCKP. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 8.3.1.15 Receive with Exception Interrupt Enable (REIE) Bit 16 The REIE bit is set to enable the SCI receive data with exception interrupt. If REIE is cleared, the receive data with exception interrupt is disabled. If both REIE and RDRF are set, and PE, FE, and OR are not all cleared, the SCI requests an SCI receive data with exception interrupt from the interrupt controller. Either a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears REIE. 8.3.2 SCI Status Register (SSR) The SSR is a 24-bit read-only register used by the DSP to determine the status of the SCI. The status bits are described in the following paragraphs. 8.3.2.1 SSR Transmitter Empty (TRNE) Bit 0 The TRNE flag bit is set when both the transmit shift register and transmit data register (STX) are empty to indicate that there is no data in the transmitter. When TRNE is set, data written to one of the three STX locations or to the transmit data address register (STXA) is transferred to the transmit shift register and is the first data transmitted. TRNE is cleared when TDRE is cleared by data being written into the STX or the STXA, or when an idle, preamble, or break is transmitted. This bit, when set, indicates that the transmitter is empty; therefore, the data written to STX or STXA is transmitted next. That is, there is no word in the transmit shift register presently being transmitted. This procedure is useful when initiating the transfer of a message (i.e., a string of characters). Either a hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, an SCI individual reset, or a STOP instruction sets TRNE. 8.3.2.2 SSR Transmit Data Register Empty (TDRE) Bit 1 The TDRE flag bit is set when the SCI transmit data register is empty. When TDRE is set, new data can be written to one of the SCI transmit data registers (STX) or the transmit data address register (STXA). TDRE is cleared when the SCI transmit data register is written. Either a hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, an SCI individual reset, or a STOP instruction sets TDRE. In synchronous mode, when the internal SCI clock is in use, there is a delay of up to 5.5 serial clock cycles between the time that STX is written until TDRE is set, indicating the Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model data has been transferred from the STX to the transmit shift register. There is a delay of 2 to 4 serial clock cycles between writing STX and loading the transmit shift register; in addition, TDRE is set in the middle of transmitting the second bit. When using an external serial transmit clock, if the clock stops, the SCI transmitter stops. TDRE is not set until the middle of the second bit transmitted after the external clock starts. Gating the external clock off after the first bit has been transmitted delays TDRE indefinitely. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... In asynchronous mode, the TDRE flag is not set immediately after a word is transferred from the STX or STXA to the transmit shift register nor when the word first begins to be shifted out. TDRE is set 2 cycles (of the 16 × clock) after the start bit; that is, 2 (16 × clock) cycles into the transmission time of the first data bit. 8.3.2.3 SSR Receive Data Register Full (RDRF) Bit 2 The RDRF bit is set when a valid character is transferred to the SCI receive data register from the SCI receive shift register (regardless of the error bits condition). RDRF is cleared when the SCI receive data register is read. Also a hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, an SCI individual reset, or a STOP instruction clears RDRF. 8.3.2.4 SSR Idle Line Flag (IDLE) Bit 3 IDLE is set when 10 (or 11) consecutive 1s are received. IDLE is cleared by a start-bit detection. The IDLE status bit represents the status of the receive line. The transition of IDLE from 0 to 1 can cause an IDLE interrupt (ILIE). A hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, an SCI individual reset, or a STOP instruction clears IDLE. 8.3.2.5 SSR Overrun Error Flag (OR) Bit 4 The OR flag bit is set when a byte is ready to be transferred from the receive shift register to the receive data register (SRX) that is already full (RDRF = 1). The receive shift register data is not transferred to the SRX. The OR flag indicates that character(s) in the received data stream may have been lost. The only valid data is located in the SRX. OR is cleared when the SCI status register is read, followed by a read of SRX. The OR bit clears the FE and PE bits; that is, overrun error has higher priority than FE or PE. A hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, an SCI individual reset, or a STOP instruction clears OR. 8.3.2.6 SSR Parity Error (PE) Bit 5 In 11-bit asynchronous modes, the PE bit is set when an incorrect parity bit has been detected in the received character. It is set simultaneously with RDRF for the byte which contains the parity error; that is, when the received word is transferred to the SRX. If PE is set, further data transfer into the SRX is not inhibited. PE is cleared when the SCI status register is read, followed by a read of SRX. A hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, an SCI individual reset, or a STOP instruction also clears PE. In 10-bit asynchronous mode, 11-bit multidrop mode, and 8-bit synchronous mode, the PE bit is Not Recommended for New Design 8-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model always cleared since there is no parity bit in these modes. If the byte received causes both parity and overrun errors, the SCI receiver recognizes only the overrun error. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 8.3.2.7 SSR Framing Error Flag (FE) Bit 6 The FE bit is set in asynchronous mode when no stop bit is detected in the data string received. FE and RDRE are set simultaneously when the received word is transferred to the SRX. However, the FE flag inhibits further transfer of data into the SRX until it is cleared. FE is cleared when the SCI status register is read followed by the SRX being read. A hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, an SCI individual reset, or a STOP instruction clears FE. In 8-bit synchronous mode, FE is always cleared. If the byte received causes both framing and overrun errors, the SCI receiver recognizes only the overrun error. 8.3.2.8 SSR Received Bit 8 (R8) Address Bit 7 In 11-bit asynchronous multidrop mode, the R8 bit is used to indicate whether the received byte is an address or data. R8 is set for addresses and is cleared for data. R8 is not affected by reads of the SRX or SCI status register. A hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, an SCI individual reset, or a STOP instruction clears R8. 8.3.3 SCI Clock Control Register (SCCR) The SCCR is a 24-bit read/write register that controls the selection of clock modes and baud rates for the transmit and receive sections of the SCI interface. The control bits are documented in the following paragraphs. The SCCR is cleared by a hardware RESET signal. The basic features of the clock generator, as in Figure 8-5 and Figure 8-6, follow: ¥ The SCI logic always uses a 16 × internal clock in asynchronous mode and always uses a 2 × internal clock in synchronous mode. The maximum internal clock available to the SCI peripheral block is the oscillator frequency divided by 4. These maximum rates are the same for internally or externally supplied clocks. ¥ The 16 × clock is necessary for asynchronous modes to synchronize the SCI to the incoming data (as in Figure 8-5). ¥ For asynchronous modes, the user must provide a 16 × clock if the user wishes to use an external baud rate generator (i.e., SCLK input). ¥ For asynchronous modes, the user can select either 1 × or 16 × for the output clock when using internal TX and RX clocks (TCM = 0 and RCM = 0). ¥ When SCKP is cleared, the transmitted data on the TXD signal changes on the negative edge of the 1 × serial clock and is stable on the positive edge. When Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model SCKP is set, the data changes on the positive edge and is stable on the negative edge. ¥ The received data on the RXD signal is sampled on the positive edge (if SCKP = 0) or on the negative edge (if SCKP = 1) of the 1 × serial clock. ¥ For asynchronous mode, the output clock is continuous. ¥ For synchronous mode, a 1 × clock is used for the output or input baud rate. The maximum 1 × clock is the crystal frequency divided by 8. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ For synchronous mode, the clock is gated. ¥ For synchronous mode, the transmitter and receiver are synchronous with each other. Select 8-or 9-bit Words 0 Idle Line 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 RX, TX Data (SSFTD = 0) Start Stop Start x1 Clock x16 Clock (SCKP = 0) AA0692 Figure 8-5 16 x Serial Clock 8.3.3.1 SCCR Clock Divider (CD[11:0]) Bits 11–0 The CD[11:0] bits specify the divide ratio of the prescale divider in the SCI clock generator. A divide ratio from 1 to 4096 (CD[11:0] = $000 to $FFF) can be selected. A hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears CD11ÐCD0. 8.3.3.2 SCCR Clock Out Divider (COD) Bit 12 The clock output divider is controlled by COD and the SCI mode. If the SCI mode is synchronous, the output divider is fixed at divide by 2. If the SCI mode is asynchronous, either: ¥ If COD is cleared and SCLK is an output (i.e., TCM and RCM are both cleared), then the SCI clock is divided by 16 before being output to the SCLK signal. Thus, the SCLK output is a 1 × clock. Not Recommended for New Design 8-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model ¥ If COD is set and SCLK is an output, the SCI clock is fed directly out to the SCLK signal. Thus, the SCLK output is a 16 × baud clock. A hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears COD. 8.3.3.3 SCCR SCI Clock Prescaler (SCP) Bit 13 The SCP bit selects a divide by 1 (SCP is cleared) or divide by 8 (SCP is set) prescaler for the clock divider. The output of the prescaler is further divided by 2 to form the SCI clock. A hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears SCP. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 8.3.3.4 SCCR Receive Clock Mode Source (RCM) Bit 14 RCM selects whether an internal or external clock is used for the receiver. If RCM is cleared, the internal clock is used. If RCM is set, the external clock (from the SCLK signal) is used. A hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears RCM. Table 8-2 TCM and RCM Bit Configuration TCM RCM TX Clock RX Clock SCLK Signal 0 0 Internal Internal Output 0 1 Internal External Input Asynchronous only 1 0 External Internal Input Asynchronous only 1 1 External External Input Synchronous/asynchronous Mode Synchronous/asynchronous Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model Fcore Divide By 2 12-bit Counter CD11–CD0 Divide By 2 Prescaler: Divide by 1 or 8 SCP Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Internal Clock Divide By 16 SCI Core Logic Uses Divide by 16 for Asynchronous Uses Divide by 2 for Synchronous Timer Interrupt (STMINT) BPS = where: COD If Asynchronous Divide by 1 or 16 If Synchronous Divide By 2 SCKP SCKP = 0 SCKP = 1 coreF 64 × (7 × SCP + 1) × CD + 1) SCP = 0 or 1 CD = $000 to $FFF + Ð TO SCLK AA0693 Figure 8-6 SCI Baud Rate Generator 8.3.3.5 SCCR Transmit Clock Source Bit (TCM) Bit 15 TCM selects whether an internal or external clock is used for the transmitter. If TCM is cleared, the internal clock is used. If TCM is set, the external clock (from the SCLK signal) is used. A hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears TCM. 8.3.4 SCI Data Registers The SCI data registers are divided into two groups: receive and transmit, as in Figure 8-7. There are two receive registers: a receive data register (SRX) and a serial-to-parallel receive shift register. There are also two transmit registers: a transmit data register (called either STX or STXA) and a parallel-to-serial transmit shift register. Not Recommended for New Design 8-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model 23 16 15 8 7 0 SRX SCI Receive Data Register High (Read Only) SRX SCI Receive Data Register Middle (Read Only) SRX SCI Receive Data Register Low (Read Only) SCI Receive Data Shift Register RXD Note: 1. SRX is the same register decoded at three different addresses. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... (a) Receive Data Register 23 16 15 8 7 0 STX SCI Transmit Data Register High (Write Only) STX SCI Transmit Data Register Middle (Write Only) STX SCI Transmit Data Register Low (Write Only) SCI Transmit Data Shift Register 23 16 15 TXD 8 7 0 STXA SCI Transmit Data Address Register (Write Only) Note: 1. Bytes are masked on the fly. 2. STX is the same register decoded at four different addresses. (b) Transmit Data Register AA0694 Figure 8-7 SCI Programming Model - Data Registers 8.3.4.1 SCI Receive Register (SRX) Data bits received on the RXD signal are shifted into the SCI receive shift register. When a complete word has been received, the data portion of the word is transferred to the byte-wide SRX. This process converts the serial data to parallel data and provides double buffering. Double buffering provides flexibility to the programmer and increased throughput since the programmer can save (and process) the previous word while the current word is being received. The SRX can be read at three locations as SRXL, SRXM, and SRXH. When SRXL is read, the contents of the SRX are placed in the lower byte of the data bus and the remaining bits on the data bus are read as 0s. Similarly, when SRXM is read, the contents of SRX are placed in the middle byte of the bus, and when SRXH is read, the contents of SRX are placed in the high byte with the remaining bits are read as 0s. This way of mapping SRX efficiently packs three bytes into one 24-bit word by OR-ing three data bytes read from the three addresses. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-19 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface SCI Programming Model The length and format of the serial word are defined by the WDS0, WDS1, and WDS2 control bits in the SCR. The clock source is defined by the receive clock mode (RCM) select bit in the SCR. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... In synchronous mode, the start bit, the eight data bits, the address/data indicator bit or the parity bit, and the stop bit are received in that order. Data bits are sent LSB first if SSFTD is cleared, and MSB first if SSFTD is set. In synchronous mode, a gated clock provides synchronization. In either synchronous or asynchronous mode, when a complete word has been clocked in, the contents of the shift register can be transferred to the SRX and the flags; RDRF, FE, PE, and OR are changed appropriately. Because the operation of the receive shift register is transparent to the DSP, the contents of this register are not directly accessible to the programmer. 8.3.4.2 SCI Transmit Register (STX) The transmit data register is a one-byte-wide register mapped into four addresses as STXL, STXM, STXH, and STXA. In asynchronous mode, when data is to be transmitted, STXL, STXM, and STXH are used. When STXL is written, the low byte on the data bus is transferred to the STX. When STXM is written, the middle byte is transferred to the STX. When STXH is written, the high byte is transferred to the STX. This structure makes it easy for the programmer to unpack the bytes in a 24-bit word for transmission. TDXA should be written in 11-bit asynchronous multidrop mode when the data is an address and the programmer wants to set the ninth bit (the address bit). When STXA is written, the data from the low byte on the data bus is stored in it. The address data bit is cleared in 11-bit asynchronous multidrop mode when any of STXL, STXM, or STXH is written. When either STX (STXL, STXM, or STXH) or STXA is written, TDRE is cleared. The transfer from either STX or STXA to the transmit shift register occurs automatically, but not immediately, after the last bit from the previous word is shifted out; that is, the transmit shift register is empty. Like the receiver, the transmitter is double-buffered. However, a delay of two to four serial clock cycles occurs between when the data is transferred from either STX or STXA to the transmit shift register and when the first bit appears on the TXD signal. (A serial clock cycle is the time required to transmit one data bit.) The transmit shift register is not directly addressable, and there is no dedicated flag for this register. Because of this fact and the two- to four-cycle delay, two bytes cannot be written consecutively to STX or STXA without polling, as the second byte might overwrite the first byte. Consequently, you should always poll the TDRE flag prior to writing STX or STXA to prevent overruns unless transmit interrupts have been enabled. Either STX or STXA is usually written as part of the interrupt service routine. An interrupt is generated only if TDRE is set. The transmit shift register is indirectly visible via the TRNE bit in the SSR. Not Recommended for New Design 8-20 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface Operating Modes In synchronous mode, data is synchronized with the transmit clock; that clock can have either an internal or external source, as defined by the TCM bit in the SCCR. The length and format of the serial word is defined by the WDS0, WDS1, and WDS2 control bits in the SCR. In asynchronous mode, the start bit, the eight data bits (with the LSB first if SSFTD = 0 and the MSB first if SSFTD = 1), the address/data indicator bit or parity bit, and the stop bit are transmitted in that order. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The data to be transmitted can be written to any one of the three STX addresses. If SCKP is set and SSHTD is set, SCI synchronous mode is equivalent to the SSI operation in 8-bit data on-demand mode. Note: 8.4 When data is written to a peripheral device, there is a two-cycle pipeline delay until any status bits affected by this operation are updated. If you read any of those status bits within the next two cycles, the bit does not reflect its current status. For details see the DSP56300 Family Manual, Appendix B, Polling a Peripheral Device for Write. OPERATING MODES The operating modes for the DSP56307 SCI are the following: ¥ 8-bit synchronous (shift register mode) ¥ 10-bit asynchronous (1 start, 8 data, 1 stop) ¥ 11-bit asynchronous (1 start, 8 data, 1 even parity, 1 stop) ¥ 11-bit asynchronous (1 start, 8 data, 1 odd parity, 1 stop) ¥ 11-bit multidrop asynchronous (1 start, 8 data, 1 data type, 1 stop) This mode is used for master/slave operation with wakeup on idle line and wakeup on address bit capability. It allows the DSP56307 to share a single serial line efficiently with other peripherals. These modes are selected by the WD[0:2] bits in the SCR. Synchronous data mode is essentially a high-speed shift register used for I/O expansion and stream-mode channel interfaces. A gated transmit and receive clock compatible with the Intel 8051 serial interface mode 0 synchronizes data. Asynchronous modes are compatible with most UART-type serial devices. Standard RS232C communication links are supported by these modes. Multidrop asynchronous mode is compatible with the MC68681 DUART, the M68HC11 SCI interface, and the Intel 8051 serial interface. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-21 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface Operating Modes 8.4.1 SCI after Reset There are several different ways to reset the SCI: Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Hardware RESET signal ¥ Software RESET instruction: Both hardware and software resets clear the port control register bits, which configure all I/O as GPIO input. The SCI remains in the Reset state as long as all SCI signals are programmed as GPIO (PC2, PC1, and PC0 all are cleared); the SCI becomes active only when at least one of the SCI I/O signals is not programmed as GPIO. ¥ Individual reset: During program execution, the PC2, PC1, and PC0 bits can be cleared (i.e., individually reset), causing the SCI to stop serial activity and enter the Reset state. All SCI status bits are set to their reset state. However, the contents of the SCR are not affected, to allow the DSP program to reset the SCI separately from the other internal peripherals. During individual reset, internal DMA accesses to the data registers of the SCI are not valid, and the data read is unknown. ¥ Stop processing state reset (i.e., the STOP instruction) Executing the STOP instruction halts operation of the SCI until the DSP is restarted, causing the SSR to be reset. No other SCI registers are affected by the STOP instruction. Table 8-3 illustrates how each type of reset affects each register in the SCI. Not Recommended for New Design 8-22 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface Operating Modes Table 8-3 SCI Registers after Reset Reset Type Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Register Bit SCR SSR Bit Mnemonic Bit Number REIE HW Reset SW Reset IR Reset ST Reset 16 0 0 Ñ Ñ SCKP 15 0 0 Ñ Ñ STIR 14 0 0 Ñ Ñ TMIE 13 0 0 Ñ Ñ TIE 12 0 0 Ñ Ñ RIE 11 0 0 Ñ Ñ ILIE 10 0 0 Ñ Ñ TE 9 0 0 Ñ Ñ RE 8 0 0 Ñ Ñ WOMS 7 0 0 Ñ Ñ RWU 6 0 0 Ñ Ñ WAKE 5 0 0 Ñ Ñ SBK 4 0 0 Ñ Ñ SSFTD 3 0 0 Ñ Ñ WDS[2:0] 2Ð0 0 0 Ñ Ñ R8 7 0 0 0 0 FE 6 0 0 0 0 PE 5 0 0 0 0 OR 4 0 0 0 0 IDLE 3 0 0 0 0 RDRF 2 0 0 0 0 TDRE 1 1 1 1 1 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-23 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface Operating Modes Table 8-3 SCI Registers after Reset (Continued) Reset Type Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Register Bit Bit Mnemonic Bit Number TRNE HW Reset SW Reset IR Reset ST Reset 0 1 1 1 1 TCM 15 0 0 Ñ Ñ RCM 14 0 0 Ñ Ñ SCP 13 0 0 Ñ Ñ COD 12 0 0 Ñ Ñ CD[11:0] 11Ð0 0 0 Ñ Ñ SRX SRX [23:0] 23Ð16, 15Ð8, 7Ð0 Ñ Ñ Ñ Ñ STX STX[23:0] 23Ð0 Ñ Ñ Ñ Ñ SRSH SRS[8:0] 8Ð0 Ñ Ñ Ñ Ñ STSH STS[8:0] 8Ð0 Ñ Ñ Ñ Ð SCCR SRSH HW SW IR ST 1 0 Ñ 8.4.2 SCI receive shift register, STSH Ñ SCI transmit shift register Hardware reset is caused by asserting the external RESET signal. Software reset is caused by executing the RESET instruction. Individual reset is caused by clearing PCRE (bits 0Ð2) (configured for GPIO). Stop reset is caused by executing the STOP instruction. The bit is set during this reset. The bit is cleared during this reset. The bit is not changed during this reset. SCI Initialization The correct way to initialize the SCI is as follows: 1. Use a hardware RESET signal or software RESET instruction. 2. Program SCI control registers. 3. Configure at least one SCI signal as not GPIO. Not Recommended for New Design 8-24 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface Operating Modes If interrupts are to be used, the signals must be selected, and interrupts must be enabled and unmasked before the SCI can operate. The order does not matter; any one of these three requirements for interrupts can be used to enable the SCI. Synchronous applications usually require exact frequencies. Consequently, the crystal frequency must be chosen carefully. An alternative to selecting the system clock to accommodate the SCI requirements is to provide an external clock to the SCI. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 8.4.3 SCI Initialization Example One way to initialize the SCI is described here as an example. 1. Ensure that the SCI is in its individual reset state (PCR = $0). 2. Configure the control registers (SCR, SCCR) according to the operating mode, but do not enable transmitter (TE = 0) or receiver (RE = 0). It is now possible to set the interrupts enable bits that used during the operation. No interrupt occurs yet. 3. Enable the SCI by setting the PCR bits according to which signals are used during operation. 4. If transmit interrupt is not used, write data to the transmitter. If transmitter interrupt enable is set, an interrupt is issued and the interrupt handler should write data into the transmitter. SCI transmit request is serviced by DMA channel if it is programmed to service the SCI transmitter. 5. Enable transmitters (TE = 1) and receiver (RE = 1), according to use. Operation starts as follows: ¥ For an internally generated clock, the SCLK signal starts operation immediately after the SCI is enabled (Step 3 above) for asynchronous modes. In synchronous mode, the SCLK signal is active only while transmitting (i.e., a gated clock). ¥ Data is received only when the receiver is enabled (RE = 1) and after the occurrence of the SCI receive sequence on the RXD signal, as defined by the operating mode (i.e., idle line sequence). ¥ Data is transmitted only after the transmitter is enabled (TE = 1), and after the initialization sequence has been transmitted (depending on the operating mode). Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-25 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface Operating Modes 8.4.4 Preamble, Break, and Data Transmission Priority Two or three transmission commands can be set simultaneously: ¥ A preamble (TE is set.) ¥ A break (SBK is set or is cleared.) ¥ An indication that there is data for transmission (TDRE is cleared.) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... After the current character transmission, if two or more of these commands are set, the transmitter executes them in the following order: 1. Preamble 2. Break 3. Data 8.4.5 SCI Exceptions The SCI can cause five different exceptions in the DSP. These exceptions are as follows (ordered from the highest to the lowest priority): 1. SCI receive data with exception status is caused by receive data register full with a receiver error (parity, framing, or overrun error). To clear the pending interrupt, read the SCI status register; then read SRX. A long interrupt service routine should be used to handle the error condition. This interrupt is enabled by SCR bit 16 (REIE). 2. SCI receive data is caused by receive data register full. Read SRX to clear the pending interrupt. This error-free interrupt can use a fast interrupt service routine for minimum overhead. This interrupt is enabled by SCR bit 11 (RIE). 3. SCI transmit data is caused by transmit data register empty. Write STX to clear the pending interrupt. This error-free interrupt can use a fast interrupt service routine for minimum overhead. This interrupt is enabled by SCR bit 12 (TIE). 4. SCI idle line is caused by the receive line entering the idle state (10 or 11 bits of 1s). This interrupt is latched and then automatically reset when the interrupt is accepted. This interrupt is enabled by SCR bit 10 (ILIE). 5. SCI timer is caused by the baud rate counter reaching zero. This interrupt is automatically reset when the interrupt is accepted. This interrupt is enabled by SCR bit 13 (TMIE). Not Recommended for New Design 8-26 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface GPIO Signals and Registers 8.5 GPIO SIGNALS AND REGISTERS The GPIO functionality of port SCI is controlled by three registers: Port E control register (PCRE), Port E direction register (PRRE) and Port E data register (PDRE). Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 8.5.1 Port E Control Register (PCRE) The read/write 24-bit PCRE controls the functionality of SCI GPIO signals. Each of PC[2:0] bits controls the functionality of the corresponding port signal. When a PC[i] bit is set, the corresponding port signal is configured as an SCI signal. When a PC[i] bit is cleared, the corresponding port signal is configured as a GPIO signal. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PC2 PC1 PC0 Port Control Bits: 1 = SCI 0 = GPIO 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility AA0695 Figure 8-8 Port E Control Register (PCRE) Note: 8.5.2 A hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears all PCR bits. Port E Direction Register (PRRE) The read/write 24-bit PRRE controls the direction of SCI GPIO signals. When port signal[i] is configured as GPIO, PDC[i] controls the port signal direction. When PDC[i] is set, the GPIO port signal[i] is configured as output. When PDC[i] is cleared, the GPIO port signal[i] is configured as input. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-27 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface GPIO Signals and Registers 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PDC2 PDC1 PDC0 Direction Control Bits: 1 = Output 0 = Input 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility AA0696 Figure 8-9 Port E Direction Register (PRRE) Note: A hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears all PRR bits. The following table shows the port signal configurations. Table 8-4 Port Control Register and Port Direction Register Bits 8.5.3 PC[i] PDC[i] Port Signal[i] Function 1 1 or 0 0 0 GPIO input 0 1 GPIO output SCI Port E Data Register (PDRE) The read/write 24-bit PDRE is reads or writes data to or from SCI GPIO signals. Bits PD[2:0] read or write data to or from the corresponding port signals if they are configured as GPIO. If a port signal [i] is configured as a GPIO input, then the corresponding PD[i] bit reflects the value of this signal. If a port signal [i] is configured as a GPIO output, then the value of the corresponding PD[i] bit is reflected on this signal. Not Recommended for New Design 8-28 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface GPIO Signals and Registers 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PD2 PD1 PD0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility AA0697 Figure 8-10 Port E Data Register (PDRE) Note: A hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction clears all PDRE bits. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 8-29 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Serial Communication Interface Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... GPIO Signals and Registers Not Recommended for New Design 8-30 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... TRIPLE TIMER MODULE Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-3 TRIPLE TIMER MODULE ARCHITECTURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-3 TRIPLE TIMER MODULE PROGRAMMING MODEL. . . . . . . . .9-5 TIMER MODES OF OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-16 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 Not Recommended for New Design 9-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Introduction 9.1 INTRODUCTION The timers in the DSP56307 internal triple timer module act as timed pulse generators or as pulse-width modulators. Each timer has a single signal that can function as a GPIO signal or as a timer signal. Each timer can also function as an event counter, to capture an event or to measure the width or period of a signal. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 9.2 TRIPLE TIMER MODULE ARCHITECTURE The timer module contains a common 21-bit prescaler and three independent and identical general-purpose 24-bit timer/event counters, each with its own register set. Each timer can use internal or external clocking and can interrupt the DSP56307 after a specified number of events (clocks) or signal an external device after counting internal events. Each timer can also trigger DMA transfers after a specified number of events (clocks) occurs. Each timer connects to the external world through one bidirectional signal, designated TIO0ÐTIO2 for timers 0Ð2. When the TIO signal is configured as input, the timer functions as an external event counter or measures external pulse width/signal period. When the TIO signal is used as output, the timer functions as a timer, a watchdog timer, or a pulse-width modulator. When the TIO signal is not used by the timer, it can be used as a GPIO signal (also called TIO0ÐTIO2). 9.2.1 Triple Timer Module Block Diagram Figure 9-1 shows a block diagram of the triple timer module. Note the 24-bit timer prescaler load register (TPLR) and the 24-bit timer prescaler count register (TPCR). Each of the three timers can use the prescaler clock as its clock source. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Architecture GDB 24 24 24 TPLR TPCR Timer Prescaler Load Register Timer Prescaler Count Register 24 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Timer 0 Timer 1 21-bit Counter Timer 2 CLK/2 TIO0 TIO1 TIO2 AA0673 Figure 9-1 Triple Timer Module Block Diagram 9.2.2 Timer Block Diagram The timer block diagram in Figure 9-2 shows the structure of a timer module.The timer programmerÕs model in Figure 9-3 shows the structure of the timer registers. The three timers are identical in structure and function. A generic timer is discussed in this section. The timer includes a 24-bit counter, a 24-bit read/write timer control and status register (TCSR), a 24-bit read-only timer count register (TCR), a 24-bit write-only timer load register (TLR), a 24-bit read/write timer compare register (TCPR), and logic for clock selection and interrupt/DMA trigger generation. The timer mode is controlled by the TC[3:0] bits of the timer control/status register (TCSR). For a listing of the timer modes, see Section 9.4. For a description of their operation, see Section 9.4.1. Not Recommended for New Design 9-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Programming Model The DSP56307 treats each timer as a memory-mapped peripheral with four registers occupying four 24-bit words in the X data memory space. Either standard polled or interrupt programming techniques can be used to service the timers. The timer programming model is shown in on page 9-6. GDB 24 24 24 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... TCSR 24 Load Register 9 TCPR TCR TLR Control/Status Register 24 Count Register Compare Register 24 24 24 2 24 Timer Control Logic Counter = Timer interrupt/ DMA request TIO CLK/2 prescaler CLK AA0676 Figure 9-2 Timer Module Block Diagram 9.3 TRIPLE TIMER MODULE PROGRAMMING MODEL The programming model for the triple timer module is shown in Figure 9-3. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Programming Model 23 0 Timer Prescaler Load Register (TPLR) TPLR = $FFFF83 23 0 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Timer Prescaler Count Register (TPCR) TPLR = $FFFF82 7 6 5 4 TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 15 14 PCE 23 22 3 2 1 TCIE TOIE 13 12 11 DO DI DIR 21 20 19 10 9 0 TE 8 TRM INV 18 17 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR) TCSR0 = $FFFF8F TCSR1 = $FFFF8B TCSR2 = $FFFF87 16 TCF TOF 23 0 Timer Load Register (TLR) TLR0 = $FFFF8E TLR1 = $FFFF8A TLR2 = $FFFF86 23 0 Timer Compare Register (TCPR) TCPR0 = $FFFF8D TCPR1 = $FFFF89 TCPR2 = $FFFF85 23 0 Timer Count Register (TCR) TCR0 = $FFFF8C TCR1 = $FFFF88 TCR2 = $FFFF84 - Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility Figure 9-3 Timer Module ProgrammerÕs Model Not Recommended for New Design 9-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Programming Model 9.3.1 Prescaler Counter The prescaler counter is a 21-bit counter that decrements on the rising edge of the prescaler input clock. The counter is enabled when at least one of the three timers is enabled (i.e., one or more of the timer enable bits are set) and is using the prescaler output as its source (i.e., one or more of the PCE bits are set). Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 9.3.2 Timer Prescaler Load Register (TPLR) The timer prescaler load register (TPLR) is a 24-bit read/write register that controls the prescaler divide factor (i. e., the number that the prescaler counter will load and begin counting from) and the source for the prescaler input clock. The control bits are documented in the following paragraphs and in Figure 9-4. 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 PS1 PS0 PL20 PL19 PL18 PL17 PL16 PL15 PL14 PL13 PL12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PL11 PL10 PL9 PL8 PL7 PL6 PL5 PL4 PL3 PL2 PL1 PL0 — Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility Figure 9-4 Timer Prescaler Load Register (TPLR) 9.3.2.1 TPLR Prescaler Preload Value (PL[20:0]) Bits 20–0 These 21 bits contain the prescaler preload value, which is loaded into the prescaler counter when the counter value reaches 0 or the counter switches state from disabled to enabled. If PL[20:0] = N, then the prescaler counts N+1 source clock cycles before generating a prescaler clock pulse. Therefore, the prescaler divide factor = (preload value) + 1. The PL[20:0] bits are cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 9.3.2.2 TPLR Prescaler Source (PS[1:0]) Bits 22–21 The two PS bits control the source of the prescaler clock. Table 9-1 summarizes PS bit functionality. The prescalerÕs use of a TIO signal is not affected by the TCSR settings of the timer of the corresponding TIO signal. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Programming Model If the prescaler source clock is external, the prescaler counter is incremented by signal transitions on the TIO signal. The external clock is internally synchronized to the internal clock. The external clock frequency must be lower than the DSP56307 internal operating frequency divided by 4 (i.e., CLK/4). The PS[1:0] bits are cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Note: To insure proper operation, change the PS[1:0] bits only when the prescaler counter is disabled. Disable the prescaler counter by clearing the TE bit in the TCSR of each of three timers. Table 9-1 Prescaler Source Selection PS1 PS0 Prescaler Clock Source 0 0 Internal CLK/2 0 1 TIO0 1 0 TIO1 1 1 TIO2 9.3.2.3 TPLR Reserved Bit 23 This reserved bit is read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. 9.3.3 Timer Prescaler Count Register (TPCR) The TPCR is a 24-bit read-only register that reflects the current value in the prescaler counter. The register bits are documented in the following paragraphs and in Figure 9-5. 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 PC20 PC19 PC18 PC17 PC16 PC15 PC14 PC13 PC12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PC11 PC10 PC9 PC8 PC7 PC6 PC5 PC4 PC3 PC2 PC1 PC0 — Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility Figure 9-5 Timer Prescaler Count Register (TPCR) Not Recommended for New Design 9-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Programming Model 9.3.3.1 TPCR Prescaler Counter Value (PC[20:0]) Bits 20–0 These 21 bits contain the current value of the prescaler counter. 9.3.3.2 TPCR Reserved Bits 23–21 These reserved bits are read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 9.3.4 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR) The TCSR is a 24-bit read/write register controlling the timer and reflecting its status. The control and status bits are documented in the following paragraphs and in Table 9-2. 9.3.4.1 Timer Enable (TE) Bit 0 The TE bit enables or disables the timer. When set, TE enables the timer and clears the timer counter. The counter starts counting according to the mode selected by the timer control (TC[3:0]) bit values. When clear, TE bit disables the timer. The TE bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. Note: When all the three timers are disabled and the signals are not in GPIO mode, all three TIO signals are tri-stated. To prevent undesired spikes on the TIO signals when you switch from tri-state into active state, these signals should be tied to the high or low signal state by pull-up or pull-down resistors. 9.3.4.2 Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable (TOIE) Bit 1 The TOIE bit enables timer overflow interrupts. When set, TOIE enables overflow interrupt generation. The timer counter can hold a maximum value of $FFFFFF. When the counter value is at the maximum value and a new event causes the counter to be incremented to $000000, the timer generates an overflow interrupt. When cleared, TOIE bit disables overflow interrupt generation. The TOIE bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 9.3.4.3 Timer Compare Interrupt Enable (TCIE) Bit 2 The TCIE bit enables or disables the timer compare interrupts. When set, TCIE enables the compare interrupts. In the timer, pulse width modulation (PWM), or watchdog modes, a compare interrupt is generated after the counter value matches the value of the TCPR. The counter starts counting up from the number loaded from the TLR and if the TCPR value is N, an interrupt occurs after (N Ð M + 1) events, where M is the value of TLR. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Programming Model When cleared, TCIE bit disables the compare interrupts. The TCIE bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 9.3.4.4 Timer Control (TC[3:0]) Bits 4–7 The four TC bits control the source of the timer clock, the behavior of the TIO signal, and the Timer mode of operation. Table 9-2 summarizes the TC bit functionality. A detailed description of the timer operating modes appears in Section 9.4 on page 9-16. The TC bits are cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. If the clock is external, the counter is incremented by the transitions on the TIO signal. The external clock is internally synchronized to the internal clock, and its frequency should be lower than the internal operating frequency divided by 4 (i.e., CLK/4). Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Note: To insure proper operation, the TC[3:0] bits should be changed only when the timer is disabled (i.e., when the TE bit in the TCSR has been cleared). Table 9-2 Timer Control Bits Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 Mode Number Mode Function TIO Clock 0 0 0 0 0 Timer and GPIO GPIO 1 Internal 0 0 0 1 1 Timer pulse Output Internal 0 0 1 0 2 Timer toggle Output Internal 0 0 1 1 3 Event counter Input External 0 1 0 0 4 Input width measurement Input Internal 0 1 0 1 5 Input period measurement Input Internal 0 1 1 0 6 Capture event Input Internal 0 1 1 1 7 Pulse width modulation Output Internal 1 0 0 0 8 Reserved Ñ Ñ 1 0 0 1 9 Watchdog pulse Output Internal Not Recommended for New Design 9-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Programming Model Table 9-2 Timer Control Bits (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 Mode Number Mode Function TIO Clock 1 0 1 0 10 Watchdog Toggle Output Internal 1 0 1 1 11 Reserved Ñ Ñ 1 1 0 0 12 Reserved Ñ Ñ 1 1 0 1 13 Reserved Ñ Ñ 1 1 1 0 14 Reserved Ñ Ñ 1 1 1 1 15 Reserved Ñ Ñ Note: The GPIO function is enabled only if all of the TC[3:0] bits are 0. 9.3.4.5 Inverter (INV) Bit 8 The INV bit affects the polarity definition of the incoming signal on the TIO signal when TIO is programmed as input. It also affects the polarity of the output pulse generated on the TIO signal when TIO is programmed as output. Table 9-3 Inverter (INV) Bit Operation TIO Programmed as Input TIO Programmed as Output Mode INV = 0 INV = 1 0 GPIO signal on the TIO signal read directly. GPIO signal on the TIO signal inverted. 1 Counter is incremented on the rising edge of the signal from the TIO signal. Counter is incremented on the falling edge of the signal from the TIO signal. Counter is incremented on the rising edge of the signal from the TIO signal. Counter is incremented on the falling edge of the signal from the TIO signal. 2 INV = 0 INV = 1 Bit written to GPIO put on TIO signal directly. Bit written to GPIO inverted and put on TIO signal. Ñ Ñ TCRx output put on TIO signal directly. TCRx output inverted and put on TIO signal. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Programming Model Table 9-3 Inverter (INV) Bit Operation (Continued) TIO Programmed as Input TIO Programmed as Output Mode Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 3 4 5 6 INV = 0 INV = 1 INV = 0 INV = 1 Counter is incremented on the rising edge of the signal from the TIO signal. Counter is incremented on the falling edge of the signal from the TIO signal. Ñ Ñ Width of the high input pulse is measured. Width of the low input pulse is measured. Ñ Ñ Period is measured between the rising edges of the input signal. Period is measured between the falling edges of the input signal. Ñ Ñ Event is captured on the rising edge of the signal from the TIO signal. Event is captured on the falling edge of the signal from the TIO signal. Ñ Ñ Ñ Ñ Pulse generated by the timer has positive polarity. Pulse generated by the timer has negative polarity. Ñ Ñ Pulse generated by the timer has positive polarity. Pulse generated by the timer has negative polarity. Ñ Pulse generated by the timer has positive polarity. Pulse generated by the timer has negative polarity. 7 9 10 Ñ The INV bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. Note: The INV bit affects both the timer and GPIO modes of operation. To ensure correct operation, change this bit only when one or both of the following conditions is true: the timer is disabled (the TE bit in the TCSR is cleared). The timer is in GPIO mode. Not Recommended for New Design 9-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Programming Model The INV bit does not affect the polarity of the prescaler source when the TIO is input to the prescaler. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 9.3.4.6 Timer Reload Mode (TRM) Bit 9 The TRM bit controls the counter preload operation. In timer (0Ð3) and watchdog (9Ð10) modes, the counter is preloaded with the TLR value after the TE bit is set and the first internal or external clock signal is received. If the TRM bit is set, the counter is reloaded each time after it reaches the value contained by the TCR. In PWM mode (7), the counter is reloaded each time counter overflow occurs. In measurement (4Ð5) modes, if the TRM and the TE bits are set, the counter is preloaded with the TLR value on each appropriate edge of the input signal. If the TRM bit is cleared, the counter operates as a free running counter and is incremented on each incoming event. The TRM bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 9.3.4.7 Direction (DIR) Bit 11 The DIR bit determines the behavior of the TIO signal when it functions as a GPIO signal. When the DIR bit is set, the TIO signal is an output; when the DIR bit is cleared, the TIO signal is an input. The TIO signal functions as a GPIO signal only when the TC[3:0] bits are cleared. If any of the TC[3:0] bits are set, then the GPIO function is disabled, and the DIR bit has no effect. The DIR bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 9.3.4.8 Data Input (DI) Bit 12 The DI bit reflects the value of the TIO signal. If the INV bit is set, the value of the TIO signal is inverted before it is written to the DI bit. If the INV bit is cleared, the value of the TIO signal is written directly to the DI bit. DI is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 9.3.4.9 Data Output (DO) Bit 13 The DO bit is the source of the TIO value when it is a data output signal. The TIO signal is data output when the GPIO mode is enabled and DIR is set. A value written to the DO bit is written to the TIO signal. If the INV bit is set, the value of the DO bit is inverted when written to the TIO signal. When the INV bit is cleared, the value of the DO bit is written directly to the TIO signal. When GPIO mode is disabled, writing the DO bit has no effect. The DO bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Programming Model Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 9.3.4.10 Prescaler Clock Enable (PCE) Bit 15 The PCE bit selects the prescaler clock as the timer source clock. When the PCE bit is cleared, the timer uses either an internal (CLK/2) signal or an external (TIO) signal as its source clock. When the PCE bit is set, the prescaler output is the timer source clock for the counter, regardless of the timer operating mode. To insure proper operation, the PCE bit is changed only when the timer is disabled (i.e., when the TE bit is cleared). The PS[1:0] bits of the TPLR determine which source clock is used for the prescaler. A timer can be clocked by a prescaler clock that is derived from the TIO of another timer. 9.3.4.11 Timer Overflow Flag (TOF) Bit 20 The TOF bit is set to indicate that a counter overflow has occurred. This bit is cleared by a 1 written to the TOF bit. A 0 written to the TOF bit itself has no effect. The bit is also cleared when the timer overflow interrupt is serviced. The TOF bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, the STOP instruction, or by clearing the TE bit to disable the timer. 9.3.4.12 Timer Compare Flag (TCF) Bit 21 The TCF bit is set to indicate that the event count is complete. In timer, PWM, and watchdog modes, the TCF bit is set after (N Ð M + 1) events are counted. (N is the value in the compare register and M is the TLR value.) In measurement modes, the TCF bit is set when the measurement has been completed. Writing a 1 to the TCF bit clears it. A 0 written to the TCF bit has no effect. The bit is also cleared when the timer compare interrupt is serviced. The TCF bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, the STOP instruction, or by clearing the TE bit to disable the timer. Note: The TOF and TCF bits are cleared by a 1 written to the specific bit. To insure that only the target bit is cleared, do not use the BSET command. The proper way to clear these bits is to write 1, using a MOVEP instruction, to the flag to be cleared and 0 to the other flag. 9.3.4.13 TCSR Reserved Bits 3, 10, 14, 16–19, 22, 23 These reserved bits are read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. 9.3.5 Timer Load Register (TLR) The TLR is a 24-bit write-only register. In all modes, the counter is preloaded with the TLR value after the TE bit in the TCSR is set and a first event occurs. Not Recommended for New Design 9-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Triple Timer Module Programming Model ¥ In timer modes, if the TRM bit in the TCSR is set, the counter is reloaded each time after reaches the value contained by the timer compare register and the new event occurs. ¥ In measurement modes, if the TRM bit in the TCSR is set and the TE bit in the TCSR is set, the counter is reloaded with the value in the TLR on each appropriate edge of the input signal. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ In PWM modes, if the TRM bit in the TCSR is set, the counter is reloaded each time after it overflows and the new event occurs. ¥ In watchdog modes, if the TRM bit in the TCSR is set, the counter is reloaded each time after it reaches the value contained by the timer compare register and the new event occurs. In this mode, the counter is also reloaded whenever the TLR is written with a new value while the TE bit in the TCSR is set. ¥ In all modes, if the TRM bit in the TCSR is cleared (TRM = 0), the counter operates as a free-running counter. 9.3.6 Timer Compare Register (TCPR) The TCPR is a 24-bit read/write register that contains the value to be compared to the counter value. These two values are compared every timer clock after the TE bit in the TCSR is set. When the values match, the timer compare flag bit is set and an interrupt is generated if interrupts are enabled (i.e., if the timer compare interrupt enable bit in the TCSR is set). The TCPR is ignored in measurement modes. 9.3.7 Timer Count Register (TCR) The TCR is a 24-bit read-only register. In timer and watchdog modes, the contents of the counter can be read at any time from the TCR register. In measurement modes, the TCR is loaded with the current value of the counter on the appropriate edge of the input signal, and its value can be read to determine the width, period, or delay of the leading edge of the input signal. When the timer is in measurement mode, the TIO signal is used for the input signal. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Timer Modes of Operation 9.4 TIMER MODES OF OPERATION Each timer has operational modes that meet a variety of system requirements, as follows: Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Timer Ð GPIO, mode 0: Internal timer interrupt generated by the internal clock Ð Pulse, mode 1: External timer pulse generated by the internal clock Ð Toggle, mode 2: Output timing signal toggled by the internal clock Ð Event counter, mode 3: Internal timer interrupt generated by an external clock ¥ Measurement Ð Input width, mode 4: Input pulse width measurement Ð Input pulse, mode 5: Input signal period measurement Ð Capture, mode 6: Capture external signal ¥ PWM, mode 7: Pulse width modulation ¥ Watchdog Ð Pulse, mode 9: Output pulse, internal clock Ð Toggle, mode 10: Output toggle, internal clock To select timer modes, select the TC[3:0] bits in the TCSR. Table 9-2 on page 9-10 shows you how to select different timer modes by setting the bits in the TCSR. The table also shows the TIO signal direction and the clock source for each timer mode. The following paragraphs document these modes in detail. Note: 9.4.1 To insure proper operation, the TC[3:0] bits are changed only when the timer is disabled (i.e., when the TE bit in the TCSR is cleared). Timer Modes The following timer modes are provided: ¥ Timer GPIO ¥ Timer pulse ¥ Timer toggle ¥ Event counter Not Recommended for New Design 9-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Timer Modes of Operation 9.4.1.1 Timer GPIO (Mode 0) Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 TIO Clock # Function Name 0 0 0 0 GPIO Internal 0 Timer GPIO Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... In this mode, the timer generates an internal interrupt when a counter value is reached (if the timer compare interrupt is enabled). Set the TE bit to clear the counter and enable the timer. Load the value the timer is to count into the TCPR. The counter is loaded with the TLR value when the first timer clock signal is received. The timer clock can be taken from either the DSP56307 clock divided by two (CLK/2) or from the prescaler clock output. Each subsequent clock signal increments the counter. When the counter equals the TCPR value, the TCF bit in TCSR is set, and a compare interrupt is generated if the TCIE bit is set. If the TRM bit in the TCSR is set, the counter is reloaded with the TLR value at the next timer clock and the count is resumed. If the TRM bit is cleared, the counter continues to be incremented on each timer clock signal.This process repeats until the timer is disabled (i.e., TE is cleared). If the counter overflows, the TOF bit is set, and if TOIE is set, an overflow interrupt is generated. You can read the counter contents at any time from the TCR. 9.4.1.2 Timer Pulse (Mode 1) Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 TIO Clock # Function Name 0 0 0 1 Output Internal 1 Timer Pulse In this mode, the timer generates an external pulse on its TIO signal when the timer count reaches a pre-set value. Set the TE bit to clear the counter and enable the timer. The value to which the timer is to count is loaded into the TCPR. The counter is loaded with the TLR value when the first timer clock signal is received. The TIO signal is loaded with the value of the INV bit. The timer clock signal can be taken from either the DSP56307 clock divided by two (CLK/2) or from the prescaler clock output. Each subsequent clock signal increments the counter. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Timer Modes of Operation When the counter matches the TCPR value, the TCF bit in TCSR is set and a compare interrupt is generated if the TCIE bit is set. The polarity of the TIO signal is inverted for one timer clock period. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... If the TRM bit is set, the counter is loaded with the TLR value on the next timer clock and the count is resumed. If the TRM bit is cleared, the counter continues to be incremented on each timer clock. This process repeats until the TE bit is cleared (disabling the timer). You can read the counter contents at any time from the TCR. The value of the TLR sets the delay between starting the timer and generating the output pulse. To generate successive output pulses with a delay of X clocks between signals, set the TLR value to X/2 and set the TRM bit. This process repeats until the timer is disabled (i.e., TE is cleared). If the counter overflows, the TOF bit is set, and if TOIE is set, an overflow interrupt is generated. You can read the counter contents at any time from the TCR. 9.4.1.3 Timer Toggle (Mode 2) Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 TIO Clock # Function Name 0 0 1 0 Output Internal 0 Timer Toggle In this mode, the timer periodically toggles the polarity of the TIO signal. Set the TE bit in the TCR to clear the counter and enable the timer. The value the timer is to count is loaded into the TPCR.The counter is loaded with the TLR value when the first timer clock signal is received. The TIO signal is loaded with the value of the INV bit. The timer clock signal can be taken from either the DSP56307 clock divided by two (i.e., CLK/2) or from the prescaler clock output. Each subsequent clock signal increments the counter. When the counter value matches the value in the TCPR, the polarity of the TIO output signal is inverted.The TCF bit in the TCSR is set, and a compare interrupt is generated if the TCIE bit is set. If the TRM bit is set, the counter is loaded with the value of the TLR when the next timer clock is received, and the count resumes. If the TRM bit is cleared, the counter continues to increment on each timer clock. Not Recommended for New Design 9-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Timer Modes of Operation This process is repeats until the TE bit is cleared, disabling the timer. You can read the counter contents at any time from the TCR. The TLR value in the TCPR sets the delay between starting the timer and toggling the TIO signal. To generate output signals with a delay of X clock cycles between toggles, set the TLR value to X/2, and set the TRM bit. This process repeats until the timer is disabled (i.e., TE is cleared). If the counter overflows, the TOF bit is set, and if TOIE is set, an overflow interrupt is generated. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... You can read the counter contents at any time from the TCR. 9.4.1.4 Timer Event Counter (Mode 3) Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 TIO Clock # Function Name 0 0 1 1 Input External 3 Timer Event Counter In this mode, the timer counts external events and issues an interrupt (if interrupt enable bits are set) when a preset number of events is counted. Set the TE bit to clear the counter and enable the timer. The value to which the timer is to count is loaded into the TPCR. The counter is loaded with the TLR value when the first timer clock signal is received. The timer clock signal can be taken from either the TIO input signal or the prescaler clock output. Each subsequent clock signal increments the counter. If an external clock is used, it must be internally synchronized to the internal clock, and its frequency must be less than the DSP56307 internal operating frequency divided by 4. The value of the INV bit in the TCSR determines whether low-to-high (0 to 1) transitions or high-to-low (1 to 0) transitions increment the counter. If the INV bit is set, high-to-low transitions increment the counter. If the INV bit is cleared, low-to-high transitions increment the counter. When the counter matches the value contained in the TCPR, the TCF bit in the TCSR is set and a compare interrupt is generated if the TCIE bit is set. If the TRM bit is set, the counter is loaded with the value of the TLR when the next timer clock is received, and the count is resumed. If the TRM bit is cleared, the counter continues to increment on each timer clock. This process repeats until the timer is disabled (i.e., TE is cleared). If the counter overflows, the TOF bit is set, and if TOIE is set, an overflow interrupt is generated. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-19 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Timer Modes of Operation You can read the counter contents at any time from the TCR. 9.4.2 Signal Measurement Modes The following signal measurement modes are provided: ¥ Measurement input width Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ¥ Measurement input period ¥ Measurement capture 9.4.2.1 Measurement Accuracy The external signal is synchronized with the internal clock that increments the counter. This synchronization process can cause the number of clocks measured for the selected signal value to vary from the actual signal value by plus or minus one counter clock cycle. 9.4.2.2 Measurement Input Width (Mode 4) Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 Mode Name Function TIO Clock 0 1 0 0 4 Input width Measurement Input Internal In this mode, the timer counts the number of clocks that occur between opposite edges of an input signal. Set the TE bit to clear the counter and enable the timer. Load the count value of the timer into the TLR. After the first appropriate transition (as determined by the INV bit) occurs on the TIO input signal, the counter is loaded with the TLR value on the first timer clock signal received either from the DSP56307 clock divided by two (i.e., CLK/2) or from the prescaler clock input. Each subsequent clock signal increments the counter. If the INV bit is set, the timer starts on the first high-to-low (1 to 0) signal transition on the TIO signal. If the INV bit is cleared, the timer starts on the first low-to-high (i.e., 0 to 1) transition on the TIO signal. When the first transition opposite in polarity to the INV bit setting occurs on the TIO signal, the counter stops. The TCF bit in the TCSR is set and a compare interrupt is generated if the TCIE bit is set. The value of the counter (which measures the width of Not Recommended for New Design 9-20 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Timer Modes of Operation the TIO pulse) is loaded into the TCR. The TCR can be read to determine the external signal pulse width. If the TRM bit is set, the counter is loaded with the TLR value on the first timer clock received following the next valid transition occurring on the TIO input signal, and the count is resumed. If the TRM bit is cleared, the counter continues to be incremented on each timer clock. This process repeats until the timer is disabled (i.e., TE is cleared). Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... If the counter overflows, the TOF bit is set, and if TOIE is set, an overflow interrupt is generated. You can read the counter contents at any time from the TCR. 9.4.2.3 Measurement Input Period (Mode 5) Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 Mode Name Function TIO Clock 0 1 0 1 5 Input period Measurement Input Internal In this mode, the timer counts the period between the reception of signal edges of the same polarity across the TIO signal. Set the TE bit to clear the counter and enable the timer. The value to which the timer is to count is loaded into the TLR. The value of the INV bit determines whether the period is measured between consecutive low-to-high (0 to 1) transitions of TIO or between consecutive high-to-low (1 to 0) transitions of TIO. If INV is set, high-to-low signal transitions are selected. If INV is cleared, low-to-high signal transitions are selected.After the first appropriate transition occurs on the TIO input signal, the counter is loaded with the TLR value on the first timer clock signal received from either the DSP56307 clock divided by two (i.e., CLK/2) or the prescaler clock output. Each subsequent clock signal increments the counter. On the next signal transition of the same polarity that occurs on TIO, the TCF bit in the TCSR is set, and a compare interrupt is generated if the TCIE bit is set. The contents of the counter are loaded into the TCR. The TCR then contains the value of the time that elapsed between the two signal transitions on the TIO signal. After the second signal transition, if the TRM bit is set, the TE bit is set to clear the counter and enable the timer. The counter is loaded with the TLR value on the first timer clock signal. Each subsequent clock signal increments the counter. This process repeats until the timer is disabled (i.e., TE is cleared). Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-21 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Timer Modes of Operation If the counter overflows, the TOF bit is set, and if TOIE is set, an overflow interrupt is generated. You can read the counter contents at any time from the TCR. 9.4.2.4 Measurement Capture (Mode 6) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 Mode Name Function TIO Clock 0 1 1 0 6 Capture Measurement Input Internal In this mode, the timer counts the number of clocks that elapse between starting the timer and receiving an external signal. Set the TE bit to clear the counter and enable the timer. The value to which the timer is to count is loaded into the TLR. When the first timer clock signal is received, the counter is loaded with the TLR value. The timer clock signal can be taken from either the DSP56307 clock divided by two (CLK/2) or from the prescaler clock output. Each subsequent clock signal increments the counter. At the first appropriate transition of the external clock detected on the TIO signal, the TCF bit in the TCSR is set and, if the TCIE bit is set, a compare interrupt is generated. The counter halts. The contents of the counter are loaded into the TCR. The value of the TCR represents the delay between the setting of the TE bit and the detection of the first clock edge signal on the TIO signal. The value of the INV bit determines whether a high-to-low (1 to 0) or low-to-high (0 to 1) transition of the external clock signals the end of the timing period. If the INV bit is set, a high-to-low transition signals the end of the timing period. If INV is cleared, a low-to-high transition signals the end of the timing period. If the counter overflows, the TOF bit is set, and if TOIE is set, an overflow interrupt is generated. You can read the counter contents at any time from the TCR. Not Recommended for New Design 9-22 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Timer Modes of Operation 9.4.3 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM, Mode 7) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 Mode Name Function TIO Clock 0 1 1 1 7 Pulse width modulation PWM Output Internal In this mode, the timer generates periodic pulses of a preset width. Set the TE bit to clear the counter and enable the timer. The value to which the timer is to count is loaded into the TPCR. When first timer clock is received from either the DSP56307 internal clock divided by two (CLK/2) or the prescaler clock output, the counter is loaded with the TLR value. Each subsequent timer clock increments the counter. When the counter equals the value in the TCPR, the TIO output signal is toggled and the TCF bit in the TCSR is set. The contents of the counter are placed into the TCR. If the TCIE bit is set, a compare interrupt is generated. The counter continues to increment on each timer clock. If counter overflow occurs, the TIO output signal is toggled, the TOF bit in TCSR is set, and an overflow interrupt is generated if the TOIE bit is set. If the TRM bit is set, the counter is loaded with the TLR value on the next timer clock and the count resumes. If the TRM bit is cleared, the counter continues to increment on each timer clock. This process repeats until the timer is disabled by the TE bit being cleared. TIO signal polarity is determined by the value of the INV bit. When the counter is started by the TE bit being set, the TIO signal assumes the value of the INV bit. On each subsequent toggle of the TIO signal, the polarity of the TIO signal is reversed. For example, if the INV bit is set, the TIO signal generates the following signal: 1010. If the INV bit is cleared, the TIO signal generates the following signal: 0101. You can read the counter contents at any time from the TCR. The value of the TLR determines the output period ($FFFFFF − TLR + 1). The timer counter increments the initial TLR value and toggles the TIO signal when the counter value exceeds $FFFFFF. The duty cycle of the TIO signal is determined by the value in the TCPR. When the value in the TLR increments to a value equal to the value in the TCPR, the TIO signal is Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-23 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Timer Modes of Operation toggled. The duty cycle is equal to ($FFFFFF Ð TCPR) divided by ($FFFFFF − TLR + 1). For a 50 percent duty cycle, the value of TCPR is equal to ($FFFFFF + TLR + 1)/2. Note: 9.4.4 The value in TCPR must be greater than the value in TLR. Watchdog Modes Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The following watchdog timer modes are provided: ¥ Watchdog pulse ¥ Watchdog toggle 9.4.4.1 Watchdog Pulse (Mode 9) Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 Mode Name Function TIO Clock 1 0 0 1 9 Pulse Watchdog Output Internal In this mode, the timer generates an external signal at a preset rate. The signal period is equal to the period of one timer clock. Set the TE bit to clear the counter and enable the timer. The value to which the timer is to count is loaded into the TCPR. The counter is loaded with the TLR value on the first timer clock received from either the DSP56307 internal clock divided by two (i.e., CLK/2) or the prescaler clock output. Each subsequent timer clock increments the counter. When the counter matches the value of the TCPR, the TCF bit in the TCSR is set, and a compare interrupt is generated if the TCIE bit is also set. If the TRM bit is set, the counter is loaded with the TLR value on the next timer clock and the count resumes. If the TRM bit is cleared, the counter continues to be incremented on each subsequent timer clock. This process repeats until the timer is disabled (i.e., TE is cleared). If the counter overflows, the TOF bit is set, and if TOIE is set, an overflow interrupt is generated. At the same time, a pulse is output on the TIO signal with a pulse width equal to the timer clock period. The pulse polarity is determined by the value of the INV bit. If the INV bit is set, the pulse polarity is high (logical 1). If the INV bit is cleared, the pulse polarity is low (logical 0). Not Recommended for New Design 9-24 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Timer Modes of Operation You can read the counter contents at any time from the TCR. The counter is reloaded whenever the TLR is written with a new value while the TE bit is set. Note: In this mode, internal logic preserves the TIO value and direction for an additional 2.5 internal clock cycles after the DSP56307 hardware RESET signal is asserted. This convention insures that a valid RESET signal is generated when the TIO signal is used to reset the DSP56307. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 9.4.4.2 Watchdog Toggle (Mode 10) Bit Settings Mode Characteristics TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 Mode Name Function TIO Clock 1 0 1 0 10 Toggle Watchdog Output Internal In this mode, the timer toggles an external signal after a preset period. Set the TE bit to clear the counter and enable the timer. The value to which the timer is to count is loaded into the TPCR. The counter is loaded with the TLR value on the first timer clock received from either the DSP56307 internal clock divided by two (CLK/2) or the prescaler clock output. Each subsequent timer clock increments the counter. The TIO signal is set to the value of the INV bit. When the counter equals the value in the TCPR, the TCF bit in the TCSR is set, and a compare interrupt is generated if the TCIE bit is also set. If the TRM bit is set, the counter is loaded with the TLR value on the next timer clock and the count resumes. If the TRM bit is cleared, the counter continues to increment on each subsequent timer clock. When a counter overflow occurs, the polarity of the TIO output signal is inverted, the TOF bit in the TCSR is set, and an overflow interrupt is generated if the TOIE bit is also set. The TIO polarity is determined by the INV bit. The counter is reloaded whenever the TLR is written with a new value while the TE bit is set. This process is repeated until the timer is disabled when the TE bit is cleared. The counter contents can be read at any time from the TCR. Note: In this mode, internal logic preserves the TIO value and direction for an additional 2.5 internal clock cycles after the DSP56307 hardware RESET signal is asserted. This convention insures that a valid reset signal is generated when the TIO signal resets the DSP56307. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 9-25 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Triple Timer Module Timer Modes of Operation 9.4.5 Reserved Modes Modes 8, 11, 12, 13, 14, and 15 are reserved. 9.4.6 Special Cases Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The following special cases apply during wait and stop state. 9.4.6.1 Timer Behavior during Wait Timer clocks are active during the execution of the WAIT instruction and timer activity is undisturbed. If a timer interrupt is generated, the DSP56307 leaves the wait state and services the interrupt. 9.4.6.2 Timer Behavior during Stop During the execution of the STOP instruction, the timer clocks are disabled, timer activity is stopped, and the TIO signals are disconnected. Any external changes that happen to the TIO signals are ignored when the DSP56307 is in stop state. To insure correct operation, disable the timers before the DSP56307 is placed in stop state. 9.4.7 DMA Trigger Each timer can also trigger DMA transfers if a DMA channel is programmed to be triggered by a timer event. The timer issues a DMA trigger on every event in all modes of operation. The DMA channel save multiple DMA triggers generated by the timer. To ensure that all DMA triggers are serviced, provide for the preceding DMA trigger to be serviced before the DMA channel receives the next trigger. Not Recommended for New Design 9-26 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 10 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ENHANCED FILTER COPROCESSOR z-1 x z-1 z-1 x x Σ Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 10-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor INTRODUCTION TO EFCOP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-3 KEY FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-3 GENERAL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-4 EFCOP PROGRAMMING MODEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 10.1 10.2 10.3 10.4 Not Recommended for New Design 10-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor Introduction to EFCOP 10.1 INTRODUCTION TO EFCOP The EFCOP is a peripheral module that functions as a general-purpose, fully programmable filter. It has optimized modes of operation to perform real and complex finite impulse response (FIR) filtering, infinite impulse response (IIR) filtering, adaptive FIR filtering, and multichannel FIR filtering. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The EFCOP allows filter operations to be completed concurrently with DSP56300 core operations with minimal CPU intervention. For optimal performance, the EFCOP has one dedicated Filter Multiplier Accumulator (FMAC) unit. Thus, for filtering, the combination Core/EFCOP offers dual MAC capabilities. Its dedicated modes make the EFCOP a very flexible filtering co-processor with operations optimized for cellular base station applications. The EFCOP architecture also allows adaptive FIR filtering in which the filter coefficient update is performed using any fixed-point standard or non-standard adaptive algorithmsÑfor example, the well-known Least Mean Square (LMS) algorithm, the Normalized LMS and customized update algorithms. In a transceiver base station, the EFCOP can perform complex matched filtering to maximize the signal-to-noise ratio (SNR) within an equalizer. In a transcoder base station or a mobile switching center, the EFCOP can perform all types of FIR and IIR filtering within a vocoder, as well as LMS-type echo cancellation. 10.2 KEY FEATURES ¥ Fully programmable real/complex filter machine with 24-bit resolution ¥ FIR filter options Ð Four modes of operation with optimized performance: ¥ Mode 0ÑFIR machine with real taps ¥ Mode 1ÑFIR machine with complex taps ¥ Mode 2ÑComplex FIR machine generating pure real/imaginary outputs alternately ¥ Mode 3ÑMagnitude (calculate the square of each input sample) Ð 4-bit decimation factor in FIR filters providing up to 1:16 decimation ratio Ð Easy to use adaptive mode supporting true or delayed LMS-type algorithms Ð K-constant input register for coefficient updates (in adaptive mode) ¥ IIR filter options: Ð Direct form 1 (DFI) and direct form 2 (DFII) configurations1 Ð Three optional output scaling factors (1, 8, or 16) 1.For details on DFI and DFII modes, refer to the Motorola application note entitled Implementing IIR/FIR Filters with MotorolaÕs DSP56000/DSP56001 (APR7/D). Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 10-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... General Description ¥ Multichannel mode to process multiple, equal-length filter channels (up to 64) simultaneously with minimal core intervention ¥ Optional input scaling for both FIR and IIR filters ¥ Two filter initialization modes Ð No initialization Ð Data initialization ¥ Sixteen-bit arithmetic mode support ¥ Three rounding options available: Ð No rounding Ð Convergent rounding Ð TwoÕs complement rounding ¥ Arithmetic saturation mode support for bit-exact applications ¥ Sticky saturation status bit indication ¥ Sticky data/coefficient transfer contention status bit ¥ 4-word deep input data buffer for maximum performance ¥ EFCOP-shared and core-shared 4K-word filter data memory bank and 4K-word filter coefficient memory bank ¥ Two memory bank base address pointers, one for data memory (shared with X memory) and one for coefficient memory (shared with Y memory) ¥ I/O data transfers via core or DMA with minimal core intervention ¥ Core-concurrent operation with minimal core intervention 10.3 GENERAL DESCRIPTION As shown in Figure 10-1, the EFCOP comprises these main functional blocks: ¥ Peripheral module bus (PMB) interface, including: Ð Data input buffer Ð Constant input buffer Ð Output buffer Ð Filter counter ¥ Filter data memory (FDM) bank ¥ Filter coefficient memory (FCM) bank ¥ Filter multiplier accumulator (FMAC) machine ¥ Address generator ¥ Control logic Not Recommended for New Design 10-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor General Description DMA BUS PMB Interface GDB BUS FDIR Control Logic FDM X Memory Shared RAM Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 4-Word Data Input Buffer DATA Memory Bank 24-bit FCNT Filter Count FCBA Coeff. Base Ad. FDBA Data Base Ad. Address Generator Y Memory Shared RAM FCM COEFFICIENT Memory Bank 24-bit FMAC 24x24 -> 56-bit Rounding & Limiting FKIR Filter Constant Output Buffer FDOR Figure 10-1 EFCOP Block Diagram 10.3.1 PMB Interface The PMB interface block provides control and status registers, buffering of the internal bus from the PMB, address decoding and generation, and control of the handshake signals required for DMA and interrupt operations. Various control and status registers are provided by the interface logic. The block generates interrupt and DMA trigger signals when data transfer is required. The interface registers accessible to the DSP56300 core through the PMB are shown in Figure 10-2 and summarized in Table 10-1. 23 0 EFCOP data input register (FDIR) EFCOP data output register (FDOR) EFCOP K-constant input register (FKIR) EFCOP filter count register (FCNT) EFCOP control status register (FCSR) EFCOP ALU control register (FACR) EFCOP data buffer base address (FDBA) EFCOP coeff. buffer base address (FCBA) EFCOP decimation/channel register(FDCH) Figure 10-2 EFCOP Register Layout Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 10-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor General Description Table 10-1 EFCOP Register Descriptions Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Register Name Description Filter data input register (FDIR) The FDIR is a 4-word-deep 24-bit-wide FIFO used for DSP-to-EFCOP data transfers. Data from the FDIR is transferred to the FDM for filter processing. Filter data output register (FDOR) The FDOR is a 24-bit-wide register used for EFCOP-to-DSP data transfers. Data is transferred to FDOR after processing of all filter taps is completed for a specific set of input samples. Filter K-constant input register (FKIR) The FKIR is a 24-bit register for DSP-to-EFCOP constant transfers. Filter count (FCNT) register The FCNT is a 24-bit register that specifies the number of filter taps. The count stored in the FCNT register is used by the EFCOP address generation logic to generate correct addressing to the FDM and FCM. EFCOP control status register (FCSR) The FCSR is a 24-bit read/write register used by the DSP56300 core to program the EFCOP and to examine the status of the EFCOP module. EFCOP ALU control register (FACR) The FACR is a 24-bit read/write register used by the DSP56300 core to program the EFCOP data ALU operating modes. EFCOP data buffer base address (FDBA) The FDBA is a 16-bit read/write register used by the DSP56300 core to indicate the EFCOP the data buffer base start address pointer in FDM RAM. EFCOP coefficient buffer base address (FCBA) The FCBA is a 16-bit read/write register by which the DSP56300 core indicates the EFCOP coefficient buffer base start address pointer in FCM RAM. Decimation/ channel count register (FDCH) The FDCH is a 24-bit register that sets the number of channels in multichannel mode and the filter decimation ratio. The EFCOP address generation logic uses this information to supply the correct addressing to the FDM and FCM. Not Recommended for New Design 10-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor General Description 10.3.2 EFCOP Memory Banks Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The EFCOP contains two memory banks: ¥ Filter Data Memory (FDM)ÑThis 24-bit-wide memory bank is mapped as X memory and stores input data samples for EFCOP filter processing. The FDM is written via a 4-word FIFO (FDIR), and its addressing is generated by the EFCOP address generation logic. The input data samples are read sequentially from the FDM into the MAC. The FDM is accessible for writes by the core, and the DMA controller and is shared with the 4K lowest locations ($0Ð$FFF) of the on-chip internal X memory. ¥ Filter Coefficient Memory (FCM)ÑThis 24-bit-wide memory bank is mapped as Y memory and stores filter coefficients for EFCOP filter processing. The FCM is written via the DSP56300 core, and the EFCOP address generation logic generates its addressing. The filter coefficients are read sequentially from the FCM into the MAC. The FCM is accessible for writes only by the core. The FCM is shared with the 4K lowest locations ($0Ð$FFF) of the on-chip internal Y memory. Note: The filter coefficients, H(n), are stored in Òreverse order,Ó where H(N-1) is stored at the lowest address of the FCM register as shown in Figure 10-4. Data Memory Bank (FDM) D(0) D(1) D(2) D(3) D(4) D(5) - H(N - 1) H(N - 2) H(1) H(0) Coefficient Memory Bank (FCM) AA1506 Figure 10-3 Storage of Filter Coefficients The EFCOP connects to the shared memory in place of the DMA bus. Simultaneous accesses by core and EFCOP to the same memory module block (256 locations) of the shared memory are not permitted. It is the userÕs responsibility to prevent such simultaneous accesses. Figure 10-4 illustrates the shared memory between core and EFCOP. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 10-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor General Description Figure 10-4. X RAM Y RAM DATA COEFF. (FDM) (FCM) X RAM Y RAM P RAM YDB PDB Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... XDB FDB CDB DDB EFCOP CORE GDB Figure 10-4 EFCOP Memory Organization 10.3.3 Filter Multiplier and Accumulator (FMAC) The FMAC machine can perform a 24-bit × 24-bit multiplication with accumulation in a 56-bit accumulator. The FMAC operates a pipeline: the multiplication is performed in one clock cycle, and the accumulation occurs in the following clock cycle. Throughput is one MAC result per clock cycle. The two MAC operands are read from the FDM and from the FCM. The full 56-bit width of the accumulator is used for intermediate results during the filter calculations. For operations in which saturation mode is disabled, the final result is rounded according to the selected rounding mode and limited to the most positive number ($7FFFFF, if overflow occurred) or most negative number ($800000, if underflow occurred) after processing of all filter taps is completed. In saturation mode, the result is limited to the most positive number ($7FFFFF, if overflow occurred), or the most negative number ($800000, if underflow occurred) after each MAC operation. The 24-bit result from the FMAC is stored in the EFCOP output buffer, FDOR. When operating in sixteen-bit arithmetic mode, the FMAC performs a 16-bit × 16-bit multiplication with accumulation into a 40-bit accumulator. As with 24-bit operations, if saturation mode is disabled, the result is rounded according to the selected rounding Not Recommended for New Design 10-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor EFCOP Programming Model mode and limited to the most positive number ($7FFF, if overflow occurred) or the most negative number ($8000, if underflow occurred) after processing of all filter taps is completed. In saturation mode, the result is limited to the most positive number ($7FFF, if overflow occurred) or the most negative number ($8000, if underflow occurred) after every MAC operation. The 16-bit result from the FMAC is stored in the EFCOP output buffer, FDOR. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 10.4 EFCOP PROGRAMMING MODEL This section documents the registers for configuring and operating the EFCOP. Appendix D EFCOP Programming on page D-1 discusses EFCOP programming. The EFCOP interrupt vector table is shown in Table 10-7 on page 10-19. The EFCOP registers available to the DSP programmer are listed in Table 10-2. The following paragraphs describe these registers in detail. Table 10-2 EFCOP Registers and Base Addresses Address EFCOP Register Name Y:$FFFFB0 Filter data input register (FDIR) Y:$FFFFB1 Filter data output register (FDOR) Y:$FFFFB2 Filter K-constant register (FKIR) Y:$FFFFB3 Filter count register (FCNT) Y:$FFFFB4 Filter control status register (FCSR) Y:$FFFFB5 Filter ALU control register (FACR) Y:$FFFFB6 Filter data buffer base address (FDBA) Y:$FFFFB7 Filter coefficient base address (FCBA) Y:$FFFFB8 Filter decimation/channel register (FDCH) NOTE: The EFCOP registers are mapped onto Y data memory space. 10.4.1 Filter Data Input Register (FDIR) The FDIR is a 4-word deep, 24-bit wide FIFO for DSP-to-EFCOP data transfers. Up to four data samples can be written into the FDIR at the same address. Data from the FDIR is transferred to the FDM for filter processing. For proper operation, write data to the FDIR only if the FDIBE status bit is set, indicating that the FIFO is empty. A write to the FDIR clears the FDIBE bit. Data transfers can be triggered by an interrupt request (for Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 10-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor EFCOP Programming Model core transfers) or a DMA request (for DMA transfers). The FDIR is accessible for writes by the DSP56300 core and the DMA controller. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 10.4.2 Filter Data Output Register (FDOR) The FDOR is a 24-bit read-only register for EFCOP-to-DSP data transfers. The result of the filter processing is transferred from the FMAC to the FDOR. For proper operation, read data from the FDOR only if the FDOBF status bit is set, indicating that the FDOR contains data. A read from the FDOR clears the FDOBF bit. Data transfers can be triggered by an interrupt request (for core transfers) or a DMA request (DMA transfers). The FDOR is accessible for reads by the DSP56300 core and the DMA controller. 10.4.3 Filter K-Constant Input Register (FKIR) The Filter K-Constant Input Register (FKIR) is a 24-bit write-only register for DSP-to-EFCOP data transfers in adaptive mode where the value stored in FKIR represents the weight update multiplier. FKIR is accessible only to the DSP core for reads or writes. When adaptive mode is enabled, the EFCOP immediately starts the coefficient update if a K-Constant value is written to FKIR. If no value is written to FKIR for the current data sample, the EFCOP halts processing until the K-Constant is written to FKIR. After the weight update multiplier is written to FKIR, the EFCOP transfers it to the FMAC unit and starts updating the filter coefficients according to the following equation: New_coefficients = Old_coefficients + FKIR * Input_buffer 10.4.4 Filter Count (FCNT) Register 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FCNT11 FCNT10 FCNT9 FCNT8 FCNT7 FCNT6 FCNT5 FCNT4 FCNT3 FCNT2 FCNT1 FCNT0 = Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility Not Recommended for New Design 10-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor EFCOP Programming Model The FCNT register is a 24-bit read/write register used to select the filter length (number of filter taps). Always write the initial count into the FCNT register before you enable the EFCOP (i.e., before you set FEN). Note: To ensure correct operation, never change the contents of the FCNT register unless the EFCOP is in the individual reset state (i.e., FEN = 0). The number stored in FCNT is used by the EFCOP address generation logic to generate the correct addressing for the FDM and for the FCM. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Note: In the individual reset state (i.e., FEN = 0), the EFCOP module is inactive, but the contents of the FCNT register are preserved. Table 10-3 FCNT Register Bit Descriptions Bit # Abbr. 23Ð12 Ñ 11Ð0 FCNT 10.4.5 23 Description These bits are reserved and unused. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. Filter CountÑThe actual value written to the FCNT register must be the number of coefficient values minus one. The number of coefficient values is the number of locations used in the FCM. For a real FIR filter, the number of coefficient values is identical to the number of filter taps. For a complex FIR filter, the number of coefficient values is twice the number of filter taps. EFCOP Control Status Register (FCSR) 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 FDOBF FDIBE FCONT FSAT 11 10 FDOIE FDIIE = 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FSCO FPRC FMLC FOM1 FOM0 FUPD FADP FLT FEN Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility The FCSR is a 24-bit read/write register by which the DSP56300 core controls the main operation modes of the EFCOP and monitors the EFCOP status. The FCSR bits are Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 10-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor EFCOP Programming Model described in the following paragraphs. All FCSR bits are cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 10-4 FCSR Bit Descriptions Bit # Abbr. 23Ð16 Ñ Description These bits are reserved and unused. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. 15 FDOBF Filter Data Output Buffer FullÑThis read-only status bit indicates, when set, that the FDOR is full and the DSP can read data from the FDOR. The FDOBF bit is set when a result from FMAC is transferred to the FDOR. For proper operation, read data from the FDOR only if the FDOBF status bit is set, indicating that the FDOR is full. A read from the FDOR clears the FDOBF bit. FDOBF is also cleared by a hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, or an individual reset. When the FDOBF bit is set, the EFCOP generates an FDOBF interrupt request to the DSP56300 core if that interrupt is enabled (i.e., FDOIE = 1). A DMA request is always generated when the FDOBF bit is set, but a DMA transfer takes place only if a DMA channel is activated and triggered by this event. 14 FDIBE 13 12 Filter Data Input Buffer EmptyÑThis read-only status bit indicates, when set, that the FDIR is empty and the DSP can write data to the FDIR. The FDIBE bit is set when all four FDIR locations are empty. For proper operation, write data to the FDIR only if the FDIBE status bit is set, indicating that the FDIR is empty. A write to the FDIR clears the FDIBE bit. The FDIBE bit is also cleared by a hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, or an individual reset. After EFCOP is enabled by setting FEN, FDIBE is set, indicating that the FDIR is empty. When FDIBE is set, the EFCOP generates a FDIR empty interrupt request to the DSP56300 core if enabled (i.e., FDIIE = 1). A DMA request is always generated when the FDIBE bit is set, but a DMA transfer takes place only if a DMA channel is activated and triggered by this event. FCONT Filter ContentionÑThis read-only status bit indicates, when set, that both the DSP56300 core and the EFCOP tried to access the same 256-word bank in either the shared FDM or FCM. A dual access could result in faulty data output in the FDOR. Once set, the FCONT bit is a sticky bit that can only be cleared by a hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, or an individual reset. FSAT Filter SaturationÑThis read-only status bit indicates, when set, that an overflow or underflow occurred in the MAC result. When an overflow occurs, the FSAT bit is set, and the result is saturated to the most positive number (i.e., $7FFFFF). When an underflow occurs, the FSAT bit is set, and the result is saturated to the most negative number (i.e., $800000). FSAT is a sticky status bit that is set by hardware and can be cleared only by a hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, or an individual reset. Not Recommended for New Design 10-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor EFCOP Programming Model Table 10-4 FCSR Bit Descriptions (Continued) Bit # 11 Abbr. Description FDOIE Filter Data Output Interrupt EnableÑThis read/write control bit is used to enable the filter data output interrupt. If FDOIE is cleared, the filter data output interrupt is disabled, and the FDOBF status bit should be polled to determine whether the FDOR is full. If both FDOIE and FDOBF are set, the EFCOP requests a data output buffer full interrupt service from the DSP56300 core. A DMA transfer is enabled if a DMA channel is activated and triggered by this event. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Note: 10 FDIIE Filter Data Input Interrupt EnableÑThis read/write control bit is used to enable the data input buffer empty interrupt. If FDIIE is cleared, the data input buffer empty interrupt is disabled, and the FDIBE status bit should be polled to determine whether the FDIR is empty. If both FDIIE and FDIBE are set, the EFCOP requests a data input buffer empty interrupt service from the DSP56300 core. DMA transfer is enabled if a DMA channel is activated and triggered by this event. Note: 9 Ñ 8 FSCO For proper operation, enable the interrupt service routine and the corresponding interrupt for core processing or enable the DMA transfer and configure the proper trigger for the selected channel. Never enable both simultaneously. For proper operation, enable the interrupt service routine and the corresponding interrupt for core processing or enable the DMA transfer and configure the proper trigger for the selected channel. Never enable both simultaneously. This bit is reserved. It is read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. Filter Shared Coefficients ModeÑThis read/write control bit is valid only when the EFCOP is operating in multichannel mode (i.e., FMLC is set). When the FSCO bit is set, the EFCOP uses the coefficients in the same memory area (i.e., the same coefficients) to implement the filter for each channel. This mode is used when several channels are being filtered through the same filter. When the FSCO bit is cleared, the EFCOP filter coefficients are stored sequentially in memory for each channel. Note: To ensure proper operation, never change the FSCO bit unless the EFCOP is in individual reset state (i.e., FEN = 0). FSCO is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 10-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor EFCOP Programming Model Table 10-4 FCSR Bit Descriptions (Continued) Bit # Abbr. Description 7 FPRC Filter Processing (FPRC) State Initialization ModeÑThis read/write control bit defines the EFCOP processing initialization mode. When this bit is cleared, the EFCOP starts processing after a state initialization. (The EFCOP machine starts computing once the FDM bank contains N input samples for an N tap filter). When this bit is set, the EFCOP starts processing with no state initialization. (The EFCOP machine starts computing as soon as the first data sample is available in the input buffer.) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Note: To ensure proper operation, never change the FPRC bit unless the EFCOP is in individual reset state (i.e., FEN = 0). FPRC is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 6 FMLC Filter Multichannel (FMLC) ModeÑThis read/write control bit, when set, enables multichannel mode, allowing the EFCOP to process several filters (defined by FCHL[5:0] bits in FDCH register) concurrently by sequentially entering a different sample to each filter. If FMLC is cleared, multichannel mode is disabled, and the EFCOP operates in single filter mode. Note: To ensure proper operation, never change the FMLC bit unless the EFCOP is in individual reset state (i.e., FEN = 0). FMLC is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 5Ð4 FOM Filter Operation ModeÑThis pair of read/write control bits defines one of four operation modes if the FIR filter has been selected (i.e., FLT is cleared): ¥ FOM = 00ÑMode 0: Real FIR filter ¥ FOM = 01ÑMode 1: Full complex FIR filter ¥ FOM = 10ÑMode 2: Complex FIR filter with alternate real and imaginary outputs ¥ FOM = 11ÑMode 3: Magnitude Note: To ensure proper operation, never change the FOM bits unless the EFCOP is in the individual reset state (i.e., FEN = 0). The FOM bits are cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 3 FUPD Filter UpdateÑWhen set, this read/write control/status bit enables the EFCOP to start a single coefficient update session. Upon completion of the session, the FUPD bit is automatically cleared. FUPD is set automatically when the EFCOP is in adaptive mode (i.e., FADP = 1). FUPD is cleared by a hardware RESET signal, a software RESET instruction, or an individual reset. Not Recommended for New Design 10-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor EFCOP Programming Model Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 10-4 FCSR Bit Descriptions (Continued) Bit # Abbr. Description 2 FADP Filter Adaptive (FADP) ModeÑWhen set, this read/write control bit enables adaptive mode. adaptive mode provides an efficient way to implement a LMS-type filter, and therefore it is used when the EFCOP operates in FIR filter mode (FLT = 0). In adaptive mode, processing of every input data sample consists of FIR processing followed by a coefficient update. When this bit is set, the EFCOP completes the FIR processing on the current data sample and immediately starts the coefficient update assuming that a K-constant value is written to the FKIR. If no value has been written to the FKIR for the current data sample, the EFCOP halts processing until the K-constant is written to the FKIR. During the coefficient update, the FUPD bit is automatically set to indicate an update session. After completion of the update, the EFCOP starts processing the next data sample. FADP is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 1 FLT Filter (FLT) TypeÑThis read/write control bit selects one of two available filter types: ¥ FLT = 0ÑFIR filter ¥ FLT = 1ÑIIR filter Note: To ensure proper operation, never change the FLT bit unless the EFCOP is in the individual reset state (i.e., FEN = 0). The FLT bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 0 FEN Filter EnableÑThis read/write control bit, when set, enables the operation of the EFCOP. When FEN is cleared, operation is disabled and the EFCOP is in the individual reset state. Note: While in the individual reset state, the EFCOP is inactive, internal logic and status bits assume the same state as that produced by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction, the contents of the FCNT, FDBA, and FCBA registers are preserved, and the control bits in FCSR and FACR remain unchanged. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 10-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor EFCOP Programming Model Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 10.4.6 EFCOP ALU Control Register (FACR) 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FISL FSA FSM FRM1 = Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility = Reserved for internal use; read as 0; should be written with 0 for proper use. FRM0 FSCL1 FSCL0 The FACR is a 24-bit read/write register by which the DSP56300 core controls the main operation modes of the EFCOP ALU. The FACR bits are described in the following paragraphs. All FACR bits are cleared after hardware and software reset. Table 10-5 FACR Bit Description Bit # Abbr. Description 23Ð16 Ñ These bits are reserved. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. 15Ð12 Ñ These bits are reserved for internal use and should always be written as 0 for proper operation. 11Ð7 Ñ These bits are reserved and unused. They read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. 6 FISL Filter Input ScaleÑWhen set, this read/write control bit directs the EFCOP ALU to scale the IIR feedback terms but not the IIR input. When cleared, the EFCOP ALU scales both the IIR feedback terms and the IIR input. The scaling value in both cases is determined by the FSCL[1:0] bits. The FISL bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 5 FSA Filter Sixteen-bit Arithmetic (FSA) ModeÑWhen set, this read/write control bit enables FSA mode. In this mode, the rounding of the arithmetic operation is performed on Bit 31 of the 56-accumulator instead of the usual bit 23 of the 56-bit accumulator. The scaling of the EFCOP data ALU is affected accordingly. The FSA bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 4 FSM Filter Saturation ModeÑWhen set, this read/write control bit selects automatic saturation on 48 bits for the results going to the accumulator. A special circuit inside the EFCOP MAC unit then saturates those results. The purpose of this bit is to provide arithmetic saturation mode for algorithms that do not recognize or cannot take advantage of the extension accumulator. The FSM bit is cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. Not Recommended for New Design 10-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor EFCOP Programming Model Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 10-5 FACR Bit Description Bit # Abbr. Description 3Ð2 FRM 1Ð0 FSCL Filter Scaling (FSCL)ÑThese read/write control bits select the scaling factor of the FMAC result: ¥ FSCL = 00ÑScaling factor = 1 (no shift) ¥ FSCL = 01ÑScaling factor = 8 (3-bit arithmetic left shift) ¥ FSCL = 10ÑScaling factor = 16 (4-bit arithmetic left shift) ¥ FSCL = 11ÑReserved for future expansion Filter Rounding ModeÑThese read/write control bits select the type of rounding performed by the EFCOP data ALU during arithmetic operation: ¥ FRM = 00ÑConvergent rounding ¥ FRM = 01ÑTwoÕs complement rounding ¥ FRM = 10ÑTruncation (no rounding) ¥ FRM = 11ÑReserved for future expansion These bits affect operation of the EFCOP data ALU. The FRM bits are cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. Note: To ensure proper operation, never change the FSCL bits unless the EFCOP is in the individual reset state (i.e., FEN = 0). The FSCL bits are cleared by a hardware RESET signal or a software RESET instruction. 10.4.7 EFCOP Data Base Address (FDBA) The FDBA is a 16-bit read/write counter register used as an address pointer to the EFCOP FDM bank. FDBA points to the location to write the next data sample. The FDBA points to a modulo delay buffer of size M, defined by the filter length (M = FCNT[11:0] + 1). The address range of this modulo delay buffer is defined by lower and upper address boundaries. The lower address boundary is the FDBA value with 0 in Ð the k-LSBs, where 2 k ≥ M ≥ 2 k 1 ; it therefore must be a multiple of 2k. The upper boundary is equal to the lower boundary plus (M Ð 1). Since M ≤ 2 k , once M has been chosen (i.e., FCNT has been assigned), a sequential series of data memory blocks (each of length 2k) will be created where multiple circular buffers for multichannel filtering can be located. If M < 2 k , there will be a space between sequential circular buffers of 2 k Ð M . The address pointer is not required to start at the lower address boundary or to end on the upper address boundary. It can point anywhere within the defined modulo address range. If the data address pointer (FDBA) increments and reaches the upper boundary of the modulo buffer, it will wrap around to the lower boundary. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 10-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor EFCOP Programming Model Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 10.4.8 EFCOP Coefficient Base Address (FCBA) The FCBA is a 16-bit read/write counter register used as an address pointer to the EFCOP FCM bank. FCBA points to the first location of the coefficient table. The FCBA points to a modulo buffer of size M, defined by the filter length (M = FCNT[11:0] + 1). The address range of this modulo buffer is defined by lower and upper address boundaries. The lower address boundary is the FCBA value with 0 in the k-LSBs, where 2 k ≥ M ≥ 2 k Ð 1 ; it therefore must be a multiple of 2k. The upper boundary is equal to the lower boundary plus (M Ð 1). Since M ≤ 2 k , once M has been chosen (i.e., FCNT has been assigned), a sequential series of coefficient memory blocks (each of length 2k) is created where multiple circular buffers for multichannel filtering can be located. If M < 2 k , there will be a space between sequential circular buffers of 2 k Ð M . The FCBA address pointer must be assigned to the lower address boundary (i.e., it must have 0 in its k-LSBs). In a compute session, the coefficient address pointer always starts at the lower boundary and ends at the upper address boundary. Therefore, a FCBA read always gives the value of the lower address boundary. 10.4.9 Decimation/Channel Count Register (FDCH) The FDCH is a 24-bit read/write register used to set the number of channels used in multichannel mode (FCHL) and to set the decimation ratio in FIR filter mode. FDCH should be written before the EFCOP is enabled by FEN. FDCH should be changed only when EFCOP is in individual reset state (FEN = 0); otherwise, improper operation may result. The number stored in FCHL is used by the EFCOP address generation logic to generate the correct address for the FDM bank and for the FCM bank in multichannel mode. When the EFCOP enable bit (FEN) is cleared, the EFCOP is in individual reset state. In this state, the EFCOP is inactive, and the contents of FDCH register are preserved. 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 FDCM3 FDCM2 FDCM1 FDCM0 = FCHL5 FCHL4 FCHL3 FCHL2 FCHL1 FCHL0 Reserved bit; read as 0; should be written with 0 for future compatibility Not Recommended for New Design 10-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor EFCOP Programming Model Table 10-6 FDCH Register Bit Descriptions Bit # Abbr. Description 23Ð12 Ñ These bits are reserved and unused. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. 11Ð8 FDCM Filter DecimationÑThese read/write control bits select the decimation function. There are 16 decimation factor options (from 1 to 16). Note: To ensure proper operation, never change the FDCM bits unless the EFCOP is in the individual reset state (FEN = 0). Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The bits are cleared by a hardware RESET or a software RESET instruction. 7Ð6 Ñ These bits are reserved and unused. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. 5Ð0 FCHL Filter ChannelsÑThese read/write control bits determine the number of filter channels to process simultaneously (from 1 to 64) in multichannel mode. The number represented by the FCHL bits is one less than the number of channels to be processed; that is, if FCHL = 0, then 1 channel is processed; if FCHL =1, then 2 channels are processed; and so on. Note: To ensure proper operation, never change the FCHL bits unless the EFCOP is in the individual reset state (FEN = 0). The bits are cleared by a hardware RESET or a software RESET instruction. 10.4.10 EFCOP Interrupt Vectors Table 10-7 shows the EFCOP interrupt vectors, and Table 10-8 shows the DMA request sources. Table 10-7 EFCOP Interrupt Vectors Interrupt Address Interrupt Vector Priority Interrupt Enable Interrupt Conditions VBA + $68 Data input buffer empty Highest FDIIE FDIBE = 1 VBA + $6A Data output buffer full Lowest FDOIE FDOBF = 1 Table 10-8 EFCOP DMA Request Sources Request Conditions Peripheral Request MDRQ EFCOP input buffer empty FDIBE = 1 MDRQ11 EFCOP output buffer full FDOBF = 1 MDRQ12 Requesting Device Number Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 10-19 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Enhanced Filter Coprocessor Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... EFCOP Programming Model Not Recommended for New Design 10-20 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ON-CHIP EMULATION MODULE Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... On-Chip Emulation Module 11.1 11.2 11.4 11.5 11.6 11.7 11.8 11.9 11.10 11.11 11.12 11.13 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3 ONCE MODULE SIGNALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3 ONCE CONTROLLER. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-4 ONCE MEMORY BREAKPOINT LOGIC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9 ONCE TRACE LOGIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-15 METHODS OF ENTERING DEBUG MODE . . . . . . . . . . . 11-16 PIPELINE INFORMATION AND OGDB REGISTER. . . . . 11-18 TRACE BUFFER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-20 SERIAL PROTOCOL DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-22 TARGET SITE DEBUG SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS . . . . 11-23 EXAMPLES OF USING THE ONCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-23 EXAMPLES OF JTAG AND ONCE INTERACTION . . . . . 11-28 Not Recommended for New Design 11-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Introduction Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 11.1 INTRODUCTION The DSP56300 core OnCE module interacts with the DSP56300 core and its peripherals non-intrusively so that you can examine registers, memory, or on-chip peripherals, thus facilitating hardware and software development on the DSP56300 core processor. Special circuits and dedicated signals on the DSP56300 core are defined to avoid sacrificing any user-accessible on-chip resource. OnCE module resources are accessible only after execution of the JTAG instruction ENABLE_ONCE; these resources are accessible even when the chip operates in normal mode. See Section 12 Joint Test Action Group Port for a description of JTAG and its relation to OnCE. Figure 11-1 shows the block diagram of the OnCE module. PDB PIL GDB Pipeline Information Trace Logic TCK Control Bus TDI OnCE Controller XAB YAB PAB TDO TRST DE Trace Buffer Tags Buffer Breakpoint Logic AA0702 Figure 11-1 OnCE Module Block Diagram 11.2 OnCE MODULE SIGNALS The OnCE module controller is accessed through the JTAG port. There are no dedicated OnCE module signals for the clock, data in, or data out. The JTAG TCK, TDI, and TDO signals shift data and instructions in and out. See Section 12.2 JTAG Signals on page 12-4 for documentation of the JTAG signals. One additional signal, called DE facilitates emulation-specific functions. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Debug Event Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 11.3 DEBUG EVENT The debug event signal (DE) is a bidirectional open drain. As input, it provides a fast means of entering debug mode from an external command controller; as output, it provides a fast means of acknowledging to an external command controller that the chip has entered debug mode. When a command controller asserts this signal, the DSP56300 core finishes the current instruction being executed, saves the instruction pipeline information, enters debug mode, and waits for commands to be entered from the TDI line. If the DE signal is used to enter debug mode, then it must be deasserted after the OnCE port responds with an acknowledge and before the first OnCE command is sent. The assertion of this signal by the DSP56300 core indicates that the DSP has entered debug mode and is waiting for commands to be entered from the TDI line. The DE signal also facilitates multiple processor connections, as shown in Figure 11-2. DE TDI TDI TDO TDI TDO TDI TDO TDO TMS TCK TRST AA0703 Figure 11-2 OnCE Module Multiprocessor Configuration Thus you can stop all the devices in the system when one of the devices enters debug mode. You can also stop all devices synchronously by asserting the DE line. 11.4 OnCE CONTROLLER The OnCE controller contains the following blocks: OnCE command register (OCR), OnCE decoder, and the status/control register. Figure 11-3 shows a block diagram of the OnCE controller. Not Recommended for New Design 11-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module OnCE Controller TDI TCK OnCE Command Register ISBKPT Update Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ISTRACE ISDR OnCE Decoder ISDEBUG ISSWDBG Status and Control Register Register Read Register Write TDO Mode Select AA0704 Figure 11-3 OnCE Controller Block Diagram 11.4.1 OnCE Command Register (OCR) The OCR is an 8-bit shift register that receives its serial data from the TDI signal. It holds the 8-bit commands to be used as input for the OnCE decoder. The OCR is shown in Figure 11-4. OCR OnCE Command Register Reset = $00 Write Only 7 6 5 R/W GO EX 4 3 2 1 0 RS4 RS3 RS2 RS1 RS0 AA0106 Figure 11-4 OnCE Command Register 11.4.1.1 Register Select (RS4–RS0) Bits 0–4 The register select bits define which register is the source or destination for read or write operations. See Table 11-1 for the OnCE register select encoding. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module OnCE Controller Table 11-1 OnCE Register Select Encoding Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... RS[4:0] Register Selected 00000 OnCE status and control register (OSCR) 00001 Memory breakpoint counter (OMBC) 00010 Breakpoint control register (OBCR) 00011 Reserved address 00100 Reserved address 00101 Memory limit register 0 (OMLR0) 00110 Memory limit register 1 (OMLR1) 00111 Reserved address 01000 Reserved address 01001 GDB register (OGDBR) 01010 PDB register (OPDBR) 01011 PIL register (OPILR) 01100 PDB GO-TO register (for GO TO command) 01101 Trace counter (OTC) 01110 Reserved address 01111 PAB register for fetch (OPABFR) 10000 PAB register for decode (OPABDR) 10001 PAB register for execute (OPABEX) 10010 Trace buffer and increment pointer 10011 Reserved address 101xx Reserved address 11xx0 Reserved address 11x0x Reserved address 110xx Reserved address 11111 No register selected Not Recommended for New Design 11-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module OnCE Controller 11.4.1.2 Exit Command (EX) Bit 5 If the EX bit is set, the core leaves debug mode and resumes normal operation. The EXIT command is executed only if the GO command is issued and the operation is a write to OPDBR or a read/write to Òno register selectedÓ. Otherwise, the EX bit is ignored. Table 11-2 shows the values of the EX bit. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 11-2 EX Bit Definition EX Action 0 Remain in debug mode 1 Leave debug mode 11.4.1.3 GO Command (GO) Bit 6 If the GO bit is set, the core executes the instruction that resides in the PIL register. To execute the instruction, the core leaves debug mode. If the EX bit is cleared, the core returns to debug mode immediately after executing the instruction. If the EX bit is set, the core goes on to normal operation. The GO command is executed only if the operation is a write to OPDBR or a read/write to Òno register selectedÓ. Otherwise, the GO bit is ignored. Table 11-3 shows the values of the GO bit. Table 11-3 GO Bit Definition GO Action 0 InactiveÑno action taken 1 Execute instruction in PIL 11.4.1.4 Read/Write Command (R/W) Bit 7 The R/W bit specifies the direction of a data transfer. Table 11-4 R/W Bit Definition R/W Action 0 Write the data associated with the command into the register specified by RS4ÐRS0. 1 Read the data contained in the register specified by RS4ÐRS0. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module OnCE Controller 11.4.2 OnCE Decoder (ODEC) The ODEC supervises the all OnCE module activity. It receives as input an 8-bit command from the OCR, a signal from JTAG controller (indicating that 8 or 24 bits have been received and that an update of the selected data register must be performed), and a signal indicating that the core has halted. The ODEC generates all the strobes required to read and write the selected OnCE registers. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 11.4.3 OnCE Status and Control Register (OSCR) The OSCR is a 24-bit register that enables trace mode and indicates the reason to enter debug mode. The control bits can be read or written, whereas the status bits are read-only. The OSCR bits are cleared by a hardware RESET signal. The OSCR is shown in Figure 11-5. 23 9 8 OnCE Status and Control Register Read/Write 7 6 OS1 OS0 5 4 3 2 1 0 TO MBO SWO IME TME Reserved bits; read as 0; should be written as 0 for future compatibility AA0705 Figure 11-5 OnCE Status and Control Register (OSCR) 11.4.3.1 Trace Mode Enable (TME) Bit 0 When set, the TME control bit enables trace mode. 11.4.3.2 Interrupt Mode Enable (IME) Bit 1 When the IME control bit is set, the chip executes a vectored interrupt at the address VBA:$06 instead of entering debug mode. 11.4.3.3 Software Debug Occurrence (SWO) Bit 2 The SWO bit is a read-only status bit that is set when debug mode is entered because of the execution of the DEBUG or DEBUGcc instruction with condition true. This bit is cleared when the core leaves debug mode. 11.4.3.4 Memory Breakpoint Occurrence (MBO) Bit 3 The MBO bit is a read-only status bit that is set when Debug mode is entered because a memory breakpoint has been encountered. This bit is cleared when the core leaves debug mode. Not Recommended for New Design 11-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module OnCE Memory Breakpoint Logic 11.4.3.5 Trace Occurrence (TO) Bit 4 The TO bit is a read-only status bit that is set when debug mode is entered because the trace counter is 0 while trace mode is enabled. This bit is cleared when the core leaves debug mode. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 11.4.3.6 Reserved OCSR Bit 5 Bit 5 is reserved for future use. It is read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. 11.4.3.7 Core Status (OS0, OS1) Bits 6–7 The OS0, OS1 bits are read-only status bits that provide core status information. By examining the status bits, you can determine whether the chip has entered debug mode. SWO, MBO, and TO identify the reason for entering debug mode. You can also examine these bits to determine why the chip has not entered debug mode after debug event assertion (DE) or after execution of the JTAG debug request instruction (e.g., core waiting for the bus, STOP or WAIT instruction, etc.). These bits are also reflected in the JTAG instruction shift register, so you can poll core status information at the JTAG level. This convention is useful to allow a read of OSCR when the DSP56300 core executes the STOP instruction (and therefore there are no clocks). See Table 11-5 for the values of the OS0ÐOS1 bits. Table 11-5 Core Status Bits Description OS1 OS0 Description 0 0 DSP56300 core is executing instructions 0 1 DSP56300 core is in wait or stop 1 0 DSP56300 core is waiting for the bus 1 1 DSP56300 core is in debug mode 11.4.3.8 Reserved Bits 8–23 Bits 8Ð23 are reserved for future use. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. 11.5 OnCE MEMORY BREAKPOINT LOGIC Memory breakpoints can be set on locations in program memory or data memory. In addition, the breakpoint does not have to be in a specific memory address, but within an approximate address range of where the program may be executing. This flexibility Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module OnCE Memory Breakpoint Logic significantly increases the programmerÕs ability to monitor what the program is doing in real-time. The breakpoint logic, illustrated in Figure 11-6, contains a latch for addresses of registers that store the upper and lower address limits, address comparators, and a breakpoint counter. TCK Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... TDO TDI PAB XAB YAB Memory Address Latch Memory Bus Select N,V TDI TCK TDO Address Comparator 0 Breakpoint Control Memory Limit Register 0 Address Comparator 1 N,V Memory Breakpoint Selection Memory Limit Register 1 Breakpoint Counter DEC Breakpoint Occurred Count = 0 ISBKPT AA0706 Figure 11-6 OnCE Memory Breakpoint Logic 0 Address comparators are useful to determine where a program may be getting lost or when data is being written where it should not be written. They are also useful in halting a program at a specific point to examine or change registers or memory. Using address comparators to set breakpoints enables the user to set breakpoints in RAM or ROM in any operating mode. Memory accesses are monitored according to the contents of the OBCR as specified in Section 11.5.6 OnCE Breakpoint Control Register (OBCR) on page 11-11. Not Recommended for New Design 11-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module OnCE Memory Breakpoint Logic 11.5.1 OnCE Memory Address Latch (OMAL) The OMAL is a 16-bit register that latches the PAB, XAB, or YAB on every instruction cycle according to the MBS1ÐMBS0 bits in OBCR. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 11.5.2 OnCE Memory Limit Register 0 (OMLR0) The OMLR0 is a 16-bit register that stores the memory breakpoint limit. OMLR0 can be read or written through the JTAG port. Before breakpoints are enabled, OMLR0 must be loaded by the external command controller. 11.5.3 OnCE Memory Address Comparator 0 (OMAC0) The OMAC0 compares the current memory address (stored in OMAL0) with the OMLR0 contents. 11.5.4 OnCE Memory Limit Register 1 (OMLR1) The OMLR1 is a 16-bit register that stores the memory breakpoint limit. OMLR1 can be read or written through the JTAG port. Before breakpoints are enabled, OMLR1 must be loaded by the external command controller. 11.5.5 OnCE Memory Address Comparator 1 (OMAC1) The OMAC1 compares the current memory address (stored in OMAL0) with the OMLR1 contents. 11.5.6 OnCE Breakpoint Control Register (OBCR) The OBCR is a 16-bit register that defines memory breakpoint events. OBCR can be read or written through the JTAG port. OBCR bits are cleared by a hardware RESET signal. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module OnCE Memory Breakpoint Logic The OBCR is illustrated in Figure 11-7. OnCE Breakpoint Control Register Reset = $0010 Read/Write 15 14 13 12 * * * * 11 10 BT1 BT0 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CC 11 CC 10 RW 11 RW 10 CC 01 CC 00 RW 01 RW 00 MB S1 MB S0 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... * Reserved bits; read as 0; should be written as 0 for future compatibility AA0707 Figure 11-7 OnCE Breakpoint Control Register (OBCR) 11.5.6.1 Memory Breakpoint Select (MBS0–MBS1) Bits 0–1 The MBS0ÐMBS1 bits enable memory breakpoints 0 and 1, allowing them to occur when a memory access is performed in P, X, or Y space. Table 11-6 lists the values of the MBS0ÐMBS1 bits. Table 11-6 Memory Breakpoint 0 and 1 Select MBS1 MBS0 Description 0 0 Reserved 0 1 Breakpoint on P access 1 0 Breakpoint on X access 1 1 Breakpoint on Y access 11.5.6.2 Breakpoint 0 Read/Write Select (RW00–RW01) Bits 2–3 The RW00ÐRW01 bits define the memory breakpoints 0 to occur when a memory address access is performed to read, write, or both. Table 11-7 lists the values of the RW00ÐRW01 bits. Not Recommended for New Design 11-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module OnCE Memory Breakpoint Logic Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 11-7 Breakpoint 0 Read/Write Select RW01 RW00 Description 0 0 Breakpoint disabled 0 1 Breakpoint on write access 1 0 Breakpoint on read access 1 1 Breakpoint on read or write access 11.5.6.3 Breakpoint 0 Condition Code Select (CC00–CC01) Bits 4–5 The CC00ÐCC01 bits define what to do after a comparison of a current memory address (OMAL0) and the memory limit register 0 (OMLR0). Table 11-8 lists the values of the CC00ÐCC01 bits. Table 11-8 Breakpoint 0 Condition Select CC01 CC00 Description 0 0 Breakpoint on not equal 0 1 Breakpoint on equal 1 0 Breakpoint on less than 1 1 Breakpoint on greater than 11.5.6.4 Breakpoint 1 Read/Write Select (RW10–RW11) Bits 6–7 The RW10ÐRW11 bits make a memory breakpoint 1 occur when a memory address access is performed to read, write, or both. Table 11-9 lists the values of the RW10ÐRW11 bits. Table 11-9 Breakpoint 1 Read/Write Select RW11 RW10 Description 0 0 Breakpoint disabled 0 1 Breakpoint on write access 1 0 Breakpoint on read access 1 1 Breakpoint read or write access Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module OnCE Memory Breakpoint Logic 11.5.6.5 Breakpoint 1 Condition Code Select (CC10–CC11) Bits 8–9 The CC10ÐCC11 bits define what to do after a comparison of a current memory address (OMAL0) and the OnCE memory limit register 1 (OMLR1). Table 11-10 lists values of the CC10ÐCC11 bits. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 11-10 Breakpoint 1 Condition Select Table CC11 CC10 Description 0 0 Breakpoint on not equal 0 1 Breakpoint on equal 1 0 Breakpoint on less than 1 1 Breakpoint on greater than 11.5.6.6 Breakpoint 0 and 1 Event Select (BT0–BT1) Bits 10–11 The BT0ÐBT1 bits define the sequence between breakpoint 0 and 1. If the condition defined by BT0ÐBT1 is met, then the breakpoint counter (OMBC) is decremented. Table 11-11 lists values of the BT0ÐBT1 bits. Table 11-11 Breakpoint 0 and 1 Event Select Table BT1 BT0 Description 0 0 Breakpoint 0 and Breakpoint 1 0 1 Breakpoint 0 or Breakpoint 1 1 0 Breakpoint 1 after Breakpoint 0 1 1 Breakpoint 0 after Breakpoint 1 11.5.6.7 OnCE Memory Breakpoint Counter (OMBC) The OMBC is a 16-bit counter that is loaded with a value equal to the number of times minus one that a memory access event should occur before a memory breakpoint is declared. The memory access event is specified by the OBCR and by the memory limit registers. On each occurrence of the memory access event, the breakpoint counter decrements. When the counter reaches 0 and a new occurrence takes place, the chip enters debug mode. The OMBC can be read or written through the JTAG port. Every time the limit register changes or a different breakpoint event is selected in the OBCR, the breakpoint counter must be written afterwards. This convention insures that the Not Recommended for New Design 11-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module OnCE Trace Logic OnCE breakpoint logic is reset and that no previous events can affect the newly selected breakpoint event. The breakpoint counter is cleared by a hardware RESET signal. 11.5.6.8 Reserved Bits 12–15 Bits 12Ð15 are reserved for future use. They are read as 0 and should be written with 0 for future compatibility. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 11.6 OnCE TRACE LOGIC The OnCE trace logic makes it possible to execute instructions in single or multiple steps. The OnCE trace logic causes the chip to enter debug mode after the execution of one or more instructions and to wait for OnCE commands from the debug serial port. The OnCE trace logic block diagram appears in Figure 11-8. End of Instruction TDI TDO Trace Counter DEC TCK Count = 0 ISTRACE AA0708 Figure 11-8 OnCE Trace Logic Block Diagram Trace mode has an associated counter so that more than one instruction can be executed before the core returns to debug mode. This counter allows you to take multiple instruction steps in real time before entering debug mode. This feature helps you debug sections of code that do not have a normal flow or are looping. The trace counter also enables you to count the number of instructions executed in a code segment. To enable trace mode, the counter is loaded with a value, the program counter is set to the start location of the instruction(s) to be executed in real time, the TME bit is set in the OSCR, and the DSP56300 core exits debug mode by executing the appropriate command issued by the external command controller. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Methods of Entering Debug mode When the core exits debug mode, the counter decrements after each execution of an instruction. Interrupts are serviceable, and all executed instructions (including fast interrupt services and repeated instructions) cause the trace counter to be decremented. When the counter decrements to 0, the DSP56300 core reenters debug mode, the trace occurrence bit (TO) in the OSCR register is set, the core status bits OS[1:0] are set to 11, and the DE signal asserts to indicate that the DSP56300 core has entered debug mode and is requesting service. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The OnCE trace counter (OTC) is a 16-bit counter that can be read or written through the JTAG port. If N instructions are to execute before debug mode, the trace counter should be loaded with N Ð 1. The trace counter is cleared by a hardware RESET signal. 11.7 METHODS OF ENTERING DEBUG MODE The DSP56307 acknowledges that it has entered debug mode by setting the core status bits OS1 and OS0 and asserting the DE line. This acknowledgment informs the external command controller that the chip has entered debug mode and is waiting for commands.The DSP56300 core can disable the OnCE module if the ROM security option is implemented so that the OnCE module remains inactive until the core executes a write operation to the OGDBRDSP56300. 11.7.1 External Debug Request during RESET Assertion If the DE line is held asserted during the assertion of RESET, then the chip enters debug mode. After receiving the acknowledgment, the external command controller must negate the DE line before sending the first command. Note: 11.7.2 In this case, the chip does not execute any instructions before entering debug mode. External Debug Request during Normal Activity If the DE line is held asserted during normal chip activity, the chip finishes executing the current instruction and enters debug mode. After receiving the acknowledge, the external command controller must negate the DE line before sending the first command. This process is the same for any newly-fetched instruction, including instructions fetched by interrupt processing or instructions to be aborted by interrupt processing. Not Recommended for New Design 11-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Methods of Entering Debug mode Note: Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 11.7.3 In this case, the chip finishes executing the current instruction and stops after the newly fetched instruction enters the instruction latch. Executing the JTAG DEBUG_REQUEST Instruction Execution of the JTAG instruction DEBUG_REQUEST asserts an internal debug request signal. Consequently, the chip finishes execution of the current instruction and stops after the newly-fetched instruction enters the instruction latch. After the core enters debug mode, the core status bits OS1 and OS0 are set, and the DE line is asserted, thus acknowledging to the external command controller that debug mode has been entered. 11.7.4 External Debug Request during Stop Execution of the JTAG instruction DEBUG_REQUEST (or assertion of DE) while the chip is in stop state (i. e., it has executed a STOP instruction) causes the chip to exit stop state and enter debug mode. After receiving the acknowledgment, the external command controller must negate DE before sending its first command. Note: 11.7.5 In this case, the chip finishes executing of the STOP instruction and halts after the next instruction enters the instruction latch. External Debug Request during Wait Execution of the JTAG instruction DEBUG_REQUEST (or assertion of DE) while the chip is in wait state (i. e., it has executed a WAIT instruction) causes the chip to exit wait state and enter debug mode. After receiving the acknowledgment, the external command controller must negate DE before sending its first command. Note: 11.7.6 In this case, the chip completes execution of the WAIT instruction and halts after the next instruction enters the instruction latch. Software Request during Normal Activity Executing the DSP56300 core instruction DEBUG (or DEBUGcc when the specified condition is true), the chip enters debug mode after the instruction following the DEBUG instruction enters the instruction latch. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Pipeline Information and OGDB Register 11.7.7 Enabling Trace Mode Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... When trace mode is enabled and the trace counter is greater than zero, the trace counter decrements after the execution of each instruction. Execution of an instruction when the value in the trace counter is 0 causes the chip to enter debug mode after it completes the execution of the instruction. Only instructions actually executed cause the trace counter to decrement. An aborted instruction does not decrement the trace counter, nor does it cause the chip to enter debug mode. 11.7.8 Enabling Memory Breakpoints When the memory breakpoint mechanism is enabled with a breakpoint counter value of 0, the chip enters debug mode after it finishes executing the instruction that caused the memory breakpoint to occur. In case of breakpoints on executed program memory fetches, the breakpoint is acknowledged immediately after the fetched instruction executes. In case of breakpoints on accesses to X, Y, or program memory spaces by MOVE instructions, the breakpoint is acknowledged after the completion of the instruction following the instruction that accessed the specified address. 11.8 PIPELINE INFORMATION AND OGDB REGISTER To restore the pipeline and to resume normal chip activity upon a return from debug mode, a number of on-chip registers store the chip pipeline status. Figure 11-9 shows the block diagram of the pipeline information registers (with the exception of the PAB registers shown in Figure 11-10 on page 11-22). Not Recommended for New Design 11-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Pipeline Information and OGDB Register GDB Register (OGDBR) GDB PDB Register (OPDBR) TDI PDB Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... PIL Register (OPILR) TDO TCK PIL AA0709 Figure 11-9 OnCE Pipeline Information and GDB Registers 11.8.1 OnCE PDB Register (OPDBR) The OPDBR is a 24-bit latch that stores the value of the PDB generated by the last program memory access of the core before debug mode is entered. The OPDBR register can be read or written through the JTAG port. This register is affected by the operations performed during debug mode and must be restored by the external command controller at a return to normal mode. 11.8.2 OnCE PIL Register (OPILR) The OPILR is a 24-bit latch that stores the value of the instruction latch before debug mode is entered. OPILR can be read only through the JTAG port. Note: 11.8.3 Since the instruction latch is affected by operations performed during debug mode, it must be restored by the external command controller at a return to normal mode. Since there is no direct write access to the instruction latch, it is restored by a write to OPDBR with no-GO and no-EX. In this case, the data written on PDB is transferred into the instruction latch. OnCE GDB Register (OGDBR) The OGDBR is a 16-bit latch that can be read only through the JTAG port. The OGDBR is not actually required for restoring pipeline status, but it is required as a means of Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-19 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Trace Buffer passing information between the chip and the external command controller. The OGDBR is mapped to the X internal I/O space at address $FFFC. Whenever the external command controller needs the contents of a register or memory location, it forces the chip to execute an instruction that brings that information to the OGDBR. Then the contents of the OGDBR are delivered serially to the external command controller by the command READ GDB REGISTER. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 11.9 TRACE BUFFER To make debugging easier and to keep track of program flow, the DSP56300 core provides a number of on-chip dedicated resources. Three read-only PAB registers give pipeline information when debug mode is entered, and a trace buffer stores the address of the last instruction that was executed as well as the addresses of the last 12 change-of-flow instructions. 11.9.1 OnCE PAB Register for Fetch (OPABFR) The OPABFR is a 16-bit register that stores the address of the last instruction whose fetch was started before debug mode was entered.The OPABFR can be read only through the JTAG port. This register is not affected by the operations performed during debug mode. 11.9.2 PAB Register for Decode (OPABDR) The OPABDR is a 16-bit register that stores the address of the instruction currently in the PDB. The fetch for this instruction was completed before the chip entered debug mode. The OPABDR can be read only through the JTAG port. This register is not affected by the operations performed during debug mode. 11.9.3 OnCE PAB Register for Execute (OPABEX) The OPABEX is a 16-bit register that stores the address of the instruction currently in the instruction latch. This instruction would have been decoded and executed if the chip had not entered debug mode. The OPABEX register can be read only through the JTAG port. This register is not affected by operations performed during debug mode. Not Recommended for New Design 11-20 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Trace Buffer Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 11.9.4 Trace Buffer The trace buffer stores the addresses of the last 12 change-of-flow instructions executed, as well as the address of the last executed instruction. The trace buffer is a circular buffer containing 17-bit registers and one 4-bit counter. All the registers have the same address, but any read access to the trace buffer address increments the counter, thus pointing to the next trace buffer register. The registers are serially available to the external command controller through their common trace buffer address. Figure 11-10 on page 11-22 shows the block diagram of the trace buffer. The trace buffer is not affected by operations performed during debug mode except for the trace buffer pointer increment when the trace buffer is being read. When the chip enters debug mode, the trace buffer counter points to the trace buffer register containing the address of the last executed instructions. The first trace buffer read obtains the oldest address, and the following trace buffer reads get the other addresses from the oldest to the newest, in order of execution. Notes: 1. To ensure trace buffer coherence, a complete set of 12 reads of the trace buffer must be performed. Twelve reads are necessary because each read increments the trace buffer pointer, thus pointing to the next location. After 12 reads, the pointer indicates the same location as it did before the read procedure started. 2. On any change-of-flow instruction, the trace buffer stores both the address of the change-of-flow instruction, as well as the address of the target of the change-of-flow instruction. In the case of conditional changes-of-flow, the address of the change-of-flow instruction is always stored (regardless of whether the change-of-flow is true or false), but if the conditional change-of-flow is false (i.e., not taken) the address of the target is not stored. In order to facilitate the program trace reconstruction, every trace buffer location has an additional invalid bit (Bit 24). If a conditional change-of-flow instruction includes Òcondition false,Ó the invalid bit is set, thus marking this instruction as not taken. Therefore, it is imperative to read 17 bits of data when you read the 12 trace buffer registers. Since data is read LSB first, the invalid bit is the first bit to be read. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-21 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Serial Protocol Description PAB Fetch Address (OPABFR) Decode Address (OPABDR) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Execute Address (OPABEX) Trace Buffer Register 0 Circular Buffer Pointer Trace Buffer Register 1 Trace Buffer Register 2 Trace Buffer Register 11 TDI Trace Buffer Shift Register TCK TDO AA0710 Figure 11-10 OnCE Trace Buffer 11.10 SERIAL PROTOCOL DESCRIPTION The following protocol promotes efficient communication between the external command controller and the DSP56300 core. Before the chip starts any debugging activity, the external command controller must wait for an acknowledgment on the DE Not Recommended for New Design 11-22 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Target Site Debug System Requirements line indicating that the chip has entered Debug mode; optionally, the external command controller can poll the OS1 and OS0 bits in the JTAG instruction shift register for the same information. The external command controller communicates with the chip by sending 8-bit commands that can be accompanied by 24 bits of data. Both commands and data are sent or received LSB first. After sending a command, the external command controller should wait for the DSP56300 to acknowledge execution of the command. The external command controller can send a new command only after the chip has acknowledged execution of the previous command. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... OnCE commands are classified as follows: ¥ Read commands (when the chip delivers the required data) ¥ Write commands (when the chip receives data and writes the data in one of the OnCE registers) ¥ Commands that do not have data transfers associated with them. The commands are 8 bits long and have the format shown in Figure 11-4 on page 11-5. 11.11 TARGET SITE DEBUG SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS A typical debugging environment consists of a target system where the DSP56300 core-based device resides in the user-defined hardware. The JTAG port interfaces to the external command controller over a 8-wire link consisting of the five JTAG port wires, one OnCE module wire, a ground, and a reset wire. The reset wire is optional and is used only to reset the DSP56300 core-based device and its associated circuitry. The external command controller acts as the medium between the DSP56300 core target system and a host computer. The external command controller circuit acts as a JTAG port driver and an interpreter for host computer commands. The controller issues commands based on the host computer inputs from a user interface program that communicates with the user. 11.12 EXAMPLES OF USING THE OnCE This section presents examples of debugging procedures. All examples assume that the DSP is the only device in the JTAG chain. If there is more than one device in the chain (such as additional DSPs or other devices), the other devices can be forced to execute the JTAG BYPASS instruction so that their effect in the serial stream is one bit per additional device. The events (such as select-DR, select-IR, update-DR, and shift-DR) mean to bring Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-23 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Examples of Using the OnCE the JTAG TAP into the corresponding state. Section 12 Joint Test Action Group Port on page 12-1 contains a detailed description of the JTAG protocol. 11.12.1 Checking Whether the Chip Has Entered Debug Mode Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... There are two methods to verify that the chip has entered debug mode: ¥ Every time the chip enters debug mode, a pulse is generated on the DE signal. A pulse is also generated every time the chip acknowledges the execution of an instruction while in debug mode. An external command controller can connect the DE line to an interrupt signal in order to sense the acknowledgment. ¥ An external command controller can poll the JTAG instruction shift register for the status bits OS[1:0]. When the chip is in debug mode, these bits are set to the value 11. Note: 11.12.2 In the following paragraphs, ACK denotes the operation performed by the command controller to check whether debug mode has been entered (either by sensing DE or by polling JTAG instruction shift register). Polling the JTAG Instruction Shift Register To poll the core status bits in the JTAG instruction shift register, perform the following steps: 1. Select shift-IR. When you pass through capture-IR, it loads the core status bits into the instruction shift register. 2. Shift in ENABLE_ONCE. While the new instruction is being shifted in, the captured status information is shifted-out. Pass through update-IR. 3. Return to run-test/idle. The external command controller can analyze the information shifted out and detect whether the chip has entered debug mode. 11.12.3 Saving Pipeline Information Debugging is accomplished by means of DSP56300 core instructions supplied from the external command controller. Therefore, the current state of the DSP56300 core pipeline Not Recommended for New Design 11-24 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Examples of Using the OnCE must be saved before debugging starts, and of course the state must be restored before a return to normal mode. Here is how to save the current pipeline state; these instructions assume that ENABLE_ONCE has been executed and debug mode has been entered and verified, as explained in Checking Whether the Chip Has Entered Debug Mode on page 11-24: 1. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒRead PDBÓ. Pass through update-DR. 2. Select shift-DR. Shift out the 24-bit OPDB register. Pass through update-DR. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 3. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒRead PILÓ. Pass through update-DR. 4. Select shift-DR. Shift out the 24-bit OPILR register. Pass through update-DR. There is no need to verify an acknowledgment between steps 1 and 2, nor between 3 and 4, because their completion is guaranteed. 11.12.4 Reading the Trace Buffer An optional step during debugging is to read the information associated with the trace buffer in order to enable an external program to reconstruct the full trace of the executed program. Here is how to read the trace buffer; these instructions assume that all actions explained in Saving Pipeline Information have already been executed: 1. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒRead PABFRÓ. Pass through update-DR. 2. Select shift-DR. Shift out the 16-bit OPABFR. Pass through update-DR. 3. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒRead PABDRÓ. Pass through update-DR. 4. Select shift-DR. Shift out the 16-bit OPABDR. Pass through update-DR. 5. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒRead PABEXÓ. Pass through update-DR. 6. Select shift-DR. Shift out the 16-bit OPABEX register. Pass through update-DR. 7. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒRead FIFOÓ. Pass through update-DR. 8. Select shift-DR. Shift out the 17-bit FIFO register. Pass through update-DR. 9. Repeat steps 7 and 8 for the entire FIFO (i.e., 12 times). Note: You must read the entire FIFO because each read increments the FIFO pointer, thus pointing to the next FIFO location. At the end of this repetition, the FIFO pointer points back to the beginning of the FIFO. The information read by the external command controller now contains the address of the newly fetched instruction, the address of the instruction currently on the PDB, the Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-25 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Examples of Using the OnCE address of the instruction currently on the instruction latch, as well as the addresses of the last 12 instructions that have been executed and are changes of flow. A user program can now reconstruct the flow of a full trace based on this information and on the original source code of the currently running program. 11.12.5 Displaying a Specified Register Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The DSP56300 must be in debug mode, and all actions described in Saving Pipeline Information on page 11-24 must have been executed. The sequence of actions follows: 1. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒWrite PDB with GO no-EXÓ. Pass through update-DR. 2. Select shift-DR. Shift in the 24-bit opcode: ÒMOVE reg, X:OGDBÓ. Pass through update-DR to write OPDBR and thus begin execution of the MOVE instruction. 3. Wait for DSP to reenter debug mode (i.e., wait for DE or poll core status). 4. Select shift-DR and shift in ÒREAD GDB REGISTERÓ. Pass through update-DR; this selects OGDBR as the data register to read. 5. Select shift-DR. Shift out the OGDBR contents. Pass through update-DR. Wait for the next command. 11.12.6 Displaying X Memory Area Starting at Address $xxxx The DSP56300 must be in Debug mode, and all actions explained in Saving Pipeline Information on page 11-24 must have been executed. Since R0 is used as a pointer for the memory, R0 is saved first. The sequence of actions to display X memory, starting at a specific address, is the following: 1. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒWrite PDB with GO no-EXÓ. Pass through update-DR. 2. Select shift-DR. Shift in the 24-bit opcode: ÒMOVE R0, X:OGDBÓ. Pass through update-DR to write OPDBR and thus begin execution of the MOVE instruction. 3. Wait for DSP to reenter debug mode (i.e., wait for DE or poll core status). 4. Select shift-DR and shift in ÒREAD GDB REGISTER.Ó Pass through update-DR; this step selects OGDBR as the data register to read. 5. Select shift-DR. Shift out the OGDBR contents. Pass through update-DR. R0 has now been saved. Not Recommended for New Design 11-26 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Examples of Using the OnCE 6. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒWrite PDB with no-GO no-EXÓ. Pass through update-DR. 7. Select shift-DR. Shift in the 24-bit opcode: ÒMOVE #$xxxx,R0Ó. Pass through update-DR to actually write OPDBR. 8. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒWrite PDB with GO no-EXÓ. Pass through update-DR. 9. Select shift-DR. Shift in the second word of the 24-bit opcode: ÒMOVE #$xxxx,R0Ó (the $xxxx field). Pass through update-DR to write OPDBR and execute the instruction. R0 is loaded with the base address of the memory block to be read. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 10. Wait for DSP to reenter debug mode (i.e., wait for DE or poll core status). 11. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒWrite PDB with GO no-EXÓ. Pass through update-DR. 12. Select shift-DR. Shift in the 24-bit opcode: ÒMOVE X:(R0)+, X:OGDBÓ. Pass through update-DR to write OPDBR and thus begin execution of the MOVE instruction. 13. Wait for DSP to reenter debug mode (i.e., wait for DE or poll core status). 14. Select shift-DR, and shift in ÒREAD GDB REGISTERÓ. Pass through update-DR; this step selects OGDBR as the data register to read. 15. Select shift-DR. Shift out the OGDBR contents. Pass through update-DR. The memory contents of address $xxxx have now been read. 16. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒNO SELECT with GO no-EXÓ. Pass through update-DR; this step re-executes the same ÒMOVE X:(R0)+, X:OGDBÓ instruction. 17. Repeat from Step 14 to finish reading the entire block. When you finish, restore the original value of R0. 11.12.7 Returning from Debug to Normal Mode (Same Program) To return to normal mode from debug mode, you must have finished examining the current state of the machine, changed some of the registers, and be ready to continue executing a program from the point where it stopped. Therefore, you must restore the pipeline of the machine and enable normal instruction execution, as follows: 1. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒWrite PDB with no-GO no-EXÓ. Pass through update-DR. 2. Select shift-DR. Shift in the 24 bits of saved PIL (instruction latch value). Pass through update-DR to write the instruction latch. 3. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒWrite PDB with GO and EXÓ. Pass through update-DR. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-27 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Examples of JTAG and OnCE interaction 4. Select shift-DR. Shift in the 24 bits of saved PDB. Pass through update-DR to actually write the PDB. At the same time as the internally saved value of the PAB is driven back from the PABFR onto the PAB, the ODEC releases the chip from debug mode, and the normal flow of execution continues. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 11.12.8 Returning from Debug to Normal Mode (New Program) To return to normal mode from debug mode, you must have finished examining the current state of the machine, changed some of the registers, and be ready to start executing a new program (the GOTO command). Therefore, you must force a change-of-flow to the starting address of the new program ($xxxx), as follows: 1. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒWrite PDB with no-GO no-EXÓ. Pass through update-DR. 2. Select shift-DR. Shift in the 24-bit $0AF080 (i.e., the opcode of the JUMP instruction). Pass through update-DR to write the Instruction Latch. 3. Select shift-DR. Shift in ÒWrite PDB-GO-TO with GO and EXÓ. Pass through update-DR. 4. Select shift-DR. Shift in the 16-bit $xxxx. Pass through update-DR to write the PDB. At this time, the ODEC releases the chip from Debug mode, and execution starts from the address $xxxx. Note: If Debug mode has been entered during a DO LOOP, REP instruction, or other special case (such as interrupt processing, STOP, WAIT, or conditional branching), it is mandatory that the user first resets the DSP56300 and only afterwards proceeds with execution of the new program. 11.13 EXAMPLES OF JTAG AND OnCE INTERACTION This subsection details interaction between the JTAG port and the OnCE module as well as the TMS sequencing needed to achieve the communication described in Examples of Using the OnCE on page 11-23. The external command controller forces the DSP56300 into debug mode by executing the JTAG instruction DEBUG_REQUEST. To check whether the DSP56300 has entered debug mode, the external command controller must poll the status by reading the OS[1:0] bits in the JTAG instruction shift register. The TMS sequencing to do so appears in Table 11-12. Not Recommended for New Design 11-28 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Examples of JTAG and OnCE interaction The sequence to enable the OnCE module appears in Table 11-13 on page 11-30. After executing the JTAG instructions DEBUG_REQUEST and ENABLE_ONCE, and after the core status has been polled to verify that the chip is in debug mode, you must save the pipeline. The TMS sequencing for this procedure appears in Table 11-14 on page 11-30. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 11-12 TMS Sequencing for DEBUG_REQUEST Step TMS JTAG Port OnCE Module a 0 Run-Test/Idle Idle b 1 Select-DR-Scan Idle c 1 Select-IR-Scan Idle d 0 Capture-IR Idle The status is sampled in the shifter. e 0 Shift-IR Idle The four bits of the JTAG DEBUG_REQUEST (0111) are shifted in while status is shifted out. .................................................................. Note e 0 Shift-IR Idle f 1 Exit1-IR Idle g 1 Update-IR Idle h 1 Select-DR-Scan Idle i 1 Select-IR-Scan Idle j 0 Capture-IR Idle The status is sampled in the shifter. k 0 Shift-IR Idle The four bits of the JTAG DEBUG_REQUEST (0111) are shifted in while status is shifted out .................................................................. k 0 Shift-IR Idle l 1 Exit1-IR Idle m 1 Update-IR Idle n 0 Run-Test/Idle Idle ................................................ n 0 Run-Test/Idle The debug request is generated. This step is repeated, enabling an external command controller to poll the status. Idle Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-29 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Examples of JTAG and OnCE interaction In step n, the external command controller verifies that the OS[1:0] bits have the value 11, indicating that the chip has entered debug mode. If the chip has not yet entered debug mode, the external command controller goes to step b, step c, etc., until debug mode is acknowledged. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table 11-13 TMS Sequencing for ENABLE_ONCE Step TMS JTAG Port OnCE Module a 1 Test-Logic-Reset Idle b 0 Run-Test/Idle Idle c 1 Select-DR-Scan Idle d 1 Select-IR-Scan Idle e 0 Capture-IR Idle The core status bits are captured. f 0 Shift-IR Idle g 0 Shift-IR Idle h 0 Shift-IR Idle The four bits of the JTAG ENABLE_ONCE instruction (0110) are shifted into the JTAG instruction register while status is shifted out. i 0 Shift-IR Idle j 1 Exit1-IR Idle k 1 Update-IR Idle The OnCE module is enabled. l 0 Run-Test/Idle Idle This step can be repeated, enabling an external command controller to poll the status. ................................................ l 0 Run-Test/Idle Note Idle Table 11-14 TMS Sequencing for Reading Pipeline Registers Step TMS JTAG Port OnCE Module a 0 Run-Test/Idle Idle b 1 Select-DR-Scan Idle c 0 Capture-DR Idle Note Not Recommended for New Design 11-30 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Examples of JTAG and OnCE interaction Table 11-14 TMS Sequencing for Reading Pipeline Registers (Continued) Step TMS JTAG Port OnCE Module Note d 0 Shift-DR Idle The eight bits of the OnCE command ÒRead PILÓ (10001011) are shifted in. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... .................................................................. d 0 Shift-DR Idle e 1 Exit1-DR Idle f 1 Update-DR Execute ÒRead PILÓ g 1 Select-DR-Scan Idle h 0 Capture-DR Idle i 0 Shift-DR Idle .................................................................. i 0 Shift-DR Idle j 1 Exit1-DR Idle k 1 Update-DR Idle l 1 Select-DR-Scan Idle m 0 Capture-DR Idle n 0 Shift-DR Idle .................................................................. n 0 Shift-DR Idle o 1 Exit1-DR Idle p 1 Update-DR Execute ÒRead PDBÓ q 1 Select-DR-Scan Idle r 0 Capture-DR Idle s 0 Shift-DR Idle .................................................................. s 0 Shift-DR The PIL value is loaded in the shifter. The 24 bits of the PIL are shifted out (24 steps). The eight bits of the OnCE command ÒRead PDBÓ (10001010) are shifted in. PDB value is loaded in shifter. The 24 bits of the PDB are shifted out (24 steps). Idle Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 11-31 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. On-Chip Emulation Module Examples of JTAG and OnCE interaction Table 11-14 TMS Sequencing for Reading Pipeline Registers (Continued) Step TMS JTAG Port OnCE Module t 1 Exit1-DR Idle u 1 Update-DR Idle v 0 Run-Test/Idle Idle ................................................ Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... v 0 Run-Test/Idle Idle Note This step can be repeated, enabling an external command controller to analyze the information. During step v, the external command controller stores the pipeline information, and afterwards it can proceed with the debug activities as requested by the user. Not Recommended for New Design 11-32 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SECTION 12 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... JOINT TEST ACTION GROUP PORT Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 12-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-3 JTAG SIGNALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-5 TAP CONTROLLER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-6 DSP56300 RESTRICTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-12 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 11.1 11.2 11.3 11.4 Not Recommended for New Design 12-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port Introduction to the JTAG Port 12.1 INTRODUCTION TO THE JTAG PORT Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The DSP56300 core provides a dedicated user-accessible TAP based on the IEEE 1149.1 Standard Test Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture. Problems associated with testing high density circuit boards led to the development of this standard under the sponsorship of the Test Technology Committee of IEEE and the JTAG. The DSP56300 core implementation supports circuit-board test strategies based on this standard. The test logic includes a TAP that consists of five dedicated signals, a 16-state controller, and three test data registers. (Figure 12-1 on page 12-4 shows a block diagram of the TAP port.) A boundary scan register (BSR) links all device signals into a single shift register. The test logic, implemented by static logic design, is independent of the device system logic. The DSP56300 core implementation provides the following capabilities: ¥ Performing boundary scan operations to test circuit-board electrical continuity (EXTEST). ¥ Bypassing the DSP56300 core for a given circuit-board test by effectively reducing the BSR to a single cell (BYPASS). ¥ Sampling the DSP56300 core-based device system signals during operation and transparently shifting out the result in the BSR. ¥ Preloading values to output signals prior to invoking the EXTEST instruction (SAMPLE/PRELOAD). ¥ Disabling the output drive to signals during circuit-board testing (HI-Z). ¥ Providing a means of accessing the OnCE controller and circuits to control a target system (ENABLE_ONCE). ¥ Providing a means of entering debug mode (DEBUG_REQUEST). ¥ Querying identification information (manufacturer, part number and version) from a DSP56300 core-based device (IDCODE). ¥ Forcing test data onto the outputs of a DSP56300 core-based device while replacing its boundary scan register in the serial data path with a single bit register (CLAMP). This section, which includes aspects of the JTAG implementation that are specific to the DSP56300 core, is intended for use with the supporting IEEE 1149.1 standard. The discussion includes those items required by the standard to be defined and, in certain cases, provides additional information specific to the DSP56300 core implementation. For internal details and applications of the standard, refer to the IEEE 1149.1 standard. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 12-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port JTAG Signals Boundary Scan Register TDI MUX Bypass Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ID Register OnCE Logic 3 2 1 0 4-Bit Instruction Register MUX Decoder TDO TMS TCK TAP Ctrl AA0113 TRST Figure 12-1 TAP Block Diagram 12.2 JTAG SIGNALS As described in the IEEE 1149.1 standard, the JTAG port requires a minimum of four signals to support TDI, TDO, TCK, and TMS signals. The DSP56300 family also provides Not Recommended for New Design 12-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port JTAG Signals the optional TRST signal. On the DSP56307, the debug event (DE) signal is provided for use by the OnCE module; it is documented in Section 11.3 Debug Event on page 11-3. The other signals are documented in the following paragraphs. 12.2.1 Test Clock (TCK) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The TCK input signal is used to synchronize the test logic. 12.2.2 Test Mode Select (TMS) The TMS input signal is used to sequence the state machine of the test controller. The TMS is sampled on the rising edge of TCK, and it has an internal pull-up resistor. 12.2.3 Test Data Input (TDI) Serial test instruction and data are received through the TDI signal. TDI is sampled on the rising edge of TCK, and it has an internal pull-up resistor. 12.2.4 Test Data Output (TDO) The TDO signal is the serial output for test instructions and data. TDO is tri-stateable and is actively driven in the shift-IR and shift-DR controller states. TDO changes on the falling edge of TCK. 12.2.5 Test Reset (TRST) The TRST input signal is used asynchronously to initialize the test controller. The TRST signal has an internal pull-up resistor. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 12-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port TAP Controller 12.3 TAP CONTROLLER Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The TAP controller is responsible for interpreting the sequence of logical values on the TMS signal. It is a synchronous state machine that controls the operation of JTAG logic. The state machine appears in Figure 12-2. The TAP controller responds to changes at the TMS and TCK signals. Transitions from one state to another occur on the rising edge of the TCK signal. The value shown adjacent to each state transition represents the value of the TMS signal sampled on the rising edge of the TCK signal. For a description of the TAP controller states, refer to the IEEE 1149.1 standard. Test-Logic-Reset 1 0 Run-Test/Idle 1 Select-DR-Scan 0 1 Select-IR-Scan 0 1 0 1 Capture-DR Capture-IR 0 0 Shift-DR Shift-IR 0 1 0 1 1 1 Exit1-DR Exit1-IR 0 0 Pause-IR Pause-DR 0 1 0 Exit2-DR 0 1 0 Exit2-IR 1 1 Update-DR 1 1 0 Update-IR 1 0 AA0114 Figure 12-2 TAP Controller State Machine Not Recommended for New Design 12-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port TAP Controller 12.3.1 Boundary Scan Register The BSR in the DSP56307 JTAG implementation contains bits for all device signals, clock signals, and associated control signals. All DSP56307 bidirectional signals have a single register bit in the BSR for signal data and are controlled by an associated control bit in the BSR. The DSP56307 BSR bit definitions are listed in Table 12-2 on page 12-13. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 12.3.2 Instruction Register The DSP56307 JTAG implementation includes the three mandatory public instructions (EXTEST, SAMPLE/PRELOAD, and BYPASS); it also supports the optional CLAMP instruction defined by IEEE 1149.1. Using the HI-Z public instruction, it possible to disable all device output drivers. The ENABLE_ONCE public instruction enables the JTAG port to communicate with the OnCE circuitry. The DEBUG_REQUEST public instruction enables the JTAG port to force the DSP56300 core into debug mode. The DSP56300 core includes a 4-bit instruction register without parity consisting of a shift register with four parallel outputs. Data is transferred from the shift register to the parallel outputs during the update-IR controller state. Figure 12-3 shows the JTAG instruction register. JTAG Instruction Register (IR) B3 B2 B1 B0 AA0746 Figure 12-3 JTAG Instruction Register The four bits are used to decode the eight unique instructions shown in Table 12-1. All other encodings are reserved for future enhancements and are decoded as BYPASS. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 12-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port TAP Controller Table 12-1 JTAG Instructions Code Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Instruction B3 B2 B1 B0 0 0 0 0 EXTEST 0 0 0 1 SAMPLE/PRELOAD 0 0 1 0 IDCODE 0 0 1 1 CLAMP 0 1 0 0 HI-Z 0 1 0 1 RESERVED 0 1 1 0 ENABLE_ONCE 0 1 1 1 DEBUG_REQUEST 1 0 x x RESERVED 1 1 0 x RESERVED 1 1 1 0 RESERVED 1 1 1 1 BYPASS The parallel output of the instruction register is reset to 0010 in the test-logic-reset controller state, equivalent to the IDCODE instruction. In the capture-IR controller state, the parallel inputs to the instruction shift register are loaded with 01 in the LSBs as required by the standard. The two MSBs are loaded with the values of the core status bits OS1 and OS0 from the OnCE controller. See Section 11.4 OnCE Controller on page 11-4 for a description of the status bits. 12.3.2.1 EXTEST (B[3:0] = 0000) The external test (EXTEST) instruction selects the BSR. EXTEST also asserts internal reset for the DSP56300 core system logic to force a predictable internal state while it performs external boundary scan operations. By using the TAP, the BSR is capable of the following: ¥ Scanning user-defined values into the output buffers ¥ Capturing values presented to input signals Not Recommended for New Design 12-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port TAP Controller ¥ Controlling the direction of bidirectional signals ¥ Controlling the output drive of tri-stateable output signals For more details about the function and use of the EXTEST instruction, refer to the IEEE 1149.1 standard. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 12.3.2.2 SAMPLE/PRELOAD (B[3:0] = 0001) The SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction provides two separate functions. First, it can make a snapshot of system data and control signals. The snapshot occurs on the rising edge of TCK in the capture-DR controller state. You can then scrutinize the data by shifting it transparently through the BSR. Since there is no internal synchronization between the JTAG clock (TCK) and the system clock (CLK), you must provide some form of external synchronization to achieve meaningful results. Note: The second function of the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction is to initialize the BSR output cells prior to selection of EXTEST. This insures that known data appear on the outputs when the EXTEST instruction is entered. 12.3.2.3 IDCODE (B[3:0] = 0010) The IDCODE instruction selects the ID register. It is provided as a public instruction to allow the manufacturer, part number, and version of a component to be determined through the TAP. Figure 12-4 shows the ID register configuration. 31 28 27 Version Information 0000 17 16 22 21 12 11 Manufacturer Identity Customer Part Number Design Center Number Core Number Chip Derivative Number 000110 00000 00011 1 0 1 00000001110 1 AA0718 Figure 12-4 JTAG ID Register One application of the ID register is to distinguish the manufacturer(s) of components on a multiply sourced board. As more components emerge which conform to the IEEE 1149.1 standard, a system diagnostic controller unit can thus interrogate a board design blindly in order to determine the type of each component in each location. This Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 12-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port TAP Controller information is also available for factory process monitoring and for failure mode analysis of assembled boards. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... MotorolaÕs manufacturer identity is 00000001110. The customer part number consists of two parts: the Motorola design center number (bits 27:22) and a sequence number (bits 21:12). The sequence number is divided into two parts: core number (bits 21:17) and chip derivative number (bits 16:12). Motorola Semiconductor IsraeL (MSIL) design center number is 000110, and the DSP56300 core number is 00001. Once the IDCODE instruction is decoded, it selects the ID register (a 32-bit data register). The BYPASS register loads a logical 0 at the start of a scan cycle, whereas the ID register loads a logical 1 into its LSB. Therefore, examination of the first bit of data shifted out of a component during a test data scan sequence and immediately following exit from test-logic-reset controller state shows whether such a register is included in the design. When the IDCODE instruction is selected, the operation of the test logic has no effect on the operation of the on-chip system logic, as required by the IEEE 1149.1 standard. 12.3.2.4 CLAMP (B[3:0] = 0011) The CLAMP instruction is not included in the IEEE 1149.1 standard. It is provided as a public instruction that selects the 1-bit BYPASS register as the serial path between TDI and TDO while allowing signals driven from the component signals to be determined from the BSR. While testing integrated circuits on printed circuit boards, it may be necessary to place static guarding values on signals that control operation of logic not involved in the test. The EXTEST instruction could be used for this purpose, but since it selects the boundary scan register, the required guarding signals would be loaded as part of the complete serial data stream shifted in, both at the start of the test and each time a new test pattern is entered. Since the CLAMP instruction allows guarding values to be applied using the boundary scan register of the appropriate integrated circuits when their bypass registers are selected, it allows much faster testing than does the EXTEST instruction. Data in the boundary scan cell remains unchanged until a new instruction is shifted in or the JTAG state machine is reset. The CLAMP instruction also asserts internal reset for the DSP56300 core system logic to force a predictable internal state while external boundary scan operations are performed. 12.3.2.5 HI-Z (B[3:0] = 0100) The HI-Z instruction is not included in the IEEE 1149.1 standard. It is provided as a manufacturerÕs optional public instruction to prevent having to backdrive the output signals during circuit-board testing. When HI-Z is invoked, all output drivers, including the two-state drivers, are turned off (i.e., high impedance). The instruction selects the BYPASS register. The HI-Z instruction also asserts internal reset for the DSP56300 core system logic to force a predictable internal state while performing external boundary scan operations Not Recommended for New Design 12-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port TAP Controller Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 12.3.2.6 ENABLE_ONCE(B[3:0] = 0110) The ENABLE_ONCE instruction is not included in the IEEE 1149.1 standard. It is provided as a public instruction to allow the user to perform system debug functions. When the ENABLE_ONCE instruction is decoded the TDI and TDO signals are connected directly to the OnCE registers. The particular OnCE register connected between TDI and TDO at a given time is selected by the OnCE controller depending on the OnCE instruction currently being executed. All communication with the OnCE controller is done through the Select-DR-Scan path of the JTAG TAP controller. See Section 11 On-Chip Emulation Module for more information about OnCE. 12.3.2.7 DEBUG_REQUEST(B[3:0] = 0111) The DEBUG_REQUEST instruction is not included in the IEEE 1149.1 standard. It is provided as a public instruction to allow the user to generate a debug request signal to the DSP56300 core. When the DEBUG_REQUEST instruction is decoded, the TDI and TDO signals are connected to the instruction registers. Due to the fact that in the capture-IR state of the TAP the OnCE status bits are captured in the Instruction shift register, the external JTAG controller must continue to shift-in the DEBUG_REQUEST instruction while polling the status bits that are shifted-out until debug mode is entered (acknowledged by the combination 11 on OS1ÐOS0). After the acknowledgment of debug mode is received, the external JTAG controller must issue the ENABLE_ONCE instruction to allow the user to perform system debug functions. 12.3.2.8 BYPASS (B[3:0] = 1111) The BYPASS instruction selects the single-bit BYPASS register, as shown in Figure 12-5. This creates a shift-register path from TDI to the BYPASS register, and finally to TDO, circumventing the BSR. This instruction is used to enhance test efficiency when a component other than the DSP56300 core-based device becomes the device under test. When the BYPASS register is selected by the current instruction, the shift-register state is set to a logical 0 on the rising edge of TCK in the capture-DR controller state. Therefore, the first bit shifted out after selecting the BYPASS register is always a logical 0. Shift DR 0 From TDI G1 1 1 Mux D C CLOCKDR To TDO AA0115 Figure 12-5 BYPASS Register Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 12-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port DSP56300 Restrictions 12.4 DSP56300 RESTRICTIONS Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The control afforded by the output enable signals using the BSR and the EXTEST instruction requires a compatible circuit-board test environment to avoid device-destructive configurations. The user must avoid situations in which the DSP56300 core output drivers are enabled into actively driven networks. In addition, the EXTEST instruction can be performed only after a power-up or regular hardware RESET signal while EXTAL is provided. Then, during the execution of EXTEST, EXTAL can remain inactive. There are two constraints related to the JTAG interface. First, the TCK input does not include an internal pull-up resistor and should not be left unconnected. Secondly, the JTAG test logic must be kept transparent to the system logic by forcing the TAP into the test-logic-reset controller state, using either of two methods. During power-up, TRST must be externally asserted to force the TAP controller into this state. After power-up is concluded, TMS must be sampled as a logical 1 for five consecutive TCK rising edges. If TMS either remains unconnected or is connected to VCC, then the TAP controller cannot leave the test-logic-reset state, regardless of the state of TCK. The DSP56300 core features a low-power stop mode; that mode is invoked by the STOP instruction. The JTAG interface interacts with low-power stop mode like this: ¥ The TAP controller must be in the test-logic-reset state to enter or to remain in low-power stop mode. To leave the TAP controller test-logic-reset state negates the ability to achieve low-power, but does not otherwise affect device functionality. ¥ The TCK input is not blocked in low-power stop mode. To consume minimal power, the TCK input should be externally connected to VCC or GND. ¥ The TMS and TDI signals include on-chip pull-up resistors. In low-power stop mode, these two signals should remain either unconnected or connected to VCC to achieve minimal power consumption. All DSP56307 core clocks are disabled during stop mode; consequently, the JTAG interface provides a means of polling the device status (sampled in the capture-IR state). Not Recommended for New Design 12-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port DSP56307 Boundary Scan Register 12.5 DSP56307 BOUNDARY SCAN REGISTER Table 12-2 provides a listing of the contents of the BSR for the DSP56307. Table 12-2 DSP56306 BSR Bit Definitions Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Bit # Pin Name Pin Type BSR Cell Type IRQA Input IRQB Bit # Pin Name Pin Type BSR Cell Type Data RES Input Data Input Data HAD0 Ñ Control IRQC Input Data HAD0 Input/Output Data IRQD Input Data HAD1 Ñ Control D23 Input/Output Data HAD1 Input/Output Data D22 Input/Output Data HAD2 Ñ Control D21 Input/Output Data HAD2 Input/Output Data D20 Input/Output Data HAD3 Ñ Control D19 Input/Output Data HAD3 Input/Output Data D18 Input/Output Data HAD4 Ñ Control D17 Input/Output Data HAD4 Input/Output Data D16 Input/Output Data HAD5 Ñ Control D15 Input/Output Data HAD5 Input/Output Data D[23:13] Ñ Control HAD6 Ñ Control D14 Input/Output Data HAD6 Input/Output Data D13 Input/Output Data HAD7 Ñ Control D12 Input/Output Data HAD7 Input/Output Data D11 Input/Output Data HAS/A0 Ñ Control D10 Input/Output Data HAS/A0 Input/Output Data D9 Input/Output Data HA8/A1 Ñ Control D8 Input/Output Data HA8/A1 Input/Output Data D7 Input/Output Data HA9/A2 Ñ Control D6 Input/Output Data HA9/A2 Input/Output Data D5 Input/Output Data HCS/A10 Ñ Control Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 12-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port DSP56307 Boundary Scan Register Table 12-2 DSP56306 BSR Bit Definitions (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Bit # Pin Name Pin Type BSR Cell Type D4 Input/Output D3 Bit # Pin Name Pin Type BSR Cell Type Data HCS/A10 Input/Output Data Input/Output Data TIO0 Ñ Control D[12:0] Ñ Control TIO0 Input/Output Data D2 Input/Output Data TIO1 Ñ Control D1 Input/Output Data TIO1 Input/Output Data D0 Input/Output Data TIO2 Ñ Control A17 Tri-State Data TIO2 Input/Output Data A16 Tri-State Data HREQ/TRQ Ñ Control A15 Tri-State Data HREQ/TRQ Input/Output Data A[17:9] Ñ Control HACK/RRQ Ñ Control A14 Tri-State Data A13 Tri-State Data HRW/RD Ñ Control A12 Tri-State Data HRW/RD Input/Output Data A11 Tri-State Data HDS/WR Ñ Control A10 Tri-State Data HDS/WR Input/Output Data A9 Tri-State Data SCK0 Ñ Control A8 Tri-State Data SCK0 Input/Output Data A7 Tri-State Data SCK1 Ñ Control A6 Tri-State Data SCK1 Input/Output Data A[8:0] Ñ Control SCLK Ñ Control A5 Tri-State Data SCLK Input/Output Data A4 Tri-State Data TXD Ñ Control A3 Tri-State Data TXD Input/Output Data A2 Tri-State Data RXD Ñ Control A1 Tri-State Data RXD Input/Output Data A0 Tri-State Data SC00 Ñ Control BG Input Data SC00 Input/Output Data HACK/RRQ Input/Output Data Not Recommended for New Design 12-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port DSP56307 Boundary Scan Register Table 12-2 DSP56306 BSR Bit Definitions (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Bit # Pin Name Pin Type BSR Cell Type AA0 Tri-State AA1 Bit # Pin Name Pin Type BSR Cell Type Data SC10 Ñ Control Tri-State Data SC10 Input/Output Data RD Tri-State Data STD0 Ñ Control WR Tri-State Data STD0 Input/Output Data AA0 Ñ Control SRD0 Ñ Control AA1 Ñ Control SRD0 Input/Output Data BB Ñ Control PINIT Input Data BB Input/Output Data DE Ñ Control BR Output Data DE Input/Output Data TA Input Data SC01 Ñ Control BCLK Tri-State Data SC01 Input/Output Data BCLK Tri-State Data SC02 Ñ Control CLKOUT Output Data SC02 Input/Output Data RD,WR,BCLK, BCLK,BS Ñ Control STD1 Ñ Control CAS Ñ Control STD1 Input/Output Data AA2 Ñ Control SRD1 Ñ Control AA3 Ñ Control SRD1 Input/Output Data EXTAL Input Data SC11 Ñ Control CAS Tri-State Data SC11 Input/Output Data AA2 Tri-State Data SC12 Ñ Control AA3 Tri-State Data SC12 Input/Output Data Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com 12-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Joint Test Action Group Port Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 Boundary Scan Register Not Recommended for New Design 12-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. APPENDIX A Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... BOOTSTRAP PROGRAMS ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; BOOTSTRAP CODE FOR DSP56307- (C) Copyright 1997 Motorola Inc. Revised March, 18 1997. Bootstrap through the Host Interface, External EPROM or SCI. This is the Bootstrap program contained in the DSP56307 192-word Boot ROM. This program can load any program RAM segment from an external EPROM, from the Host Interface or from the SCI serial interface. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com A-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Bootstrap Programs Not Recommended for New Design A-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Bootstrap Programs ; BOOTSTRAP CODE FOR DSP56307 - (C) Copyright 1997 Motorola Inc. ; Revised March, 18 1997. ; ; Bootstrap through the Host Interface, External EPROM or SCI. ; ; This is the Bootstrap program contained in the DSP56307 192-word Boot ; ROM. This program can load any program RAM segment from an external ; EPROM, from the Host Interface or from the SCI serial interface. ; ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ; If MD:MC:MB:MA=x000, then the Boot ROM is bypassed and the DSP56302A ; will start fetching instructions beginning with address $C00000 (MD=0) ; or $008000 (MD=1) assuming that an external memory of SRAM type is ; used. The accesses will be performed using 31 wait states with no ; address attributes selected (default area). ; ; ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ; Operation modes MD:MC:MB:MA=0001-0111 are reserved. ; ; ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ; If MD:MC:MB:MA=1001, then it loads a program RAM segment from consecutive ; byte-wide P memory locations, starting at P:$D00000 (bits 7-0). ; The memory is selected by the Address Attribute AA1 and is accessed with ; 31 wait states. ; The EPROM bootstrap code expects to read 3 bytes ; specifying the number of program words, 3 bytes specifying the address ; to start loading the program words and then 3 bytes for each program ; word to be loaded. The number of words, the starting address and the ; program words are read least significant byte first followed by the ; mid and then by the most significant byte. ; The program words will be condensed into 24-bit words and stored in ; contiguous PRAM memory locations starting at the specified starting address. ; After reading the program words, program execution starts from the same ; address where loading started. ; ; ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ; If MD:MC:MB:MA=1010, then it loads the program RAM from the SCI interface. ; The number of program words to be loaded and the starting address must ; be specified. The SCI bootstrap code expects to receive 3 bytes ; specifying the number of program words, 3 bytes specifying the address ; to start loading the program words and then 3 bytes for each program ; word to be loaded. The number of words, the starting address and the ; program words are received least significant byte first followed by the ; mid and then by the most significant byte. After receiving the ; program words, program execution starts in the same address where ; loading started. The SCI is programmed to work in asynchronous mode ; with 8 data bits, 1 stop bit and no parity. The clock source is ; external and the clock frequency must be 16x the baud rate. ; After each byte is received, it is echoed back through the SCI ; transmitter. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com A-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Bootstrap Programs ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ; Operation mode MD:MC:MB:MA=1011 is reserved. ; ; ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ; If MD:MC:MB:MA=1100, then it loads the program RAM from the Host ; Interface programmed to operate in the ISA mode. ; The HOST ISA bootstrap code expects to read a 24-bit word ; specifying the number of program words, a 24-bit word specifying the address ; to start loading the program words and then a 24-bit word for each program ; word to be loaded. The program words will be stored in ; contiguous PRAM memory locations starting at the specified starting address. ; After reading the program words, program execution starts from the same ; address where loading started. ; The Host Interface bootstrap load program may be stopped by ; setting the Host Flag 0 (HF0). This will start execution of the loaded ; program from the specified starting address. ; ; ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ; If MD:MC:MB:MA=1101, then it loads the program RAM from the Host ; Interface programmed to operate in the HC11 non multiplexed mode. ; ; The HOST HC11 bootstrap code expects to read a 24-bit word ; specifying the number of program words, a 24-bit word specifying the address ; to start loading the program words and then a 24-bit word for each program ; word to be loaded. The program words will be stored in ; contiguous PRAM memory locations starting at the specified starting address. ; After reading the program words, program execution starts from the same ; address where loading started. ; The Host Interface bootstrap load program may be stopped by ; setting the Host Flag 0 (HF0). This will start execution of the loaded ; program from the specified starting address. ; ; ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ; If MD:MC:MB:MA=1110, then it loads the program RAM from the Host ; Interface programmed to operate in the 8051 multiplexed bus mode, ; in double-strob pin configuration. ; The HOST 8051 bootstrap code expects accesses that are byte wide. ; The HOST 8051 bootstrap code expects to read 3 bytes forming a 24-bit word ; specifying the number of program words, 3 bytes forming a 24-bit word ; specifying the address to start loading the program words and then 3 bytes ; forming 24-bit words for each program word to be loaded. ; The program words will be stored in contiguous PRAM memory locations ; starting at the specified starting address. ; After reading the program words, program execution starts from the same ; address where loading started. ; The Host Interface bootstrap load program may be stopped by setting the ; Host Flag 0 (HF0). This will start execution of the loaded program from ; the specified starting address. ; ; The base address of the HI08 in multiplexed mode is 0x80 and is not Not Recommended for New Design A-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Bootstrap Programs ; modified by the bootstrap code. All the address lines are enabled ; and should be connected accordingly. ; ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ; If MD:MC:MB:MA=1111, then it loads the program RAM from the Host ; Interface programmed to operate in the MC68302 (IMP) bus mode, ; in single-strob pin configuration. ; The HOST MC68302 bootstrap code expects accesses that are byte wide. ; The HOST MC68302 bootstrap code expects to read 3 bytes forming a 24-bit word ; specifying the number of program words, 3 bytes forming a 24-bit word ; specifying the address to start loading the program words and then 3 bytes ; forming 24-bit words for each program word to be loaded. ; The program words will be stored in contiguous PRAM memory locations ; starting at the specified starting address. ; After reading the program words, program execution starts from the same ; address where loading started. ; The Host Interface bootstrap load program may be stopped by setting the ; Host Flag 0 (HF0). This will start execution of the loaded program from ; the specified starting address. ; ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; MEMORY EQUATES ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; page 132,55,0,0,0 opt mex EQUALDATA equ 1 ;; 1 if xram and yram are of equal ;; size and addresses, 0 otherwise. if start_dram length_dram else start_xram length_xram start_yram length_yram endif (EQUALDATA) equ 0 equ $1C00 equ equ equ equ 0 $1C00 0 $1C00 ;; 7k XRAM start_pram length_pram equ equ 0 $5000 ;; 20k PRAM ;; 7k X and Y RAM ;; same addresses ;; 7k YRAM ;; ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; GENERAL EQUATES ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ;; BOOT equ $D00000 AARV equ $D00409 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; this is the location in P memory on the external memory bus where the external byte-wide EPROM would be located AAR1 selects the EPROM as CE~ mapped as P from $D00000 to $DFFFFF, active low Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com A-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Bootstrap Programs Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ;; ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; DSP I/O REGISTERS ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ;; M_OGDB M_PDRC M_PRRC M_SSR M_STXL M_SRXL M_SCCR M_SCR M_PCRE M_AAR1 M_HPCR M_HSR M_HRX HRDF HF0 HEN SCK0 EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFFFC $FFFFBD $FFFFBE $FFFF93 $FFFF95 $FFFF98 $FFFF9B $FFFF9C $FFFF9F $FFFFF8 $FFFFC4 $FFFFC3 $FFFFC6 $0 $3 $6 $3 ;; OnCE GDB Register ;; Port C GPIO Data Register ;; Port C Direction Register ; SCI Status Register ; SCI Transmit Data Register (low) ; SCI Receive Data Register (low) ; SCI Clock Control Register ; SCI Control Register ; Port E Control register ; Address Attribute Register 1 ; Host Port Control Register ; Host Status Rgister ; Host Recceive Register ; Host Receive Data Full ; Host Flag 0 ; Host Enable ;; SCK0 is bit #3 as GPIO ORG PL:$ff0000,PL:$ff0000 ; bootstrap code starts at $ff0000 START clr a #$0,r5 jclr #3,omr,OMR0XXX jclr #2,omr,EPRSCILD jclr #1,omr,OMR1IS0 jclr #0,omr,I8051HOSTLD ; ; ; ; ; ; clear a and init r5=0 If MD:MC:MB:MA=0xxx, go to OMR0XXX If MD:MC:MB:MA=10xx, load from EPROM/SCI IF MD:MC:MB:MA=110x, look for ISA/HC11 If MD:MC:MB:MA=1110, load from 8051 Host If MD:MC:MB:MA=1111, load from MC68302 Host ;======================================================================== ; This is the routine which loads a program through the HI08 host port ; The program is downloaded from the host MCU with the following rules: ; 1) 3 bytes - Define the program length. ; 2) 3 bytes - Define the address to which to start loading the program to. ; 3) 3n bytes (while n is any integer number) ; The program words will be stroed in contiguous PRAM memory locations starting ; at the specified starting address. ; After reading the program words, program execution starts from the same ; address where loading started. ; The host MCU may terminate the loading process by setting the HF1=0 and HF0=1. ; When the downloading is terminated, the program will start execution of the ; loaded program from the specified starting address. ; The HI08 boot ROM program enables the following busses to download programs ; through the HI08 port: ; ; 1 - ISA - Dual strobes non-multiplexed bus with negative strobe ; pulses duale positive request ; 2 - HC11 - Single strobe non-multiplexed bus with positive strobe Not Recommended for New Design A-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Bootstrap Programs ; pulse single negative request. ; 4 - i8051 - Dual strobes multiplexed bus with negative strobe pulses ; dual negative request. ; 5 - MC68302 - Single strobe non-multiplexed bus with negative strobe ; pulse single negative request. ;======================================================================== Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... MC68302HOSTLD movep bra #%0000000000111000,x:M_HPCR ; Configure ; HAP = 0 ; HRP = 0 ; HCSP = 0 ; HD/HS = 0 ; HMUX = 0 ; HASP = 0 ; ; HDSP = 0 ; HROD = 0 ; spare = 0 ; ; HEN = 0 ; ; HAEN = 1 ; HREN = 1 ; HCSEN = 1 ; HA9EN = 0 ; ; HA8EN = 0 ; ; HGEN = 0 <HI08CONT the following conditions: Negative host acknowledge Negative host request Negatice chip select input Single strobe bus (R/W~ and DS) Non multiplexed bus (address strobe polarity has no meaning in non-multiplexed bus) Negative data stobes polarity Host request is active when enabled This bit should be set to 0 for future compatability When the HPCR register is modified HEN should be cleared Host acknowledge is enabled Host requests are enabled Host chip select input enabled (address 9 enable bit has no meaning in non-multiplexed bus) (address 8 enable bit has no meaning in non-multiplexed bus) Host GPIO pins are disabled OMR1IS0 jset #0,omr,HC11HOSTLD ; If MD:MC:MB:MA=1101, go load from HC11 Host ; If MD:MC:MB:MA=1100, go load from ISA HOST ISAHOSTLD movep #%0101000000011000,x:M_HPCR ; Configure ; HAP = 0 ; HRP = 1 ; HCSP = 0 ; HD/HS = 1 ; HMUX = 0 ; HASP = 0 ; ; HDSP = 0 ; HROD = 0 ; spare = 0 ; ; HEN = 0 ; ; HAEN = 0 the following conditions: Negative host acknowledge Positive host request Negatice chip select input Dual strobes bus (RD and WR) Non multiplexed bus (address strobe polarity has no meaning in non-multiplexed bus) Negative data stobes polarity Host request is active when enabled This bit should be set to 0 for future compatability When the HPCR register is modified HEN should be cleared Host acknowledge is disabled Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com A-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Bootstrap Programs ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... bra HC11HOSTLD movep bra I8051HOSTLD movep HREN = 1 Host requests are enabled HCSEN = 1 Host chip select input enabled HA9EN = 0 (address 9 enable bit has no meaning in non-multiplexed bus) HA8EN = 0 (address 8 enable bit has no meaning non-multiplexed bus) HGEN = 0 Host GPIO pins are disabled <HI08CONT #%0000001000011000,x:M_HPCR ; Configure ; HAP = 0 ; HRP = 0 ; HCSP = 0 ; HD/HS = 0 ; HMUX = 0 ; HASP = 0 ; ; HDSP = 1 ; HROD = 0 ; spare = 0 ; ; HEN = 0 ; ; HAEN = 0 ; HREN = 1 ; HCSEN = 1 ; HA9EN = 0 ; ; HA8EN = 0 ; ; HGEN = 0 <HI08CONT #%0001110000011110,x:M_HPCR ; Configure ; HAP = 0 ; HRP = 0 ; HCSP = 0 ; HD/HS = 1 ; HMUX = 1 ; HASP = 1 ; HDSP = 0 ; HROD = 0 ; spare = 0 ; ; HEN = 0 ; ; HAEN = 0 ; HREN = 1 ; HCSEN = 1 ; HA9EN = 1 ; HA8EN = 1 the following conditions: Negative host acknowledge Negative host request Negatice chip select input Single strobe bus (R/W~ and DS) Non multiplexed bus (address strobe polarity has no meaning in non-multiplexed bus) Negative data stobes polarity Host request is active when enabled This bit should be set to 0 for future compatability When the HPCR register is modified HEN should be cleared Host acknowledge is disabled Host requests are enabled Host chip select input enabled (address 9 enable bit has no meaning in non-multiplexed bus) (address 8 enable bit has no meaning in non-multiplexed bus) Host GPIO pins are disabled the following conditions: Negative host acknowledge Negatice host request Negatice chip select input Dual strobes bus (RD and WR) Multiplexed bus Positive address strobe polarity Negative data stobes polarity Host request is active when enabled This bit should be set to 0 for future compatability When the HPCR register is modified HEN should be cleared Host acknowledge is disabled Host requests are enabled Host chip select input enabled Enable address 9 input Enable address 8 input Not Recommended for New Design A-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Bootstrap Programs ; HGEN = 0 Host GPIO pins are disabled Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... HI08CONT bset #HEN,x:M_HPCR ; ; ; ; jclr #HRDF,x:M_HSR,* movep jclr x:M_HRX,a0 #HRDF,x:M_HSR,* movep move do x:M_HRX,r0 r0,r1 a0,HI08LOOP jset #HRDF,x:M_HSR,HI08NW jclr #HF0,x:M_HSR,HI08LL enddo bra <HI08LOOP movep x:M_HRX,p:(r0)+ Enable the HI08 to operate as host interface (set HEN=1) wait for the program length to be written ; wait for the program starting address ; to be written ; set a loop with the downloaded length HI08LL ; ; ; ; ; If new word was loaded then jump to read that word If HF0=0 then continue with the downloading Must terminate the do loop HI08NW ; Move the new word into its destination ; location in the program RAM ; pipeline delay nop HI08LOOP bra <FINISH ;======================================================================== EPRSCILD jclr #1,omr,EPROMLD ; If MD:MC:MB:MA=1001, go load from EPROM ; jset #0,omr,SCILD ; If MD:MC:MB:MA=1011, reserved, default to SCI ;======================================================================== ; This is the routine that loads from the SCI. ; MD:MC:MB:MA=1010 - external SCI clock SCILD movep #$0302,X:M_SCR movep #$C000,X:M_SCCR movep #7,X:M_PCRE ; Configure SCI Control Reg ; Configure SCI Clock Control Reg ; Configure SCLK, TXD and RXD do #6,_LOOP6 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; jclr #2,X:M_SSR,* movep X:M_SRXL,A2 jclr #1,X:M_SSR,* movep A2,X:M_STXL asr #8,a,a get 3 bytes for number of program words and 3 bytes for the starting address Wait for RDRF to go high Put 8 bits in A2 Wait for TDRE to go high echo the received byte _LOOP6 move a1,r0 move a1,r1 ; starting address for load ; save starting address do a0,_LOOP7 ; Receive program words Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com A-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Bootstrap Programs do #3,_LOOP8 jclr #2,X:M_SSR,* movep X:M_SRXL,A2 jclr #1,X:M_SSR,* movep a2,X:M_STXL asr #8,a,a ; ; ; ; movem a1,p:(r0)+ nop ; Store 24-bit result in P mem. ; pipeline delay bra <FINISH ; Boot from SCI done Wait for RDRF to go high Put 8 bits in A2 Wait for TDRE to go high echo the received byte _LOOP8 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... _LOOP7 ;======================================================================== ; This is the routine that loads from external EPROM. ; MD:MC:MB:MA=1001 EPROMLD move #BOOT,r2 movep #AARV,X:M_AAR1 ; r2 = address of external EPROM ; aar1 configured for SRAM types of access do #6,_LOOP9 movem p:(r2)+,a2 asr #8,a,a ; ; ; ; ; ; ; _LOOP9 move a1,r0 move a1,r1 read number of words and starting address Get the 8 LSB from ext. P mem. Shift 8 bit data into A1 starting address for load save it in r1 a0 holds the number of words do a0,_LOOP10 do #3,_LOOP11 movem p:(r2)+,a2 asr #8,a,a ; read program words ; Each instruction has 3 bytes ; Get the 8 LSB from ext. P mem. ; Shift 8 bit data into A1 _LOOP11 ; Go get another byte. movem a1,p:(r0)+ ; Store 24-bit result in P mem. nop ; pipeline delay _LOOP10 ; and go get another 24-bit word. ; Boot from EPROM done ;======================================================================== FINISH ; This is the exit handler that returns execution to normal ; expanded mode and jumps to the RESET vector. andi #$0,ccr ; Clear CCR as if RESET to 0. jmp (r1) ; Then go to starting Prog addr. ;======================================================================== Not Recommended for New Design A-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. APPENDIX B Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... EQUATES ;***************************************************************************** ; ; EQUATES for DSP56307 I/O registers and ports ; ; Last update: June 11 1998 ; ;***************************************************************************** page opt ioequ ident 132,55,0,0,0 mex 1,0 ;------------------------------------------------------------------------ Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com B-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Equates B.1 B.2 B.4 B.4 B.5 B.6 B.7 B.8 B.9 B.10 I/O EQUATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3 HI08 EQUATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-3 ESSI EQUATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-7 ESSI EQUATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-7 EXCEPTION PROCESSING EQUATES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-9 TIMER MODULE EQUATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-10 DMA EQUATES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-11 PLL EQUATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-14 BIU EQUATES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-14 INTERRUPT EQUATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B-16 Not Recommended for New Design B-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... B.1 I/O EQUATES ;*********************************************************************** ; ; EQUATES for 56307 I/O registers and ports ; Reference: Specifications Revision 3.00 ; + 56307 spec rev 1.2 ;*********************************************************************** ;---------------------------------------------------------------------; ; EQUATES for I/O Port Programming ; ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; Register Addresses M_DATH M_DIRH M_PCRC M_PRRC M_PDRC M_PCRD M_PRRD M_PDRD M_PCRE M_PRRE M_PDRE M_OGDB EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFFCF $FFFFCE $FFFFBF $FFFFBE $FFFFBD $FFFFAF $FFFFAE $FFFFAD $FFFF9F $FFFF9E $FFFF9D $FFFFFC ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; B.2 HI08 EQUATES Host Host Port Port Port Port Port Port Port Port Port OnCE port GPIO data Register port GPIO direction Register C Control Register C Direction Register C GPIO Data Register D Control register D Direction Data Register D GPIO Data Register E Control register E Direction Register E Data Register GDB Register ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; ; EQUATES for Host Interface ; ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; M_DTXS M_DTXM M_DRXR M_DPSR M_DSR M_DPAR M_DPMC M_DPCR M_DCTR Register Addresses EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFFCD $FFFFCC $FFFFCB $FFFFCA $FFFFC9 $FFFFC8 $FFFFC7 $FFFFC6 $FFFFC5 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; DSP DSP DSP DSP DSP DSP DSP DSP DSP SLAVE TRANSMIT DATA FIFO (DTXS) MASTER TRANSMIT DATA FIFO (DTXM) RECEIVE DATA FIFO (DRXR) PCI STATUS REGISTER (DPSR) STATUS REGISTER (DSR) PCI ADDRESS REGISTER (DPAR) PCI MASTER CONTROL REGSTER (DPMC) PCI CONTROL REGISTER (DPCR) CONTROL REGISTER (DCTR) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com B-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ; M_HCIE M_STIE M_SRIE M_HF35 M_HF3 M_HF4 M_HF5 M_HINT M_HDSM M_HRWP M_HTAP M_HDRP M_HRSP M_HIRP M_HIRC M_HM0 M_HM1 M_HM2 M_HM ; M_PMTIE M_PMRIE M_PMAIE M_PPEIE M_PTAIE M_PTTIE M_PTCIE M_CLRT M_MTT M_SERF M_MACE M_MWSD M_RBLE M_IAE ; M_ARH M_BL M_FC ; M_ARL M_C M_BE ; Host Control Register Bit Flags EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU 0 1 2 $38 3 4 5 6 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 $700000 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Host Command Interrupt Enable Slave Transmit Interrupt Enable Slave Receive Interrupt Enable Host Flags 5-3 Mask Host Flag 3 Host Flag 4 Host Flag 5 Host Interrupt A Host Data Strobe Mode Host RD/WR Polarity Host Transfer Acknowledge Polarity Host Dma Request Polarity Host Reset Polarity Host Interrupt Request Polarity Host Interupt Request Control Host Interface Mode Host Interface Mode Host Interface Mode Host Interface Mode Mask Host PCI Control Register Bit Flags EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU 1 2 4 5 7 9 12 14 15 16 18 19 20 21 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; PCI Master Transmit Interrupt PCI Master Receive Interrupt PCI Master Address Interrupt PCI Parity Error Interrupt PCI Transacton Abort Interrupt PCI Transaction Term Interrupt PCI Transfer Complet Interrupt Clear Transmitter Master Transfer Terminate HSERR~ Force Master Access Counter Enable Master Wait States Disable Receive Buffer Lock Enable Insert Address Enable Enable Enable Enable Enable Enable Enable Enable Host PCI Master Control Register Bit Flags EQU EQU EQU $00ffff $3f0000 $c00000 ; DSP PCI Transaction Address (High) ; PCI Data Burst Length ; Data Transfer Format Control Host PCI Address Register Bit Flags EQU EQU EQU $00ffff $0f0000 $f00000 ; DSP PCI Transaction Address (Low) ; PCI Bus Command ; PCI Byte Enables DSP Status Register Bit Flags Not Recommended for New Design B-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates M_HCP M_STRQ M_SRRQ M_HF02 M_HF0 M_HF1 M_HF2 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ; EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU 0 1 2 $38 3 4 5 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Host Command pending Slave Transmit Data Request Slave Receive Data Request Host Flag 0-2 Mask Host Flag 0 Host Flag 1 Host Flag 2 DSP PCI Status Register Bit Flags M_MWS M_MTRQ M_MRRQ M_MARQ M_APER M_DPER M_MAB M_TAB M_TDIS M_TRTY M_TO M_RDC M_RDC0 M_RDC1 M_RDC2 M_RDC3 M_RDC4 M_RDC5 M_HACT EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU 0 1 2 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 $3F0000 16 17 18 19 20 21 23 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; B.3 SCI EQUATES PCI Master Wait States PCI Master Transmit Data Request PCI Master Receive Data Request PCI Master Address Request PCI Address Parity Error PCI Data Parity Error PCI Master Abort PCI Target Abort PCI Target Disconnect PCI Target Retry PCI Time Out Termination Remaining Data Count Mask (RDC5-RDC0) Remaining Data Count 0 Remaining Data Count 1 Remaining Data Count 2 Remaining Data Count 3 Remaining Data Count 4 Remaining Data Count 5 Hi32 Active ;---------------------------------------------------------------------; ; EQUATES for Serial Communications Interface (SCI) ; ;---------------------------------------------------------------------; M_STXH M_STXM M_STXL M_SRXH M_SRXM M_SRXL M_STXA M_SCR M_SSR M_SCCR Register Addresses EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFF97 $FFFF96 $FFFF95 $FFFF9A $FFFF99 $FFFF98 $FFFF94 $FFFF9C $FFFF93 $FFFF9B ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; SCI SCI SCI SCI SCI SCI SCI SCI SCI SCI Transmit Data Register (high) Transmit Data Register (middle) Transmit Data Register (low) Receive Data Register (high) Receive Data Register (middle) Receive Data Register (low) Transmit Address Register Control Register Status Register Clock Control Register Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com B-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ; M_WDS M_WDS0 M_WDS1 M_WDS2 M_SSFTD M_SBK M_WAKE M_RWU M_WOMS M_SCRE M_SCTE M_ILIE M_SCRIE M_SCTIE M_TMIE M_TIR M_SCKP M_REIE ; M_TRNE M_TDRE M_RDRF M_IDLE M_OR M_PE M_FE M_R8 ; M_CD M_COD M_SCP M_RCM M_TCM SCI Control Register Bit Flags EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Word Select Mask (WDS0-WDS3) Word Select 0 Word Select 1 Word Select 2 SCI Shift Direction Send Break Wakeup Mode Select Receiver Wakeup Enable Wired-OR Mode Select SCI Receiver Enable SCI Transmitter Enable Idle Line Interrupt Enable SCI Receive Interrupt Enable SCI Transmit Interrupt Enable Timer Interrupt Enable Timer Interrupt Rate SCI Clock Polarity SCI Error Interrupt Enable (REIE) SCI Status Register Bit Flags EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Transmitter Empty Transmit Data Register Empty Receive Data Register Full Idle Line Flag Overrun Error Flag Parity Error Framing Error Flag Received Bit 8 (R8) Address SCI Clock Control Register EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFF 12 13 14 15 ; ; ; ; ; Clock Divider Mask (CD0-CD11) Clock Out Divider Clock Prescaler Receive Clock Mode Source Bit Transmit Clock Source Bit Not Recommended for New Design B-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates B.4 ESSI EQUATES Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; ; EQUATES for Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) ; ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; ; Register M_TX00 EQU M_TX01 EQU M_TX02 EQU M_TSR0 EQU M_RX0 EQU M_SSISR0 EQU M_CRB0 EQU M_CRA0 EQU M_TSMA0 EQU M_TSMB0 EQU M_RSMA0 EQU M_RSMB0 EQU Addresses Of SSI0 $FFFFBC ; SSI0 Transmit Data Register 0 $FFFFBB ; SSIO Transmit Data Register 1 $FFFFBA ; SSIO Transmit Data Register 2 $FFFFB9 ; SSI0 Time Slot Register $FFFFB8 ; SSI0 Receive Data Register $FFFFB7 ; SSI0 Status Register $FFFFB6 ; SSI0 Control Register B $FFFFB5 ; SSI0 Control Register A $FFFFB4 ; SSI0 Transmit Slot Mask Register A $FFFFB3 ; SSI0 Transmit Slot Mask Register B $FFFFB2 ; SSI0 Receive Slot Mask Register A $FFFFB1 ; SSI0 Receive Slot Mask Register B ; Register M_TX10 EQU M_TX11 EQU M_TX12 EQU M_TSR1 EQU M_RX1 EQU M_SSISR1 EQU M_CRB1 EQU M_CRA1 EQU M_TSMA1 EQU M_TSMB1 EQU M_RSMA1 EQU M_RSMB1 EQU Addresses Of SSI1 $FFFFAC ; SSI1 Transmit Data Register 0 $FFFFAB ; SSI1 Transmit Data Register 1 $FFFFAA ; SSI1 Transmit Data Register 2 $FFFFA9 ; SSI1 Time Slot Register $FFFFA8 ; SSI1 Receive Data Register $FFFFA7 ; SSI1 Status Register $FFFFA6 ; SSI1 Control Register B $FFFFA5 ; SSI1 Control Register A $FFFFA4 ; SSI1 Transmit Slot Mask Register A $FFFFA3 ; SSI1 Transmit Slot Mask Register B $FFFFA2 ; SSI1 Receive Slot Mask Register A $FFFFA1 ; SSI1 Receive Slot Mask Register B ; M_PM M_PSR M_DC M_ALC M_WL M_SSC1 ; M_OF M_OF0 M_OF1 M_SCD SSI Control Register A Bit Flags EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $FF 11 $1F000 18 $380000 22 ; ; ; ; ; ; Prescale Modulus Slct Mask (PM0-PM7) Prescaler Range Frm Rate Divider Contl Mask (DC0-DC7) Alignment Control (ALC) Word Length Control Mask (WL0-WL7) Select SC1 as TR #0 drive enable (SSC1) SSI Control Register B Bit Flags EQU EQU EQU EQU $3 0 1 $1C ; ; ; ; Serial Serial Serial Serial Output Flag Mask Output Flag 0 Output Flag 1 Control Direction Mask Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com B-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Equates M_SCD0 M_SCD1 M_SCD2 M_SCKD M_SHFD M_FSL M_FSL0 M_FSL1 M_FSR M_FSP M_CKP M_SYN M_MOD M_SSTE M_SSTE2 M_SSTE1 M_SSTE0 M_SSRE M_SSTIE M_SSRIE M_STLIE M_SRLIE M_STEIE M_SREIE ; M_IF M_IF0 M_IF1 M_TFS M_RFS M_TUE M_ROE M_TDE M_RDF ; EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $3 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Serial Input Flag Mask Serial Input Flag 0 Serial Input Flag 1 Transmit Frame Sync Flag Receive Frame Sync Flag Transmitter Underrun Error FLag Receiver Overrun Error Flag Transmit Data Register Empty Receive Data Register Full $FFFF ; SSI Xmit Slot Bits Mask A (TS0-TS15) SSI Transmit Slot Mask Register B $FFFF ; SSI Xmit Slot Bits Mask B (TS16-TS31) SSI Receive Slot Mask Register A M_SSRSA EQU ; Serial Control 0 Direction Serial Control 1 Direction Serial Control 2 Direction Clock Source Direction Shift Direction Frame Sync Length Mask (FSL0-FSL1) Frame Sync Length 0 Frame Sync Length 1 Frame Sync Relative Timing Frame Sync Polarity Clock Polarity Sync/Async Control SSI Mode Select SSI Transmit enable Mask SSI Transmit #2 Enable SSI Transmit #1 Enable SSI Transmit #0 Enable SSI Receive Enable SSI Transmit Interrupt Enable SSI Receive Interrupt Enable SSI Transmit Last Slot Intrupt Enable SSI Receive Last Slot Interupt Enable SSI Transmit Error Interrupt Enable SSI Receive Error Interrupt Enable SSI Transmit Slot Mask Register A M_SSTSB EQU ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; SSI Status Register Bit Flags M_SSTSA EQU ; 2 3 4 5 6 $180 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 $1C000 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 $FFFF ; SSI Rcv Slot Bits Mask A (RS0-RS15) SSI Receive Slot Mask Register B M_SSRSB EQU $FFFF ; SSI Rcv Slot Bits Mask B (RS16-RS31) Not Recommended for New Design B-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates B.5 EXCEPTION PROCESSING EQUATES ;---------------------------------------------------------------------; ; EQUATES for Exception Processing ; ;---------------------------------------------------------------------- Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ; M_IPRC M_IPRP ; M_IAL M_IAL0 M_IAL1 M_IAL2 M_IBL M_IBL0 M_IBL1 M_IBL2 M_ICL M_ICL0 M_ICL1 M_ICL2 M_IDL M_IDL0 M_IDL1 M_IDL2 M_D0L M_D0L0 M_D0L1 M_D1L M_D1L0 M_D1L1 M_D2L M_D2L0 M_D2L1 M_D3L M_D3L0 M_D3L1 M_D4L M_D4L0 M_D4L1 M_D5L M_D5L0 M_D5L1 Register Addresses EQU EQU $FFFFFF $FFFFFE ; Interrupt Priority Register Core ; Interupt Priority Register Peripheral Interrupt Priority Register Core (IPRC) EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $7 0 1 2 $38 3 4 5 $1C0 6 7 8 $E00 9 10 11 $3000 12 13 $C000 14 15 $30000 16 17 $C0000 18 19 $300000 20 21 $C00000 22 23 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; IRQA IRQA IRQA IRQA IRQB IRQB IRQB IRQB IRQC IRQC IRQC IRQC IRQD IRQD IRQD IRQD DMA0 DMA0 DMA0 DMA1 DMA1 DMA1 DMA2 DMA2 DMA2 DMA3 DMA3 DMA3 DMA4 DMA4 DMA4 DMA5 DMA5 DMA5 Mode Mask Mode Interupt Priority Level (low) Mode Interrupt Priority Level (high) Mode Trigger Mode Mode Mask Mode Interrupt Priority Level (low) Mode Interrupt Priority Level (high) Mode Trigger Mode Mode Mask Mode Interrupt Priority Level (low) Mode Interrupt Priority Level (high) Mode Trigger Mode Mode Mask Mode Interrupt Priority Level (low) Mode Interrupt Priority Level (high) Mode Trigger Mode Interrupt priority Level Mask Interrupt Priority Level (low) Interrupt Priority Level (high) Interrupt Priority Level Mask Interrupt Priority Level (low) Interrupt Priority Level (high) Interrupt priority Level Mask Interrupt Priority Level (low) Interrupt Priority Level (high) Interrupt Priority Level Mask Interrupt Priority Level (low) Interrupt Priority Level (high) Interrupt priority Level Mask Interrupt Priority Level (low) Interrupt Priority Level (high) Interrupt priority Level Mask Interrupt Priority Level (low) Interrupt Priority Level (high) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com B-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ; Interrupt Priority Register Peripheral (IPRP) M_HPL M_HPL0 M_HPL1 M_S0L M_S0L0 M_S0L1 M_S1L M_S1L0 M_S1L1 M_SCL M_SCL0 M_SCL1 M_T0L M_T0L0 M_T0L1 M_KPL M_KPL0 M_KPL1 M_VPL M_VPL0 M_VPL1 M_CPL M_CPL0 M_CPL1 EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $3 0 1 $C 2 3 $30 4 5 $C0 6 7 $300 8 9 $C00 10 11 $3000 12 13 $C000 14 15 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Host Interrupt Priority Level Mask Host Interrupt Priority Level (low) Host Interrupt Priority Level (high) SSI0 Interrupt Priority Level Mask SSI0 Interrupt Priority Level (low) SSI0 Interrupt Priority Level (high) SSI1 Interrupt Priority Level Mask SSI1 Interrupt Priority Level (low) SSI1 Interrupt Priority Level (high) SCI Interrupt Priority Level Mask SCI Interrupt Priority Level (low) SCI Interrupt Priority Level (high) TIMER Interrupt Priority Level Mask TIMER Interrupt Priority Level (low) TIMER Interrupt Priority Level (high) FKOP Interrupt Priority Level Mask FKOP Interrupt Priority Level (low) FKOP Interrupt Priority Level (high) VCOP Interrupt Priority Level Mask VCOP Interrupt Priority Level (low) VCOP Interrupt Priority Level (high) CCOP Interrupt Priority Level Mask CCOP Interrupt Priority Level (low) CCOP Interrupt Priority Level (high) B.6 TIMER MODULE EQUATES ;---------------------------------------------------------------------; ; EQUATES for TIMER ; ;---------------------------------------------------------------------; M_TCSR0 M_TLR0 M_TCPR0 M_TCR0 ; M_TCSR1 M_TLR1 M_TCPR1 M_TCR1 Register Addresses Of TIMER0 EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFF8F $FFFF8E $FFFF8D $FFFF8C ; ; ; ; TIMER0 TIMER0 TIMER0 TIMER0 Control/Status Register Load Reg Compare Register Count Register Register Addresses Of TIMER1 EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFF8B $FFFF8A $FFFF89 $FFFF88 ; ; ; ; TIMER1 TIMER1 TIMER1 TIMER1 Control/Status Register Load Reg Compare Register Count Register Not Recommended for New Design B-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates ; M_TCSR2 M_TLR2 M_TCPR2 M_TCR2 M_TPLR M_TPCR Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ; M_TE M_TOIE M_TCIE M_TC M_INV M_TRM M_DIR M_DI M_DO M_PCE M_TOF M_TCF ; M_PS M_PS0 M_PS1 ; M_TC0 M_TC1 M_TC2 M_TC3 B.7 Register Addresses Of TIMER2 EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFF87 $FFFF86 $FFFF85 $FFFF84 $FFFF83 $FFFF82 ; ; ; ; ; ; TIMER2 Control/Status Register TIMER2 Load Reg TIMER2 Compare Register TIMER2 Count Register TIMER Prescaler Load Register TIMER Prescalar Count Register Timer Control/Status Register Bit Flags EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU 0 1 2 $F0 8 9 11 12 13 15 20 21 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Timer Enable Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable Timer Compare Interrupt Enable Timer Control Mask (TC0-TC3) Inverter Bit Timer Restart Mode Direction Bit Data Input Data Output Prescaled Clock Enable Timer Overflow Flag Timer Compare Flag Timer Prescaler Register Bit Flags EQU EQU EQU $600000 21 22 ; Prescaler Source Mask Timer Control Bits EQU 4 EQU 5 EQU 6 EQU 7 ; ; ; ; Timer Timer Timer Timer Control Control Control Control 0 1 2 3 DMA EQUATES ;---------------------------------------------------------------------; ; EQUATES for Direct Memory Access (DMA) ; ;---------------------------------------------------------------------; Register Addresses Of DMA M_DSTR EQU $FFFFF4 ; DMA Status Register M_DOR0 EQU $FFFFF3 ; DMA Offset Register 0 M_DOR1 EQU $FFFFF2 ; DMA Offset Register 1 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com B-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates M_DOR2 M_DOR3 ; M_DSR0 M_DDR0 M_DCO0 M_DCR0 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ; M_DSR1 M_DDR1 M_DCO1 M_DCR1 ; M_DSR2 M_DDR2 M_DCO2 M_DCR2 ; M_DSR3 M_DDR3 M_DCO3 M_DCR3 ; M_DSR4 M_DDR4 M_DCO4 M_DCR4 ; EQU EQU $FFFFF1 $FFFFF0 ; DMA Offset Register 2 ; DMA Offset Register 3 Register Addresses Of DMA0 EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFFEF $FFFFEE $FFFFED $FFFFEC ; ; ; ; DMA0 DMA0 DMA0 DMA0 Source Address Register Destination Address Register Counter Control Register DMA1 DMA1 DMA1 DMA1 Source Address Register Destination Address Register Counter Control Register DMA2 DMA2 DMA2 DMA2 Source Address Register Destination Address Register Counter Control Register DMA3 DMA3 DMA3 DMA3 Source Address Register Destination Address Register Counter Control Register DMA4 DMA4 DMA4 DMA4 Source Address Register Destination Address Register Counter Control Register ; ; ; ; DMA5 DMA5 DMA5 DMA5 Source Address Register Destination Address Register Counter Control Register ; ; ; ; DMA DMA DMA DMA Register Addresses Of DMA1 EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFFEB $FFFFEA $FFFFE9 $FFFFE8 ; ; ; ; Register Addresses Of DMA2 EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFFE7 $FFFFE6 $FFFFE5 $FFFFE4 ; ; ; ; Register Addresses Of DMA4 EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFFE3 $FFFFE2 $FFFFE1 $FFFFE0 ; ; ; ; Register Addresses Of DMA4 EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFFDF $FFFFDE $FFFFDD $FFFFDC ; ; ; ; Register Addresses Of DMA5 M_DSR5 M_DDR5 M_DCO5 M_DCR5 EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFFDB $FFFFDA $FFFFD9 $FFFFD8 ; DMA Control Register M_DSS M_DSS0 M_DSS1 M_DDS EQU EQU EQU EQU $3 0 1 $C Source Space Mask (DSS0-Dss1) Source Memory space 0 Source Memory space 1 Destination Space Mask (DDS-DDS1) Not Recommended for New Design B-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Equates M_DDS0 M_DDS1 M_DAM M_DAM0 M_DAM1 M_DAM2 M_DAM3 M_DAM4 M_DAM5 M_D3D M_DRS M_DCON M_DPR M_DPR0 M_DPR1 M_DTM M_DTM0 M_DTM1 M_DTM2 M_DIE M_DE ; M_DTD M_DTD0 M_DTD1 M_DTD2 M_DTD3 M_DTD4 M_DTD5 M_DACT M_DCH M_DCH0 M_DCH1 M_DCH2 EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU 2 3 $3f0 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 $F800 16 $60000 17 18 $380000 19 20 21 22 23 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA DMA Destination Memory Space 0 Destination Memory Space 1 Address Mode Mask (DAM5-DAM0) Address Mode 0 Address Mode 1 Address Mode 2 Address Mode 3 Address Mode 4 Address Mode 5 Three Dimensional Mode Request Source Mask (DRS0-DRS4) Continuous Mode Channel Priority Channel Priority Level (low) Channel Priority Level (high) Transfer Mode Mask (DTM2-DTM0) Transfer Mode 0 Transfer Mode 1 Transfer Mode 2 Interrupt Enable bit Channel Enable bit ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Channel Transfer Done Status MASK (DTD0-DTD5) DMA Channel Transfer Done Status 0 DMA Channel Transfer Done Status 1 DMA Channel Transfer Done Status 2 DMA Channel Transfer Done Status 3 DMA Channel Transfer Done Status 4 DMA Channel Transfer Done Status 5 DMA Active State DMA Active Channel Mask (DCH0-DCH2) DMA Active Channel 0 DMA Active Channel 1 DMA Active Channel 2 DMA Status Register EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $3F 0 1 2 3 4 5 8 $E00 9 10 11 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com B-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates B.8 PLL EQUATES ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; ; EQUATES for Phase Locked Loop (PLL) ; ;---------------------------------------------------------------------; Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... M_PCTL ; Register Addresses Of PLL EQU $FFFFFD ; PLL Control Register PLL Control Register M_MF M_DF M_XTLR M_XTLD M_PSTP M_PEN M_PCOD M_PD EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFF $7000 15 16 17 18 19 $F00000 B.9 BIU EQUATES ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Multiplication Factor Bits Mask (MF0-MF11) Division Factor Bits Mask (DF0-DF2) XTAL Range select bit XTAL Disable Bit STOP Processing State Bit PLL Enable Bit PLL Clock Output Disable Bit PreDivider Factor Bits Mask (PD0-PD3) ;---------------------------------------------------------------------; ; EQUATES for BIU ;---------------------------------------------------------------------; M_BCR M_DCR M_AAR0 M_AAR1 M_AAR2 M_AAR3 M_IDR ; M_BA0W M_BA1W M_BA2W M_BA3W Register Addresses Of BIU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $FFFFFB $FFFFFA $FFFFF9 $FFFFF8 $FFFFF7 $FFFFF6 $FFFFF5 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Bus Control Register DRAM Control Register Address Attribute Register Address Attribute Register Address Attribute Register Address Attribute Register ID Register ; ; ; ; Area Area Area Area 0 1 2 3 Bus Control Register EQU EQU EQU EQU $1F $3E0 $1C00 $E000 0 1 2 3 Wait Wait Wait Wait Control Control Control Control Mask Mask Mask Mask (BA0W0-BA0W4) (BA1W0-BA14) (BA2W0-BA2W2) (BA3W0-BA3W3) Not Recommended for New Design B-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates M_BDFW M_BBS M_BLH M_BRH Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ; M_BCW M_BRW M_BPS M_BPLE M_BME M_BRE M_BSTR M_BRF M_BRP ; EQU EQU EQU EQU $1F0000 21 22 23 ; ; ; ; Default Area Wait Control Mask (BDFW0-BDFW4) Bus State Bus Lock Hold Bus Request Hold ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; In Page Wait States Bits Mask (BCW0-BCW1) Out Of Page Wait States Bits Mask (BRW0-BRW1) DRAM Page Size Bits Mask (BPS0-BPS1) Page Logic Enable Mastership Enable Refresh Enable Software Triggered Refresh Refresh Rate Bits Mask (BRF0-BRF7) Refresh prescaler DRAM Control Register EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $3 $C $300 11 12 13 14 $7F8000 23 Address Attribute Registers M_BAT EQU $3 M_BAAP M_BPEN M_BXEN M_BYEN M_BAM M_BPAC M_BNC M_BAC EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU 2 3 4 5 6 7 $F00 $FFF000 ; External Access Type ;and Pin Definition Bits Mask (BAT0-BAT1) ; Address Attribute Pin Polarity ; Program Space Enable ; X Data Space Enable ; Y Data Space Enable ; Address Muxing ; Packing Enable ; No of Addr Bits to Compare Mask (BNC0-BNC3) ; Address to Compare Bits Mask (BAC0-BAC11) ; control and status bits in SR M_CP M_CA M_V M_Z M_N M_U M_E M_L M_S M_I0 M_I1 M_S0 M_S1 M_SC M_DM M_LF M_FV M_SA M_CE M_SM M_RM EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU $c00000 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 13 14 15 16 17 19 20 21 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; mask for CORE-DMA priority bits in SR Carry Overflow Zero Negative Unnormalized Extension Limit Scaling Bit Interupt Mask Bit 0 Interupt Mask Bit 1 Scaling Mode Bit 0 Scaling Mode Bit 1 Sixteen_Bit Compatibility Double Precision Multiply DO-Loop Flag DO-Forever Flag Sixteen-Bit Arithmetic Instruction Cache Enable Arithmetic Saturation Rounding Mode Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com B-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Equates M_CP0 M_CP1 EQU EQU 22 23 ; bit 0 of priority bits in SR ; bit 1 of priority bits in SR ; M_CDP M_MA M_MB M_MC M_MD M_EBD M_SD M_CDP0 M_CDP1 M_BEN M_TAS M_BRT M_XYS M_EUN M_EOV M_WRP M_SEN control EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU EQU and status bits in OMR $300 ; mask for CORE-DMA priority bits in OMR 0 ; Operating Mode A 1 ; Operating Mode B 2 ; Operating Mode C 3 ; Operating Mode D 4 ; External Bus Disable bit in OMR 6 ; Stop Delay 8 ; bit 0 of priority bits in OMR 9 ; bit 1 of priority bits in OMR 10 ; Burst Enable 11 ; TA Synchronize Select 12 ; Bus Release Timing 16 ; Stack Extension space select bit in OMR. 17 ; Extensed stack UNderflow flag in OMR. 18 ; Extended stack OVerflow flag in OMR. 19 ; Extended WRaP flag in OMR. 20 ; Stack Extension Enable bit in OMR. B.10 INTERRUPT EQUATES ;*********************************************************************** ; EQUATES for 56307 interrupts ; Reference: Specifications Revision 3.00 ; + 56307 spec 1.2 ; Last update: July 1 1997 ;*********************************************************************** ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; Non-Maskable Interrupts ;----------------------------------------------------------------------I_RESET EQU I_VEC+$00 ; Hardware RESET I_STACK EQU I_VEC+$02 ; Stack Error I_ILL EQU I_VEC+$04 ; Illegal Instruction I_DBG EQU I_VEC+$06 ; Debug Request I_TRAP EQU I_VEC+$08 ; Trap I_NMI EQU I_VEC+$0A ; Non Maskable Interrupt ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; Interrupt Request Pins ;----------------------------------------------------------------------I_IRQA EQU I_VEC+$10 ; IRQA I_IRQB EQU I_VEC+$12 ; IRQB I_IRQC EQU I_VEC+$14 ; IRQC I_IRQD EQU I_VEC+$16 ; IRQD ;----------------------------------------------------------------------- Not Recommended for New Design B-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ; DMA Interrupts ;----------------------------------------------------------------------I_DMA0 EQU I_VEC+$18 ; DMA Channel 0 I_DMA1 EQU I_VEC+$1A ; DMA Channel 1 I_DMA2 EQU I_VEC+$1C ; DMA Channel 2 I_DMA3 EQU I_VEC+$1E ; DMA Channel 3 I_DMA4 EQU I_VEC+$20 ; DMA Channel 4 I_DMA5 EQU I_VEC+$22 ; DMA Channel 5 ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; Timer Interrupts ;----------------------------------------------------------------------I_TIM0C EQU I_VEC+$24 ; TIMER 0 compare I_TIM0OF EQU I_VEC+$26 ; TIMER 0 overflow I_TIM1C EQU I_VEC+$28 ; TIMER 1 compare I_TIM1OF EQU I_VEC+$2A ; TIMER 1 overflow I_TIM2C EQU I_VEC+$2C ; TIMER 2 compare I_TIM2OF EQU I_VEC+$2E ; TIMER 2 overflow ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; ESSI Interrupts ;----------------------------------------------------------------------I_SI0RD EQU I_VEC+$30 ; ESSI0 Receive Data I_SI0RDE EQU I_VEC+$32 ; ESSI0 Receive Data With Exception Status I_SI0RLS EQU I_VEC+$34 ; ESSI0 Receive last slot I_SI0TD EQU I_VEC+$36 ; ESSI0 Transmit data I_SI0TDE EQU I_VEC+$38 ; ESSI0 Transmit Data With Exception Status I_SI0TLS EQU I_VEC+$3A ; ESSI0 Transmit last slot I_SI1RD EQU I_VEC+$40 ; ESSI1 Receive Data I_SI1RDE EQU I_VEC+$42 ; ESSI1 Receive Data With Exception Status I_SI1RLS EQU I_VEC+$44 ; ESSI1 Receive last slot I_SI1TD EQU I_VEC+$46 ; ESSI1 Transmit data I_SI1TDE EQU I_VEC+$48 ; ESSI1 Transmit Data With Exception Status I_SI1TLS EQU I_VEC+$4A ; ESSI1 Transmit last slot ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; SCI Interrupts ;----------------------------------------------------------------------I_SCIRD EQU I_VEC+$50 ; SCI Receive Data I_SCIRDE EQU I_VEC+$52 ; SCI Receive Data With Exception Status I_SCITD EQU I_VEC+$54 ; SCI Transmit Data I_SCIIL EQU I_VEC+$56 ; SCI Idle Line I_SCITM EQU I_VEC+$58 ; SCI Timer ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; HOST Interrupts ;----------------------------------------------------------------------I_HPTT EQU I_VEC+$60 ; Host PCI Transaction Termination I_HPTA EQU I_VEC+$62 ; Host PCI Transaction Abort I_HPPE EQU I_VEC+$64 ; Host PCI Parity Error I_HPTC EQU I_VEC+$66 ; Host PCI Transfer Complete I_HPMR EQU I_VEC+$68 ; Host PCI Master Receive I_HSR EQU I_VEC+$6A ; Host Slave Receive Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com B-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Equates I_HPMT I_HST I_HPMA I_HCNMI EQU EQU EQU EQU I_VEC+$6C I_VEC+$6E I_VEC+$70 I_VEC+$72 ; ; ; ; Host Host Host Host PCI Master Transmit Slave Transmit PCI Master Address Command/Host NMI (Default) ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; EFCOP Filter Interrupts ;----------------------------------------------------------------------- Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... I_FDIIE EQU I_FDOIE EQU I_VEC+$68 I_VEC+$6A ; EFilter input buffer empty ; EFilter output buffer full ;----------------------------------------------------------------------; INTERRUPT ENDING ADDRESS ;----------------------------------------------------------------------I_INTEND EQU I_VEC+$FF ; last address of interrupt vector space Not Recommended for New Design B-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. APPENDIX C Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 BSDL LISTING -- M O T O R O L A S S D T J T A G S O F T W A R E -- BSDL File Generated: Mon Apr 8 10:13:47 1996 --- Revision History: -entity DSP56307 is generic (PHYSICAL_PIN_MAP : string := "TQFP144"); port ( DE_: SC02: SC01: SC00: STD0: SCK0: inout inout inout inout inout inout bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com C-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 BSDL Listing Not Recommended for New Design C-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 BSDL Listing ---------------------------------------------------------------------- M O T O R O L A S S D T J T A G S O F T W A R E -- BSDL File Generated: Wed May 20 09:52:21 1998 --- Revision History: --- 1) Date : Tue Oct 14 20:31:41 1997 -Changes : Created for dsp56307 rev0, PBGA, mask 0H83G --- 2) Date : Thu Nov 20 21:26:28 1997 -Changes : Correction in the COMPONENT_CONFORMANCE statement --- 3) Date : Mon Dec 15 15:28:06 1997 -Changes : Indentifiers ending with an underscore (_) -were replaced by indentifiers ending with (_N) --- 4) Date : Wed May 20 09:52:21 1998 -Changes : Fix in definition of DE_N, it is Pull1 when disabled -Updated by Roman Sajman -entity DSP56307 is generic (PHYSICAL_PIN_MAP : string := “PBGA196”); port ( DE_N: SC02: SC01: SC00: STD0: SCK0: SRD0: SRD1: SCK1: STD1: SC10: SC11: SC12: TXD: SCLK: RXD: TIO0: TIO1: TIO2: HAD: HREQ: MODD: MODC: MODB: MODA: D: A: EXTAL: XTAL: inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout inout in in in in inout out in linkage bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit_vector(0 to 7); bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit_vector(0 to 23); bit_vector(0 to 17); bit; bit; Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com C-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. DSP56307 BSDL Listing Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... RD_N: WR_N: AA: BR_N: BG_N: BB_N: PCAP: RESET_N: PINIT: TA_N: CAS_N: BCLK: BCLK_N: CLKOUT: TRST_N: TDO: TDI: TCK: TMS: RESERVED: SVCC: HVCC: DVCC: AVCC: HACK: HDS: HRW: CVCC: HCS: HA9: HA8: HAS: GND: QVCCL: QVCCH: PVCC: PGND: PGND1: out out out buffer in inout linkage in in in out out out buffer in out in in in linkage linkage linkage linkage linkage inout inout inout linkage inout inout inout inout linkage linkage linkage linkage linkage linkage bit; bit; bit_vector(0 bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit; bit_vector(0 bit_vector(0 bit; bit_vector(0 bit_vector(0 bit; bit; bit; bit_vector(0 bit; bit; bit; bit; bit_vector(0 bit_vector(0 bit_vector(0 bit; bit; bit); to 3); to 4); to 1); to 3); to 2); to 1); to 63); to 3); to 2); use STD_1149_1_1994.all; attribute COMPONENT_CONFORMANCE of DSP56307 : entity is “STD_1149_1_1993”; attribute PIN_MAP of DSP56307 : entity is PHYSICAL_PIN_MAP; constant PBGA196 : PIN_MAP_STRING := “RESERVED: (A1, A14, B14, P1, P14), “ & “SC11: A2, “ & “TMS: A3, “ & “TDO: A4, “ & “MODB: A5, “ & “D: (E14, D12, D13, C13, C14, B13, C12, A13, B12, A12, B11, A11, C10, B10, A10, B9, “ & Not Recommended for New Design C-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 BSDL Listing “A9, B8, C8, A8, B7, B6, C6, A6), “ & “DVCC: (A7, C9, C11, D14), “ & “SRD1: B1, “ & “SC12: B2, “ & “TDI: B3, “ & “TRST_N: B4, “ & “MODD: B5, “ & “SC02: C1, “ & “STD1: C2, “ & “TCK: C3, “ & “MODA: C4, “ & “MODC: C5, “ & “QVCCL: (C7, G13, H2, N9), “ & “PINIT: D1, “ & “SC01: D2, “ & “DE_N: D3, “ & “GND: (E8, E9, E10, E11, F4, F5, F11, G4, G5, G6, G7, G8, G9, G10, G11, H4, H5, H6, “ & “H7, H8, H9, H10, H11, J4, J5, J6, J7, J8, J9, J10, J11, K4, K5, K6, K7, K8, K9, “ & “K10, K11, L4, L5, L6, L7, L8, L9, L10, L11, D4, D5, D6, D7, D8, D9, D10, D11, E4, “ & “STD0: “SVCC: “SRD0: “A: “E5, E6, E1, (E2, E3, (N14, E7, F6, F7, F8, F9, F10), “ & “ & K1), “ & “ & M13, M14, L13, L14, K13, K14, J13, J12, J14, H13, H14, G14, G12, F13, F14, “ & “RXD: “SC10: “SC00: “QVCCH: “SCK1: “SCLK: “TXD: “SCK0: “AVCC: “HACK: “HRW: “HDS: “HREQ: “TIO2: “HCS: “TIO1: “TIO0: “HA8: “HA9: “HAS: “HVCC: “HAD: “PVCC: “EXTAL: “E13, E12), “ & F1, “ & F2, “ & F3, “ & (F12, H1, M7), “ & G1, “ & G2, “ & G3, “ & H3, “ & (H12, K12, L12), “ & J1, “ & J2, “ & J3, “ & K2, “ & K3, “ & L1, “ & L2, “ & L3, “ & M1, “ & M2, “ & M3, “ & M4, “ & (M5, P4, N4, P3, N3, P2, N1, N2), “ & M6, “ & M8, “ & Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com C-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. DSP56307 BSDL Listing Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... “CLKOUT: “BCLK_N: “WR_N: “RD_N: “RESET_N: “PGND: “AA: “CAS_N: “BCLK: “BR_N: “CVCC: “PCAP: “PGND1: “XTAL: “TA_N: “BB_N: “BG_N: attribute attribute attribute attribute attribute M9, “ & M10, “ & M11, “ & M12, “ & N5, “ & N6, “ & (N13, P12, P7, N7), “ & N8, “ & N10, “ & N11, “ & (N12, P9), “ & P5, “ & P6, “ & P8, “ & P10, “ & P11, “ & P13 “; TAP_SCAN_IN TAP_SCAN_OUT TAP_SCAN_MODE TAP_SCAN_RESET TAP_SCAN_CLOCK of TDI : of TDO : of TMS : of TRST_N : of TCK : signal signal signal signal signal is is is is is true; true; true; true; (20.0e6, BOTH); attribute INSTRUCTION_LENGTH of DSP56307 : entity is 4; attribute INSTRUCTION_OPCODE of DSP56307 : entity is “EXTEST (0000),” & “SAMPLE (0001),” & “IDCODE (0010),” & “CLAMP (0101),” & “HIGHZ (0100),” & “ENABLE_ONCE (0110),” & “DEBUG_REQUEST (0111),” & “BYPASS (1111)”; attribute INSTRUCTION_CAPTURE of DSP56307 : entity is “0001”; attribute IDCODE_REGISTER of DSP56307 : entity is “0000” & -- version “000110” & -- manufacturer’s use “0000000111” & -- sequence number “00000001110” & -- manufacturer identity “1”; -- 1149.1 requirement attribute REGISTER_ACCESS of DSP56307 : entity is “ONCE[8] (ENABLE_ONCE,DEBUG_REQUEST)” ; attribute BOUNDARY_LENGTH of DSP56307 : entity is 144; attribute -- num “0 “1 BOUNDARY_REGISTER of DSP56307 : entity is cell port func safe [ccell dis rslt] (BC_1, MODA, input, X),” & (BC_1, MODB, input, X),” & Not Recommended for New Design C-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 BSDL Listing “2 “3 “4 “5 “6 “7 “8 “9 “10 “11 “12 “13 “14 “15 “16 “17 “18 “19 -- num “20 “21 “22 “23 “24 “25 “26 “27 “28 “29 “30 “31 “32 “33 “34 “35 “36 “37 “38 “39 -- num “40 “41 “42 “43 “44 “45 “46 “47 “48 “49 “50 “51 “52 (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, cell (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, cell (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, MODC, input, MODD, input, D(23), bidir, D(22), bidir, D(21), bidir, D(20), bidir, D(19), bidir, D(18), bidir, D(17), bidir, D(16), bidir, D(15), bidir, *, control, D(14), bidir, D(13), bidir, D(12), bidir, D(11), bidir, D(10), bidir, D(9), bidir, port func D(8), bidir, D(7), bidir, D(6), bidir, D(5), bidir, D(4), bidir, D(3), bidir, *, control, D(2), bidir, D(1), bidir, D(0), bidir, A(17), output3, A(16), output3, A(15), output3, *, control, A(14), output3, A(13), output3, A(12), output3, A(11), output3, A(10), output3, A(9), output3, port func A(8), output3, A(7), output3, A(6), output3, *, control, A(5), output3, A(4), output3, A(3), output3, A(2), output3, A(1), output3, A(0), output3, BG_N, input, AA(0), output3, AA(1), output3, X),” & X),” & X, 13, X, 13, X, 13, X, 13, X, 13, X, 13, X, 13, X, 13, X, 13, 1),” & X, 13, X, 13, X, 13, X, 26, X, 26, X, 26, safe [ccell dis X, 26, X, 26, X, 26, X, 26, X, 26, X, 26, 1),” & X, 26, X, 26, X, 26, X, 33, X, 33, X, 33, 1),” & X, 33, X, 33, X, 33, X, 33, X, 33, X, 33, safe [ccell dis X, 43, X, 43, X, 43, 1),” & X, 43, X, 43, X, 43, X, 43, X, 43, X, 43, X),” & X, 55, X, 56, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” & & & & & & & & & 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” rslt] 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” & & & & & & 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” & & & & & & 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” rslt] 1, Z),” 1, Z),” 1, Z),” & & & & & & 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” Z),” & & & & & & 1, 1, Z),” & Z),” & & & & & & & & & & Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com C-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. DSP56307 BSDL Listing Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... “53 “54 “55 “56 “57 “58 “59 -- num “60 “61 “62 “63 “64 “65 “66 “67 “68 “69 “70 “71 “72 “73 “74 “75 “76 “77 “78 “79 -- num “80 “81 “82 “83 “84 “85 “86 “87 “88 “89 “90 “91 “92 “93 “94 “95 “96 “97 “98 “99 -- num “100 “101 “102 (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, cell (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, cell (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, cell (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, RD_N, output3, WR_N, output3, *, control, *, control, *, control, BB_N, bidir, BR_N, output2, port func TA_N, input, BCLK_N, output3, BCLK, output3, CLKOUT, output2, *, control, *, control, *, control, *, control, EXTAL, input, CAS_N, output3, AA(2), output3, AA(3), output3, RESET_N, input, *, control, HAD(0), bidir, *, control, HAD(1), bidir, *, control, HAD(2), bidir, *, control, port func HAD(3), bidir, *, control, HAD(4), bidir, *, control, HAD(5), bidir, *, control, HAD(6), bidir, *, control, HAD(7), bidir, *, control, HAS, bidir, *, control, HA8, bidir, *, control, HA9, bidir, *, control, HCS, bidir, *, control, TIO0, bidir, *, control, port func TIO1, bidir, *, control, TIO2, bidir, X, 64, X, 64, 1),” & 1),” & 1),” & X, 57, X),” & safe [ccell dis X),” & X, 64, X, 64, X),” & 1),” & 1),” & 1),” & 1),” & X),” & X, 65, X, 66, X, 67, X),” & 1),” & X, 73, 1),” & X, 75, 1),” & X, 77, 1),” & safe [ccell dis X, 79, 1),” & X, 81, 1),” & X, 83, 1),” & X, 85, 1),” & X, 87, 1),” & X, 89, 1),” & X, 91, 1),” & X, 93, 1),” & X, 95, 1),” & X, 97, 1),” & safe [ccell dis X, 99, 1),” & X, 101, 1, 1, Z),” & Z),” & 1, Z),” & rslt] 1, 1, Z),” & Z),” & 1, 1, 1, Z),” & Z),” & Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & rslt] 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & rslt] 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & Not Recommended for New Design C-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 BSDL Listing “103 “104 “105 “106 “107 “108 “109 “110 “111 “112 “113 “114 “115 “116 “117 “118 “119 -- num “120 “121 “122 “123 “124 “125 “126 “127 “128 “129 “130 “131 “132 “133 “134 “135 “136 “137 “138 “139 -- num “140 “141 “142 “143 (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, cell (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, cell (BC_1, (BC_6, (BC_1, (BC_6, *, control, HREQ, bidir, *, control, HACK, bidir, *, control, HRW, bidir, *, control, HDS, bidir, *, control, SCK0, bidir, *, control, SCK1, bidir, *, control, SCLK, bidir, *, control, TXD, bidir, *, control, port func RXD, bidir, *, control, SC00, bidir, *, control, SC10, bidir, *, control, STD0, bidir, *, control, SRD0, bidir, PINIT, input, *, control, DE_N, bidir, *, control, SC01, bidir, *, control, SC02, bidir, *, control, STD1, bidir, *, control, SRD1, bidir, port func *, control, SC11, bidir, *, control, SC12, bidir, 1),” & X, 103, 1),” & X, 105, 1),” & X, 107, 1),” & X, 109, 1),” & X, 111, 1),” & X, 113, 1),” & X, 115, 1),” & X, 117, 1),” & safe [ccell dis X, 119, 1),” & X, 121, 1),” & X, 123, 1),” & X, 125, 1),” & X, 127, X),” & 1),” & X, 130, 1),” & X, 132, 1),” & X, 134, 1),” & X, 136, 1),” & X, 138, safe [ccell dis 1),” & X, 140, 1),” & X, 142, 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & rslt] 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Pull1),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & 1, Z),” & rslt] 1, Z),” & 1, Z)”; end DSP56307; Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com C-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 BSDL Listing Not Recommended for New Design C-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. APPENDIX D Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... EFCOP PROGRAMMING z-1 x z-1 z-1 x x Σ Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming EFCOP PROGRAMMING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 EXAMPLES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 VERIFICATION FOR ALL EXAMPLES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... D.1 D.2 D.3 D.4 Not Recommended for New Design D-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming D.1 EFCOP PROGRAMMING Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... The DSP56307 Enhanced Filter Coprocessor (EFCOP) supports both Finite Impulse Response (FIR) filters and Infinite Impulse Response (IIR) filters.1 This appendix discusses the different ways data can be transferred in and out of the EFCOP and presents some programming examples in which such transfers are performed for FIR and IIR filters. EFCOP operation is determined by the control bits in the EFCOP Control/Status Register (FCSR), described in Section 10.4.5. Further filtering operations are enabled via the appropriate bits in the FACR and FDCH registers. After the FCSR is configured to the mode of choice, enable the EFCOP by setting Bit 0 of the FCSR. To ensure proper EFCOP operation, most FCSR bits must not be changed while the EFCOP is enabled. Table D-1 summarizes the EFCOP operating modes. Table D-1 EFCOP Operating Modes FCSR Bits Mode Description3 3 2 2 FUPD FADP2 6 FMLC 5Ð4 FOM EFCOP Disabled1 x x x FIR, Real, single channel 0 00 FIR, Real, adaptive, single channel 0 FIR, Real, coeff. update, single channel 1 FLT 0 FEN x x 0 0 0 0 1 00 0 1 0 1 0 00 1 0 0 1 FIR, Real, adaptive + coeff. update, single channel 0 00 1 1 0 1 FIR, Real, multichannel 1 00 0 0 0 1 FIR, Real, adaptive, multichannel 1 00 0 1 0 1 FIR, Real, coeff. update, multichannel 1 00 1 0 0 1 FIR, Real, adaptive + coeff. update, multichannel 1 00 1 1 0 1 FIR, Full Complex, single channel 0 01 0 0 0 1 FIR, Complex Alternating, single channel 0 10 0 0 0 1 FIR, Magnitude, single channel 0 11 0 0 0 1 IIR, Real, single channel 0 00 0 0 1 1 IIR, Real, multichannel 1 00 0 0 1 1 1.For details on FIR and IIR filters, refer to the Motorola application note entitled Implementing IIR/FIR Filters with MotorolaÕs DSP56000/DSP56001 (APR7/D). Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming Table D-1 EFCOP Operating Modes (Continued) FCSR Bits Mode Description3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Note: 1. 2. 3. D.2 6 FMLC 5Ð4 FOM 3 2 2 FUPD FADP2 1 FLT 0 FEN An x indicates that the specified value can be 1 or 0. If the user sets the FUPD bit, the EFCOP updates the coefficients and clears the FUPD bit. The adaptive mode (i.e., FADP = 1) sets the FUPD bit, which causes the EFCOP to update the coefficients and then automatically clear the FUPD bit. Therefore, the value assigned to the FUPD bit in this table refers only to its initial setting and not its dynamic state during operation. All bit combinations not defined by this table are reserved for future development. OVERVIEW This section describes how to transfer data to and from the EFCOP using an FIR filter configuration. Here, we provide background information to help you understand the examples in D.3 Examples on page D-6. The following notations are used throughout the examples: ¥ D(n): Data sample at time n ¥ H(n): Filter coefficient at time n ¥ F(n): Output result at time n ¥ #filter_count: Number of coefficient values in the coefficient memory bank FCM; it is equal to the initial value written to the FCNT register plus 1. ¥ Compute: Perform all calculations to determine one filter output F(n) for a specific set of input data samples D.2.1 Transferring Data to and From the EFCOP To transfer data to/from the EFCOP input/output registers, the Filter Data Input Register (FDIR) and the Filter Data Output Register (FDOR) are triggered by three different methods: ¥ Direct Memory Access (DMA) ¥ Interrupts ¥ Polling Not Recommended for New Design D-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Two FCSR bits (FDIBE and FDOBF) indicate the status of the FDIR and the FDOR, respectively. All three data transfer methods use these two FCSR bits as their control mechanism. If FDIBE is set, the input buffer is empty; if FDOBF is set, the output buffer is full. Because these bits come into full operation only when the EFCOP is enabled (FCSR:FEN is set), the polling, DMA, or interrupt methods can be initialized either before or after the EFCOP is enabled. No service request is issued until the EFCOP is enabled, since FDIBE and FDOBF are cleared while the EFCOP is in the Individual Reset state. The most straightforward EFCOP transfer implementation is to use the core processor to poll the status flags, monitoring for input/output service requests. The disadvantage of this approach is that it demands large amounts of (if not all of) the coreÕs processing time. The interrupt and DMA methods are more efficient in their use of the core processor. Interrupts intervene on the core processor infrequently in order to service input/output data. DMA can operate concurrently with the processor core and demands only minimal core resource for setup. DMA transfers are recommended when the EFCOP is in FIR/IIR filtering mode since the core can operate independently of the EFCOP while DMA transfers data to the FDIR and from the FDOR. Since the EFCOPÕs input buffer (FDIR) is four words deep, the DMA can input in blocks of up to four words. A combination of DMA transfer for input and an interrupt request for processing the output is recommended for adaptive FIR mode. This combination gives the following benefits: ¥ Input data transfers to the FDIR can occur independently of the core. ¥ There is minimal intervention of the core while the weight update multiplier is updated. If the initialization mode is enabled (i.e., if the FCSR:FPRC bit is cleared), the core can initialize the coefficient bank while the DMA controller concurrently transfers initial data values to the data bank. The EFCOP state machine starts computation as soon as #filter_count data samples are input. If no initialization mode is used (the FPRC bit is set), the EFCOP machine starts computation as soon as the first data sample becomes available in the input buffer. The filter coefficient bank must therefore be initialized prior an input data transfer starts. The DMA input channel can continue transferring data whenever the input FIFO becomes empty, while the EFCOP state machine takes data words from the FIFO whenever required. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming D.3 EXAMPLES The following sections provide examples of how to use the EFCOP in different modes. D.3.1 Real FIR Filter: Mode 0 In this example, an N tap FIR filter is represented as follows: NÐ1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... F(n) = ∑ H(i) ⋅ D(n Ð i) i=0 The filter is implemented with three different data transfers using the EFCOP in data initialization mode: 1. DMA input/DMA output 2. DMA input/Polling output 3. DMA input/Interrupt output This transfer combination is only one of many possible combinations.2 DMA Input/DMA Output D.3.1.1 A 20-tap FIR filter using a 28-input sample signal is implemented in the following stages: 1. Setup: Ð Ð Ð Ð Ð Set the filter count register (FCNT) to the length of the filter coefficients Ð1 (i.e N-1). Set the Data and Coefficient Base Address pointers (FDBA, FCBA). Set the operation mode (FCSR[5:4] = FOM[00]). Set Initialization mode (FCSR[7] = FPRC = 0). Set DMA registers: ¥ DMA input: A two-dimensional (2D) DMA transfer fills up the FDM bank via channel 0. DCR0 (DMA Control Register 0) is initialized as follows: Ð DIE = 0 Disables end-of-transfer interrupt. Ð DTM = 2 Chooses line transfer triggered by request; DE auto clear on end of transfer. Ð DPR = 2 Priority 2. 2.For information on DMA transfers, refer to the Motorola application note entitled Using the DSP56300 Direct Memory Access Controller (APR23/D). Not Recommended for New Design D-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... EFCOP Programming Ð DCON = 0 Disables continuous mode. Ð DRS = $15 Chooses DMA to trigger on EFCOP input buffer empty. Ð D3D = 0 Chooses non-3D mode. Ð DAM = $20 Sets the following DMA Address Mode: source address - 2D, counter mode B, offset DOR0; destination address - no update, no offset. Ð DDS = 1 Destination in Y memory space (because EFCOP is in Y memory). Ð DSS = 0 Source in X memory space. Ð DOR0=1 Offset register Ð DCO0= $006003. Gives transfer of 7 * 4 = 28 items (input sequence length). Ð DSR0 = address of source data Ð DDR0 = $FFFFB0 ¥ DMA output: Channel 1 is used, with a configuration similar to that of the DMA input channel, except for a 1D transfer. DCR1 (DMA Control Register 1) is initialized as follows: Ð DIE = 0 Disables end-of-transfer interrupt. Ð DTM = 1 Chooses word transfer triggered by request, DE auto clear on end of transfer. Ð DPR = 3 Priority 3. Ð DCON = 0 Disables continuous mode. Ð DRS = $16 Chooses DMA to trigger on EFCOP output buffer full. Ð D3D = 0 Chooses non-3D mode. Ð DAM = $2C Sets the following DMA Address Mode: source address - no update, no offset; destination address - 1D, post-increment by 1, no offset. Ð DDS = 0 Destination in X memory space. Ð DSS = 1 Source in Y memory space (because EFCOP is in Y memory). Ð DCO1 = $12 Gives transfer of 9 items. Ð DSR1 = address of FDOR = $FFFFFB1 Ð DDR1 = address of destination memory space Setting the DCO0 and DCO1 must be considered carefully. These registers must be loaded with one less than the number of items to be transferred. Also, the following equality must hold: DCO1=input length - filter length. Note: 2. Initialization: Ð Enable DMA channel 1 (output) DCR1[23] DE=1 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming Ð Enable EFCOP FCSR[0] FEN=1 Ð Enable DMA channel 0. (input) DCR0[23] DE=1 3. Processing: Ð Ð Note: Whenever the Input Data Buffer (FDIR) is empty (i.e., FDIBE = 1), the EFCOP triggers DMA input to transfer up to four new data words to FDIR. Compute F(n); The result is stored in FDOR, and this triggers the DMA for an output data transfer. The filter coefficients are stored in Òreverse order,Ó as shown in Figure D-1. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... in Òreverse Data Memory Bank (FDM) D(0) D(1) D(2) D(3) D(4) D(5) - Output Data Stream F(0) F(1) F(2) F(3) F(4) F(5) - H(N - 1) H(N - 2) H(1) H(0) Coefficient Memory Bank (FCM) AA1506 Figure D-1 Real FIR Filter Data stream Example D-1 Real FIR Filter Using DMA Input/DMA Output INCLUDE 'ioequ.asm' ;;****************************************************************** ; equates ;;****************************************************************** Start equ $00100 ; main program starting address FCON equ $001 ; EFCOP FSCR register contents: ; enable the EFCOP FIR_LEN equ 20 ; EFCOP FIR length SRC_ADDRS equ $10A0 ; DMA source address point to DATA bank DST_ADDRS equ $1000 ; address at which to begin output SRC_COUNT equ $006003 ; DMA0 count (7*4 word transfers) DST_COUNT equ 8 ; number of outputs generated. FDBA_ADDRS equ 0 ; Input samples Start Address x:$0 FCBA_ADDRS equ 0 ; Coeff. Start Address y:$0 ;;****************************************************************** ; main program ;;****************************************************************** ORG p:Start Not Recommended for New Design D-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... EFCOP Programming move #FDBA_ADDRS,r0 move #0,x0 rep #DST_COUNT move x0,x:(r0)+ ; ** DMA channel 1 initialisation - output movep #M_FDOR,x:M_DSR1 movep #DST_ADDRS,x:M_DDR1 movep #DST_COUNT,x:M_DCO1 movep #$8EB2C1,x:M_DCR1 ; ** EFCOP initialisation ** movep #FIR_LEN-1,y:M_FCNT movep #FDBA_ADDRS,y:M_FDBA movep #FCBA_ADDRS,y:M_FCBA movep #FCON,y:M_FCSR ; FDM memory area ; clear FDM memory area from EFCOP ** ; DMA source address points to the EFCOP FDIR ; Init DMA destination address. ; Init DMA count. ; Start DMA 1 with FDOBF request. ; ; ; ; FIR length FIR input samples Start Address FIR Coeff. Start Address Enable EFCOP ; ** DMA channel 0 initialisation - input to EFCOP ** movep #SRC_ADDRS,x:M_DSR0 ; DMA source address points to the DATA bank. movep #M_FDIR,x:M_DDR0 ; Init DMA destination address. movep #SRC_COUNT,x:M_DCO0 ; Init DMA count to line mode. movep #$1,x:M_DOR0 ; DMA offset reg. is 1. movep #$94AA04,x:M_DCR0 ; Init DMA control reg to line mode FDIBE request. nop nop ;;****************************************************************** jclr #0,x:M_DSTR,* jclr #1,x:M_DSTR,* nop nop stop_label nop jmp stop_label org x:SRC_ADDRS INCLUDE ‘input.asm’ org y:FCBA_ADDRS INCLUDE ‘coefs.asm’ D.3.1.2 DMA Input/Polling Output The different stages of Input/Polling are as follows: 1. Setup: Ð Ð Ð Ð Ð Set the filter count register (FCNT) to the length of the filter coefficients Ð1 (i.e N-1). Set the data and coefficient base address pointers (FDBA, FCBA). Set the operation mode (FCSR[5:4] = FOM[00],), = 1). Set the initialization mode (FCSR[7] = FPRC = 0). Set DMA registers: DMA input: as per channel 0 in Section D.3.1.1 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming 2. Initialization: Ð Enable EFCOP FCSR[0] FEN=1. Ð Enable DMA input channel, DCR0[23] DE=1. 3. Processing: Ð Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Ð Ð Whenever the Input Data Buffer (FDIR) is empty (i.e., FDIBE = 1), the EFCOP triggers DMA input to transfer up to four new data words to FDM via FDIR. Compute F(n); the result is stored in FDOR. The core keeps polling the FCSR:FDOBF bit and stores the data in memory. Example D-2 Real FIR Filtering using DMA input/Polling output INCLUDE 'ioequ.asm' ;;****************************************************************** ; equates ;;****************************************************************** Start equ $00100 ; main program starting address FCON equ $001 ; EFCOP FSCR register contents: ; enable the EFCOP FIR_LEN equ 20 ; EFCOP FIR length SRC_ADDRS equ $10A0 ; DMA source address point to DATA bank DST_ADDRS equ $1000 ; address at which to begin output SRC_COUNT equ $006003 ; DMA0 count (7*4 word transfers) DST_COUNT equ 8 ; number of outputs generated. FDBA_ADDRS equ 0 ; Input samples Start Address x:$0 FCBA_ADDRS equ 0 ; Coeff. Start Address y:$0 ;;****************************************************************** ; main program ;;****************************************************************** ORG p:Start move #0,b move #0,a move #DST_COUNT,b0 move #FDBA_ADDRS,r0 move #0,x0 rep #DST_COUNT move x0,x:(r0)+ move #DST_ADDRS,r0 ; ** EFCOP initialisation ** movep #FIR_LEN-1,y:M_FCNT movep #FDBA_ADDRS,y:M_FDBA movep #FCBA_ADDRS,y:M_FCBA movep #FCON,y:M_FCSR ; counter for output interrupt ; FDM memory area ; clear FDM memory area ; Destination address ; ; ; ; FIR length FIR input samples Start Address FIR Coeff. Start Address Enable EFCOP ; ** DMA channel 0 initialisation - input to EFCOP ** movep #SRC_ADDRS,x:M_DSR0 ; DMA source address points to the DATA bank. Not Recommended for New Design D-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... EFCOP Programming movep #M_FDIR,x:M_DDR0 ; Init DMA destination address. movep #SRC_COUNT,x:M_DCO0 ; Init DMA count to line mode. movep #$1,x:M_DOR0 ; DMA offset reg. is 1. movep #$94AA04,x:M_DCR0 ; Init DMA control reg to line mode FDIBE request. nop nop ;;****************************************************************** do #DST_COUNT,endd nop jclr #15,y:M_FCSR,* movep y:M_FDOR,x:(r0)+ endd nop nop stop_label nop jmp stop_label org x:SRC_ADDRS INCLUDE ‘input.asm’ org y:FCBA_ADDRS INCLUDE ‘coefs.asm’ D.3.1.3 DMA Input/Interrupt Output The different stages of DMA input and interrupt output are as follows: 1. Setup: Ð Set the filter count register (FCNT) to the length of the filter coefficients Ð1 (i.e N-1). Ð Set the Data and Coefficient Base Address pointers (FDBA, FCBA). Ð Set the operation mode (FCSR[5:4] = FOM[00],). Ð Set Initialization mode (FCSR[7] = FPRC = 0). Ð Set Filter Data Output Interrupt Enable FSCR[11]=FDOIE=1. Ð Set DMA register with DMA input as per channel 0 in Section D.3.1.1. 2. Initialization: Ð Enable interrupts in the Interrupt Priority Register IPRP[10:11]=E0L=11. Ð Enable interrupts in the Status Register SR[8:9]=00. Ð Enable EFCOP FCSR[0]=FEN=1. Ð Enable the DMA input channel, DCR0[23]=DE=1. 3. Processing: Ð Whenever the Input Data Buffer (FDIR) is empty (i.e., FDIBE = 1), the EFCOP triggers DMA, which loads the next input into the FDIR. Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming Ð Compute F(n); the result is stored in FDOR; The core is interrupted when FDOBF is set and stores the data in memory. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Example D-3 Real FIR Filter DMA Input/Interrupt Output INCLUDE 'ioequ.asm' ;;****************************************************************** ; equates ;;****************************************************************** Start equ $00100 ; main program starting address FCON equ $801 ; EFCOP FSCR register contents: ; enable output interrupt ; enable the EFCOP FIR_LEN equ 20 ; EFCOP FIR length SRC_ADDRS equ $10A0 ; DMA source address point to DATA bank DST_ADDRS equ $1000 ; address at which to begin output SRC_COUNT equ $006003 ; DMA0 count (7*4 word transfers) DST_COUNT equ 8 ; number of outputs generated. FDBA_ADDRS equ 0 ; Input samples Start Address x:$0 FCBA_ADDRS equ 0 ; Coeff. Start Address y:$0 ;;****************************************************************** org P:$0 jmp Start ORG p:$6a jsr >kdo nop nop ;;****************************************************************** ; main program ;;****************************************************************** ORG p:Start ; ** interrupt initialisation ** bset #10,x:M_IPRP bset #11,x:M_IPRP bclr #8,SR bclr #9,SR move #0,b move #0,a move #DST_COUNT,b0 move #FDBA_ADDRS,r0 move #0,x0 rep #DST_COUNT move x0,x:(r0)+ move #DST_ADDRS,r0 ; ** EFCOP initialisation ** movep #FIR_LEN-1,y:M_FCNT movep #FDBA_ADDRS,y:M_FDBA movep #FCBA_ADDRS,y:M_FCBA movep #FCON,y:M_FCSR ; ; enable EFCOP interrupts in IPRP ; ; enable interrupts in SR ; counter for output interrupt ; FDM memory area ; clear FDM memory area ; Destination address ; ; ; ; FIR length FIR input samples Start Address FIR Coeff. Start Address Enable EFCOP Not Recommended for New Design D-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... EFCOP Programming ; ** DMA channel 0 initialisation - input to EFCOP ** movep #SRC_ADDRS,x:M_DSR0 ; DMA source address points to the DATA bank. movep #M_FDIR,x:M_DDR0 ; Init DMA destination address. movep #SRC_COUNT,x:M_DCO0 ; Init DMA count to line mode. movep #$1,x:M_DOR0 ; DMA offset reg. is 1. movep #$94AA04,x:M_DCR0 ; Init DMA control reg to line mode FDIBE request. nop nop ;;****************************************************************** wait1 jset #11,y:M_FCSR,* ; Wait until FDOIE is cleared. do #40,endd nop endd nop nop stop_label nop jmp stop_label ;;****************************************************************** kdo ; Interrupt handler for EFCOP output movep y:M_FDOR,x:(r0)+ ; Get y(k) from FDOR ; Store in destination memory space. nop dec b jne cont nop bclr #11,y:M_FCSR ; Disable output interrupt cont rti nop nop nop org x:SRC_ADDRS INCLUDE ‘input.asm’ org INCLUDE D.3.2 y:FCBA_ADDRS ‘coefs.asm’ Real FIR Filter With Decimation by M An N tap real FIR filter with decimation by M of a sequence of real numbers is represented by, NÐ1 F(n M ) = ∑ H(i) ⋅ D(n Ð i) i=0 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming A DMA data transfer occurs in the following stages for both input and output.The stages are the similar to the ones described in Section D.3.1.1. The difference is: set FDCH[11:8] = FDCM =M. 1. Processing: Ð Ð Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Ð Whenever the Input Data Buffer (FDIR) is empty (i.e., FDIBE = 1), the EFCOP triggers DMA input to transfer up to four new data words to FDM via FDIR. Compute F(n); the result is stored in FDOR; the EFCOP triggers DMA output for an output data transfer. Repeat M times: { Get new data word; EFCOP increments data memory pointer. } Data Memory Bank (FDM) D(0) D(1) D(2) D(3) D(4) D(5) - Output Data Stream F(0) F(M) F(2M) F(3M) F(4M) - H(N - 1) H(N - 2) H(1) H(0) Coefficient Memory Bank (FCM) AA1507 Figure D-2 Real FIR Filter Data stream with Decimation by M Not Recommended for New Design D-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming D.3.3 Adaptive FIR Filter An adaptive FIR filter is represented in Figure D-3. The goal of the FIR filter is to adjust the filter coefficients so that the output, F(n), becomes as close as possible to the desired signal, R(n)Ñthat is, E(n) -> 0. R(n) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... D(n) Adaptive FIR Filter F(n) Filter Update E(n) Figure D-3 Adaptive FIR Filter The adaptive FIR filter typically comprises four stages, which are performed for each input sample at time n: ¥ Stage 1. The FIR filter output value is calculated for the EFCOP FIR session according to this equation: NÐ1 F(n) = ∑ Hn ( i )D ( n Ð i ) i=0 where Hn(i) are the filter coefficients at time n, D(n) is the input signal and F(n) is the filter output at time n,. This stage requires N MAC operations, calculated by the EFCOP FMAC unit. ¥ Stage 2. The core calculates the error signal, E(n), in software according to the following equation: E(n) = R(n) Ð F(n) where R(n) is the desired signal at time n. This stage requires a single arithmetic operation. ¥ Stage 3. The core calculates the weight multiplier, Ke(n), in software according to the following equation: Ke(n) = K * E(n) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming where K is the convergence factor of the algorithm. After calculating the weight multiplier, Ke, the core must write it into the FKIR. ¥ Stage 4. The coefficients are updated by the EFCOP update session: H n + 1 ( i ) = H n ( i ) + Ke D ( n Ð i ) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... where Hn+1(i) are the adaptive filter coefficients at time n+1, Ke(n) is the weight multiplier at time n, and D(n) is the input signal. This stage starts immediately after Ke(n) is written in the FKIR (if adaptive mode is enabled). D.3.3.1 Implementation Using Polling Figure D-4 shows a flowchart for an adaptive FIR filter that uses polling to transfer data. Start Set FCNT=N-1 Set FDBA, FCBA Calculate Ke Enable EFCOP (ADP) Real FIR Mode Write Ke to FKIR Write next x(n) Set FUPD = 1 No (opt.) Automatically Done in ADP Mode Output Buffer Full? Yes Read y(n) Block Done? No Yes AA1511 End Figure D-4 Adaptive FIR Filter Using Polling Not Recommended for New Design D-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming D.3.3.2 Implementation Using DMA Input and Interrupt Output Figure D-5 shows a flowchart for an adaptive FIR filter that uses DMA and an interrupt to transfer data. Start Output Buffer Full Interrupt Set DMA/Int for input on FDIBE Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Set FCNT=L-1 Set FDBA, FCBA Read y(n) Enable EFCOP ADP Real FIR Mode Calculate Ke No Block Done? Write Ke to FKIR Yes Set FUPD = 1 End (opt.) Automatically Done in ADP Mode RTI Figure D-5 Adaptive FIR Filter Using DMA Input and Interrupt Output D.3.3.3 Updating an FIR Filter The following example shows an FIR adaptive filter that is updated using the LMS algorithm. Example D-4 FIR Adaptive Filter Update Using the LMS Algorithm TITLE 'ADAPTIVE' INCLUDE 'ioequ.asm' ;;************************************************************************************** ; equates ;;************************************************************************************** Start equ $00100 ; main program starting address FCON equ $805 ; EFCOP FSCR register contents: ; enable output interrupt ; Choose adaptive real FIR mode ; enable the EFCOP Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... FIR_LEN DES_ADDRS SRC_ADDRS DST_ADDRS SRC_COUNT DST_COUNT MU2 FDBA_ADDRS FCBA_ADDRS equ equ equ equ equ equ equ equ equ 20 $1200 $1100 $1000 $06003 8 $100000 0 0 ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; EFCOP FIR length Desired signal R(n) Reference signal D(n) address at which to begin output (signal F(n)) DMA0 count (7*4 word transfers) number of outputs generated. stepsize mu = 0.0625 (i.e. 2mu = 0.125) Input samples Start Address x:$0 Coeff. Start Address y:$0 ;;************************************************************************************** org p:$0 jmp Start ORG p:$6a jsr nop nop >kdo ;;************************************************************************************** ; main program ;;************************************************************************************** ORG p:Start ; ** interrupt initialisation ** bset bset #10,x:M_IPRP #11,x:M_IPRP ; ; enable EFCOP interrupts in IPRP bclr bclr #8,SR #9,SR ; ; enable interrupts in SR move move move #0,b #0,a #DST_COUNT,b0 ; counter for output interrupt ; ** FDM memory initialisation ** move move rep move #FDBA_ADDRS,r0 #0,x0 #FIR_LEN x0,x:(r0)+ ; FDM memory area ; clear FDM memory area ; ** address register initialisation ** move move #DST_ADDRS,r0 #DES_ADDRS,r1 rep move #FIR_LEN-1 (r1)+ ; Destination address ; Desired signal address ; Set reference pointer correctly Not Recommended for New Design D-18 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming ; ** EFCOP initialisation ** movep movep movep movep #FIR_LEN-1,y:M_FCNT #FDBA_ADDRS,y:M_FDBA #FCBA_ADDRS,y:M_FCBA #FCON,y:M_FCSR ; ; ; ; FIR length FIR input samples Start Address FIR Coeff. Start Address Enable EFCOP Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ; ** DMA channel 0 initialisation - input to EFCOP ** movep movep movep movep movep #SRC_ADDRS,x:M_DSR0 #M_FDIR,x:M_DDR0 #SRC_COUNT,x:M_DCO0 #$1,x:M_DOR0 #$94AA04,x:M_DCR0 ; ; ; ; ; DMA source address points to the DATA bank. Init DMA destination address. Init DMA count to line mode. DMA offset reg. is 1. Init DMA control reg to line mode FDIBE request. nop nop ;;****************************************************************** wait1 jset #11,y:M_FCSR,* ; Wait until FDOIE is cleared. do #40,endd nop endd nop nop stop_label nop jmp stop_label ;;****************************************************************** kdo ; Interrupt handler for EFCOP output movep y:M_FDOR,x:(r0) ; Get F(n) from FDOR ; Store in destination memory space. ;******* Calculate Ke ********* move x:(r1)+,a ; Retrieve desired value R(n) move sub x:(r0)+,y0 y0,a ; ; calculate E(n) = R(n) - F(n) move move mpy #MU2,y0 a,y1 y0,y1,a ; ; ; calculate Ke = mu * 2 * E(n) ;****************************** movep a1,y:M_FKIR dec jne nop bclr ; store Ke in FKIR b cont #11,y:M_FCSR ; Disable output interrupt Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-19 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. EFCOP Programming cont rti nop nop nop ;;****************************************************************** ;;****************************************************************** ORG y:FCBA_ADDRS Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc dc $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 $000000 ORG x:SRC_ADDRS INCLUDE 'input.asm'; Reference signal D(n) ORG x:DES_ADDRS INCLUDE 'desired.asm'; Desired signal R(n) D.4 D.4.1 VERIFICATION For All Exercises Input Sequence (input.asm) dc $000000 dc $37cc8a dc $343fae dc $0b63b1 Not Recommended for New Design D-20 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... EFCOP Programming dc $0595b4 dc $38f46e dc $6a4ea2 dc $5e8562 dc $2beda5 dc $1b3cd0 dc $42f452 dc $684ca0 dc $5093b0 dc $128ab8 dc $f74ee1 dc $15c13a dc $336e48 dc $15e98e dc $d428d2 dc $b76af5 dc $d69eb3 dc $f749b6 dc $dee460 dc $a43601 dc $903d59 dc $b9999a dc $e5744e D.4.2 Filter Coefficients (coefs.asm) dc $F8125C dc $F77839 dc $F4E9EE dc $F29373 dc $F2DC9A dc $F51D6E dc $F688CE dc $F6087E dc $F5B5D3 dc $F7E65E dc $FBE0F8 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-21 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... EFCOP Programming dc $FEC8B7 dc $FF79F5 dc $000342 dc $02B24F dc $06C977 dc $096ADD dc $097556 dc $08FD54 dc $0A59A5 D.4.3 Output Sequence for Examples D-1, D-2, and D-3 $d69ea9 $ccae36 $c48f2a $be8b28 $bad8c5 $b9998c $bad8cb $be8b2d $c48f27 D.4.4 Desired Signal for Example D-4 dc $000000 dc $0D310F dc $19EA7C dc $25B8E2 dc $30312E dc $38F46D dc $3FB327 dc $443031 dc $4642D6 dc $45D849 dc $42F452 dc $3DB126 dc $363E7F Not Recommended for New Design D-22 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... EFCOP Programming dc $2CDFE8 dc $21EA5B dc $15C13A dc $08D2CE dc $FB945D dc $EE7E02 dc $E2066F dc $D69EB2 dc $CCAE3C dc $C48F2F dc $BE8B32 dc $BAD8D3 dc $B99999 dc $BAD8D3 dc $BE8B32 D.4.5 Output Sequence for Example D-4 $000000 $f44c4c $ee54b3 $e7cd6b $daed26 $cc1071 $c7db1c $cdfe45 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com D-23 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... EFCOP Programming Not Recommended for New Design D-24 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. APPENDIX E Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... PROGRAMMING REFERENCE Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-3 INTERNAL I/O MEMORY MAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-5 INTERRUPT ADDRESSES AND SOURCES . . . . . . . . . . . E-13 INTERRUPT PRIORITIES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-15 PROGRAMMING SHEETS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E-17 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... E.1 E.2 E.3 E.4 E.5 Not Recommended for New Design E-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. PERIPHERAL ADDRESSES Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... E.1 Programming Reference INTRODUCTION This reference for programmers includes a table showing the addresses of all DSP memory-mapped peripherals, an exception priority table, and programming sheets for the major programmable DSP registers. The programming sheets are grouped in the following order: central processor, Phase Lock Loop, (PLL), Host Interface (HI08), Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface (ESSI), Serial Communication Interface (SCI), Timer, GPIO, and EFCOP. Each sheet provides room to write in the value of each bit and the hexadecimal value for each register. You can photocopy these sheets and reuse them for each application development project. For details on the instruction set of the DSP56300 family of DSPs, see the DSP56300 Family Manual. ¥ Table E-2 Internal X I/O Memory Map on page E-5 and Table E-3 Internal Y I/O Memory Map on page E-12 list the memory addresses of all on-chip peripherals. ¥ Table E-4 Interrupt Sources on page E-13 lists the interrupt starting addresses and sources. ¥ Table E-5 Interrupt Source Priorities within an IPL on page E-15 lists the priorities of specific interrupts within interrupt priority levels. ¥ The programming sheets appear in this manual as figures (listed in Table E-1); they show the major programmable registers on the DSP56307. Table E-1 Programming Sheets Central Processor Figure E-1 Status Register (SR) on page E-17 Figure E-2 Interrupt Priority RegisterÐCore (IPRÐC) on page E-18 Figure E-3 Interrupt Priority Register Ð Peripherals (IPRÐP) on page E-19 PLL Figure E-4 Phase Lock Loop Control Register (PCTL) on page E-20 HI08 Figure E-5 Host Receive and Host Transmit Data Registers on page E-21 Figure E-6 Host Control and Host Status Registers on page E-22 Figure E-7 Host Base Address and Host Port Control Registers on page E-23 Figure E-8 Interrupt Control and Interrupt Status Registers on page E-24 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Table E-1 Programming Sheets Figure E-9 Interrupt Vector and Command Vector Registers on page E-25 Figure E-10 Host Receive and Host Transmit Data Registers on page E-26 ESSI Figure E-11 ESSI Control Register A (CRA) on page E-27 Figure E-12 ESSI Control Register B (CRB) on page E-28 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Figure E-13 ESSI Status Register (SSISR) on page E-29 Figure E-14 ESSR Transmit and Receive Slot Mask Registers (TSM, RSM) on page E-30 SCI Figure E-15 SCI Control Register (SCR) on page E-31 Figure E-16 SCI Status and Clock Control Registers (SSR, SCCR) on page E-32 Figure E-17 SCI Receive and Transmit Data Registers (SRX, TRX) on page E-33 Timers Figure E-18 Timer Prescaler Load/Count Register (TPLR, TPCR) on page E-34 Figure E-19 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR) on page E-35 Figure E-20 Timer Load, Compare, Count Registers (TLR, TCPR, TCR) on page E-36 GPIO Figure E-21 Host Data Direction and Host Data Registers (HDDR, HDR) on page E-37 Figure E-22 Port C Registers (PCRC, PRRC, PDRC) on page E-38 Figure E-23 Port D Registers (PCRD, PRRD, PDRD) on page E-39 Figure E-24 Port E Registers (PCRE, PRRE, PDRE) on page E-40 EFCOP Figure E-25 EFCOP Counter and Control Status Registers on page E-41 Figure E-26 EFCOP FACR, FDBA, FCBA, and FDCH Registers on page E-42 Not Recommended for New Design E-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference E.2 INTERNAL I/O MEMORY MAP Table E-2 Internal X I/O Memory Map Peripheral Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... IPR 16-Bit Address 24-Bit Address Register Name $FFFF $FFFFFF Interrupt Priority Register Core (IPR-C) $FFFE $FFFFFE Interrupt Priority Register Peripheral (IPR-P) PLL $FFFD $FFFFFD PLL Control Register (PCTL) OnCE $FFFC $FFFFFC OnCE GDB Register (OGDB) BIU $FFFB $FFFFFB Bus Control Register (BCR) $FFFA $FFFFFA DRAM Control Register (DCR) $FFF9 $FFFFF9 Address Attribute Register 0 (AAR0) $FFF8 $FFFFF8 Address Attribute Register 1 (AAR1) $FFF7 $FFFFF7 Address Attribute Register 2 (AAR2) $FFF6 $FFFFF6 Address Attribute Register 3 (AAR3) $FFF5 $FFFFF5 ID Register (IDR) $FFF4 $FFFFF4 DMA Status Register (DSTR) $FFF3 $FFFFF3 DMA Offset Register 0 (DOR0) $FFF2 $FFFFF2 DMA Offset Register 1 (DOR1) $FFF1 $FFFFF1 DMA Offset Register 2 (DOR2) $FFF0 $FFFFF0 DMA Offset Register 3 (DOR3) $FFEF $FFFFEF DMA Source Address Register (DSR0) $FFEE $FFFFEE DMA Destination Address Register (DDR0) $FFED $FFFFED DMA Counter (DCO0) $FFEC $FFFFEC DMA Control Register (DCR0) DMA DMA0 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Table E-2 Internal X I/O Memory Map (Continued) Peripheral Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DMA1 DMA2 DMA3 DMA4 DMA5 16-Bit Address 24-Bit Address Register Name $FFEB $FFFFEB DMA Source Address Register (DSR1) $FFEA $FFFFEA DMA Destination Address Register (DDR1) $FFE9 $FFFFE9 DMA Counter (DCO1) $FFE8 $FFFFE8 DMA Control Register (DCR1) $FFE7 $FFFFE7 DMA Source Address Register (DSR2) $FFE6 $FFFFE6 DMA Destination Address Register (DDR2) $FFE5 $FFFFE5 DMA Counter (DCO2) $FFE4 $FFFFE4 DMA Control Register (DCR2) $FFE3 $FFFFE3 DMA Source Address Register (DSR3) $FFE2 $FFFFE2 DMA Destination Address Register (DDR3) $FFE1 $FFFFE1 DMA Counter (DCO3) $FFE0 $FFFFE0 DMA Control Register (DCR3) $FFDF $FFFFDF DMA Source Address Register (DSR4) $FFDE $FFFFDE DMA Destination Address Register (DDR4) $FFDD $FFFFDD DMA Counter (DCO4) $FFDC $FFFFDC DMA Control Register (DCR4) $FFDB $FFFFDB DMA Source Address Register (DSR5) $FFDA $FFFFDA DMA Destination Address Register (DDR5) $FFD9 $FFFFD9 DMA Counter (DCO5) $FFD8 $FFFFD8 DMA Control Register (DCR5) Not Recommended for New Design E-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Table E-2 Internal X I/O Memory Map (Continued) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Peripheral PORT B HI08 16-Bit Address 24-Bit Address Register Name $FFD7 $FFFFD7 Reserved $FFD6 $FFFFD6 Reserved $FFD5 $FFFFD5 Reserved $FFD4 $FFFFD4 Reserved $FFD3 $FFFFD3 Reserved $FFD2 $FFFFD2 Reserved $FFD1 $FFFFD1 Reserved $FFD0 $FFFFD0 Reserved $FFCF $FFFFCF Reserved $FFCE $FFFFCE Reserved $FFCD $FFFFCD Reserved $FFCC $FFFFCC Reserved $FFCB $FFFFCB Reserved $FFCA $FFFFCA Reserved $FFC9 $FFFFC9 Host Port GPIO Data Register (HDR) $FFC8 $FFFFC8 Host Port GPIO Direction Register (HDDR) $FFC7 $FFFFC7 Host Transmit Register (HTX) $FFC6 $FFFFC6 Host Receive Register (HRX) $FFC5 $FFFFC5 Host Base Address Register (HBAR) $FFC4 $FFFFC4 Host Port Control Register (HPCR) $FFC3 $FFFFC3 Host Status Register (HSR) $FFC2 $FFFFC2 Host Control Register (HCR) $FFC1 $FFFFC1 Reserved $FFC0 $FFFFC0 Reserved Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Table E-2 Internal X I/O Memory Map (Continued) Peripheral PORT C Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ESSI 0 PORT D 16-Bit Address 24-Bit Address Register Name $FFBF $FFFFBF Port C Control Register (PCRC) $FFBE $FFFFBE Port C Direction Register (PRRC) $FFBD $FFFFBD Port C GPIO Data Register (PDRC) $FFBC $FFFFBC ESSI 0 Transmit Data Register 0 (TX00) $FFBB $FFFFBB ESSI 0 Transmit Data Register 1 (TX01) $FFBA $FFFFBA ESSI 0 Transmit Data Register 2 (TX02) $FFB9 $FFFFB9 ESSI 0 Time Slot Register (TSR0) $FFB8 $FFFFB8 ESSI 0 Receive Data Register (RX0) $FFB7 $FFFFB7 ESSI 0 Status Register (SSISR0) $FFB6 $FFFFB6 ESSI 0 Control Register B (CRB0) $FFB5 $FFFFB5 ESSI 0 Control Register A (CRA0) $FFB4 $FFFFB4 ESSI 0 Transmit Slot Mask Register A (TSMA0) $FFB3 $FFFFB3 ESSI 0 Transmit Slot Mask Register B (TSMB0) $FFB2 $FFFFB2 ESSI 0 Receive Slot Mask Register A (RSMA0) $FFB1 $FFFFB1 ESSI 0 Receive Slot Mask Register B (RSMB0) $FFB0 $FFFFB0 Reserved $FFAF $FFFFAF Port D Control Register (PCRD) $FFAE $FFFFAE Port D Direction Register (PRRD) $FFAD $FFFFAD Port C GPIO Data Register (PDRD) Not Recommended for New Design E-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Table E-2 Internal X I/O Memory Map (Continued) Peripheral Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ESSI 1 PORT E 16-Bit Address 24-Bit Address Register Name $FFAC $FFFFAC ESSI 1 Transmit Data Register 0 (TX10) $FFAB $FFFFAB ESSI 1 Transmit Data Register 1 (TX11) $FFAA $FFFFAA ESSI 1 Transmit Data Register 2 (TX12) $FFA9 $FFFFA9 ESSI 1 Time Slot Register (TSR1) $FFA8 $FFFFA8 ESSI 1 Receive Data Register (RX1) $FFA7 $FFFFA7 ESSI 1 Status Register (SSISR1) $FFA6 $FFFFA6 ESSI 1 Control Register B (CRB1) $FFA5 $FFFFA5 ESSI 1 Control Register A (CRA1) $FFA4 $FFFFA4 ESSI 1 Transmit Slot Mask Register A (TSMA1) $FFA3 $FFFFA3 ESSI 1 Transmit Slot Mask Register B (TSMB1) $FFA2 $FFFFA2 ESSI 1 Receive Slot Mask Register A (RSMA1) $FFA1 $FFFFA1 ESSI 1 Receive Slot Mask Register B (RSMB1) $FFA0 $FFFFA0 Reserved $FF9F $FFFF9F Port E Control Register (PCRE) $FF9E $FFFF9E Port E Direction Register (PRRE) $FF9D $FFFF9D Port E GPIO Data Register (PDRE) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Table E-2 Internal X I/O Memory Map (Continued) Peripheral Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... SCI 16-Bit Address 24-Bit Address Register Name $FF9C $FFFF9C SCI Control Register (SCR) $FF9B $FFFF9B SCI Clock Control Register (SCCR) $FF9A $FFFF9A SCI Receive Data Register - High (SRXH) $FF99 $FFFF99 SCI Receive Data Register - Middle (SRXM) $FF98 $FFFF98 SCI Recieve Data Register - Low (SRXL) $FF97 $FFFF97 SCI Transmit Data Register - High (STXH) $FF96 $FFFF96 SCI Transmit Data Register - Middle (STXM) $FF95 $FFFF95 SCI Transmit Data Register - Low (STXL) $FF94 $FFFF94 SCI Transmit Address Register (STXA) $FF93 $FFFF93 SCI Status Register (SSR) $FF92 $FFFF92 Reserved $FF91 $FFFF91 Reserved $FF90 $FFFF90 Reserved Not Recommended for New Design E-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Table E-2 Internal X I/O Memory Map (Continued) Peripheral Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Triple Timer 16-Bit Address 24-Bit Address Register Name $FF8F $FFFF8F Timer 0 Control/Status Register (TCSR0) $FF8E $FFFF8E Timer 0 Load Register (TLR0) $FF8D $FFFF8D Timer 0 Compare Register (TCPR0) $FF8C $FFFF8C Timer 0 Count Register (TCR0) $FF8B $FFFF8B Timer 1 Control/Status Register (TCSR1) $FF8A $FFFF8A Timer 1 Load Register (TLR1) $FF89 $FFFF89 Timer 1 Compare Register (TCPR1) $FF88 $FFFF88 Timer 1 Count Register (TCR1) $FF87 $FFFF87 Timer 2 Control/Status Register (TCSR2) $FF86 $FFFF86 Timer 2 Load Register (TLR2) $FF85 $FFFF85 Timer 2 Compare Register (TCPR2) $FF84 $FFFF84 Timer 2 Count Register (TCR2) $FF83 $FFFF83 Timer Prescaler Load Register (TPLR) $FF82 $FFFF82 Timer Prescaler Count Register (TPCR) $FF81 $FFFF81 Reserved $FF80 $FFFF80 Reserved Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Table E-3 Internal Y I/O Memory Map Peripheral Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Enhanced Filter Coprocessor (EFCOP) 16-Bit Address 24-Bit Address Register Name $FFBF $FFFFBF RESERVED $FFBE $FFFFBE RESERVED $FFBD $FFFFBD RESERVED $FFBC $FFFFBC RESERVED $FFBB $FFFFBB RESERVED $FFBA $FFFFBA RESERVED $FFB9 $FFFFB9 RESERVED $FFB8 $FFFFB8 EFCOP Decimation/Channel (FDCH) Register $FFB7 $FFFFB7 EFCOP Coefficient Base Address (FCBA) $FFB6 $FFFFB6 EFCOP Data Base Address (FDBA) $FFB5 $FFFFB5 EFCOP ALU Control Register (FACR) $FFB4 $FFFFB4 EFCOP Control Status Register (FCSR) $FFB3 $FFFFB3 EFCOP Filter Count (FCNT) Register $FFB2 $FFFFB2 EFCOP K-Constant Register (FKIR) $FFB1 $FFFFB1 EFCOP Data Output Register (FDOR) $FFB0 $FFFFB0 EFCOP Data Input Register (FDIR) $FFAFÐ $FF80 $FFFFAFÐ $FFFF80 RESERVED Not Recommended for New Design E-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference E.3 INTERRUPT ADDRESSES AND SOURCES Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table E-4 Interrupt Sources Interrupt Starting Address Interrupt Priority Level Range VBA:$00 3 Hardware RESET VBA:$02 3 Stack Error VBA:$04 3 Illegal Instruction VBA:$06 3 Debug Request Interrupt VBA:$08 3 Trap VBA:$0A 3 Non-Maskable Interrupt (NMI) VBA:$0C 3 Reserved VBA:$0E 3 Reserved VBA:$10 0Ð2 IRQA VBA:$12 0Ð2 IRQB VBA:$14 0Ð2 IRQC VBA:$16 0Ð2 IRQD VBA:$18 0Ð2 DMA Channel 0 VBA:$1A 0Ð2 DMA Channel 1 VBA:$1C 0Ð2 DMA Channel 2 VBA:$1E 0Ð2 DMA Channel 3 VBA:$20 0Ð2 DMA Channel 4 VBA:$22 0Ð2 DMA Channel 5 VBA:$24 0Ð2 TIMER 0 Compare VBA:$26 0Ð2 TIMER 0 Overflow VBA:$28 0Ð2 TIMER 1 Compare VBA:$2A 0Ð2 TIMER 1 Overflow VBA:$2C 0Ð2 TIMER 2 Compare VBA:$2E 0Ð2 TIMER 2 Overflow VBA:$30 0Ð2 ESSI0 Receive Data VBA:$32 0Ð2 ESSI0 Receive Data With Exception Status VBA:$34 0Ð2 ESSI0 Receive Last Slot VBA:$36 0Ð2 ESSI0 Transmit Data Interrupt Source Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-13 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Table E-4 Interrupt Sources (Continued) Interrupt Starting Address Interrupt Priority Level Range VBA:$38 0Ð2 ESSI0 Transmit Data With Exception Status VBA:$3A 0Ð2 ESSI0 Transmit Last Slot VBA:$3C 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$3E 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$40 0Ð2 ESSI1 Receive Data VBA:$42 0Ð2 ESSI1 Receive Data With Exception Status VBA:$44 0Ð2 ESSI1 Receive Last Slot VBA:$46 0Ð2 ESSI1 Transmit Data VBA:$48 0Ð2 ESSI1 Transmit Data With Exception Status VBA:$4A 0Ð2 ESSI1 Transmit Last Slot VBA:$4C 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$4E 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$50 0Ð2 SCI Receive Data VBA:$52 0Ð2 SCI Receive Data With Exception Status VBA:$54 0Ð2 SCI Transmit Data VBA:$56 0Ð2 SCI Idle Line VBA:$58 0Ð2 SCI Timer VBA:$5A 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$5C 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$5E 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$60 0Ð2 Host Receive Data Full VBA:$62 0Ð2 Host Transmit Data Empty VBA:$64 0Ð2 Host Command (Default) VBA:$66 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$68 0Ð2 EFCOP Data Input Buffer Empty VBA:$6A 0Ð2 EFCOP Data Output Buffer Full VBA:$6C 0Ð2 Reserved VBA:$6E 0Ð2 Reserved : : VBA:$FE 0Ð2 Interrupt Source : Reserved Not Recommended for New Design E-14 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference E.4 INTERRUPT PRIORITIES Table E-5 Interrupt Source Priorities within an IPL Priority Interrupt Source Level 3 (Nonmaskable) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Highest Hardware RESET Stack Error Illegal Instruction Debug Request Interrupt Trap Lowest Non-Maskable Interrupt Levels 0, 1, 2 (Maskable) Highest IRQA (External Interrupt) IRQB (External Interrupt) IRQC (External Interrupt) IRQD (External Interrupt) DMA Channel 0 Interrupt DMA Channel 1 Interrupt DMA Channel 2 Interrupt DMA Channel 3 Interrupt DMA Channel 4 Interrupt DMA Channel 5 Interrupt Host Command Interrupt Host Transmit Data Empty Host Receive Data Full ESSI0 RX Data with Exception Interrupt Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Table E-5 Interrupt Source Priorities within an IPL (Continued) Priority Interrupt Source ESSI0 RX Data Interrupt ESSI0 Receive Last Slot Interrupt ESSI0 TX Data With Exception Interrupt Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ESSI0 Transmit Last Slot Interrupt ESSI0 TX Data Interrupt ESSI1 RX Data With Exception Interrupt ESSI1 RX Data Interrupt ESSI1 Receive Last Slot Interrupt ESSI1 TX Data With Exception Interrupt ESSI1 Transmit Last Slot Interrupt ESSI1 TX Data Interrupt SCI Receive Data With Exception Interrupt SCI Receive Data SCI Transmit Data SCI Idle Line SCI Timer TIMER0 Overflow Interrupt TIMER0 Compare Interrupt TIMER1 Overflow Interrupt TIMER1 Compare Interrupt TIMER2 Overflow Interrupt TIMER2 Compare Interrupt EFCOP Data Input Buffer Empty Lowest EFCOP Data Output Buffer Full Not Recommended for New Design E-16 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference E.5 PROGRAMMING SHEETS Central Processor Carry Overflow Zero Negative Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Unnormalized ( U = Acc(47) xnor Acc(46) ) Extension Limit FFT Scaling ( S = Acc(46) xor Acc(45) ) I(1:0) 00 01 10 11 Scaling Mode S(1:0) Scaling Mode 00 No scaling 01 Scale down 10 Scale up 11 Reserved Interrupt Mask Exceptions Masked None IPL 0 IPL 0, 1 IPL 0, 1, 2 Reserved Sixteen-Bit Compatibilitity Double Precision Multiply Mode Loop Flag DO-Forever Flag Sixteenth-Bit Arithmetic Reserved Instruction Cache Enable Arithmetic Saturation Rounding Mode Core Priority CP(1:0) Core Priority 00 0 (lowest) 01 1 10 2 11 3 (highest) 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CP1 I0 S L E U N Z V C CP0 RM SM CE *0 SA Extended Mode Register (MR) Status Register (SR) Read/Write Reset = $C00300 FV LF DM SC *0 S1 S0 I1 Mode Register (MR) Condition Code Register (CCR) * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-1 Status Register (SR) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-17 Programming Reference E-18 CENTRAL PROCESSOR MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 User’s Manual Figure E-2 Interrupt Priority RegisterÐCore (IPRÐC) IRQC Mode ICL2 0 1 Trigger Level Neg. Edge ICL1 0 0 1 1 ICL0 0 1 0 1 IRQA Mode Enabled No Yes Yes Yes IAL2 0 1 IPL — 0 1 2 Trigger Level Neg. Edge IRQD Mode IDL2 0 1 Trigger Level Neg. Edge Interrupt Priority Register (IPR–C) X:$FFFF Read/Write Reset = $000000 IDL1 0 0 1 1 IDL0 0 1 0 1 IAL1 0 0 1 1 IAL0 0 1 0 1 Enabled No Yes Yes Yes IPL — 0 1 2 IRQB Mode Enabled No Yes Yes Yes IPL — 0 1 2 IBL2 0 1 Trigger Level Neg. Edge 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 D5L1 D5L0 D4L1 D4L0 D3L1 D3L0 D2L1 D2L0 D1L1 D1L0 D0L1 D0L0 IDL2 IDL1 IBL1 0 0 1 1 9 8 7 IBL0 0 1 0 1 6 Enabled No Yes Yes Yes 5 4 IPL — 0 1 2 3 2 1 0 IDL0 ICL2 ICL1 ICL0 IBL2 IBL1 IBL0 IAL2 IAL1 IAL0 Host IPL ESSI1 IPL S1L1 S1L0 Enabled 0 0 No 0 1 Yes 1 0 Yes 1 1 Yes IPL — 0 1 2 HPL1 HPL0 Enabled 0 0 No 0 1 Yes 1 0 Yes 1 1 Yes ESSI0 IPL SCI IPL SCL1 0 0 1 1 SCL0 0 1 0 1 Enabled No Yes Yes Yes *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 $0 * $0 = Reserved, Program as 0 $0 S0L1 S0L0 Enabled 0 0 No 0 1 Yes 1 0 Yes 1 1 Yes IPL — 0 1 2 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 Interrupt Priority Register (IPR–P) X:$FFFF Read/Write Reset = $000000 IPL — 0 1 2 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 IPL — 0 1 2 2 1 0 T0L1 T0L0 SCL1 SCL0 S1L1 S1L0 SOL1 S0L0 HPL1 HPL0 E-19 Programming Reference Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... DSP56307 User’s Manual Figure E-3 Interrupt Priority Register Ð Peripherals (IPRÐP) MOTOROLA CENTRAL PROCESSOR Figure E-4 Phase Lock Loop Control Register (PCTL) DSP56307 User’s Manual MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... XTAL Disable Bit (XTLD) 0 = Enable Xtal Oscillator 1 = EXTAL Driven From An External Source PSTP and PEN Relationship Operation During STOP PSTP PEN PLL Oscillator 0 1 Disabled Disabled 1 0 Disabled Enabled 1 1 Enabled Enabled Crystal Range Bit (XTLR) 0 = External Xtal Freq> 200KHz 1 = External Xtal Freq < 200KHz Multiplication Factor Bits MF0 – MF11 MF11 – MF0 Multiplication Factor MF $000 1 $001 2 $002 3 • • • • • • $FFF 4095 $FFF 4096 Clock Output Disable (COD) 0 = 50% Duty Cycle Clock 1 = Pin Held In High State Predivision Factor Bits (PD0 – PD3) PD3 – PD0 Predivision Factor PDF $0 1 $1 2 $2 3 • • • • • • $F 16 Division Factor Bits (DF0 – DF2) DF2 – DF0 Division Factor DF $0 20 $1 21 $2 22 • • • • • • 27 $7 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 PLL Control Register (PCTL) X:$FFFFFD Read/Write Reset = $000000 Programming Reference E-20 PLL PD3 PD2 PD1 PD0 COD PEN PSTP XTLD XTLR DF2 DF1 8 DF0 MF11 MF10 MF9 MF8 7 6 5 4 3 2 MF7 MF6 MF5 MF4 MF3 MF2 1 0 MF1 MF0 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference HOST Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Host Receive Data (usually Read by program) 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Receive High Byte 8 7 6 Receive Middle Byte 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 0 Receive Low Byte Host Receive Data Register (HRX) X:$FFEC6 Read Only Reset = empty Host Transmit Data (usually Loaded by program) 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Transmit High Byte 8 7 Transmit Middle Byte 6 5 4 3 2 Transmit Low Byte Host Transmit Data Register (HTX) X:$FFEC7 Write Only Reset = empty Figure E-5 Host Receive and Host Transmit Data Registers Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-21 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference HOST Host Receive Interrupt Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable if HRDF = 1 Host Transmit Interrupt Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable if HTDE = 1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Host Command Interrupt Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable if HCP = 1 Host Flag 2 Host Flag 3 15 7 Host Control Register (HCR) X:$FFFFC2 Read /Write Reset = $0 6 5 *0 *0 *0 *0 4 3 HF3 HF2 2 1 HCIE HTIE 0 HRIE DSP Side Host Receive Data Full 0 = ∏ Wait 1 = ∏ Read Host Transmit Data Empty 0 = ∏ Wait 1 = ∏ Write Host Command Pending 0 = ∏ Wait 1 = ∏ Ready Host Flags Read Only 15 7 Host Staus Register (HSR) X:$FFFFC3 Read Only Reset = $2 6 5 *0 *0 *0 *0 4 3 HF1 HF0 2 1 0 HCP HTDE HRDF * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-6 Host Control and Host Status Registers Not Recommended for New Design E-22 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference HOST 15 7 *0 *0 Host Base Address Register (HBAR) X:$FFFFC5 Reset = $80 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 8 Host Request Open Drain HDRQ HROD HREN/HEW 0 0 1 0 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 BA9 5 4 3 2 1 0 BA8 BA7 BA6 BA5 BA4 BA3 Host GPIO Port Enable 0 = GPIO Pins Disable, 1 = GPIO Pin Enable Host Address Line 8 Enable 0 Æ HA8 = GPIO, 1 Æ HA8 = HA8 Host Address Line 9 Enable 0 Æ HA9 = GPIO, 1 Æ HA9 = HA9 Host Data Strobe Polarity 0 = Strobe Active Low, 1 = Strobe Active High Host Chip Select Enable 0 Æ HCS/HAI0 = GPIO, 1 Æ HCS/HA10 = HC8, if HMUX = 0 1 Æ HCS/HA10 = HC10, if HMUX = 1 Host Address Strobe Polarity 0 = Strobe Active Low, 1 = Strobe Active High Host Multiplexed Bus 0 = Nonmultiplexed, 1 = Multiplexed Host Request Enable 0 Æ HREQ/HACK = GPIO, 1 Æ HREQ = HREQ, if HDRQ = 0 Host Dual Data Strobe 0 = Single Strobe, 1 = Dual Strobe Host Chip Select Polarity 0 = HCS Active Low HTRQ & HRRQ Enable 1 = HCS Active High HDRQ 0 0 1 1 6 BA10 Host Acknowledge Enable 0 Æ HACK = GPIO If HDRQ & HREN = 1, HACK = HACK Host Request Polarity HRP 0 HREQ Active Low 1 HREQ Active High 0 HTRQ,HRRQ Active Low 1 HTRQ,HRRQ Active High Host Enable 0 Æ HI08 Disable Pins = GPIO 1 Æ HI08 Enable Host Acknowledge Polarity 0 = HACK Active Low, 1 = HACK Active High 15 Host Port Control Register (HPCR) X:$FFFFC4 Read/Write Reset = $0 HAP 14 13 12 HRP HCSP HDDS HMUX 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 HASP HDSP HROD *0 HEN HAEN 4 3 2 1 0 HREN HCSEN HA9EN HA8EN HGEN * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-7 Host Base Address and Host Port Control Registers Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-23 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Processor Side Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... HOST Receive Request Enable DMA Off 0 = ∏ Interrupts Disabled DMA On 0 = Host Æ DSP 1 = Interrupts Enabled 1 = DSP Æ Host Transmit Request Enable DMA Off 0 = ’ Interrupts Disabled DMA On 0 = DSP Æ Host 1 = Interrupts Enabled 1 = Host Æ DSP HDRQ HREQ/HTRQ HACK/HRRQ 0 HREQ HACK 1 HTRQ HRRQ Host Flags Write Only Host Little Endian Initialize (Write Only) 0 = ∏ No Action 1 = ∏ Initialize DMA 7 6 5 4 3 INIT *0 HLEND HF1 HF0 7 6 5 4 3 HREQ DMA *0 HF3 HF2 Interrupt Control Register (ICR) X:$ Read/Write Reset = $0 2 1 0 HDRQ TREQ RREQ Receive Data Register Full 0 = Wait 1 = Read Transmit Data Register Empty 0 = Wait 1 = Write Transmitter Ready 0 = Data in HI 1 = Data Not in HI Host Flags Read Only DMA Status 0 = ∏ DMA Disabled 1 = ∏ DMA Enabled Host Request 0 = ∏ HREQ Deasserted 1 = ∏ HREQ Asserted Interrupt Status Register (ISR) $2 Read/Write Reset = $06 2 1 TRDY TXDE 0 RXDF = Reserved, Program as 0 * Figure E-8 Interrupt Control and Interrupt Status Registers Not Recommended for New Design E-24 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... HOST 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 IV7 IV6 IV5 IV4 IV3 IV2 IV1 IV0 Interrupt Vector Register (IVR) Reset = $0F Contains the interruptvectoror number Host Vector Contains Host Command Interrupt Address ∏ 2 Host Command Handshakes Executing Host Command Interrupts 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 HC7 HC6 HC5 HC4 HC3 HC2 HC1 HC0 Command Vector Register (CVR) Reset = $2A Contains the host command interrupt addressr Figure E-9 Interrupt Vector and Command Vector Registers Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-25 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference HOST Processor Side Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Host Receive Data (usually Read by program) 7 0 7 Receive Low Byte 0 7 Receive Middle Byte 0 7 Not Used 0 $7 0 Receive High Byte $6 0 0 0 $5 0 0 0 0 $4 Receive Byte Registers $7, $6, $5, $4 Read Only Reset = $00 Receive Byte Registers Host Transmit Data (usually loaded by program) 7 0 7 Transmit Low Byte 0 7 Transmit Middle Byte 0 7 Not Used 0 $7 $6 0 Transmit High Byte $5 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 $4 Transmit Byte Registers $7, $6, $5, $4 Write Only Reset = $00 Figure E-10 Host Receive and Host Transmit Data Registers Not Recommended for New Design E-26 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Word Length Control WL2 WL1 WL0 Number of bits/word 0 0 0 8 0 0 1 12 0 1 0 16 0 1 1 24 1 0 0 32 (data in first 24 bits) 1 0 1 32 (data in last 24 bits) 1 1 0 Reserved 1 1 1 Reserved ESSI Control Register A (CRAx) ESSI0 :$FFFFB5 Read/Write ESSI1 :$FFFFA5 Read/Write Reset = $000000 Alignment Control 0 = 16-bit data left aligned to bit 23 1 = 16-bit data left aligned to bit 15 Select SC1 as Tx#0 drive enable 0 = SC1 functions as serial I/O flag 1 = functions as driver enable of Tx#0 external buffer Frame Rate Divider Control DC4:0 = $00-$1F (1 to 32) Divide ratio for Normal mode # of time slots for Network PSR = 1 & PM[7:0] = $00 is Prescaler Range 0 = ÷8 1 = ÷1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 *0 SSC1 WL2 WL1 WL0 ALC *0 * = Reserved, Program as 0 DC4 DC3 DC2 DC1 DC0 PSR 8 *0 *0 *0 7 Prescale Modulus Select PM7:0 = $00-$FF (÷1 to ÷256) 6 PM7 PM6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PM5 PM4 PM3 PM2 PM1 PM0 E-27 Programming Reference Figure E-11 ESSI Control Register A (CRA) DSP56307 User’s Manual Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... MOTOROLA ESSI Frame Sync Relative Timing (WL Frame Sync only) 0 = with 1st data bit 1 = 1 clock cycle earlier than 1st data bit Frame Sync Polarity 0 = high level (positive) FSL1 FSL0 0 0 1 1 1 = low level (negative) Clock Polarity (clk edge data & Frame Sync clocked out/in) 0 = out on rising / in on falling 1 = in on rising / out on falling 0 1 0 1 Frame Sync Length TX RX Word Word Bit Word Bit Bit Word Bit Figure E-12 ESSI Control Register B (CRB) DSP56307 User’s Manual Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Sync/Async Control (Tx & Rx transfer together or not) 0 = Asynchronous 1 = Synchronous Mode Select 0 = Normal Output Flag x If SYN = 1 and SCD1 = 1 OFx Æ SCx Pin 1 = Network Transmit 2 Enable (SYN=1 only) 0 = Disable 1 = Enable Serial Control Direction Bits 0 = Input 1 = Ouptut Transmit 1 Enable (SYN=1 only) 0 = Disable 1 = Enable Shift Direction 0 = MSB First Transmit 0 Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable 1 = LSB First Clock Source Direction 0 = External Clock 1 = Internal Clock Receiver Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable Transmit Interrupt Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable Receive Interrupt Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable Transmit Last Slot Interrupt Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable Receive Last Slot Interrupt Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable Transmit Exception Interrupt Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable Receive Exception Interrupt Enable 0 = Disable 1 = Enable MOTOROLA ESSI Control Register B (CRBx) ESSI0 :$FFFFB6 Read/Write ESSI1 :$FFFFA6 Read/Write Reset = $000000 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 REIE TEIE RLIE TLIE RIE TIE RE TE0 TE1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TE2 MOD SYN CKP FSP FSR FSL1 FSL0 SHFD SCKD SCD2 SCD1 SCD0 OF1 OF0 Programming Reference E-28 ESSI Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... ESSI Serial Input Flag 0 If SCD0 = 0, SYN = 1, & TE1 = 0 latch SC0 on FS Serial Input Flag 1 If SCD1 = 0, SYN = 1, & TE2 = 0 latch SC0 on FS Transmit Frame Sync 0 = Sync Inactive 1 = Sync Active Receive Frame Sync 0 = Wait 1 = Frame Sync Occurred Transmitter Underrun Error Flag 0 = OK 1 = Error Receiver Overrun Error Flag 0 = OK 1 = Error Transmit Data Register Empty 0 = Wait 1 = Write Receive Data Register Full 0 = Wait 1 = Read ESSI Status Register (SSISRx) ESSI0: $FFFFB7 (Read) ESSI1: $FFFFA7 (Read) 23 7 *0 RDF 6 5 TDE ROE 4 3 2 1 0 TUE RFS TFS IF1 IF0 SSI Status Bits * = Reserved, program as 0 Figure E-13 ESSI Status Register (SSISR) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-29 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference ESSI ESSI Transmit Slot Mask 0 = Ignore Time Slot 1 = Active Time Slot Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 23 ESSI Transmit Slot Mask A TSMAx ESSI0: $FFFFB4 Read/Write ESSI1: $FFFFA4 Read/Write Reset = $FFFF 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 *0 *0 TS15 TS14 TS13 TS12 TS11 TS10 TS9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TS8 TS7 TS6 TS5 TS4 TS3 TS2 TS1 TS0 ESSI Transmit Slot Mask A * = Reserved, Program as 0 ESSI Transmit Slot Mask 0 = Ignore Time Slot 1 = Activ e Time Slot 23 ESSI Transmit Slot Mask B TSMBx ESSI0: $FFFFB3 Read/Write ESSI1: $FFFFA3 Read/Write Reset = $FFFF 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 *0 *0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TS31 TS30 TS29 TS28 TS27 TS26 TS25 TS24 TS23 TS22 TS21 TS20 TS19 TS18 TS17 TS16 ESSI Transmit Slot Mask B * = Reserved, Program as 0 ESSI Receive Slot Mask 0 = Ignore Time Slot 1 = Active Time Slot 23 ESSI Receive Slot Mask A RSMAx ESSI0: $FFFFB2 Read/Write ESSI1: $FFFFA2 Read/Write Reset = $FFFF 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 *0 *0 RS15 RS14 RS13 RS12 RS11 RS10 RS9 8 7 6 5 4 RS8 RS7 RS6 RS5 RS4 ESSI Receive Slot Mask A 3 2 RS3 RS2 1 0 RS1 RS0 * = Reserved, Program as 0 ESSI Receive Slot Mask 0 = Ignore Time Slot 1 = Active Time Slot ESSI Receive Slot Mask B RSMBx ESSI0: $FFFFB1 Read/Write ESSI1: $FFFFA1 Read/Write Reset = $FFFF 23 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 *0 *0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RS31 RS30 RS29 RS28 RS27 RS26 RS25 RS24 RS23 RS22 RS21 RS20 RS19 RS18 RS17 RS16 ESSI Receive Slot Mask B = Reserved, Program as 0 * Figure E-14 ESSR Transmit and Receive Slot Mask Registers (TSM, RSM) Not Recommended for New Design E-30 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Port E Pin Control 0 = General Purpose I/O Pin 1 = SCI pin SCI Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Port E Control Register (PCRE) X:$FFFF9F Read/Write Reset = $000000 8 7 6 5 4 3 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 $0 $0 2 1 0 PC2 PC1 PC0 $0 Port E Control Register (PCRE) * = Reserved, Program as 0 Word Select Bits 0 0 0 = 8-bit Synchronous Data (Shift Register Mode) 0 0 1 = Reserved 0 1 0 = 10-bit Asynchronous (1 Start, 8 Data, 1 Stop) 0 1 1 = Reserved 1 0 0 = 11-bit Asynchronous (1 Start, 8 Data, Even Parity, 1 Stop) 1 0 1 = 11-bit Asynchronous (1 Start, 8 Data, Odd Parity, 1 Stop) 1 1 0 = 11-bit Multidrop (1 Start, 8 Data, Data Type, 1 Stop) 1 1 1 = Reserved Transmitter Enable 0 = Transmitter Disable 1 = Transmitter Enable Idle Line Interrupt Enable 0 = Idle Line Interrupt Disabled 1 = Idle Line Interrupt Enabled Receive Interrupt Enable 0 = Receive Interrupt Disabled 1 = Idle Line Interrupt Enabled Receiver Wakeup Enable 0 = receiver has awakened 1 = Wakeup function enabled Transmit Interrupt Enable 0 = Transmit Interrupts Disabled 1 = Transmit Interrupts Enabled Wired-Or Mode Select 1 = Multidrop 0 = Point to Point Timer Interrupt Enable 0 = Timer Interrupts Disabled 1 = Timer Interrupts Enabled Send Break 0 = Send break, then revert 1 = Continually send breaks Receiver Enable 0 = Receiver Disabled 1 = Receiver Enabled SCI Timer Interrupt Rate 0 = ∏ 32, 1 = ∏ 1 SCI Shift Direction 0 = LSB First 1 = MSB First Wakeup Mode Select 0 = Idle Line Wakeup 1 = Address Bit Wakeup SCI Clock Polarity 0 = Clock Polarity is Positive 1 = Clock Polarity is Negative SCI Receive Exception Inerrupt 0 = Receive Interrupt Disable 1 = Receive Interrupt Enable 23 SCI Control Register (SCR) Address X:$FFFF9C Read/Write *0 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 REIE SCKP STIR TMIE TIE RIE ILIE TE 8 RE 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WOMS RWU WAKE SBK SSFTD WDS2 WDS1 WDS0 SCI Control Register (SCR) * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-15 SCI Control Register (SCR) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-31 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... SCI Overrun Error Flag 0 = No error 1 = Overrun detected Idle Line Flag 0 = Idle not detected 1 = Idle State Parity Error Flag 0 = No error 1 = Incorrect Parity detected Receive Data Register Full 0 = Receive Data Register Full 1 = Receive Data Register Empty Framing Error Flag 0 = No error 1 = No Stop Bit detected Transmitter Data Register Empty 0 = Transmitter Data Register full 1 = Transmitter Data Register empty Received Bit 8 0 = Data 1 = Address Transmitter Empty 0 = Transmitter full 1 = Transmitter empty SCI Status Register (SSR) Address X:$FFFF93 Read Only Reset = $000003 23 7 6 5 4 *0 R8 FE PE OR 3 2 1 0 IDLE RDRF TDRE TRNE $0 $3 = Reserved, Program as 0 * SCI Status Register (SSR) Clock Divider Bits CD11 – CD0) CD11 – CD0 Icyc Rate $000 Icyc/1 $001 Icyc/2 $002 Icyc/3 • • • • • • $FFE Icyc/4095 $FFF Icyc/4096 Clock Divider Bits CD11 – CD0) TCM RCM TX Clock RX Clock SCLK Pin Mode 0 0 Internal Internal Output Synchronous/Asynchronous 0 1 Internal External Input Asynchronous only 1 0 External Internal Input Asynchronous only 1 1 External External Input Synchronous/Asynchronous Transmitter Clock Mode/Source 0 = Internal clock for Transmitter 1 = External clock from SCLK Receiver Clock Mode/Source 0 = Internal clock for Receiver 1 = External clock from SCLK Clock Out Divider 0 = Divide clock by 16 before feed to SCLK 1 = Feed clock to directly to SCLK SCI Clock Prescaler 0 = ∏1 1 = ∏ 8 23 15 14 13 12 11 10 *0 TCM RCM SCP 9 COD CD11 CD10 CD9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CD8 CD7 CD6 CD5 CD4 CD3 CD2 CD1 CD0 SCI Clock Control Register (SCCR) * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-16 SCI Status and Clock Control Registers (SSR, SCCR) Not Recommended for New Design E-32 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference SCI “A” X0 Unpacking 16 15 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... 23 SCI Transmit Data Registers Address X:$FFFF95 – X:$FFFF97 Write Reset = xxxxxx Note: X:$FFFF97 X:$FFFF96 “B” “C” 87 0 STX STX X:$FFFF95 STX STX is the same register decoded at four different addresses SCI Transmit SR TXD SCI Transmit Data Registers X:$FFFF94 STXA RXD SCI Receive SR 23 SCI Receive Data Registers Address X:$FFFF98 – X:$FFFF9A Read Reset = xxxxxx 16 15 87 SRX X:$FFFF9A SRX X:$FFFF99 X:$FFFF98 0 SRX Packing “A” Note: “B” “C” STX is the same register decoded at three different addresses SCI Receive Data Registers Figure E-17 SCI Receive and Transmit Data Registers (SRX, TRX) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-33 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Timers PS (1:0) 00 01 10 11 Prescaler Clock Source Internal CLK/2 TIO0 TIO1 TIO2 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 *0 PS1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PS0 Prescaler Preload Value (PL [0:20]) Timer Prescaler Load Register TPLR:$FFFF83 Read/Write Reset = $000000 * = Reserved, Program as 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 *0 *0 *0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Current Value of Prescaler Counter (PC [0:20]) Timer Prescaler Count Register TPCR:$FFFF82 Read Only Reset = $000000 * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-18 Timer Prescaler Load/Count Register (TPLR, TPCR) Not Recommended for New Design E-34 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Inverter Bit 8 0 = 0- to-1 transitions on TIO input increment the counter, or high pulse width measured, or high pulse output on TIO Timers 1 = 1-to-0 transitions on TIO input increment the counter, or low pulse width measured, or low pulse output on TIO Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Timer Reload Mode Bit 9 0 = Timer operates as a free running counter TC (3:0) 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 1 = Timer is reloaded when selected condition occurs Direction Bit 11 0 = TIO pin is input 1 = TIO pin is output Data Input Bit 12 0 = Zero read on TIO pin 1 = One read on TIO pin Data Output Bit 13 0 = Zero written to TIO pin 1 = One written to TIO pin Timer Control Bits 4 – 7 (TC0 – TC3) TIO Clock Mode GPIO Internal Timer Output Internal Timer Pulse Output Internal Timer Toggle Input External Event Counter Input Internal Input Width Input Internal Input Period Input Internal Capture Output Internal Pulse Width Modulation – – Reserved Output Internal Watchdog Pulse Output Internal Watchdog Toggle – – Reserved – – Reserved – – Reserved – – Reserved – – Reserved Timer Enable Bit 0 0 = Timer Disabled 1 = Timer Enabled Prescaled Clock Enable Bit 15 0 = Clock source is CLK/2 or TIO 1 = Clock source is prescaler output Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit 1 0 = Overflow Interrupts Disabled 1 = Overflow Interrupts Enabled Timer Compare Flag Bit 21 0 = “1” has been written to TCSR(TCF), or timer compare interrupt serviced 1 = Timer Compare has occurred Timer Compare Interrupt Enable Bit 2 0 = Compare Interrupts Disabled 1 = Compare Interrupts Enabled Timer Overflow Flag Bit 20 0 = “1” has been written to TCSR(TOF), or timer Overflow interrupt serviced 1 = Counter wraparound has occurred 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 *0 *0 TCF TOF *0 *0 *0 *0 PCE *0 DO DI DIR *0 8 TRM INV 7 6 5 4 3 TC3 TC2 TC1 TC0 *0 Timer Control/Status Register TCSR0:$FFFF8F Read/Write TCSR1:$FFFF8B Read/Write TCSR2:$FFFF87 Read/Write Reset = $000000 2 1 TCIE TQIE 0 TE * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-19 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-35 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Timers 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Timer Reload Value Timer Load Register TLR0:$FFFF8E Write Only TLR1:$FFFF8A Write Only TLR2:$FFFF86 Write Only Reset = $000000 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Value Compared to Counter Value Timer Compare Register TCPR0:$FFFF8D Read/Write TCPR1:$FFFF89 Read/Write TCPR2:$FFFF85 Read/Write Reset = $000000 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 Timer Count Value Timer Count Register TCR0:$FFFF8C Read Only TCR1:$FFFF88 Read Only TCR2:$FFFF84 Read Only Reset = $000000 Figure E-20 Timer Load, Compare, Count Registers (TLR, TCPR, TCR) Not Recommended for New Design E-36 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... GPIO Host Data Direction Register (HDDR) Port B (HI08) 15 DR15 14 13 DR14 DR13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DR12 DR11 DR10 DR9 DR8 DR7 DR6 DR5 DR4 DR3 DR2 DR1 DR0 X:$FFFFC8 Write Reset = $0 DRx = 1 Æ HIx is Output Host Data Register (HDR) DRx = 0 Æ HIx is Input 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D15 D14 D13 D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 X:$FFFFC9 Write Reset = Undefined DRx holds value of corresponding HI08 GPIO pin. Function depends on HDDR. Figure E-21 Host Data Direction and Host Data Registers (HDDR, HDR) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-37 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference GPIO Port C (ESSI0) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Port C Control Register (PCRC) X:$FFFFBF ReadWrite Reset = $0 23 6 *0 *0 5 4 3 2 1 0 PC5 PC4 PC3 PC2 PC1 PC0 PCn = 1 Æ Port Pin configured as ESSI PCn = 0 Æ Port Pin configured as GPIO Port C Direction Register (PRRC) X:$FFFFBE ReadWrite Reset = $0 23 6 *0 *0 5 4 3 2 1 0 PDC5 PDC4 PDC3 PDC2 PDC1 PDC0 PDCn = 1 Æ Port Pin is Output PDCn = 0 Æ Port Pin is Input Port C GPIO Data Register (PDRC) X:$FFFFBD ReadWrite Reset = $0 23 6 *0 *0 5 4 3 2 1 0 PD5 PD4 PD3 PD2 PD1 PD0 port pin n is GPIO input, then PDn reflects the value on port pin n if port pin n is GPIO output, then value written to PDn is reflected on port pin n * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-22 Port C Registers (PCRC, PRRC, PDRC) Not Recommended for New Design E-38 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... GPIO Port D (ESSI1) Port D Control Register (PCRD) X:$FFFFAF ReadWrite Reset = $0 23 6 *0 *0 5 4 3 2 1 0 PC5 PC4 PC3 PC2 PC1 PC0 PCn = 1 Æ Port Pin configured as ESSI PCn = 0 Æ Port Pin configured as GPIO Port D Direction Register (PRRD) X:$FFFFAE ReadWrite Reset = $0 23 6 *0 *0 5 4 3 2 1 0 PDC5 PDC4 PDC3 PDC2 PDC1 PDC0 PDCn = 1 Æ Port Pin is Output PDCn = 0 Æ Port Pin is Input Port D GPIO Data Register (PDRD) X:$FFFFAD ReadWrite Reset = $0 23 6 *0 *0 5 4 3 2 1 0 PD5 PD4 PD3 PD2 PD1 PD0 port pin n is GPIO input, then PDn reflects the value on port pin n if port pin n is GPIO output, then value written to PDn is reflected on port pin n * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-23 Port D Registers (PCRD, PRRD, PDRD) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-39 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference GPIO Port E (SCI) Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Port E Control Register (PCRE) X:$FFFF9F ReadWrite Reset = $0 23 6 5 4 3 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 2 1 0 PC2 PC1 PC0 PCn = 1 Æ Port Pin configured as SCI PCn = 0 Æ Port Pin configured as GPIO Port E Direction Register (PRRE) X:$FFFF9E ReadWrite Reset = $0 23 6 5 4 3 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 2 1 0 PDC2 PDC1 PDC0 PDCn = 1 Æ Port Pin is Output PDCn = 0 Æ Port Pin is Input Port E GPIO Data Register (PDRE) X:$FFFF9D ReadWrite Reset = $0 23 6 5 4 3 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 2 1 0 PD2 PD1 PD0 port pin n is GPIO input, then PDn reflects the value on port pin n if port pin n is GPIO output, then value written to PDn is reflected on port pin n * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-24 Port E Registers (PCRE, PRRE, PDRE) Not Recommended for New Design E-40 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference EFCOP 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Filter Count Value Filter Count Register (FCNT) Y:$FFFFB3 Read/Write Reset = $000000 * = Reserved, Program as 0 Filter Enable Bit 0 0 = EFCOP Disabled 1 = EFCOP Enabled FilterData Input Interrupt Enable Bit 10 (Read/write control bit) 0 = Interrupt disabled 1 = Interrupt enabled Filter Type Bit 1 0 = FIR 1 = IIR FilterData Output Interrupt Enable Bit 11 (Read/write control bit) 0 = Interrupt disabled 1 = Interrupt enabled Adaptive Mode Enable Bit 2 0 = Adaptive Mode Disabled 1 = Adaptive Mode Enabled Update Mode Enable Bit 3 0 = Update Mode Disabled 1 = Update Mode Enabled FilterSaturation Bit 12 (Read only status bit) 0 = No FMAC underflow/overflow 1 = FMAC underflow/overflow occurred Filter Operating ModeBits 5–4 00 = Real 10 = Alt. Complex 01 = Complex 11 = Magnitude FilterContention Bit 13 (Read only status bit) 0 = No dual access occurred 1 = Core and EFCOP tried to access the same bank in FDM or FCM Channels Bit 6 0 = Single channel 1 = Multichannel Initialization Bit 7 0 = Preprocess initialization 1 = No initialization Filter Data Input Buffer Empty Bit 14 (Read only status bit) 0 = FDIR is not empty 1 = FDIR is empty Coefficients Bit 8 0 = Not shared 1 = Shared Filter Data Output Buffer Full Bit 15 (Read only status bit) 0 = FDOR is not full 1 = FDOR is full 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 FD FD F FSAT FDOE FDIE OBF IBE CONT *0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 FSCO FPCR FMLC FOM1FOM0 FUPD FADP FLT EFCOP Control Status Register (FCSR) Y:$FFFFB4 Read/Write Reset = $000000 0 FEN * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-25 EFCOP Counter and Control Status Registers (FCNT and FCSR) Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com E-41 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Programming Reference EFCOP Saturation Mode Bit 4 0 = Disabled 1 = Enabled Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Sixteen-bit Arithmetic Mode Bit 5 0 = Disabled 1 = Enabled Filter Rounding Mode Bits 3–2 00 = Convergent 10 = Two’s complement 01 = Truncation 11 = Reserved Filter Scaling Bits 1–0 00 = ¥ 1 10 = ¥ 16 01 = ¥ 8 11 = Reserved Filter Input Scaling Bit 6 0 = Not used 1 = Used 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 *0 EFCOP ALU Control Register (FACR) Y:$FFFFB5 Read/Write 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Reset = $000000 8 5 4 FISL FSA FSM 3 2 Rounding Mode 1 0 Filter Scaling = Reserved, Program as 0 * 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Data Base Address (FDM Pointer) EFCOP Data Base Address (FDBA) Y:$FFFFB6 Read/Write Reset = $000000 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 2 1 0 Coefficient Base Address (FDM Pointer) EFCOP Coefficient Base Address (FCBA) Y:$FFFFB7 Read/Write Reset = $000000 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 Filter Deci0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 mation Value ************ 7 6 *0 *0 EFCOP Decimation/Channel Count Register (FDCH) Y:$FFFFB8 Read/Write Reset = $000000 5 4 3 Filter Channels Value * = Reserved, Program as 0 Figure E-26 EFCOP FACR, FDBA, FCBA, and FDCH Registers Not Recommended for New Design E-42 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. INDEX Numerics S8 11-9 8051 4-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... A AAR see Address Attribute Registers adaptive filter 10-3 adder modulo 1-9 offset 1-9 reverse-carry 1-9 Address Arithmetic Logic Unit (Address ALU) 1-9 Address Attribute Registers (AAR1-AAR4) 4-19 address bus 2-3 Address Generation Unit 1-9 addressing modes 1-10 AGU see Address Generation Unit ALC bit 7-13 Alignment Control bit (ALC) 7-13 ALU see Address Arithmetic Logic Unit see Data Arithmetic Logic Unit Asynchronous/Synchronous bit (SYN) 7-18 B BA3ÐBA10 bits 6-12 barrel shifter 1-8 Base Address bits (BA3ÐBA10) 6-12 bit, sticky 10-4 bootstrap 3-3, 3-5, 4-8 from byte-wide external memory 4-6 program 4-8 program options, invoking 4-9 through HI08 (ISA) 4-7 through HI08 (MC68302/68360) 4-8 through HI08 (multiplexed) 4-7 through HI08 (non-multiplexed) 4-7 through SCI 4-6 Bootstrap mode 0 4-5 Bootstrap mode 1 4-6 Bootstrap mode 3 (reserved) 4-6 Bootstrap mode 4 4-7 Bootstrap mode 6 4-7 Bootstrap mode 7 4-8 Bootstrap mode 8 4-5 Boundary Scan Description Language listing C-3 Boundary Scan Register (BSR) 4-20, 12-7 break 8-9 Breakpoint 0 and 1 Event bits (BT0ÐBT1) 11-14 Breakpoint 0 Condition Code Select bits (CC00ÐCC01) 11-13 Breakpoint 0 Read/Write Select bits (RW00ÐRW01) 11-12 Breakpoint 1 Condition Code Select bits (CC10ÐCC11) 11-14 Breakpoint 1 Read/Write Select bits (RW10ÐRW11) 11-13 BSDL listing C-3 BSR see Boundary Scan Register BT0ÐBT1 bits 11-14 bus address 2-4 control 2-3 data 2-4 external address 2-8 external data 2-8 internal 1-13 multiplexed 2-4 non-multiplexed 2-4 BYPASS instruction 12-11 C CC00ÐCC01 bits 11-13 CC10ÐCC11 bits 11-14 CD0ÐCD11 bits 8-16 cellular base station 10-3 Central Processing Unit (CPU) 1-3 CFSP bit 7-17 chip derivative number 12-10 CKP bit 7-18 CLAMP instruction 12-10 clock 1-7, 2-3, 2-7 Clock Divider bits (CD0ÐCD11) 8-16 Clock Generator (CLKGEN) 1-11 Clock Out Divider bit (COD) 8-16 Clock Polarity bit (CKP) 7-18 Clock Source Direction bit (SCKD) 7-16 CMOS 1-7 COD bit 8-16 code bootstrap programs A-1 BSDL listing C-1 compatible 1-7 equates B-1 real FIR filter with polling D-8 Command Vector Register (CVR) 6-25 Control Register A 7-11 bit 11ÑPrescaler Range bit (PSR) 7-11 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com I-1 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. bit 17Ñreserved bit 7-13 bit 18ÑAlignment Control bit (ALC) 7-13 bit 22ÑSelect SC1 as Transmitter 0 Drive Enable bit (SSC1) 7-14 bits 0Ð7ÑPrescale Modulus Select bits (PM0ÐPM7) 7-11 bits 12Ð16ÑFrame Rate Divider Control bits (DC4ÐDC0) 7-12 bits 19Ð21ÑWord Length Control bits (WL0ÐWL1) 7-14 bits 8Ð10Ñreserved bits 7-11 reserved bitsÑbit 17 7-13 reserved bitsÑbit 23 7-14 reserved bitsÑbits 8Ð10 7-11 see also ESSI Control Register B 7-15 see also ESSI core number 12-10 Core Status bits (OS0ÐOS1) 11-9 CRA see Control Register A CRB see Control Register B cross-correlation filtering 10-3 CVR see Command Vector Register D design center number 12-10 DFI 10-3 DFII 10-3 DI bit 9-13 DIR bit 9-13 Direct Form 1 10-3 Direct Form 2 10-3 Direct Memory Access (DMA) EFCOP and 10-4 Request Source bits (DRS4-DRS0) 4-15 restrictions on EFCOP 10-8 triggered by timer 9-27 Direction bit (DIR) 9-13 DMA see Direct Memory Access DO bit 9-13 DO loop 1-10 Double Data Strobe 2-4 Double Host Request bit (HDRQ) 6-23 DRAM 1-13 DS 2-4 DSP56300 core 1-3 DSP56300 Family Manual 1-3, 1-7 DSP56307 Technical Data 1-3 dynamic memory configuration switching 3-10 E Data Arithmetic Logic Unit 1-8 Multiplier-Accumulator (MAC) 1-8 registers 1-8 data bus 2-3 Data Input bit (DI) 9-13 Data Output bit (DO) 9-13 data/coefficient transfer contention bit 10-4 DC4ÐDC0 bits 7-12 DE signal 2-33, 11-4 Debug Event signal (DE signal) 2-33, 11-4 Debug mode acknowledging 12-11 entering 2-33, 11-4, 12-3, 12-11 external indication 2-33 JTAG port and 12-3, 12-7 OnCE module and 11-4, 11-16 public instructions for 12-7 warning 3-11 DEBUG_REQUEST instruction 12-11 executing during Stop state 11-17 executing during Wait state 11-17 executing in OnCE module 11-17 decimation 10-3, 10-6, 10-7, 10-10, 10-20 example (sequence of even real numbers) D-14 Decimation/Channel Count Register 10-20 echo cancellation 10-3 echo cancellation filter D-15 EFCOP 1-4, 1-18, 10-1 block diagram 10-4 control and status registers 10-5 core transfers 10-4 DMA restrictions 10-7 DMA transfers 10-4 FACR 10-17 FCBA 10-19 FCM 10-7 FCNT 10-11 FCSR 10-12 FDBA 10-18 FDCH 10-20 FDIR 10-10 FDM 10-7 FDOR 10-10 Filter Coefficient Memory bank 10-4 Filter Data Memory 10-4 FKIR 10-10 FMAC 10-9 general description 10-4 initialization 10-3 Not Recommended for New Design I-2 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. input data buffer 10-4 interrupt vector table 10-9 interrupts B-18 memory bank base address pointers 10-4 memory banks 10-7 memory organization 10-7 PMB 10-4, 10-5 programming 1-4, D-1 programming model 10-9 Saturation mode 10-9 Sixteen-bit Arithmetic mode 10-9 ENABLE_ONCE instruction 12-11 Enhanced Filter Coprocessor (EFCOP) 1-6, 1-18, 10-1 Enhanced Synchronous Serial Interface (ESSI) 2-3, 2-22, 2-25, 7-3 see also ESSI equalization 10-3 ESSI 1-16, 2-3, 2-4, 2-22, 2-25, 7-3 after reset 7-35 Asynchronous modes 7-39 asynchronous operating mode 7-39 byte format 7-41 Control Register A 7-11 Control Register B 7-15 data and control signals 7-4 exceptions 7-36 flags 7-42 frame sync length 7-40 frame sync polarity 7-41 frame sync selection 7-40 frame sync word length 7-41 GPIO functionality 7-42 initialization 7-35 interrupts 7-36, B-17 Network mode 7-39 Normal mode 7-39 operating mode 7-35 operating modes 7-35, 7-39 Port Control Register (PCR) 7-43 Port Control Registers (C and D) 7-43 Port Data Register (PDR) 7-44 Port Data Registers (C and D) 7-44 Port Direction Register (PRR) 7-44 Port Direction Registers (C and D) 7-44 programming model 7-9 Receive Data Register 7-32 Receive Shift Register 7-32 Receive Slot Mask Registers 7-9, 7-34 Received Data Register 7-9 reset 7-35 SC0 7-6 SC1 7-7 SC2 7-8 SCK 7-5 SRD 7-4 Status Register 7-27 status register 7-9 STD 7-4 Synchronous modes 7-39 synchronous operating mode 7-39 Time Slot Register 7-9, 7-33 Transmit Data Registers 7-33 Transmit Shift Registers 7-32 Transmit Slot Mask Registers 7-9, 7-33 word length frame sync timing 7-41 ESSI Control Register A (CRA) 7-11 ESSI Control Registers 7-9 see also Control Register A, B ESSI Mode Select bit (MOD) 7-20 ESSI programming model 7-9 ESSI Receive Data Register (RX) 7-32 ESSI Receive Enable bit (RE) 7-25 ESSI Receive Exception Interrupt Enable bit (REIE) 7-27 ESSI Receive Interrupt Enable bit (RIE) 7-26 ESSI Receive Last Slot Interrupt Enable bit (RLIE) 7-27 ESSI Receive Shift Register 7-32 ESSI Receive Slot Mask Registers (RSMA, RSMB) 7-34 ESSI Status Register (SSISR) 7-27 ESSI Time Slot Register (TSR) 7-33 ESSI Transmit 0 Enable bit (TE0) 7-24 ESSI Transmit 1 Enable bit (TE1) 7-23 ESSI Transmit 2 Enable bit (TE2) 7-22 ESSI Transmit Data Registers 7-9 ESSI Transmit Data registers (TX2, TX1, TX0) 7-33 ESSI Transmit Exception Interrupt Enable bit (TEIE) 7-27 ESSI Transmit Interrupt Enable bit (TIE) 7-26 ESSI Transmit Last Slot Interrupt Enable bit (TLIE) 7-26 ESSI Transmit Shift Registers 7-32 ESSI Transmit Slot Mask Registers (TSMA, TSMB) 7-33 ESSI0 (GPIO) 5-3 ESSI1 (GPIO) 5-4 EX bit 11-7 Exit Command bit (EX) 11-7 expanded mode 4-5 expansion memory 3-3 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com I-3 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. external address bus 2-8 external bus control 2-8, 2-10, 2-11 external data bus 2-8 external memory expansion port 2-8 external Y I/O space 3-9 EXTEST instruction 12-8 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... F FCM 10-4 FDM 10-4 FE bit 8-15 filter adaptive 10-3 cross-correlation 10-3 echo cancellation D-15 FIR 10-3 IIR 10-3 multichannel 10-3 Filter ALU Control Register 10-17 Filter Coefficient Base Address 10-19 Filter Coefficient Memory 10-4 Filter Control Status Register 10-12 Filter Count Register 10-11 Filter Data Base Address 10-18 Filter Data Input Register 10-10 Filter Data Memory bank 10-4 Filter Data Output Register 10-10 Filter K-Constant Input Register 10-10 Filter Multiplier and Accumulator 10-9 Finite Impulse Response filter 10-3 FIR filter 10-3 mode 10-3 Real mode (0) D-6 Adaptive mode D-6 no decimation D-6, D-15 DMA and interrupts D-18 polling D-8, D-17 decimation by 2 D-14 Frame Rate Divider Control bits (DC4ÐDC0) 7-12 Frame Sync Length bits (FSL1ÐFSL0) 7-17 Frame Sync Polarity bit (FSP) 7-17 Frame Sync Relative Timing bit (FSR) 7-17 frame sync selection ESSI 7-40 Framing Error Flag bit (FE) 8-15 frequency operation 1-7 FSL1ÐFSL0 bits 7-17 FSR bit 7-17 functional groups 2-4 functional signal groups 2-3 G Global Data Bus 1-13 GO Command bit (GO) 11-7 GPIO 1-15, 2-4 on HI08 6-30 Timers 2-4 GPIO (ESSI0, Port C) 5-3 GPIO (ESSI1, Port D) 5-4 GPIO (HI08, Port B) 5-3 GPIO (SCI, Port E) 5-4 GPIO (Timer) 5-4 GPIO functionality on ESSI 7-42 Ground 2-6 PLL 2-6 ground 2-3 H HA8EN bit 6-14 HA9EN bit 6-14 HAEN bit 6-14 HAP bit 6-17 hardware stack 1-10 HASP bit 6-15 HBAR register 6-12 HC bit 6-25 HCIE bit 6-10 HCP bit 6-11 HCR register 6-9, 6-10 HCSEN bit 6-14 HCSP bit 6-16 HDDS bit 6-16 HDR register 6-18 HDRQ bit 6-23 HDSP bit 6-15 HEN bit 6-15 HF0 bit 6-24 HF0, HF1 bits 6-12 HF1 bit 6-24 HF2 bit 6-27 HF2, HF3 bits 6-10 HF3 bit 6-27 HGEN bit 6-13 HI08 1-16, 2-3, 2-4, 2-16, 2-17, 2-19, 2-20, 2-21, 6-3 (GPIO) 5-3 data transfer 6-31 Not Recommended for New Design I-4 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. DSP core interrupts 6-20 DSP side control registers 6-8 DSP side data registers 6-8 DSP side registers after reset 6-19 DSP to host data word 6-4 handshaking protocols 6-5 interrupts 6-5 mapping 6-4 transfer modes 6-5 external host programmerÕs model 6-21 GPIO 6-30 HI08 to DSP core interface 6-3 HI08 to host processor interface 6-4 Host Base Address Register (HBAR) 6-12 Host Control Register (HCR) 6-9, 6-10 Host Data Direction Register (HDDR) 6-17 Host Data Register (HDR) 6-18 Host Port Control Register (HPCR) 2-16, 2-17, 2-18, 2-19, 2-20, 2-21, 6-7, 6-8, 6-13, 6-14, 6-15, 6-16, 6-17, 6-19, 6-30, 6-35, 6-36, 6-37, A-6, A-7, A-8, E-7, E-23 Host Receive Data Register (HRX) 6-9 host side Command Vector Register (CVR) 6-25 Interface Control Register (ICR) 6-22 Interface Status Register (ISR) 6-26 Interface Vector Register (IVR) 6-28 Receive Byte Registers (RXH, RXM, RXL) 6-28 registers after reset 6-30 Transmit Byte Registers (TXH, TXM, TXL) 6-29 Host Status Register (HSR) 6-11 host to DSP data word 6-3 handshaking protocols 6-4 instructions 6-4 mapping 6-3 transfer modes 6-3 Host Transmit Data Register (HTX) 6-9 polling 6-31 registers 6-7 servicing interrupts 6-33 HI-Z instruction 12-10 HLEND bit 6-24 HMUX bit 6-15 Host Acknowledge Enable bit (HAEN) 6-14 Host Acknowledge Polarity bit (HAP) 6-17 Host Address Line 8 Enable bit (HA8EN) 6-14 Host Address Line 9 Enable bit (HA9EN) 6-14 Host Address Strobe Polarity bit (HASP) 6-15 Host Base Address Register (HBAR) 6-12 Host Chip Select Enable bit (HCSEN) 6-14 Host Chip Select Polarity bit (HCSP) 6-16 Host Command bit (HC) 6-25 Host Command Interrupt Enable bit (HCIE) 6-10 Host Command Pending bit (HCP) 6-11 Host Control Register (HCR) 6-9, 6-10 Host Data Direction Register (HDDR) 6-17 Host Data Register (HDR) 6-18 Host Data Strobe Polarity bit (HDSP) 6-15 Host Dual Data Strobe bit (HDDS) 6-16 Host Enable bit (HEN) 6-15 Host Flag 0 and 1 bits (HF0, HF1) 6-12 Host Flag 0 bit (HF0) 6-24 Host Flag 1 bit (HF1) 6-24 Host Flag 2 and 3 bits (HF2, HF3) 6-10 Host Flag 2 bit (HF2) 6-27 Host Flag 3 bit (HF3) 6-27 Host GPIO Port Enable bit (HGEN) 6-13 Host Inteface 2-3 Host Interface 2-4, 2-16, 2-17, 2-19, 2-20, 2-21, 6-3 Host Little Endian bit (HLEND) 6-24 Host Multiplexed Bus bit (HMUX) 6-15 Host Port Control Register (HPCR) 2-16, 2-17, 2-18, 2-19, 2-20, 2-21, 6-7, 6-8, 6-13, 6-14, 6-15, 6-16, 6-17, 6-19, 6-30, 6-35, 6-36, 6-37, A-6, A-7, A-8, E-7, E-23 Host Receive Data Full bit (HRDF) 6-11 Host Receive Data Register (HRX) 6-9 Host Receive Interrupt Enable bit (HRIE) 6-10 Host Request Double 2-4 Single 2-4 Host Request Enable bit (HREN) 6-14 Host Request Open Drain bit (HROD) 6-15 Host Request Polarity bit (HRP) 6-16 Host Status Register (HSR) 6-11 Host Transmit Data Empty bit (HTDE) 6-11 Host Transmit Data Register (HTX) 6-9 Host Transmit Interrupt Enable bit (HTIE) 6-10 Host Vector bits (HV0ÐHV6) 6-25 HPCR register 2-16-2-21, 6-7-6-19, 6-30, 6-35, 6-36, 6-37, A-6-A-8, E-7, E-23 HR 2-4 HRDF bit 6-11 HREN bit 6-14 HREQ bit 6-27 HRIE bit 6-10 HROD bit 6-15 HRP bit 6-16 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com I-5 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. HRX register 6-9 HSR register 6-11 HTDE bit 6-11 HTIE bit 6-10 HTX register 6-9 HV0ÐHV6 bits 6-25 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... I I/O space external Y data Memory 3-9 X data Memory 3-7 Y data Memory 3-9 ICR register 6-22 IDCODE instruction 12-9 Idle Line Flag bit (IDLE) 8-14 Idle Line Interrupt Enable bit (ILIE) 8-11 IF0 bit 7-27 IF1 bit 7-28 IIR filter 10-3 scaling 10-3 ILIE bit 8-11 IME bit 11-8 Infinite Impulse Response filter 10-3 INIT bit 6-24 initialization EFCOP 10-3 Initialize bit (INIT) 6-24 Instruction Cache 3-5 instruction cache 3-3 instruction set 1-7 Interface Control Register (ICR) 6-22 Interface Status Register (ISR) 6-26 Interface Vector Register (IVR) 6-28 internal buses 1-13 internal program memory 3-3 internal Y data Memory 3-8 Internal Y I/O space 3-9 interrupt 1-10 ESSI 7-36 HI08 6-20 priority levels 4-12 servicing on HI08 6-33 sources 4-9 interrupt and mode control 2-3, 2-13 interrupt control 2-13 Interrupt Mode Enable bit (IME) 11-8 Interrupt Priority Levels 4-12 Interrupt Priority Register P (IPRÑP) 4-12 Interrupt Source Priorities 4-13 Interrupt Sources 4-9 interrupts DMA B-17 EFCOP B-18 ending address B-18 ESSI B-17 host B-17 non-maskable B-16 request pins B-16 SCI B-17 timer B-17 INV bit 9-11 Inverter bit (INV) 9-11 IPRÑP 4-12 ISR Host Request bit (HREQ) 6-27 ISR register 6-26 IVR register 6-28 J Joint Test Action Group (JTAG) 1-7, 1-11, 12-3 BSR 4-20 interface 2-31 JTAG 1-11 JTAG instructions BYPASS instruction 12-11 CLAMP instruction 12-10 DEBUG_REQUEST instruction 12-11 ENABLE_ONCE instruction 12-11 EXTEST instruction 12-8 HI-Z instruction 12-10 IDCODE instruction 12-9 SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction 12-9 JTAG/OnCE Interface signals Debug Event signal (DE signal) 2-33, 11-4 K K-constant 10-3 L LA register 1-10 LC register 1-10 logic 1-7 Loop Address register (LA) 1-10 Loop Counter register (LC) 1-10 M MAC 1-8 Manual Conventions 1-4 Not Recommended for New Design I-6 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. MBO bit 11-8 MBS0ÐMBS1 bits 11-12 memory allocation switching 3-4 configuration 3-10 dynamic switching 3-10 enabling breakpoints 11-18 expansion 1-12, 3-3 external expansion port 1-12 maps 3-11 off-chip 1-12 on-chip 1-12 shared 10-4 Memory Breakpoint Occurrence bit (MBO) 11-8 Memory Breakpoint Select bits (MBS0ÐMBS1) 11-12 memory maps 3-11, 3-12, 3-13, 3-14, 3-15, 3-16, 3-17, 3-18, 3-19, 3-20, 3-21, 3-22, 3-23, 3-24, 3-25, 3-26, 3-27, 3-28, 3-29, 3-30, 3-31 Memory Switch mode 3-4 X data Memory 3-6 Y data Memory 3-8 MF bits 4-18 MIPS 1-7 mobile switching center 10-3 MOD bit 7-20 mode control 2-13 Mode Select bit (MOD) 7-20 modulo adder 1-9 Motorola Design Center Number 12-10 Motorola Manufacturer Identity 12-10 Motorola Semiconductor IsraeL (MSIL) Design Center Number 12-10 multichannel filter 10-3 multiplexed bus 2-4 Multiplication Factor bits (MF) 4-18 Multiplier-Accumulator (MAC) 1-8 N non-multiplexed bus 2-4 O OBCR register 11-11 ODEC 11-8 OF0ÐOF1 bits 7-15 off-chip memory expansion 3-3 offset adder 1-9 OGDBR register 11-19 OMAC0 comparator 11-11 OMAC1 comparator 11-11 OMAL register 11-11 OMBC counter 11-14 OMLR0 register 11-11 OMLR1 register 11-11 OMR 1-10, 4-16 OnCE 1-7 commands 11-23 controller 11-4 trace logic 11-15 OnCE Breakpoint Control Register (OBCR) 11-11 OnCE Command Register (OCR) 11-5 OnCE Decoder (ODEC) 11-8 OnCE GDB Register (OGDBR) 11-19 OnCE Memory Address Comparator 0 (OMAC0) 11-11 OnCE Memory Address Comparator 1 (OMAC1) 11-11 OnCE Memory Address Latch register (OMAL) 11-11 OnCE Memory Breakpoint Counter (OMBC) 11-14 OnCE Memory Limit Register 0 (OMLR0) 11-11 OnCE Memory Limit Register 1 (OMLR1) 11-11 OnCE module 1-4, 1-11, 11-3 checking for Debug mode 11-24 displaying a specified register 11-26 displaying X data memory 11-26 interaction with JTAG port 11-28 interface 2-31 polling the JTAG Instruction Shift register 11-24 reading the Trace buffer 11-25 returning to Normal mode 11-27 saving pipeline information 11-24 OnCE PAB Register for Decode Register (OPABDR) 11-20 OnCE PAB Register for Execute (OPABEX) 11-20 OnCE PAB Register for Fetch Register (OPABFR) 11-20 OnCE PIL Register (OPILR) 11-19 OnCE Program Data Bus Register (OPDBR) 11-19 OnCE Status and Control Register (OSCR) 11-8 OnCE Trace Counter (OTC) 11-16 OnCE/JTAG 2-4 OnCE/JTAG port 2-3 On-Chip Emulation (OnCE) module 1-11, 11-3 on-chip memory 1-12 OPABDR register 11-20 OPABEX register 11-20 OPABFR register 11-20 OPDBR register 11-19 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com I-7 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Operating 4-3 operating mode 4-3, 4-4 bootstrap from byte-wide external memory 4-6 bootstrap through HI08 (ISA) 4-7 bootstrap through HI08 (MC68302/68360) 4-8 bootstrap through HI08 (multiplexed) 4-7 bootstrap through HI08 (non-multiplexed) 4-7 bootstrap through SCI 4-6 ESSI 7-35, 7-39 expanded 4-5 expanded mode 4-5 Operating Mode Register 4-16 Operating Mode Register (OMR) 1-10 operating modes 4-3 OPILR register 11-19 OR bit 8-14 OS0ÐOS1 bits 11-9 OSCR register 11-8 OTC counter 11-16 Overrun Error Flag bit (OR) 8-14 P PAB 1-13 PAG 1-10 Parity Error bit (PE) 8-14 PC register 1-10 PC0-PC20 bits 9-9 PCE bit 9-14 PCRC register 7-43 PCRD register 7-43 PCRE register 8-27 PCTL 4-17 PCTL register 4-17 PCU 1-9 PD bits 4-17 PDB 1-13 PDC 1-10 PDRC register 7-44 PDRD register 7-44 PDRE register 8-28 PE bit 8-14 Peripheral I/O Expansion Bus 1-13 Peripheral Module Bus 10-4 PIC 1-10 PL0-PL20 bits 9-7 PL21-PL22 bits 9-7 PLL 1-11, 2-3, 2-7 PLL Control Register 4-17 PLL control register (PCTL) 4-17 PM0ÐPM7 bits 7-11 PMB 10-4, 10-5 pointers EFCOP memory bank base address 10-4 Port A 2-3, 2-8 Port B 2-3, 2-4, 2-19, 5-3 Port C 2-3, 2-4, 2-22, 5-3 Port C and D control registers 7-42 Port C Control Register (PCRC) 7-43 Port C Data Register (PDRC) 7-44 Port C Direction Register (PRRC) 7-44 Port D 2-3, 2-4, 2-25, 5-4 Port D Control Register (PCRD) 7-43 Port D Data Register (PDRD) 7-44 Port D Direction Register (PRRD) 7-44 Port E 2-3, 5-4 Port E Control Register (PCRE) 8-27 Port E Data Register (PDRE) 8-28 Port E Direction Register (PRRE) 8-27 position independent code 1-10 power 2-3, 2-5 low 1-7 management 1-7 standby modes 1-7 PreDivider Factor bits (PD) 4-17 Prescale Modulus Select bits (PM0ÐPM7) 7-11 Prescaler Clock Enable bit (PCE) 9-14 Prescaler Counter 9-7 Prescaler Counter Value bits (PC0-PC20) 9-9 Prescaler Load Value bits (PL0-PL20) 9-7 Prescaler Range bit (PSR) 7-11 Prescaler Source bits (PL21-PL22) 9-7 Program Address Bus (PAB) 1-13 Program Address Generator (PAG) 1-10 Program Control Unit (PCU) 1-9 Program Counter register (PC) 1-10 Program Data Bus (PDB) 1-13 Program Decode Controller (PDC) 1-10 Program Interrupt Controller (PIC) 1-10 Program Memory Expansion Bus 1-13 Program RAM 3-3 Program ROM bootstrap 3-3 programming model EFCOP 10-9 ESSI 7-9 SCI 8-4 Programming Sheets Ñ See Appendix B PRRC register 7-44 PRRD register 7-44 PRRE register 8-27 PSR bit 7-11 Not Recommended for New Design I-8 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... R R/W bit 11-7 R8 bit 8-15 RAM Program 3-3 RCM bit 8-17 RDF bit 7-29 RDRF bit 8-14 RE bit 8-10 Read/Write Command bit (R/W) 11-7 Receive Byte Registers (RXH, RXM, RXL) 6-28 Receive Clock Mode Source bit (RCM) 8-17 Receive Data Register (RX) 7-32 Receive Data Register Full bit (RDF) 7-29 Receive Data Register Full bit (RDRF) 8-14 Receive Data Register Full bit (RXDF) 6-26 Receive Data signal (RXD) 8-3 Receive Exception Interrupt Enable bit (REIE) 7-27 Receive Frame Sync Flag bit (RFS) 7-28 Receive Interrupt Enable bit (RIE) 7-26, 8-12 Receive Last Slot Interrupt Enable bit (RLIE) 7-27 Receive Request Enable bit (RREQ) 6-23 Receive Shift Register 7-32 Receive Slot Mask Registers (RSMA, RSMB) 7-34 Received Bit 8 Address bit (R8) 8-15 Receiver Enable bit (RE) 8-10 Receiver Overrun Error Flag bit (ROE) 7-29 Receiver Wakeup Enable bit (SBK) 8-9 Register Select bits (RS0ÐRS4) 11-5 REIE bit 7-27, 8-13 reserved bits in Control Register A 7-11, 7-13 in CRA register 7-14 in HBAR register bits 5Ð15 6-12 in HCR register bits 5Ð15 6-11 in HPC register bit 7 6-15 in HSR register bits 5Ð15 6-12 in ICR register bit 6 6-24 in ISR register bit 5 6-27 bit 6 6-27 in OBCR register bits 12Ð15 11-15 in OSCR register bit 5, bits 8Ð23 11-9 in TCSR register bits 3, 10, 14, 16Ð19, 22, 23 9-14 in TPLR 9-8 RESET 2-13 reset bus signals 2-8, 2-9 clock signals 2-7 essi signals 2-22, 2-25 host interface signals 2-16 interrupt signals 2-13 JTAG signals 2-32 mode control 2-13 OnCE signals 2-32 phase lock loop signals 2-7 sci signals 2-28 timers 2-30 reverse-carry adder 1-9 RFS bit 7-28 RIE bit 7-26, 8-12 RLIE bit 7-27 ROE bit 7-29 ROM bootstrap 3-3, 3-5 RREQ bit 6-23 RS0ÐRS4 bits 11-5 RSMA and RSMB 7-9, 7-34 RSMA, RSMB registers 7-34 RW00ÐRW01 bits 11-12 RW10ÐRW11 bits 11-13 RWU bit 8-9 RX 7-9, 7-32 RX register 7-32 RXD 8-3 RXD signal 8-3 RXDF bit 6-26 RXH, RXM, RXL registers 6-28 S SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction 12-9 saturation status bit 10-4 SBK bit 8-9 SC register 1-10 SC0 7-6 SC0 signal 7-6, 7-7, 7-8 SC1 7-7 SC2 7-8 SCCR 8-15 SCD0 bit 7-16 SCD1 bit 7-16 SCD2 bit 7-16 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com I-9 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SCI 1-17, 2-4, 2-28, 8-3 Clock Control Register 8-15 Control Register 8-8 data registers 8-18 exceptions 8-26 Idle Line 8-26 Receive Data 8-26 Receive Data with Exception Status 8-26 Timer 8-26 Transmit Data 8-26 GPIO functionality 8-27 I/O signals 8-3 initialization 8-24 example 8-25 interrupts B-17 operating mode Asynchronous 8-21 Synchronous 8-21 operating modes 8-21 Asynchronous 8-21 programming model 8-4 Receive Data 8-3 Receive Register 8-19 reset 8-22 state after reset 8-23 Serial Clock 8-4 Status Register 8-13 transmission priority preamble, break, and data 8-26 Transmit Data 8-4 Transmit Register 8-20 SCI (GPIO) 5-4 SCI Clock Control Register (SCCR) 8-15 SCI Clock Polarity bit (SCKP) 8-12 SCI Clock Prescaler bit (SCP) 8-17 SCI Control Register (SCR) 8-8 SCI exceptions Receive Data 8-26 SCI pins RXD, TXD, SCLK 8-3 SCI Receive Register (SRX) 8-19 SCI Receive with Exception Interrupt bit (REIE) 8-13 SCI Serial Clock signal (SCLK) 8-4 SCI Shift Direction bit (SSFTD) 8-9 SCI Status Register (SSR) 8-13 SCI Transmit Register (STX) STX register 8-20 SCK 7-5 SCK signal 7-5 SCKD bit 7-16 SCKP bit 8-12 SCLK 8-4 SCLK signal 8-4 SCP bit 8-17 SCR 8-8 SCR register 8-8 Select SC1 as Transmitter 0 Drive Enable bit (SSC1) 7-14 Send Break bit (SBK) 8-9 Serial Clock 7-5 Serial Clock signal (SCK) 7-5 Serial Communication Interface 2-28 Serial Communications Interface 8-3 Serial Communications Interface (SCI) 1-17, 2-3, 8-3 Serial Control 0 7-6 Serial Control 0 Direction bit (SCD0) 7-16 serial control 0 signal (SC0) 7-6, 7-7, 7-8 Serial Control 1 7-7 Serial Control 1 Direction bit (SCD1) 7-16 Serial Control 2 7-8 Serial Control 2 Direction bit (SCD2) 7-16 Serial Input Flag 0 bit (IF0) 7-27 Serial Input Flag 1 bit (IF1) 7-28 Serial Output Flag bits (OF0ÐOF1) 7-15 serial protocol in OnCE module 11-22 Serial Receive Data 7-4 Serial Receive Data signal (SRD) 7-4 Serial Transmit Data 7-4 Serial Transmit Data signal (STD) 7-4 shared memory 10-4 SHFD bit 7-17 Shift Direction bit (SHFD) 7-17 signal groupings 2-3 signals 2-3 ESSI data and control 7-4 functional grouping 2-4 Single Data Strobe 2-4 Sixteen-bit Compatibility mode 3-11 Size register (SZ) 1-10 Software Debug Occurrence bit (SWO) 11-8 SP 1-10 SR register 1-10 SRAM interfacing 1-13 SRD 7-4 SRD signal 7-4 SRX 8-19 read as SRXL, SRXM, SRXH 8-19 SRX register 8-19 Not Recommended for New Design I-10 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. SS 1-10 SSC1 bit 7-14 SSFTD bit 8-9 SSISR 7-9, 7-27 SSISR register 7-27 SSR 8-13 SSR register 8-13 Stack Counter register (SC) 1-10 Stack Pointer (SP) 1-10 standby mode Stop 1-7 Wait 1-7 Status Register (SR) 1-10 STD 7-4 STD signal 7-4 sticky bits 10-4 STIR bit 8-12 stop standby mode 1-7 STX 8-20 STX register read as STXL, STXM. STXH, and STXA 8-20 switching memory configuration dynamically 3-10 switching memory sizes 3-4 SWO bit 11-8 SYN bit 7-18 System Stack (SS) 1-10 SZ register 1-10 T TAP 1-11 TAP controller 12-6 TC0ÐTC3 bits 9-10 TCF bit 9-14 TCIE bit 9-9 TCK pin 12-5 TCM bit 8-18 TCPR register 9-15 TCR register 9-15 TCSR register 9-9 TDE bit 7-29 TDI pin 12-5 TDO pin 12-5 TDRE bit 8-13 TE bit 8-11, 9-9 TE0 bit 7-24 TE1 bit 7-23 TE2 bit 7-22 TEIE bit 7-27 Test Access Port (TAP) 1-11, 12-3 Test Clock Input pin (TCK) 12-5 Test Data Input pin (TDI) 12-5 Test Data Output pin (TDO) 12-5 Test Mode Select Input pin (TMS) 12-5 Test Reset Input pin (TRST) 12-5 TFS bit 7-28 TIE bit 7-26, 8-12 Time Slot Register (TSR) 7-33 timer interrupts B-17 special cases 9-27 Timer (GPIO) 5-4 Timer Compare Flag bit (TCF) 9-14 Timer Compare Interrupt Enable bit (TCIE) 9-9 Timer Compare Register (TCPR) 9-15 Timer Control bits (TC0ÐTC3) 9-10 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR) 9-9 Timer Count Register (TCR) 9-15 Timer Enable bit (TE) 9-9 Timer Interrupt Enable bit (TMIE) 8-12 Timer Interrupt Rate bit (STIR) 8-12 Timer Load Register (TLR) 9-14 timer mode mode 0ÑGPIO 9-17 mode 1Ñtimer pulse 9-17 mode 2Ñtimer toggle 9-18 mode 3Ñtimer event counter 9-19 mode 4Ñmeasurement input width 9-20 mode 5Ñmeasurement input period 9-21 mode 6Ñmeasurement capture 9-22 mode 7Ñpulse width modulation 9-23 mode 8Ñreserved 9-25 mode 9Ñwatchdog pulse 9-25 mode 10Ñmeasurement toggle 9-26 modes 11Ð15Ñreserved 9-26 Timer module 1-17 architecture 9-3 programming model 9-5 timer block diagram 9-4 Timer Overflow Flag bit (TOF) 9-14 Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable bit (TOIE) 9-9 Timer Prescaler Count Register (TPCR) 9-8 Timer Prescaler Load Register (TPLR) 9-7 Timer Reload Mode bit (TRM) 9-13 Timers 2-3, 2-4, 2-30 TLIE bit 7-26 TLR register 9-14 TME bit 11-8 TMIE bit 8-12 TMS pin 12-5 Not Recommended for New Design MOTOROLA DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com I-11 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. TO bit 11-9 TOF bit 9-14 TOIE bit 9-9 TPCR register 9-8 reserved bitsÑbits 21-23 9-9 TPLR register 9-7 reserved bitÑbit 23 9-8 Trace buffer 11-21 Trace mode enabling 11-18 in OnCE module 11-15 Trace Mode Enable bit (TME) 11-8 Trace Occurrence bit (TO) 11-9 transcoder basestation 10-3 Transmit 0 Enable bit (TE0) 7-24 Transmit 1 Enable bit (TE1) 7-23 Transmit 2 Enable bit (TE2) 7-22 Transmit Byte Registers (TXH, TXM, TXL) 6-29 Transmit Clock Source bit (TCM) 8-18 Transmit Data Register Empty bit (TDE) 7-29 Transmit Data Register Empty bit (TDRE) 8-13 Transmit Data Register Empty bit (TXDE) 6-26 Transmit Data signal (TXD) 8-4 Transmit Exception Interrupt Enable bit (TEIE) 7-27 Transmit Frame Sync Flag bit (TFS) 7-28 Transmit Interrupt Enable bit (TIE) 7-26, 8-12 Transmit Last Slot Interrupt Enable bit (TLIE) 7-26 Transmit Request Enable bit (TREQ) 6-23 Transmit Shift Registers 7-32 Transmit Slot Mask Registers (TSMA, TSMB) 7-33 Transmitter Empty bit (TRNE) 8-13 Transmitter Enable bit (TE) 8-11 Transmitter Ready bit (TRDY) 6-27 Transmitter Underrun Error Flag bit (TUE) 7-29 TRDY bit 6-27 TREQ bit 6-23 triple timer module 1-17 TRM bit 9-13 TRNE bit 8-13 TRST pin 12-5 TSMA and TSMB 7-9, 7-33 TSMA, TSMB registers 7-33 TSR 7-9, 7-33 TSR register 7-33 TUE bit 7-29 TX0ÐTX2 7-9, 7-33 TX2, TX1, TX0 registers 7-33 TXD 8-4 TXD signal 8-4 TXDE bit 6-26 TXH, TXM, TXL registers 6-29 V VBA register 1-10 Vector Base Address register (VBA) 1-10 vocoder 10-3 W wait standby mode 1-7 see also reset WAKE bit 8-9 Wakeup Mode Select bit (WAKE) 8-9 WDS0-WDS2 bits 8-8 Wired-OR Select bit (WOMS) 8-10 WL0ÐWL1 bits 7-14 WOMS bit 8-10 Word Length Control bits (WL0ÐWL1) 7-14 Word Select bits (WDS0-WDS2) 8-8 X X data memory 3-5 X I/O space 3-7 X Memory Address Bus (XAB) 1-13 X Memory Data Bus (XDB) 1-13 X Memory Expansion Bus 1-13 XAB 1-13 XDB 1-13 XTAL Disable bit (XTLD) 4-17 XTLD bit 4-17 Y Y data Memory 3-7 internal 3-8 Y I/O space 3-9 Y Memory Address Bus (YAB) 1-13 Y Memory Data Bus (YDB) 1-13 Y Memory Expansion Bus 1-13 YAB 1-13 YDB 1-13 Not Recommended for New Design I-12 DSP56307 User’s Manual For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com MOTOROLA Freescale Semiconductor, Inc... Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. DSP56307 OVERVIEW 1 SIGNAL/CONNECTION DESCRIPTIONS 2 MEMORY CONFIGURATION 3 CORE CONFIGURATION 4 GENERAL PURPOSE I/O 5 HOST INTERFACE (HI08) 6 ENHANCED SYNCHRONOUS SERIAL INTERFACE 7 SERIAL COMMUNICATION INTERFACE (SCI) 8 TIMER MODULE 9 ENHANCED FILTER COPROCESSOR (EFCOP) 10 ON-CHIP EMULATION MODULE 11 JTAG PORT 12 BOOTSTRAP PROGRAM A EQUATES B BSDL LISTING C EFCOP PROGRAMMING D PROGRAMMING REFERENCE E Not Recommended for New Design I INDEX For More Information On This Product, Go to: www.freescale.com